arc: Add prologue analysis
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 @node Sample Session
550 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
551
552 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
553 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
554 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
555
556 @iftex
557 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
558 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
559 @end iftex
560
561 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
562 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
563
564 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
565 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
566 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
567 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
568 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
569 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
570 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
571 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
572 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
573
574 @smallexample
575 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
576 $ @b{./m4}
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
582
583 @b{bar}
584 0000
585 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
586
587 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
588 @b{baz}
589 @b{Ctrl-d}
590 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
595
596 @smallexample
597 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
598 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
599 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
600 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
602 the conditions.
603 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
604 for details.
605
606 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
607 (@value{GDBP})
608 @end smallexample
609
610 @noindent
611 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
612 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
613 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
614 that examples fit in this manual.
615
616 @smallexample
617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
618 @end smallexample
619
620 @noindent
621 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
622 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
623 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
624 @code{break} command.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
628 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
633 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
634 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
638 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
639 @b{define(foo,0000)}
640
641 @b{foo}
642 0000
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
647 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
648 context where it stops.
649
650 @smallexample
651 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
652
653 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
654 at builtin.c:879
655 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
660 the next line of the current function.
661
662 @smallexample
663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
664 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
665 : nil,
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
670 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
671 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
672 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
679 @end smallexample
680
681 @noindent
682 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
683 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
684 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
685 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
686 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
687 stack frame for each active subroutine.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
691 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692 at input.c:530
693 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
694 at builtin.c:882
695 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
696 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
697 at macro.c:71
698 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
699 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
700 @end smallexample
701
702 @noindent
703 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
704 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
705 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
709 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
711 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
712 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
714 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
715 : xstrdup(rq);
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
717 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
722 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
723 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
724 (@code{print}) to see their values.
725
726 @smallexample
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
728 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
730 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
735 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
736 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
737
738 @smallexample
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
740 533 xfree(rquote);
741 534
742 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
743 : xstrdup (lq);
744 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
745 : xstrdup (rq);
746 537
747 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
748 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749 540 @}
750 541
751 542 void
752 @end smallexample
753
754 @noindent
755 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
756 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
757
758 @smallexample
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
760 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
762 540 @}
763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
764 $3 = 9
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
766 $4 = 7
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
771 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
772 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
773 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
774 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
775 assignments.
776
777 @smallexample
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
779 $5 = 7
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
781 $6 = 9
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
786 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
787 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
788 example that caused trouble initially:
789
790 @smallexample
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
792 Continuing.
793
794 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795
796 baz
797 0000
798 @end smallexample
799
800 @noindent
801 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
802 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
803 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @b{Ctrl-d}
807 Program exited normally.
808 @end smallexample
809
810 @noindent
811 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
812 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
813 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
814
815 @smallexample
816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
817 @end smallexample
818
819 @node Invocation
820 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
821
822 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
823 The essentials are:
824 @itemize @bullet
825 @item
826 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
827 @item
828 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
829 @end itemize
830
831 @menu
832 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
833 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
834 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
835 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
836 @end menu
837
838 @node Invoking GDB
839 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
840
841 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
842 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
843
844 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
845 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
846
847 The command-line options described here are designed
848 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
849 options may effectively be unavailable.
850
851 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
852 specifying an executable program:
853
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
856 @end smallexample
857
858 @noindent
859 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
860 specified:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
864 @end smallexample
865
866 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
867 to debug a running process:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
875 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
876
877 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
878 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
879 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
880 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
881 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
882
883 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
884 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
885 option processing.
886 @smallexample
887 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
888 @end smallexample
889 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
890 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
891
892 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
893 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
894 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
895
896 @smallexample
897 @value{GDBP} --silent
898 @end smallexample
899
900 @noindent
901 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
902 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
903
904 @noindent
905 Type
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} -help
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
913 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
914
915 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
916 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
917 @samp{-x} option is used.
918
919
920 @menu
921 * File Options:: Choosing files
922 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
923 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
924 @end menu
925
926 @node File Options
927 @subsection Choosing Files
928
929 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
930 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
931 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
932 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
933 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
934 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
935 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
936 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
937 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
938 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
939 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
940 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
941 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
942
943 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
944 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
945 argument and ignore it.
946
947 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
948 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
949 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
950 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
951 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
952
953 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
954 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
955 @c it.
956
957 @table @code
958 @item -symbols @var{file}
959 @itemx -s @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--symbols}
961 @cindex @code{-s}
962 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
963
964 @item -exec @var{file}
965 @itemx -e @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--exec}
967 @cindex @code{-e}
968 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
969 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
970
971 @item -se @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--se}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
974 file.
975
976 @item -core @var{file}
977 @itemx -c @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--core}
979 @cindex @code{-c}
980 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
981
982 @item -pid @var{number}
983 @itemx -p @var{number}
984 @cindex @code{--pid}
985 @cindex @code{-p}
986 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
987
988 @item -command @var{file}
989 @itemx -x @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--command}
991 @cindex @code{-x}
992 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
993 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
994 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
995
996 @item -eval-command @var{command}
997 @itemx -ex @var{command}
998 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
999 @cindex @code{-ex}
1000 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1001
1002 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1003 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1004
1005 @smallexample
1006 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1007 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1008 @end smallexample
1009
1010 @item -init-command @var{file}
1011 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1012 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1013 @cindex @code{-ix}
1014 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1015 after loading gdbinit files).
1016 @xref{Startup}.
1017
1018 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1019 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1020 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1021 @cindex @code{-iex}
1022 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1023 after loading gdbinit files).
1024 @xref{Startup}.
1025
1026 @item -directory @var{directory}
1027 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--directory}
1029 @cindex @code{-d}
1030 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1031
1032 @item -r
1033 @itemx -readnow
1034 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1035 @cindex @code{-r}
1036 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1037 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1038 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1039
1040 @end table
1041
1042 @node Mode Options
1043 @subsection Choosing Modes
1044
1045 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1046 batch mode or quiet mode.
1047
1048 @table @code
1049 @anchor{-nx}
1050 @item -nx
1051 @itemx -n
1052 @cindex @code{--nx}
1053 @cindex @code{-n}
1054 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1055 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1056
1057 @table @code
1058 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1059 This is the system-wide init file.
1060 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1061 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1062 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1063 have been processed.
1064 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1065 This is the init file in your home directory.
1066 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1067 command options have been processed.
1068 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1069 This is the init file in the current directory.
1070 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1071 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1072 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1073 @end table
1074
1075 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1076 For documentation on how to write command files,
1077 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1078
1079 @anchor{-nh}
1080 @item -nh
1081 @cindex @code{--nh}
1082 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1083 in your home directory.
1084 @xref{Startup}.
1085
1086 @item -quiet
1087 @itemx -silent
1088 @itemx -q
1089 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1090 @cindex @code{--silent}
1091 @cindex @code{-q}
1092 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1093 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1094
1095 @item -batch
1096 @cindex @code{--batch}
1097 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1098 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1099 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1100 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1101 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1102 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1103 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1104
1105 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1106 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1107 make this more useful, the message
1108
1109 @smallexample
1110 Program exited normally.
1111 @end smallexample
1112
1113 @noindent
1114 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1115 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1116 mode.
1117
1118 @item -batch-silent
1119 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1120 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1121 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1122 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1123 for an interactive session.
1124
1125 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1126 messages, for example.
1127
1128 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1129 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1130
1131 @item -return-child-result
1132 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1133 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1134 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1135
1136 @itemize @bullet
1137 @item
1138 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1139 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1140 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1141 @item
1142 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1143 @item
1144 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1145 the exit code will be -1.
1146 @end itemize
1147
1148 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1149 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1150 interface.
1151
1152 @item -nowindows
1153 @itemx -nw
1154 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1155 @cindex @code{-nw}
1156 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1157 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1158 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1159
1160 @item -windows
1161 @itemx -w
1162 @cindex @code{--windows}
1163 @cindex @code{-w}
1164 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1165 used if possible.
1166
1167 @item -cd @var{directory}
1168 @cindex @code{--cd}
1169 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1170 instead of the current directory.
1171
1172 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1173 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1174 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1175 @cindex @code{-D}
1176 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1177 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1178 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1179
1180 @item -fullname
1181 @itemx -f
1182 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1183 @cindex @code{-f}
1184 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1185 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1186 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1187 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1188 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1189 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1190 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1191 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1192 frame.
1193
1194 @item -annotate @var{level}
1195 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1196 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1197 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1198 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1199 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1200 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1201 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1202 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1203 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1204
1205 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1206 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1207
1208 @item --args
1209 @cindex @code{--args}
1210 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1211 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1212 This option stops option processing.
1213
1214 @item -baud @var{bps}
1215 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1216 @cindex @code{--baud}
1217 @cindex @code{-b}
1218 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1219 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -l @var{timeout}
1222 @cindex @code{-l}
1223 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1224 for remote debugging.
1225
1226 @item -tty @var{device}
1227 @itemx -t @var{device}
1228 @cindex @code{--tty}
1229 @cindex @code{-t}
1230 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1231 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1232
1233 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1234 @item -tui
1235 @cindex @code{--tui}
1236 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1237 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1238 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1239 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1240 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1241 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1242
1243 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1244 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1245 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1246 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1247 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1248 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1249
1250 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1251 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1252 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1253 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1254 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1255 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1256
1257 @item -write
1258 @cindex @code{--write}
1259 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1260 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1261 (@pxref{Patching}).
1262
1263 @item -statistics
1264 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1266 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1267
1268 @item -version
1269 @cindex @code{--version}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1271 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1272
1273 @item -configuration
1274 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1275 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1276 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1277 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1278
1279 @end table
1280
1281 @node Startup
1282 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1283 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1284
1285 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1286
1287 @enumerate
1288 @item
1289 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1290 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1291
1292 @item
1293 @cindex init file
1294 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1295 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1296 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1297 that file.
1298
1299 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1300 @item
1301 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1302 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1303 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1304 that file.
1305
1306 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1307 @item
1308 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1309 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1310 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1311 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1312 gets loaded.
1313
1314 @item
1315 Processes command line options and operands.
1316
1317 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1318 @item
1319 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1320 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1321 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1322 This is only done if the current directory is
1323 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1324 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1325 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1326 @value{GDBN}.
1327
1328 @item
1329 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1330 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1331 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1332 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1333
1334 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1335 you must do something like the following:
1336
1337 @smallexample
1338 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1339 @end smallexample
1340
1341 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1342 off too late.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1346 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1347 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1348
1349 @item
1350 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1351 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1352 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1353 @end enumerate
1354
1355 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1356 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1357 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1358 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1359 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1360 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1361
1362 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1363 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1364
1365 @cindex init file name
1366 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1367 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1368 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1369 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1370 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1371 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1372 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1373 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1374
1375
1376 @node Quitting GDB
1377 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1378 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1379 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1380
1381 @table @code
1382 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1383 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1384 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @itemx q
1386 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1387 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1388 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1389 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1390 error code.
1391 @end table
1392
1393 @cindex interrupt
1394 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1395 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1396 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1397 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1398 until a time when it is safe.
1399
1400 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1401 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1402 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1403
1404 @node Shell Commands
1405 @section Shell Commands
1406
1407 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1408 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1409 just use the @code{shell} command.
1410
1411 @table @code
1412 @kindex shell
1413 @kindex !
1414 @cindex shell escape
1415 @item shell @var{command-string}
1416 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1417 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1418 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1419 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1420 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1421 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1422 @end table
1423
1424 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1425 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1426 @value{GDBN}:
1427
1428 @table @code
1429 @kindex make
1430 @cindex calling make
1431 @item make @var{make-args}
1432 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1433 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1434 @end table
1435
1436 @node Logging Output
1437 @section Logging Output
1438 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1439 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1440
1441 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1442 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1443
1444 @table @code
1445 @kindex set logging
1446 @item set logging on
1447 Enable logging.
1448 @item set logging off
1449 Disable logging.
1450 @cindex logging file name
1451 @item set logging file @var{file}
1452 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1453 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1454 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1455 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1456 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1457 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1458 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1459 @kindex show logging
1460 @item show logging
1461 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1462 @end table
1463
1464 @node Commands
1465 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1466
1467 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1468 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1469 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1470 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1471 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1472
1473 @menu
1474 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1475 * Completion:: Command completion
1476 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1477 @end menu
1478
1479 @node Command Syntax
1480 @section Command Syntax
1481
1482 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1483 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1484 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1485 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1486 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1487 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1488
1489 @cindex abbreviation
1490 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1491 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1492 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1493 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1494 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1495 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1496 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1497
1498 @cindex repeating commands
1499 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1500 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1501 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1502 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1503 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1504 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1505 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1506
1507 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1508 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1509 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1510
1511 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1512 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1513 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1514 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1515 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1516
1517 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1518 @cindex comment
1519 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1520 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1521 Files,,Command Files}).
1522
1523 @cindex repeating command sequences
1524 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1525 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1526 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1527 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1528 for editing.
1529
1530 @node Completion
1531 @section Command Completion
1532
1533 @cindex completion
1534 @cindex word completion
1535 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1536 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1537 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1538 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1539
1540 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1541 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1542 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1543 enter it). For example, if you type
1544
1545 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1546 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1547 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1548 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1549 @smallexample
1550 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1551 @end smallexample
1552
1553 @noindent
1554 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1555 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1556
1557 @smallexample
1558 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1559 @end smallexample
1560
1561 @noindent
1562 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1563 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1564 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1565 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1566 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1567 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1568
1569 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1570 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1571 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1572 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1573 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1574 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1575 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1576 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1577 example:
1578
1579 @smallexample
1580 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1581 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1582 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1583 make_abs_section make_function_type
1584 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1585 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1586 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1587 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1588 @end smallexample
1589
1590 @noindent
1591 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1592 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1593 command.
1594
1595 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1596 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1597 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1598 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1599 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1600
1601 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1602 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1603 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1604
1605 @smallexample
1606 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1607 main
1608 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1609 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1610 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 @noindent
1614 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1615
1616 @table @code
1617 @kindex set max-completions
1618 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1619 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1620 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1621 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1622 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1623 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1624 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1625 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1626 completion slow.
1627 @kindex show max-completions
1628 @item show max-completions
1629 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1630 during completion.
1631 @end table
1632
1633 @cindex quotes in commands
1634 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1635 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1636 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1637 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1638 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1639 @value{GDBN} commands.
1640
1641 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1642 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1643 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1644 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1645 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1646 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1647 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1648 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1649 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1650 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1651 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1652
1653 @smallexample
1654 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1655 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1656 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1657 @end smallexample
1658
1659 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1660 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1661 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1662 place:
1663
1664 @smallexample
1665 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1666 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1667 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1668 @end smallexample
1669
1670 @noindent
1671 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1672 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1673 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1674
1675 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1676 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1677 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1678 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1679
1680 @cindex completion of structure field names
1681 @cindex structure field name completion
1682 @cindex completion of union field names
1683 @cindex union field name completion
1684 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1685 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1686 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1687 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1688 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1689 left-hand-side:
1690
1691 @smallexample
1692 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1693 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1694 to_data to_isatty to_write
1695 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1696 to_flush to_read
1697 @end smallexample
1698
1699 @noindent
1700 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1701 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1702 follows:
1703
1704 @smallexample
1705 struct ui_file
1706 @{
1707 int *magic;
1708 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1709 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1710 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1711 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1712 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1713 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1714 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1715 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1716 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1717 void *to_data;
1718 @}
1719 @end smallexample
1720
1721
1722 @node Help
1723 @section Getting Help
1724 @cindex online documentation
1725 @kindex help
1726
1727 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1728 using the command @code{help}.
1729
1730 @table @code
1731 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1732 @item help
1733 @itemx h
1734 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1735 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1736
1737 @smallexample
1738 (@value{GDBP}) help
1739 List of classes of commands:
1740
1741 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1742 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1743 data -- Examining data
1744 files -- Specifying and examining files
1745 internals -- Maintenance commands
1746 obscure -- Obscure features
1747 running -- Running the program
1748 stack -- Examining the stack
1749 status -- Status inquiries
1750 support -- Support facilities
1751 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1752 stopping the program
1753 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1754
1755 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1756 commands in that class.
1757 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1758 documentation.
1759 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1760 (@value{GDBP})
1761 @end smallexample
1762 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1763
1764 @item help @var{class}
1765 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1766 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1767 help display for the class @code{status}:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1771 Status inquiries.
1772
1773 List of commands:
1774
1775 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1776 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1777 info -- Generic command for showing things
1778 about the program being debugged
1779 show -- Generic command for showing things
1780 about the debugger
1781
1782 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1783 documentation.
1784 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1785 (@value{GDBP})
1786 @end smallexample
1787
1788 @item help @var{command}
1789 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1790 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1791
1792 @kindex apropos
1793 @item apropos @var{args}
1794 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1795 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1796 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1797
1798 @smallexample
1799 apropos alias
1800 @end smallexample
1801
1802 @noindent
1803 results in:
1804
1805 @smallexample
1806 @c @group
1807 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1808 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1809 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1810 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1811 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1812 @c @end group
1813 @end smallexample
1814
1815 @kindex complete
1816 @item complete @var{args}
1817 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1818 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1819 command you want completed. For example:
1820
1821 @smallexample
1822 complete i
1823 @end smallexample
1824
1825 @noindent results in:
1826
1827 @smallexample
1828 @group
1829 if
1830 ignore
1831 info
1832 inspect
1833 @end group
1834 @end smallexample
1835
1836 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1837 @end table
1838
1839 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1840 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1841 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1842 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1843 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1844 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1845 Index}.
1846
1847 @c @group
1848 @table @code
1849 @kindex info
1850 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1851 @item info
1852 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1853 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1854 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1855 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1856 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1857 @w{@code{help info}}.
1858
1859 @kindex set
1860 @item set
1861 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1862 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1863 @code{set prompt $}.
1864
1865 @kindex show
1866 @item show
1867 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1868 @value{GDBN} itself.
1869 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1870 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1871 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1872 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1873
1874 @kindex info set
1875 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1876 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1877 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1878 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1879 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1880 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1881 @end table
1882 @c @end group
1883
1884 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1885 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1886
1887 @table @code
1888 @kindex show version
1889 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1890 @item show version
1891 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1892 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1893 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1894 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1895 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1896 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1897 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1898 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1899 @value{GDBN}.
1900
1901 @kindex show copying
1902 @kindex info copying
1903 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1904 @item show copying
1905 @itemx info copying
1906 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1907
1908 @kindex show warranty
1909 @kindex info warranty
1910 @item show warranty
1911 @itemx info warranty
1912 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1913 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1914
1915 @kindex show configuration
1916 @item show configuration
1917 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1918 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1919 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1920 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1921 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1922 your report.
1923
1924 @end table
1925
1926 @node Running
1927 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1928
1929 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1930 debugging information when you compile it.
1931
1932 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1933 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1934 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1935 kill a child process.
1936
1937 @menu
1938 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1939 * Starting:: Starting your program
1940 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1941 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1942
1943 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1944 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1945 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1946 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1947
1948 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1949 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1950 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1951 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1952 @end menu
1953
1954 @node Compilation
1955 @section Compiling for Debugging
1956
1957 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1958 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1959 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1960 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1961 and addresses in the executable code.
1962
1963 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1964 the compiler.
1965
1966 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1967 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1968 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1969 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1970 executables containing debugging information.
1971
1972 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1973 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1974 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1975 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1976 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1977
1978 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1979 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1980 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1981
1982 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1983 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1984 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1985 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1986 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1987 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1988
1989 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1990 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1991 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1992
1993 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1994 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1995 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1996 format in @value{GDBN}.
1997
1998 @need 2000
1999 @node Starting
2000 @section Starting your Program
2001 @cindex starting
2002 @cindex running
2003
2004 @table @code
2005 @kindex run
2006 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2007 @item run
2008 @itemx r
2009 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2010 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2011 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2012 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2013 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2014
2015 @end table
2016
2017 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2018 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2019 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2020 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2021 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2022 message like this one:
2023
2024 @smallexample
2025 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2026 Try "help target" or "continue".
2027 @end smallexample
2028
2029 @noindent
2030 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2031 first (@pxref{load}).
2032
2033 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2034 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2035 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2036 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2037 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2038 divided into four categories:
2039
2040 @table @asis
2041 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2042 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2043 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2044 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2045 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2046 the arguments.
2047 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2048 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2049 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2050 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2051 below for details).
2052
2053 @item The @emph{environment.}
2054 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2055 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2056 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2057 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2060 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2061 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2062 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2063
2064 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2065 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2066 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2067 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2068 set a different device for your program.
2069 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2070
2071 @cindex pipes
2072 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2073 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2074 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2075 wrong program.
2076 @end table
2077
2078 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2079 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2080 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2081 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2082 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2083
2084 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2085 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2086 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2087 your current breakpoints.
2088
2089 @table @code
2090 @kindex start
2091 @item start
2092 @cindex run to main procedure
2093 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2094 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2095 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2096 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2097 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2098 procedure, depending on the language used.
2099
2100 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2101 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2102 the @samp{run} command.
2103
2104 @cindex elaboration phase
2105 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2106 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2107 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2108 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2109 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2110 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2111 will remain to halt execution.
2112
2113 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2114 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2115 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2116 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2117 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2118
2119 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2120 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2121 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2122 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2123 elaboration code before running your program.
2124
2125 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2126 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2127 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2128 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2129 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2130 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2131 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2132 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2133 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2134 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2135 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2136 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2137
2138 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2139 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2140 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2141 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2142
2143 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2144 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2145 environment:
2146
2147 @smallexample
2148 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2149 (@value{GDBP}) run
2150 @end smallexample
2151
2152 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2153 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2154
2155 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2156 @item set startup-with-shell
2157 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2158 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2159 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2160 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2161 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2162 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2163 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2164 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2165 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2166 startup failures such as:
2167
2168 @smallexample
2169 (@value{GDBP}) run
2170 Starting program: ./a.out
2171 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2172 @end smallexample
2173
2174 @noindent
2175 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2176 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2177 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2178 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2179 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2180 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2181
2182 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2183 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2184 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2185 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2186 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2187 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2188
2189 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2190 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2191 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2192 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2193 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2194 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2195
2196 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2197 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2198 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2199
2200 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2201 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2202
2203 @smallexample
2204 (@value{GDBP}) run
2205 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2206 @end smallexample
2207
2208 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2209 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2210
2211 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2212 @code{target native} command. For example,
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2216 (@value{GDBP}) run
2217 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2218 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2219 (@value{GDBP}) run
2220 Starting program: ./a.out
2221 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2222 @end smallexample
2223
2224 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2225 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2226 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2227 disconnect.
2228
2229 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2230 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2231 proc}, @code{info os}.
2232
2233 @kindex set disable-randomization
2234 @item set disable-randomization
2235 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2236 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2237 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2238 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2239 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2240
2241 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2242 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2243
2244 @smallexample
2245 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2246 @end smallexample
2247
2248 @item set disable-randomization off
2249 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2250 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2251 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2252 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2253 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2254 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2255
2256 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2257 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2258 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2259 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2260 a code at its expected addresses.
2261
2262 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2263 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2264 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2265 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2266 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2267 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2268 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2269 a randomly chosen address.
2270
2271 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2272 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2273 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2274 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2275 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2276
2277 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2278 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2279
2280 @item show disable-randomization
2281 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2282 the virtual address space of the started program.
2283
2284 @end table
2285
2286 @node Arguments
2287 @section Your Program's Arguments
2288
2289 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2290 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2291 @code{run} command.
2292 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2293 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2294 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2295 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2296 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2297
2298 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2299 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2300 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2301 the program, not by the shell.
2302
2303 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2304 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2305
2306 @table @code
2307 @kindex set args
2308 @item set args
2309 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2310 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2311 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2312 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2313 it again without arguments.
2314
2315 @kindex show args
2316 @item show args
2317 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2318 @end table
2319
2320 @node Environment
2321 @section Your Program's Environment
2322
2323 @cindex environment (of your program)
2324 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2325 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2326 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2327 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2328 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2329 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2330 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2331
2332 @table @code
2333 @kindex path
2334 @item path @var{directory}
2335 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2336 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2337 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2338 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2339 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2340 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2341 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2342
2343 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2344 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2345 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2346 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2347 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2348 @var{directory} to the search path.
2349 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2350 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2351
2352 @kindex show paths
2353 @item show paths
2354 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2355 environment variable).
2356
2357 @kindex show environment
2358 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2359 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2360 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2361 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2362 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2363
2364 @kindex set environment
2365 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2366 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2367 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2368 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2369 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2370 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2371 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2372 null value.
2373 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2374 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2375
2376 For example, this command:
2377
2378 @smallexample
2379 set env USER = foo
2380 @end smallexample
2381
2382 @noindent
2383 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2384 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2385 are not actually required.)
2386
2387 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2388 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2389 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2390 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2391 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2392
2393 @kindex unset environment
2394 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2395 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2396 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2397 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2398 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2399 @end table
2400
2401 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2402 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2403 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2404 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2405 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2406 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2407 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2408 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2409 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2410 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2411
2412 @node Working Directory
2413 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2414
2415 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2416 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2417 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2418 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2419 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2420 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2421
2422 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2423 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2424 Specify Files}.
2425
2426 @table @code
2427 @kindex cd
2428 @cindex change working directory
2429 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2430 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2431 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2432
2433 @kindex pwd
2434 @item pwd
2435 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2436 @end table
2437
2438 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2439 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2440 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2441 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2442 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2443 current working directory of the debuggee.
2444
2445 @node Input/Output
2446 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2447
2448 @cindex redirection
2449 @cindex i/o
2450 @cindex terminal
2451 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2452 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2453 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2454 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2455 running your program.
2456
2457 @table @code
2458 @kindex info terminal
2459 @item info terminal
2460 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2461 program is using.
2462 @end table
2463
2464 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2465 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2466
2467 @smallexample
2468 run > outfile
2469 @end smallexample
2470
2471 @noindent
2472 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2473
2474 @kindex tty
2475 @cindex controlling terminal
2476 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2477 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2478 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2479 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2480 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2481
2482 @smallexample
2483 tty /dev/ttyb
2484 @end smallexample
2485
2486 @noindent
2487 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2488 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2489 that as their controlling terminal.
2490
2491 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2492 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2493 terminal.
2494
2495 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2496 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2497 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2498 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2499
2500 @cindex inferior tty
2501 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2502 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2503 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2504 program.
2505
2506 @table @code
2507 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2508 @kindex set inferior-tty
2509 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2510 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2511 @value{GDBN}.
2512
2513 @item show inferior-tty
2514 @kindex show inferior-tty
2515 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2516 @end table
2517
2518 @node Attach
2519 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2520 @kindex attach
2521 @cindex attach
2522
2523 @table @code
2524 @item attach @var{process-id}
2525 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2526 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2527 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2528 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2529 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2530
2531 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2532 executing the command.
2533 @end table
2534
2535 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2536 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2537 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2538 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2539
2540 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2541 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2542 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2543 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2544 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2545 Specify Files}.
2546
2547 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2548 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2549 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2550 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2551 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2552 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2553 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2554
2555 @table @code
2556 @kindex detach
2557 @item detach
2558 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2559 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2560 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2561 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2562 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2563 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2564 executing the command.
2565 @end table
2566
2567 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2568 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2569 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2570 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2571 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2572 Messages}).
2573
2574 @node Kill Process
2575 @section Killing the Child Process
2576
2577 @table @code
2578 @kindex kill
2579 @item kill
2580 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2581 @end table
2582
2583 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2584 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2585 is running.
2586
2587 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2588 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2589 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2590 outside the debugger.
2591
2592 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2593 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2594 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2595 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2596 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2597 breakpoint settings).
2598
2599 @node Inferiors and Programs
2600 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2601
2602 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2603 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2604 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2605 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2606 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2607 from multiple executables.
2608
2609 @cindex inferior
2610 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2611 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2612 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2613 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2614 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2615 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2616 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2617 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2618 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2619 threads running in it.
2620
2621 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2622 inferiors}}:
2623
2624 @table @code
2625 @kindex info inferiors
2626 @item info inferiors
2627 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2628
2629 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2630
2631 @enumerate
2632 @item
2633 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2634
2635 @item
2636 the target system's inferior identifier
2637
2638 @item
2639 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2640
2641 @end enumerate
2642
2643 @noindent
2644 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2645 indicates the current inferior.
2646
2647 For example,
2648 @end table
2649 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2650
2651 @smallexample
2652 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2653 Num Description Executable
2654 2 process 2307 hello
2655 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2656 @end smallexample
2657
2658 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2659
2660 @table @code
2661 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2662 @item inferior @var{infno}
2663 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2664 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2665 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2666 @end table
2667
2668 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2669 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2670 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2671 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2672 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2673 information on convenience variables.
2674
2675 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2676 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2677 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2678 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2679 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2680 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2681
2682 @table @code
2683 @kindex add-inferior
2684 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2685 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2686 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2687 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2688 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2689 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2690
2691 @kindex clone-inferior
2692 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2693 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2694 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2695 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2696 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2697
2698 @smallexample
2699 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2700 Num Description Executable
2701 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2702 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2703 Added inferior 2.
2704 1 inferiors added.
2705 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2706 Num Description Executable
2707 2 <null> helloworld
2708 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2709 @end smallexample
2710
2711 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2712
2713 @kindex remove-inferiors
2714 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2715 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2716 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2717 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2718
2719 @end table
2720
2721 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2722 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2723 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2724 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2725
2726 @table @code
2727 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2728 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2729 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2730 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2731 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2732 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2733
2734 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2735 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2736 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2737 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2738 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2739 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2740 @end table
2741
2742 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2743 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2744 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2745 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2746
2747
2748 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2749 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2750
2751 @table @code
2752 @kindex set print inferior-events
2753 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2754 @item set print inferior-events
2755 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2756 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2757 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2758 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2759 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2760 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2761
2762 @kindex show print inferior-events
2763 @item show print inferior-events
2764 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2765 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2766 @end table
2767
2768 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2769 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2770 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2771
2772
2773 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2774 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2775 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2776 info program-spaces}} command.
2777
2778 @table @code
2779 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2780 @item maint info program-spaces
2781 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2782 @value{GDBN}.
2783
2784 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2785
2786 @enumerate
2787 @item
2788 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2789
2790 @item
2791 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2792 the @code{file} command.
2793
2794 @end enumerate
2795
2796 @noindent
2797 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2798 indicates the current program space.
2799
2800 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2801 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2802 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2803
2804 @smallexample
2805 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2806 Id Executable
2807 * 1 hello
2808 2 goodbye
2809 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2810 @end smallexample
2811
2812 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2813 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2814 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2815 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2816 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2817
2818 @smallexample
2819 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2820 Id Executable
2821 * 1 vfork-test
2822 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2823 @end smallexample
2824
2825 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2826 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2827 @end table
2828
2829 @node Threads
2830 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2831
2832 @cindex threads of execution
2833 @cindex multiple threads
2834 @cindex switching threads
2835 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2836 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2837 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2838 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2839 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2840 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2841 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2842
2843 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2844 programs:
2845
2846 @itemize @bullet
2847 @item automatic notification of new threads
2848 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2849 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2850 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2851 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2852 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2853 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2854 messages on thread start and exit.
2855 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2856 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2857 isn't compatible with the program.
2858 @end itemize
2859
2860 @cindex focus of debugging
2861 @cindex current thread
2862 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2863 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2864 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2865 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2866 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2867
2868 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2869 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2870 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2871 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2872 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2873 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2874 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2875 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2876 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2877 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2878
2879 @smallexample
2880 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2881 @end smallexample
2882
2883 @noindent
2884 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2885 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2886 further qualifier.
2887
2888 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2889 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2890 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2891 @c program?
2892 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2893 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2894 @c threads ab initio?
2895
2896 @anchor{thread numbers}
2897 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2898 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2899 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2900 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2901 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2902 between threads of different inferiors.
2903
2904 @cindex qualified thread ID
2905 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2906 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2907 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2908 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2909 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2910 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2911 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2912 inferior.
2913
2914 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2915 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2916 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2917 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2918
2919 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2920 @cindex thread ID lists
2921 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2922 argument. A list element can be:
2923
2924 @enumerate
2925 @item
2926 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2927 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2928 @samp{1}.
2929
2930 @item
2931 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2932 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2933 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2934
2935 @item
2936 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2937 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2938 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2939 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2940 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2941
2942 @end enumerate
2943
2944 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2945 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2946 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2947 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2948 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2949 7.1}.
2950
2951
2952 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2953 @cindex global thread number
2954 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2955 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2956 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2957 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2958 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2959 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2960
2961 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2962 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2963 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2964
2965 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2966 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2967 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2968 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2969 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2970 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2971 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2972 general information on convenience variables.
2973
2974 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2975 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2976 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2977
2978 @smallexample
2979 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2980 @end smallexample
2981
2982 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2983
2984 @smallexample
2985 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2986 @end smallexample
2987
2988 @table @code
2989 @kindex info threads
2990 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2991
2992 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
2993 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
2994 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2995 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2996
2997 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2998
2999 @enumerate
3000 @item
3001 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3002
3003 @item
3004 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3005 option was specified
3006
3007 @item
3008 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3009
3010 @item
3011 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3012 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3013 program itself.
3014
3015 @item
3016 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3017 @end enumerate
3018
3019 @noindent
3020 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3021 indicates the current thread.
3022
3023 For example,
3024 @end table
3025 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3026
3027 @smallexample
3028 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3029 Id Target Id Frame
3030 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3031 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3032 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3033 at threadtest.c:68
3034 @end smallexample
3035
3036 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3037 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3038 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3039
3040 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3041 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3042
3043 @smallexample
3044 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3045 Id GId Target Id Frame
3046 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3047 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3048 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3049 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3050 @end smallexample
3051
3052 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3053 Solaris-specific command:
3054
3055 @table @code
3056 @item maint info sol-threads
3057 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3058 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3059 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3060 @end table
3061
3062 @table @code
3063 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3064 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3065 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3066 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3067 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3068 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3069
3070 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3071 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3075 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3076 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3077 8 printf ("hello\n");
3078 @end smallexample
3079
3080 @noindent
3081 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3082 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3083 threads.
3084
3085 @kindex thread apply
3086 @cindex apply command to several threads
3087 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3088 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3089 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3090 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3091 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3092 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3093 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3094 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3095
3096
3097 @kindex thread name
3098 @cindex name a thread
3099 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3100 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3101 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3102 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3103
3104 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3105 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3106 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3107 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3108 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3109
3110 @kindex thread find
3111 @cindex search for a thread
3112 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3113 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3114 matches the supplied regular expression.
3115
3116 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3117 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3118 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3119 is the LWP id.
3120
3121 @smallexample
3122 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3123 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3124 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3125 Id Target Id Frame
3126 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3127 @end smallexample
3128
3129 @kindex set print thread-events
3130 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3131 @item set print thread-events
3132 @itemx set print thread-events on
3133 @itemx set print thread-events off
3134 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3135 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3136 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3137 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3138 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3139
3140 @kindex show print thread-events
3141 @item show print thread-events
3142 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3143 have started and exited.
3144 @end table
3145
3146 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3147 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3148 programs with multiple threads.
3149
3150 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3151 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3152
3153 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3154 @table @code
3155 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3156 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3157 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3158 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3159 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3160 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3161 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3162 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3163 macro.
3164
3165 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3166 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3167 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3168 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3169 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3170 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3171
3172 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3173 refers to the default system directories that are
3174 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3175 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3176 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3177
3178 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3179 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3180 was loaded in the inferior process.
3181
3182 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3183 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3184 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3185 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3186 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3187 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3188 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3189
3190 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3191 only on some platforms.
3192
3193 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3194 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3195 Display current libthread_db search path.
3196
3197 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3198 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3199 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3200 @item set debug libthread-db
3201 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3202 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3203 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3204 @end table
3205
3206 @node Forks
3207 @section Debugging Forks
3208
3209 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3210 @cindex multiple processes
3211 @cindex processes, multiple
3212 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3213 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3214 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3215 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3216 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3217 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3218 will cause it to terminate.
3219
3220 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3221 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3222 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3223 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3224 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3225 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3226 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3227 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3228 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3229 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3230
3231 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3232 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3233 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3234 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3235
3236 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3237 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3238 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3239
3240 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3241 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3242
3243 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3244 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3245
3246 @table @code
3247 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3248 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3249 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3250 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3251 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3252
3253 @table @code
3254 @item parent
3255 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3256 unimpeded. This is the default.
3257
3258 @item child
3259 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3260 unimpeded.
3261
3262 @end table
3263
3264 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3265 @item show follow-fork-mode
3266 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3267 @end table
3268
3269 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3270 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3271 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3272
3273 @table @code
3274 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3275 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3276 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3277 retain debugger control over them both.
3278
3279 @table @code
3280 @item on
3281 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3282 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3283 independently. This is the default.
3284
3285 @item off
3286 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3287 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3288 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3289 is held suspended.
3290
3291 @end table
3292
3293 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3294 @item show detach-on-fork
3295 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3296 @end table
3297
3298 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3299 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3300 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3301 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3302 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3303 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3304
3305 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3306 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3307 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3308 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3309 and Programs}.
3310
3311 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3312 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3313 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3314 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3315 the child process's @code{main}.
3316
3317 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3318 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3319
3320 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3321 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3322 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3323 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3324 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3325 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3326 command.
3327
3328 @table @code
3329 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3330 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3331
3332 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3333 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3334
3335 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3336
3337 @table @code
3338 @item new
3339 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3340 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3341 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3342 original inferior.
3343
3344 For example:
3345
3346 @smallexample
3347 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3348 (gdb) info inferior
3349 Id Description Executable
3350 * 1 <null> prog1
3351 (@value{GDBP}) run
3352 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3353 Program exited normally.
3354 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3355 Id Description Executable
3356 1 <null> prog1
3357 * 2 <null> prog2
3358 @end smallexample
3359
3360 @item same
3361 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3362 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3363 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3364 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3365 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3366
3367 For example:
3368
3369 @smallexample
3370 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3371 Id Description Executable
3372 * 1 <null> prog1
3373 (@value{GDBP}) run
3374 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3375 Program exited normally.
3376 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3377 Id Description Executable
3378 * 1 <null> prog2
3379 @end smallexample
3380
3381 @end table
3382 @end table
3383
3384 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3385 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3386
3387 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3388 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3389 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3390
3391 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3392 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3393
3394 @cindex checkpoint
3395 @cindex restart
3396 @cindex bookmark
3397 @cindex snapshot of a process
3398 @cindex rewind program state
3399
3400 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3401 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3402 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3403 later.
3404
3405 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3406 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3407 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3408 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3409 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3410
3411 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3412 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3413 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3414 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3415 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3416 start again from there.
3417
3418 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3419 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3420
3421 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3422
3423 @table @code
3424 @kindex checkpoint
3425 @item checkpoint
3426 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3427 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3428 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3429
3430 @kindex info checkpoints
3431 @item info checkpoints
3432 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3433 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3434 listed:
3435
3436 @table @code
3437 @item Checkpoint ID
3438 @item Process ID
3439 @item Code Address
3440 @item Source line, or label
3441 @end table
3442
3443 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3444 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3445 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3446 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3447 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3448 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3449 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3450
3451 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3452 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3453 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3454 the debugger.
3455
3456 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3457 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3458 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3459
3460 @end table
3461
3462 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3463 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3464 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3465 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3466 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3467 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3468 previously read data can be read again.
3469
3470 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3471 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3472 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3473 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3474 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3475 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3476
3477 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3478 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3479 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3480 different execution path this time.
3481
3482 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3483 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3484 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3485 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3486 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3487 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3488 potentially pose a problem.
3489
3490 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3491
3492 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3493 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3494 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3495 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3496 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3497 next.
3498
3499 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3500 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3501 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3502 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3503 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3504
3505 @node Stopping
3506 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3507
3508 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3509 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3510 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3511
3512 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3513 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3514 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3515 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3516 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3517 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3518 explicitly request this information at any time.
3519
3520 @table @code
3521 @kindex info program
3522 @item info program
3523 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3524 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3525 @end table
3526
3527 @menu
3528 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3529 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3530 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3531 Skipping over functions and files
3532 * Signals:: Signals
3533 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3534 @end menu
3535
3536 @node Breakpoints
3537 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3538
3539 @cindex breakpoints
3540 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3541 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3542 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3543 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3544 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3545 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3546 program.
3547
3548 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3549 the executable is run.
3550
3551 @cindex watchpoints
3552 @cindex data breakpoints
3553 @cindex memory tracing
3554 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3555 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3556 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3557 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3558 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3559 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3560 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3561 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3562 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3563 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3564 same commands.
3565
3566 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3567 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3568 Automatic Display}.
3569
3570 @cindex catchpoints
3571 @cindex breakpoint on events
3572 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3573 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3574 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3575 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3576 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3577 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3578 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3579
3580 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3581 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3582 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3583 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3584 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3585 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3586 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3587 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3588 enable it again.
3589
3590 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3591 @cindex breakpoint lists
3592 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3593 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3594 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3595 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3596 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3597 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3598 are operated on.
3599
3600 @menu
3601 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3602 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3603 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3604 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3605 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3606 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3607 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3608 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3609 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3610 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3611 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3612 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3613 @end menu
3614
3615 @node Set Breaks
3616 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3617
3618 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3619 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3620 @c
3621 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3622
3623 @kindex break
3624 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3625 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3626 @cindex latest breakpoint
3627 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3628 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3629 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3630 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3631 convenience variables.
3632
3633 @table @code
3634 @item break @var{location}
3635 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3636 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3637 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3638 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3639 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3640
3641 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3642 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3643 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3644 that situation.
3645
3646 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3647 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3648 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3649
3650 @item break
3651 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3652 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3653 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3654 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3655 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3656 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3657 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3658 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3659 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3660 inside loops.
3661
3662 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3663 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3664 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3665 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3666 existed when your program stopped.
3667
3668 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3669 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3670 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3671 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3672 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3673 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3674 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3675
3676 @kindex tbreak
3677 @item tbreak @var{args}
3678 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3679 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3680 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3681 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3682
3683 @kindex hbreak
3684 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3685 @item hbreak @var{args}
3686 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3687 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3688 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3689 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3690 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3691 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3692 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3693 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3694 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3695 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3696 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3697 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3698 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3699 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3700 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3701 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3702 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3703 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3704
3705 @kindex thbreak
3706 @item thbreak @var{args}
3707 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3708 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3709 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3710 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3711 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3712 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3713 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3714 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3715
3716 @kindex rbreak
3717 @cindex regular expression
3718 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3719 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3720 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3721 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3722 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3723 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3724 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3725 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3726 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3727
3728 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3729 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3730 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3731 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3732 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3733 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3734
3735 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3736 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3737 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3738 classes.
3739
3740 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3741 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3742 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3743
3744 @smallexample
3745 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3746 @end smallexample
3747
3748 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3749 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3750 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3751 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3752 every function in a given file:
3753
3754 @smallexample
3755 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3756 @end smallexample
3757
3758 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3759 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3760
3761 @kindex info breakpoints
3762 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3763 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3764 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3765 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3766 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3767 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3768 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3769
3770 @table @emph
3771 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3772 @item Type
3773 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3774 @item Disposition
3775 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3776 @item Enabled or Disabled
3777 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3778 that are not enabled.
3779 @item Address
3780 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3781 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3782 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3783 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3784 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3785 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3786 @item What
3787 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3788 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3789 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3790 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3791 @end table
3792
3793 @noindent
3794 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3795 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3796 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3797 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3798 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3799 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3800
3801 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3802 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3803 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3804 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3805
3806 @noindent
3807 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3808 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3809 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3810 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3811 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3812
3813 @noindent
3814 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3815 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3816 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3817 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3818 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3819 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3820
3821 @noindent
3822 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3823 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3824
3825 @end table
3826
3827 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3828 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3829 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3830 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3831
3832 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3833 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3834 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3835 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3836
3837 @itemize @bullet
3838 @item
3839 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3840
3841 @item
3842 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3843 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3844
3845 @item
3846 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3847 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3848
3849 @item
3850 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3851 several places where that function is inlined.
3852 @end itemize
3853
3854 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3855 the relevant locations.
3856
3857 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3858 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3859 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3860 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3861 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3862 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3863 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3864
3865 For example:
3866
3867 @smallexample
3868 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3869 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3870 stop only if i==1
3871 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3872 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3873 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3874 @end smallexample
3875
3876 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3877 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3878 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3879 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3880 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3881 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3882 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3883 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3884 that belong to that breakpoint.
3885
3886 @cindex pending breakpoints
3887 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3888 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3889 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3890 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3891 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3892 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3893 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3894 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3895 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3896 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3897 is not yet resolved.
3898
3899 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3900 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3901 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3902 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3903 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3904 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3905
3906 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3907 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3908 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3909 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3910
3911 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3912 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3913 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3914
3915 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3916 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3917 address specification to an address:
3918
3919 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3920 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3921 @table @code
3922 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3923 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3924 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3925
3926 @item set breakpoint pending on
3927 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3928 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3929
3930 @item set breakpoint pending off
3931 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3932 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3933 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3934
3935 @item show breakpoint pending
3936 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3937 @end table
3938
3939 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3940 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3941 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3942
3943 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3944 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3945 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3946 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3947 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3948 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3949 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3950 breakpoints.
3951
3952 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
3953
3954 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3955 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3956 @table @code
3957 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3958 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3959 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3960 breakpoint must be used.
3961
3962 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3963 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3964 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3965 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3966 @end table
3967
3968 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3969 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3970 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3971 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3972 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3973 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3974 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3975 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3976 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3977
3978 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3979 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3980 @table @code
3981 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3982 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3983 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3984 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3985
3986 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3987 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3988 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3989 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3990 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3991 @end table
3992
3993 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3994 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3995 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3996
3997 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3998 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3999
4000 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4001
4002 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4003 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4004 @table @code
4005 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4006 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4007 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4008 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4009 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4010
4011 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4012 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4013 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4014 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4015 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4016 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4017 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4018 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4019 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4020 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4021 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4022 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4023 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4024
4025 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4026 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4027 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4028 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4029 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4030 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4031 @end table
4032
4033
4034 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4035 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4036 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4037 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4038 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4039 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4040 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4041 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4042
4043
4044 @node Set Watchpoints
4045 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4046
4047 @cindex setting watchpoints
4048 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4049 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4050 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4051 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4052 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4053
4054 @itemize @bullet
4055 @item
4056 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4057
4058 @item
4059 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4060 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4061 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4062
4063 @item
4064 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4065 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4066 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4067 @end itemize
4068
4069 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4070 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4071 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4072 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4073 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4074 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4075 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4076 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4077 the expression changes.
4078
4079 @cindex software watchpoints
4080 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4081 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4082 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4083 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4084 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4085 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4086 culprit.)
4087
4088 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4089 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4090 slow down the running of your program.
4091
4092 @table @code
4093 @kindex watch
4094 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4095 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4096 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4097 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4098 to watch the value of a single variable:
4099
4100 @smallexample
4101 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4102 @end smallexample
4103
4104 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4105 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4106 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4107 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4108 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4109 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4110
4111 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4112 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4113 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4114 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4115 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4116 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4117 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4118 error.
4119
4120 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4121 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4122 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4123 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4124 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4125 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4126 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4127 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4128 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4129 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4130 Examples:
4131
4132 @smallexample
4133 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4134 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4135 @end smallexample
4136
4137 @kindex rwatch
4138 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4139 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4140 by the program.
4141
4142 @kindex awatch
4143 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4144 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4145 or written into by the program.
4146
4147 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4148 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4149 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4150 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4151 @end table
4152
4153 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4154 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4155 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4156 a never-changing value:
4157
4158 @smallexample
4159 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4160 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4161 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4162 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4163 @end smallexample
4164
4165 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4166 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4167 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4168 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4169 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4170 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4171
4172 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4173 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4174 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4175 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4176 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4177 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4178 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4179 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4180
4181 @table @code
4182 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4183 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4184 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4185
4186 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4187 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4188 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4189 @end table
4190
4191 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4192 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4193 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4194
4195 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4196
4197 @smallexample
4198 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4199 @end smallexample
4200
4201 @noindent
4202 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4203
4204 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4205 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4206 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4207 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4208 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4209 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4210 will print a message like this:
4211
4212 @smallexample
4213 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4214 @end smallexample
4215
4216 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4217 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4218 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4219 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4220 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4221 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4222 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4223 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4224
4225 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4226 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4227 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4228 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4229 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4230 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4231
4232 @smallexample
4233 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4234 @end smallexample
4235
4236 @noindent
4237 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4238
4239 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4240 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4241 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4242 expression with separately allocated resources.
4243
4244 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4245 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4246 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4247
4248 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4249 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4250 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4251 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4252 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4253 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4254 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4255 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4256 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4257
4258 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4259 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4260 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4261 watched expression from every thread.
4262
4263 @quotation
4264 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4265 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4266 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4267 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4268 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4269 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4270 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4271 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4272 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4273 @end quotation
4274
4275 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4276
4277 @node Set Catchpoints
4278 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4279 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4280 @cindex exception handlers
4281 @cindex event handling
4282
4283 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4284 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4285 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4286
4287 @table @code
4288 @kindex catch
4289 @item catch @var{event}
4290 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4291
4292 @table @code
4293 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4294 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4295 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4296 @kindex catch throw
4297 @kindex catch rethrow
4298 @kindex catch catch
4299 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4300 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4301
4302 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4303 regular expression will be caught.
4304
4305 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4306 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4307 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4308 exception being thrown.
4309
4310 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4311 @value{GDBN}:
4312
4313 @itemize @bullet
4314 @item
4315 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4316 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4317 supported.
4318
4319 @item
4320 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4321 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4322 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4323 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4324 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4325 built.
4326
4327 @item
4328 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4329 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4330
4331 @item
4332 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4333 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4334 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4335 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4336
4337 @item
4338 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4339 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4340 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4341 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4342 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4343 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4344 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4345 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4346 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4347
4348 @item
4349 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4350
4351 @item
4352 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4353 @end itemize
4354
4355 @item exception
4356 @kindex catch exception
4357 @cindex Ada exception catching
4358 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4359 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4360 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4361 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4362 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4363
4364 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4365 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4366 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4367 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4368 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4369 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4370 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4371 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4372
4373 @item exception unhandled
4374 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4375 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4376
4377 @item assert
4378 @kindex catch assert
4379 A failed Ada assertion.
4380
4381 @item exec
4382 @kindex catch exec
4383 @cindex break on fork/exec
4384 A call to @code{exec}.
4385
4386 @item syscall
4387 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4388 @kindex catch syscall
4389 @cindex break on a system call.
4390 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4391 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4392 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4393 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4394 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4395 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4396 will be caught.
4397
4398 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4399 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4400 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4401 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4402
4403 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4404 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4405 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4406 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4407
4408 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4409 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4410 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4411 available choices.
4412
4413 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4414 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4415 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4416 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4417 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4418 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4419 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4420 behind the OS upgrades).
4421
4422 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4423 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4424 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4425 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4426 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4427 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4428 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4429 syscall groups available on your environment.
4430
4431 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4432 arguments to it:
4433
4434 @smallexample
4435 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4436 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4437 (@value{GDBP}) r
4438 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4439
4440 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4441 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4442 (@value{GDBP}) c
4443 Continuing.
4444
4445 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4446 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4447 (@value{GDBP})
4448 @end smallexample
4449
4450 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4451
4452 @smallexample
4453 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4454 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4455 (@value{GDBP}) r
4456 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4457
4458 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4459 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4460 (@value{GDBP}) c
4461 Continuing.
4462
4463 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4464 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4465 (@value{GDBP})
4466 @end smallexample
4467
4468 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4469 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4470 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4471
4472 @smallexample
4473 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4474 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4475 (@value{GDBP}) r
4476 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4477
4478 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4479 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4480 (@value{GDBP}) c
4481 Continuing.
4482
4483 Program exited normally.
4484 (@value{GDBP})
4485 @end smallexample
4486
4487 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4488
4489 @smallexample
4490 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4491 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4492 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4493 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4494 (@value{GDBP}) r
4495 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4496
4497 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4498 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4499
4500 (@value{GDBP}) c
4501 Continuing.
4502 @end smallexample
4503
4504 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4505 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4506 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4507 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4508
4509 @smallexample
4510 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4511 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4512 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4513 (@value{GDBP})
4514 @end smallexample
4515
4516 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4517 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4518 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4519 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4520 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4521 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4522
4523 @smallexample
4524 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4525 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4526 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4527 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4528 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4529 (@value{GDBP})
4530 @end smallexample
4531
4532 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4533
4534 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4535 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4536
4537 @smallexample
4538 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4539 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4540 @end smallexample
4541
4542 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4543
4544 @item fork
4545 @kindex catch fork
4546 A call to @code{fork}.
4547
4548 @item vfork
4549 @kindex catch vfork
4550 A call to @code{vfork}.
4551
4552 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4553 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4554 @kindex catch load
4555 @kindex catch unload
4556 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4557 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4558 matches one of the affected libraries.
4559
4560 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4561 @kindex catch signal
4562 The delivery of a signal.
4563
4564 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4565 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4566 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4567
4568 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4569 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4570 signal names.
4571
4572 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4573 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4574 will be caught.
4575
4576 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4577 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4578 catchpoint.
4579
4580 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4581 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4582 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4583 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4584 commands.
4585
4586 @end table
4587
4588 @item tcatch @var{event}
4589 @kindex tcatch
4590 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4591 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4592
4593 @end table
4594
4595 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4596
4597
4598 @node Delete Breaks
4599 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4600
4601 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4602 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4603 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4604 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4605 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4606 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4607
4608 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4609 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4610 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4611 their breakpoint numbers.
4612
4613 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4614 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4615 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4616
4617 @table @code
4618 @kindex clear
4619 @item clear
4620 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4621 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4622 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4623 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4624
4625 @item clear @var{location}
4626 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4627 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4628 most useful ones are listed below:
4629
4630 @table @code
4631 @item clear @var{function}
4632 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4633 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4634
4635 @item clear @var{linenum}
4636 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4637 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4638 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4639 @end table
4640
4641 @cindex delete breakpoints
4642 @kindex delete
4643 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4644 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4645 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4646 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4647 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4648 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4649 @end table
4650
4651 @node Disabling
4652 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4653
4654 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4655 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4656 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4657 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4658 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4659
4660 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4661 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4662 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4663 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4664 do not know which numbers to use.
4665
4666 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4667 affects all of its locations.
4668
4669 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4670 different states of enablement:
4671
4672 @itemize @bullet
4673 @item
4674 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4675 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4676 @item
4677 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4678 @item
4679 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4680 disabled.
4681 @item
4682 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4683 N times, then becomes disabled.
4684 @item
4685 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4686 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4687 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4688 @end itemize
4689
4690 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4691 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4692
4693 @table @code
4694 @kindex disable
4695 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4696 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4697 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4698 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4699 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4700 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4701 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4702
4703 @kindex enable
4704 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4705 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4706 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4707
4708 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4709 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4710 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4711
4712 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4713 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4714 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4715 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4716 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4717 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4718 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4719
4720 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4721 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4722 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4723 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4724 @end table
4725
4726 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4727 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4728 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4729 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4730 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4731 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4732 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4733 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4734 Stepping}.)
4735
4736 @node Conditions
4737 @subsection Break Conditions
4738 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4739 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4740
4741 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4742 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4743 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4744 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4745 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4746 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4747 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4748 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4749
4750 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4751 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4752 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4753 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4754 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4755
4756 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4757 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4758 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4759 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4760 one.
4761
4762 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4763 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4764 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4765 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4766 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4767 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4768 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4769 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4770 conditions for the
4771 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4772 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4773
4774 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4775 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4776 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4777 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4778 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4779 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4780
4781 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4782 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4783 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4784 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4785 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4786
4787 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4788 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4789 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4790 with the @code{condition} command.
4791
4792 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4793 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4794 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4795 catchpoint.
4796
4797 @table @code
4798 @kindex condition
4799 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4800 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4801 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4802 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4803 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4804 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4805 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4806 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4807 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4808 prints an error message:
4809
4810 @smallexample
4811 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4812 @end smallexample
4813
4814 @noindent
4815 @value{GDBN} does
4816 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4817 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4818 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4819
4820 @item condition @var{bnum}
4821 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4822 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4823 @end table
4824
4825 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4826 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4827 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4828 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4829 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4830 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4831 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4832 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4833 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4834 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4835 your program reaches it.
4836
4837 @table @code
4838 @kindex ignore
4839 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4840 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4841 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4842 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4843 takes no action.
4844
4845 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4846 a count of zero.
4847
4848 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4849 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4850 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4851 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4852
4853 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4854 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4855 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4856
4857 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4858 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4859 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4860 Variables}.
4861 @end table
4862
4863 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4864
4865
4866 @node Break Commands
4867 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4868
4869 @cindex breakpoint commands
4870 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4871 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4872 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4873 enable other breakpoints.
4874
4875 @table @code
4876 @kindex commands
4877 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4878 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4879 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4880 @itemx end
4881 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4882 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4883 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4884
4885 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4886 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4887
4888 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4889 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4890 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4891 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4892 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4893 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4894 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4895 Expressions}).
4896 @end table
4897
4898 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4899 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4900
4901 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4902 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4903 that resumes execution.
4904
4905 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4906 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4907 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4908 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4909 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4910
4911 @kindex silent
4912 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4913 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4914 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4915 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4916 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4917 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4918
4919 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4920 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4921 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4922
4923 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4924 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4925
4926 @smallexample
4927 break foo if x>0
4928 commands
4929 silent
4930 printf "x is %d\n",x
4931 cont
4932 end
4933 @end smallexample
4934
4935 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4936 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4937 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4938 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4939 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4940 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4941 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4942
4943 @smallexample
4944 break 403
4945 commands
4946 silent
4947 set x = y + 4
4948 cont
4949 end
4950 @end smallexample
4951
4952 @node Dynamic Printf
4953 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4954
4955 @cindex dynamic printf
4956 @cindex dprintf
4957 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4958 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4959 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4960 having to recompile it.
4961
4962 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4963 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4964 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4965 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4966 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4967 redirects to files and so forth.
4968
4969 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4970 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4971 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4972 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4973 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4974 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4975 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4976
4977 @table @code
4978 @kindex dprintf
4979 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4980 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4981 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4982 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4983
4984 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4985 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4986 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4987 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4988 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4989 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4990
4991 @table @code
4992 @item gdb
4993 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4994 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4995
4996 @item call
4997 @kindex dprintf-style call
4998 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4999 @code{printf}).
5000
5001 @item agent
5002 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5003 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5004 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5005 support running commands on the target.
5006 @end table
5007
5008 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5009 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5010 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5011 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5012 command.
5013
5014 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5015 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5016 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5017 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5018 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5019 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5020
5021 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5022 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5023 you could do the following:
5024
5025 @example
5026 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5027 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5028 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5029 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5030 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5031 (gdb) info break
5032 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5033 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5034 continue
5035 (gdb)
5036 @end example
5037
5038 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5039 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5040 the variable settings.
5041
5042 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5043 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5044 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5045 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5046 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5047 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5048
5049 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5050 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5051 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5052
5053 @end table
5054
5055 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5056 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5057 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5058 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5059 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5060 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5061
5062 @node Save Breakpoints
5063 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5064
5065 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5066 breakpoints}} command.
5067
5068 @table @code
5069 @kindex save breakpoints
5070 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5071 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5072 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5073 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5074 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5075 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5076 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5077 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5078 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5079 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5080 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5081 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5082 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5083 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5084 that can no longer be recreated.
5085 @end table
5086
5087 @node Static Probe Points
5088 @subsection Static Probe Points
5089
5090 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5091 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5092 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5093 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5094 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5095
5096 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5097 ELF-compatible systems:
5098
5099 @itemize @bullet
5100
5101 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5102 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5103 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5104 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5105 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5106 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5107 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5108 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5109
5110 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5111 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5112 C@t{++} languages.
5113 @end itemize
5114
5115 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5116 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5117 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5118 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5119 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5120 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5121 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5122 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5123 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5124
5125 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5126 probes}, with optional arguments:
5127
5128 @table @code
5129 @kindex info probes
5130 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5131 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5132 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5133 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5134
5135 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5136 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5137 probes from all providers are listed.
5138
5139 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5140 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5141 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5142
5143 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5144 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5145 given, all object files are considered.
5146
5147 @item info probes all
5148 List the available static probes, from all types.
5149 @end table
5150
5151 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5152 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5153 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5154 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5155 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5156
5157 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5158 commands, with optional arguments:
5159
5160 @table @code
5161 @kindex enable probes
5162 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5163 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5164 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5165 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5166
5167 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5168 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5169 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5170
5171 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5172 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5173 given, all object files are considered.
5174
5175 @kindex disable probes
5176 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5177 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5178 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5179 @end table
5180
5181 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5182 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5183 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5184 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5185 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5186 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5187 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5188 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5189 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5190 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5191 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5192 at the current probe point.
5193
5194 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5195 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5196 an error message.
5197
5198
5199 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5200 @node Error in Breakpoints
5201 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5202
5203 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5204 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5205
5206 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5207 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5208 @smallexample
5209 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5210 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5211 @end smallexample
5212
5213 @noindent
5214 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5215 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5216 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5217
5218 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5219 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5220
5221 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5222 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5223 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5224
5225 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5226 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5227 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5228 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5229
5230 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5231 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5232 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5233 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5234 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5235 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5236 first in the bundle.
5237
5238 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5239 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5240 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5241 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5242 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5243 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5244 is hit.
5245
5246 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5247 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5248
5249 @smallexample
5250 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5251 @end smallexample
5252
5253 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5254 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5255 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5256 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5257 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5258 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5259 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5260 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5261
5262 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5263 adjusted breakpoints:
5264
5265 @smallexample
5266 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5267 to 0x00010410.
5268 @end smallexample
5269
5270 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5271 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5272 frequently than expected.
5273
5274 @node Continuing and Stepping
5275 @section Continuing and Stepping
5276
5277 @cindex stepping
5278 @cindex continuing
5279 @cindex resuming execution
5280 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5281 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5282 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5283 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5284 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5285 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5286 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5287 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5288 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5289 handlers}).)
5290
5291 @table @code
5292 @kindex continue
5293 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5294 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5295 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5296 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5297 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5298 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5299 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5300 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5301 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5302 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5303
5304 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5305 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5306 @code{continue} is ignored.
5307
5308 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5309 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5310 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5311 @code{continue}.
5312 @end table
5313
5314 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5315 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5316 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5317 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5318
5319 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5320 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5321 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5322 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5323 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5324 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5325
5326 @table @code
5327 @kindex step
5328 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5329 @item step
5330 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5331 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5332 abbreviated @code{s}.
5333
5334 @quotation
5335 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5336 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5337 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5338 @c distinction here.
5339 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5340 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5341 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5342 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5343 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5344 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5345 below.
5346 @end quotation
5347
5348 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5349 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5350 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5351 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5352 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5353 called within the line.
5354
5355 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5356 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5357 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5358 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5359 was any debugging information about the routine.
5360
5361 @item step @var{count}
5362 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5363 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5364 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5365
5366 @kindex next
5367 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5368 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5369 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5370 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5371 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5372 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5373 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5374 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5375
5376 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5377
5378
5379 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5380 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5381 @c
5382 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5383 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5384 @c function are executed without stopping.
5385
5386 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5387 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5388 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5389
5390 @kindex set step-mode
5391 @item set step-mode
5392 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5393 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5394 @itemx set step-mode on
5395 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5396 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5397 information rather than stepping over it.
5398
5399 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5400 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5401 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5402
5403 @item set step-mode off
5404 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5405 debug information. This is the default.
5406
5407 @item show step-mode
5408 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5409 source line debug information.
5410
5411 @kindex finish
5412 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5413 @item finish
5414 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5415 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5416 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5417
5418 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5419 ,Returning from a Function}).
5420
5421 @kindex until
5422 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5423 @cindex run until specified location
5424 @item until
5425 @itemx u
5426 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5427 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5428 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5429 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5430 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5431 than the address of the jump.
5432
5433 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5434 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5435 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5436 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5437 through the next iteration.
5438
5439 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5440 stack frame.
5441
5442 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5443 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5444 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5445 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5446 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5447
5448 @smallexample
5449 (@value{GDBP}) f
5450 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5451 206 expand_input();
5452 (@value{GDBP}) until
5453 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5454 @end smallexample
5455
5456 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5457 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5458 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5459 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5460 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5461 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5462 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5463
5464 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5465 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5466 argument.
5467
5468 @item until @var{location}
5469 @itemx u @var{location}
5470 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5471 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5472 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5473 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5474 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5475 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5476 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5477 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5478 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5479 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5480 invocations have returned.
5481
5482 @smallexample
5483 94 int factorial (int value)
5484 95 @{
5485 96 if (value > 1) @{
5486 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5487 98 @}
5488 99 return (value);
5489 100 @}
5490 @end smallexample
5491
5492
5493 @kindex advance @var{location}
5494 @item advance @var{location}
5495 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5496 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5497 @ref{Specify Location}.
5498 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5499 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5500 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5501 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5502
5503
5504 @kindex stepi
5505 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5506 @item stepi
5507 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5508 @itemx si
5509 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5510
5511 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5512 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5513 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5514 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5515
5516 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5517
5518 @need 750
5519 @kindex nexti
5520 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5521 @item nexti
5522 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5523 @itemx ni
5524 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5525 proceed until the function returns.
5526
5527 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5528
5529 @end table
5530
5531 @anchor{range stepping}
5532 @cindex range stepping
5533 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5534 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5535 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5536 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5537 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5538 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5539 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5540 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5541 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5542 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5543 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5544 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5545 if necessary:
5546
5547 @table @code
5548 @kindex set range-stepping
5549 @kindex show range-stepping
5550 @item set range-stepping
5551 @itemx show range-stepping
5552 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5553
5554 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5555 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5556 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5557 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5558 default is @code{on}.
5559
5560 @end table
5561
5562 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5563 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5564 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5565
5566 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5567 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5568 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5569 a particular file when stepping.
5570
5571 For example, consider the following C function:
5572
5573 @smallexample
5574 101 int func()
5575 102 @{
5576 103 foo(boring());
5577 104 bar(boring());
5578 105 @}
5579 @end smallexample
5580
5581 @noindent
5582 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5583 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5584 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5585 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5586
5587 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5588 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5589 is called from many places.
5590
5591 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5592 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5593 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5594 @code{foo}.
5595
5596 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5597 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5598 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5599
5600 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5601 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5602 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5603 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5604 the underlying system.
5605 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5606 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5607
5608 @table @code
5609 @kindex skip
5610 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5611 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5612 that specify what to skip.
5613 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5614
5615 @table @code
5616 @item -file @var{file}
5617 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5618 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5619
5620 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5621 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5622 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5623 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5624 over when stepping.
5625
5626 @smallexample
5627 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5628 @end smallexample
5629
5630 @item -function @var{linespec}
5631 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5632 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5633 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5634 @xref{Specify Location}.
5635
5636 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5637 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5638 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5639 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5640
5641 This form is useful for complex function names.
5642 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5643 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5644 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5645 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5646 regular expression makes this easier.
5647
5648 @smallexample
5649 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5650 @end smallexample
5651
5652 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5653 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5654
5655 @smallexample
5656 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5657 @end smallexample
5658 @end table
5659
5660 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5661 will be skipped.
5662
5663 @kindex skip function
5664 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5665 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5666 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5667 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5668
5669 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5670 will be skipped.
5671
5672 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5673 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5674
5675 @kindex skip file
5676 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5677 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5678 will be skipped over when stepping.
5679
5680 @smallexample
5681 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5682 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5683 @end smallexample
5684
5685 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5686 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5687 @end table
5688
5689 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5690 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5691
5692 @table @code
5693 @kindex info skip
5694 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5695 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5696 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5697 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5698
5699 @table @emph
5700 @item Identifier
5701 A number identifying this skip.
5702 @item Enabled or Disabled
5703 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5704 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5705 @item Glob
5706 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5707 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5708 @item File
5709 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5710 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5711 @item RE
5712 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5713 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5714 @item Function
5715 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5716 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5717 @end table
5718
5719 @kindex skip delete
5720 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5721 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5722 skips.
5723
5724 @kindex skip enable
5725 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5726 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5727 skips.
5728
5729 @kindex skip disable
5730 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5731 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5732 skips.
5733
5734 @end table
5735
5736 @node Signals
5737 @section Signals
5738 @cindex signals
5739
5740 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5741 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5742 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5743 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5744 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5745 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5746 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5747 requested an alarm).
5748
5749 @cindex fatal signals
5750 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5751 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5752 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5753 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5754 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5755 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5756
5757 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5758 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5759 signal.
5760
5761 @cindex handling signals
5762 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5763 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5764 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5765 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5766 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5767
5768 @table @code
5769 @kindex info signals
5770 @kindex info handle
5771 @item info signals
5772 @itemx info handle
5773 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5774 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5775 the defined types of signals.
5776
5777 @item info signals @var{sig}
5778 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5779
5780 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5781
5782 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5783 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5784 for details about this command.
5785
5786 @kindex handle
5787 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5788 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5789 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5790 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5791 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5792 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5793 say what change to make.
5794 @end table
5795
5796 @c @group
5797 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5798 Their full names are:
5799
5800 @table @code
5801 @item nostop
5802 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5803 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5804
5805 @item stop
5806 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5807 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5808
5809 @item print
5810 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5811
5812 @item noprint
5813 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5814 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5815
5816 @item pass
5817 @itemx noignore
5818 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5819 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5820 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5821
5822 @item nopass
5823 @itemx ignore
5824 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5825 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5826 @end table
5827 @c @end group
5828
5829 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5830 program until you
5831 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5832 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5833 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5834 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5835 program sees that signal when you continue.
5836
5837 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5838 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5839 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5840 erroneous signals.
5841
5842 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5843 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5844 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5845 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5846 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5847 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5848 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5849 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5850 Program a Signal}.
5851
5852 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5853 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5854
5855 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5856 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5857 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5858 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5859 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5860 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5861 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5862 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5863 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5864 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5865 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5866 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5867 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5868
5869 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5870
5871 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5872 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5873 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5874 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5875
5876 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5877 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5878 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5879 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5880
5881 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5882 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5883
5884 @smallexample
5885 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5886 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5887 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5888 (@value{GDBP}) c
5889 Continuing.
5890
5891 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5892 main () sigusr1.c:28
5893 28 p = 0;
5894 (@value{GDBP}) si
5895 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5896 9 @{
5897 @end smallexample
5898
5899 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5900 program to receive the signal first:
5901
5902 @smallexample
5903 (@value{GDBP}) n
5904 28 p = 0;
5905 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5906 (@value{GDBP}) si
5907 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5908 9 @{
5909 (@value{GDBP})
5910 @end smallexample
5911
5912 @cindex extra signal information
5913 @anchor{extra signal information}
5914
5915 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5916 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5917 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5918 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5919 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5920 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5921 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5922 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5923 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5924 system header.
5925
5926 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5927 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5928
5929 @smallexample
5930 @group
5931 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5932 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5933 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5934 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5935 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5936 type = struct @{
5937 int si_signo;
5938 int si_errno;
5939 int si_code;
5940 union @{
5941 int _pad[28];
5942 struct @{...@} _kill;
5943 struct @{...@} _timer;
5944 struct @{...@} _rt;
5945 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5946 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5947 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5948 @} _sifields;
5949 @}
5950 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5951 type = struct @{
5952 void *si_addr;
5953 @}
5954 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5955 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5956 @end group
5957 @end smallexample
5958
5959 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5960
5961 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5962 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5963 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5964 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5965 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5966 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5967 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5968 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5969 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5970 information is displayed.
5971
5972 The usual output of a segfault is:
5973 @smallexample
5974 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5975 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5976 68 value = *(p + len);
5977 @end smallexample
5978
5979 While a bound violation is presented as:
5980 @smallexample
5981 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5982 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5983 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
5984 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5985 68 value = *(p + len);
5986 @end smallexample
5987
5988 @node Thread Stops
5989 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5990
5991 @cindex stopped threads
5992 @cindex threads, stopped
5993
5994 @cindex continuing threads
5995 @cindex threads, continuing
5996
5997 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5998 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5999 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6000 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6001 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6002 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6003 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6004 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6005 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6006
6007 @menu
6008 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6009 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6010 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6011 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6012 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6013 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6014 @end menu
6015
6016 @node All-Stop Mode
6017 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6018
6019 @cindex all-stop mode
6020
6021 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6022 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6023 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6024 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6025 underfoot.
6026
6027 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6028 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6029 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6030
6031 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6032 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6033 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6034 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6035 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6036 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6037 stops.
6038
6039 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6040 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6041 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6042 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6043
6044 @cindex automatic thread selection
6045 @cindex switching threads automatically
6046 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6047 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6048 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6049 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6050 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6051 thread.
6052
6053 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6054 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6055
6056 @table @code
6057 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6058 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6059 @cindex lock scheduler
6060 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6061 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6062 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6063 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6064 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6065 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6066 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6067 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6068 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6069 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6070 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6071 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6072 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6073 @code{on} in replay mode.
6074
6075 @item show scheduler-locking
6076 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6077 @end table
6078
6079 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6080 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6081 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6082 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6083 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6084 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6085 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6086 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6087 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6088 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6089 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6090 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6091 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6092 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6093
6094 @table @code
6095 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6096 @item set schedule-multiple
6097 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6098 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6099 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6100 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6101 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6102 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6103
6104 @item show schedule-multiple
6105 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6106 multiple processes.
6107 @end table
6108
6109 @node Non-Stop Mode
6110 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6111
6112 @cindex non-stop mode
6113
6114 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6115 @c with more details.
6116
6117 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6118 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6119 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6120 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6121 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6122 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6123
6124 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6125 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6126 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6127 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6128 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6129 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6130 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6131 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6132 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6133 independently and simultaneously.
6134
6135 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6136 or attach to your program:
6137
6138 @smallexample
6139 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6140 set pagination off
6141
6142 # Finally, turn it on!
6143 set non-stop on
6144 @end smallexample
6145
6146 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6147
6148 @table @code
6149 @kindex set non-stop
6150 @item set non-stop on
6151 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6152 @item set non-stop off
6153 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6154 @kindex show non-stop
6155 @item show non-stop
6156 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6157 @end table
6158
6159 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6160 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6161 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6162 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6163 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6164 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6165 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6166 default.
6167
6168 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6169 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6170 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6171
6172 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6173 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6174 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6175 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6176 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6177
6178 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6179 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6180 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6181 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6182 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6183
6184 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6185
6186 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6187 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6188 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6189 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6190 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6191 previously current thread.
6192
6193 @node Background Execution
6194 @subsection Background Execution
6195
6196 @cindex foreground execution
6197 @cindex background execution
6198 @cindex asynchronous execution
6199 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6200
6201 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6202 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6203 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6204 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6205 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6206 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6207
6208 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6209 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6210
6211 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6212 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6213 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6214 are:
6215
6216 @table @code
6217 @kindex run&
6218 @item run
6219 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6220
6221 @item attach
6222 @kindex attach&
6223 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6224
6225 @item step
6226 @kindex step&
6227 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6228
6229 @item stepi
6230 @kindex stepi&
6231 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6232
6233 @item next
6234 @kindex next&
6235 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6236
6237 @item nexti
6238 @kindex nexti&
6239 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6240
6241 @item continue
6242 @kindex continue&
6243 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6244
6245 @item finish
6246 @kindex finish&
6247 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6248
6249 @item until
6250 @kindex until&
6251 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6252
6253 @end table
6254
6255 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6256 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6257 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6258 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6259 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6260 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6261
6262 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6263 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6264
6265 @table @code
6266 @kindex interrupt
6267 @item interrupt
6268 @itemx interrupt -a
6269
6270 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6271 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6272 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6273 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6274 @end table
6275
6276 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6277 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6278
6279 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6280 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6281 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6282
6283 @table @code
6284 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6285 @cindex thread breakpoints
6286 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6287 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6288 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6289 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6290 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6291 specify some source line.
6292
6293 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6294 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6295 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6296 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6297 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6298
6299 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6300 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6301 program.
6302
6303 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6304 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6305 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6306
6307 @smallexample
6308 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6309 @end smallexample
6310
6311 @end table
6312
6313 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6314 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6315 thread list. For example:
6316
6317 @smallexample
6318 (@value{GDBP}) c
6319 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6320 @end smallexample
6321
6322 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6323 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6324 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6325 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6326 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6327 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6328 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6329 command.
6330
6331 @node Interrupted System Calls
6332 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6333
6334 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6335 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6336 @cindex premature return from system calls
6337 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6338 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6339 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6340 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6341 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6342 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6343 stop execution.
6344
6345 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6346 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6347 style anyways.
6348
6349 For example, do not write code like this:
6350
6351 @smallexample
6352 sleep (10);
6353 @end smallexample
6354
6355 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6356 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6357
6358 Instead, write this:
6359
6360 @smallexample
6361 int unslept = 10;
6362 while (unslept > 0)
6363 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6364 @end smallexample
6365
6366 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6367 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6368 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6369 @value{GDBN}.
6370
6371 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6372 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6373 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6374 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6375
6376 @node Observer Mode
6377 @subsection Observer Mode
6378
6379 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6380 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6381 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6382 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6383 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6384
6385 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6386 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6387 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6388 mode.
6389
6390 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6391 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6392 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6393 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6394 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6395
6396 @table @code
6397
6398 @kindex observer
6399 @item set observer on
6400 @itemx set observer off
6401 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6402 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6403 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6404 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6405
6406 @item show observer
6407 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6408
6409 @kindex may-write-registers
6410 @item set may-write-registers on
6411 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6412 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6413 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6414 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6415
6416 @item show may-write-registers
6417 Show the current permission to write registers.
6418
6419 @kindex may-write-memory
6420 @item set may-write-memory on
6421 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6422 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6423 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6424 defaults to @code{on}.
6425
6426 @item show may-write-memory
6427 Show the current permission to write memory.
6428
6429 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6430 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6431 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6432 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6433 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6434 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6435
6436 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6437 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6438
6439 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6440 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6441 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6442 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6443 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6444 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6445 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6446
6447 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6448 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6449
6450 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6451 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6452 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6453 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6454 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6455 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6456 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6457
6458 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6459 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6460
6461 @kindex may-interrupt
6462 @item set may-interrupt on
6463 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6464 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6465 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6466 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6467 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6468
6469 @item show may-interrupt
6470 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6471
6472 @end table
6473
6474 @node Reverse Execution
6475 @chapter Running programs backward
6476 @cindex reverse execution
6477 @cindex running programs backward
6478
6479 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6480 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6481 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6482 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6483
6484 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6485 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6486 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6487 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6488 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6489 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6490
6491 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6492 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6493 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6494 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6495 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6496 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6497 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6498 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6499 prior values@footnote{
6500 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6501 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6502 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6503
6504 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6505 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6506 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6507 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6508 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6509 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6510 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6511 }.
6512
6513 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6514 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6515
6516 @table @code
6517 @kindex reverse-continue
6518 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6519 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6520 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6521 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6522 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6523 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6524 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6525
6526 @kindex reverse-step
6527 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6528 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6529 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6530 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6531
6532 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6533 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6534 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6535 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6536 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6537 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6538
6539 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6540 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6541
6542 @kindex reverse-stepi
6543 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6544 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6545 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6546 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6547 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6548 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6549 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6550
6551 @kindex reverse-next
6552 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6553 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6554 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6555 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6556 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6557 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6558 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6559 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6560 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6561 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6562
6563 @kindex reverse-nexti
6564 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6565 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6566 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6567 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6568 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6569 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6570 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6571 frame) is reached.
6572
6573 @kindex reverse-finish
6574 @item reverse-finish
6575 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6576 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6577 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6578 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6579
6580 @kindex set exec-direction
6581 @item set exec-direction
6582 Set the direction of target execution.
6583 @item set exec-direction reverse
6584 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6585 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6586 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6587 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6588 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6589 @item set exec-direction forward
6590 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6591 This is the default.
6592 @end table
6593
6594
6595 @node Process Record and Replay
6596 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6597 @cindex process record and replay
6598 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6599
6600 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6601 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6602 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6603
6604 @cindex replay mode
6605 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6606 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6607 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6608 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6609 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6610 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6611 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6612 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6613 execution log.
6614
6615 @cindex record mode
6616 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6617 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6618 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6619 for future replay.
6620
6621 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6622 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6623 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6624 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6625 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6626 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6627
6628 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6629 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6630 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6631 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6632
6633 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6634 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6635
6636 @table @code
6637 @kindex target record
6638 @kindex target record-full
6639 @kindex target record-btrace
6640 @kindex record
6641 @kindex record full
6642 @kindex record btrace
6643 @kindex record btrace bts
6644 @kindex record btrace pt
6645 @kindex record bts
6646 @kindex record pt
6647 @kindex rec
6648 @kindex rec full
6649 @kindex rec btrace
6650 @kindex rec btrace bts
6651 @kindex rec btrace pt
6652 @kindex rec bts
6653 @kindex rec pt
6654 @item record @var{method}
6655 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6656 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6657 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6658 recording methods are available:
6659
6660 @table @code
6661 @item full
6662 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6663 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6664 execution.
6665
6666 @item btrace @var{format}
6667 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6668 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6669 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6670 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6671 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6672 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6673 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6674
6675 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6676 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6677 formats are available:
6678
6679 @table @code
6680 @item bts
6681 @cindex branch trace store
6682 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6683 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6684 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6685
6686 @item pt
6687 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6688 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6689 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6690 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6691
6692 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6693 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6694 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6695
6696 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6697 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6698 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6699 buffer-size with care.
6700 @end table
6701
6702 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6703 @end table
6704
6705 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6706 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6707 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6708 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6709
6710 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6711 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6712 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6713 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6714 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6715
6716 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6717 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6718 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6719 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6720 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6721 does not support these two modes.
6722
6723 @kindex record stop
6724 @kindex rec s
6725 @item record stop
6726 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6727 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6728 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6729
6730 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6731 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6732 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6733 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6734 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6735
6736 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6737 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6738 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6739 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6740 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6741
6742 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6743 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6744
6745 @kindex record goto
6746 @item record goto
6747 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6748 ways to specify the location to go to:
6749
6750 @table @code
6751 @item record goto begin
6752 @itemx record goto start
6753 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6754
6755 @item record goto end
6756 Go to the end of the execution log.
6757
6758 @item record goto @var{n}
6759 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6760 @end table
6761
6762 @kindex record save
6763 @item record save @var{filename}
6764 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6765 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6766 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6767
6768 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6769
6770 @kindex record restore
6771 @item record restore @var{filename}
6772 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6773 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6774
6775 @kindex set record full
6776 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6777 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6778 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6779 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6780
6781 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6782 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6783 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6784 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6785 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6786 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6787 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6788 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6789
6790 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6791 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6792 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6793
6794 @kindex show record full
6795 @item show record full insn-number-max
6796 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6797 recording method.
6798
6799 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6800 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6801 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6802 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6803 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6804 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6805 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6806 oldest one to be deleted.
6807
6808 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6809 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6810
6811 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6812 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6813
6814 @item set record full memory-query
6815 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6816 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6817 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6818 case.
6819
6820 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6821 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6822 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6823 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6824 results.
6825
6826 @item show record full memory-query
6827 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6828
6829 @kindex set record btrace
6830 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6831 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6832 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6833 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6834 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6835 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6836 You can use the following command for that:
6837
6838 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6839 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6840 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6841 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6842 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6843 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6844 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6845 position.
6846
6847 @kindex show record btrace
6848 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6849 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6850
6851 @kindex set record btrace bts
6852 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6853 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6854 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6855 format. Default is 64KB.
6856
6857 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6858 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6859 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6860 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6861 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6862 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6863 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6864
6865 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6866 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6867
6868 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6869 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6870
6871 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6872 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6873 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6874
6875 @kindex set record btrace pt
6876 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6877 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6878 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6879 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6880
6881 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6882 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6883 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6884 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6885 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6886 actual buffer size for each thread.
6887
6888 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6889 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6890
6891 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6892 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6893
6894 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6895 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6896 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6897
6898 @kindex info record
6899 @item info record
6900 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6901 method:
6902
6903 @table @code
6904 @item full
6905 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6906 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6907
6908 @itemize @bullet
6909 @item
6910 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6911 @item
6912 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6913 @item
6914 Highest recorded instruction number.
6915 @item
6916 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6917 @item
6918 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6919 @item
6920 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6921 @end itemize
6922
6923 @item btrace
6924 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6925
6926 @itemize @bullet
6927 @item
6928 Recording format.
6929 @item
6930 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6931 @item
6932 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6933 instructions.
6934 @item
6935 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6936 @end itemize
6937
6938 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6939 @itemize @bullet
6940 @item
6941 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6942 @end itemize
6943
6944 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6945 @itemize @bullet
6946 @item
6947 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6948 @end itemize
6949 @end table
6950
6951 @kindex record delete
6952 @kindex rec del
6953 @item record delete
6954 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6955 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6956 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6957 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6958
6959 @kindex record instruction-history
6960 @kindex rec instruction-history
6961 @item record instruction-history
6962 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6963 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6964 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6965 are printed in execution order.
6966
6967 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6968 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6969 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6970
6971 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6972 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6973 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6974 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6975 @code{/p} modifier.
6976
6977 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6978 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6979 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6980
6981 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6982 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6983
6984 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6985 disassemble:
6986
6987 @table @code
6988 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6989 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6990 @var{insn}.
6991
6992 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6993 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6994 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6995 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6996 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6997 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6998
6999 @item record instruction-history
7000 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7001
7002 @item record instruction-history -
7003 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7004
7005 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7006 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7007 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7008 number @var{end} is included.
7009 @end table
7010
7011 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7012
7013 @kindex set record
7014 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7015 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7016 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7017 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7018 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7019
7020 @kindex show record
7021 @item show record instruction-history-size
7022 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7023 instruction-history} command.
7024
7025 @kindex record function-call-history
7026 @kindex rec function-call-history
7027 @item record function-call-history
7028 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7029 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7030 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7031 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7032 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7033 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7034 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7035 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7036 given together.
7037
7038 @smallexample
7039 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7040 1 void foo (void)
7041 2 @{
7042 3 @}
7043 4
7044 5 void bar (void)
7045 6 @{
7046 7 ...
7047 8 foo ();
7048 9 ...
7049 10 @}
7050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7051 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7052 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7053 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7054 @end smallexample
7055
7056 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7057 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7058 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7059 to print:
7060
7061 @table @code
7062 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7063 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7064
7065 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7066 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7067 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7068 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7069 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7070
7071 @item record function-call-history
7072 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7073
7074 @item record function-call-history -
7075 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7076
7077 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7078 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7079 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7080 @end table
7081
7082 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7083
7084 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7085 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7086 Define how many lines to print in the
7087 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7088 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7089
7090 @item show record function-call-history-size
7091 Show how many lines to print in the
7092 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7093 @end table
7094
7095
7096 @node Stack
7097 @chapter Examining the Stack
7098
7099 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7100 stopped and how it got there.
7101
7102 @cindex call stack
7103 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7104 is generated.
7105 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7106 the arguments of the call,
7107 and the local variables of the function being called.
7108 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7109 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7110 stack}.
7111
7112 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7113 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7114
7115 @cindex selected frame
7116 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7117 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7118 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7119 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7120 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7121 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7122
7123 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7124 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7125 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7126
7127 @menu
7128 * Frames:: Stack frames
7129 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7130 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7131 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7132 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7133
7134 @end menu
7135
7136 @node Frames
7137 @section Stack Frames
7138
7139 @cindex frame, definition
7140 @cindex stack frame
7141 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7142 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7143 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7144 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7145 which the function is executing.
7146
7147 @cindex initial frame
7148 @cindex outermost frame
7149 @cindex innermost frame
7150 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7151 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7152 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7153 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7154 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7155 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7156 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7157 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7158
7159 @cindex frame pointer
7160 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7161 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7162 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7163 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7164 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7165 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7166
7167 @cindex frame number
7168 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7169 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7170 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7171 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7172 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7173
7174 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7175 @c underflow problems.
7176 @cindex frameless execution
7177 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7178 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7179 @smallexample
7180 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7181 @end smallexample
7182 generates functions without a frame.)
7183 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7184 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7185 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7186 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7187 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7188 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7189 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7190
7191 @node Backtrace
7192 @section Backtraces
7193
7194 @cindex traceback
7195 @cindex call stack traces
7196 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7197 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7198 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7199 stack.
7200
7201 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7202 @table @code
7203 @kindex backtrace
7204 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7205 @item backtrace
7206 @itemx bt
7207 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7208 frames in the stack.
7209
7210 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7211 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7212
7213 @item backtrace @var{n}
7214 @itemx bt @var{n}
7215 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7216
7217 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7218 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7219 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7220
7221 @item backtrace full
7222 @itemx bt full
7223 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7224 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7225 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7226 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7227
7228 @item backtrace no-filters
7229 @itemx bt no-filters
7230 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7231 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7232 @itemx bt no-filters full
7233 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7234 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7235 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7236 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7237 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7238 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7239 support.
7240 @end table
7241
7242 @kindex where
7243 @kindex info stack
7244 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7245 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7246
7247 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7248 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7249 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7250 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7251 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7252 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7253 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7254 multi-threaded program.
7255
7256 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7257 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7258 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7259 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7260 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7261 line number.
7262
7263 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7264 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7265
7266 @smallexample
7267 @group
7268 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7269 at builtin.c:993
7270 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7271 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7272 at macro.c:71
7273 (More stack frames follow...)
7274 @end group
7275 @end smallexample
7276
7277 @noindent
7278 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7279 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7280 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7281
7282 @noindent
7283 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7284 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7285 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7286 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7287 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7288
7289 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7290 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7291 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7292 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7293 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7294 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7295 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7296 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7297 such a backtrace might look like:
7298
7299 @smallexample
7300 @group
7301 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7302 at builtin.c:993
7303 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7304 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7305 at macro.c:71
7306 (More stack frames follow...)
7307 @end group
7308 @end smallexample
7309
7310 @noindent
7311 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7312 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7313
7314 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7315 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7316 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7317
7318 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7319 @cindex program entry point
7320 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7321 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7322 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7323 @code{main}@footnote{
7324 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7325 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7326 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7327 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7328 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7329 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7330
7331 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7332 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7333
7334 @table @code
7335 @item set backtrace past-main
7336 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7337 @kindex set backtrace
7338 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7339
7340 @item set backtrace past-main off
7341 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7342 default.
7343
7344 @item show backtrace past-main
7345 @kindex show backtrace
7346 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7347
7348 @item set backtrace past-entry
7349 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7350 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7351 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7352 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7353
7354 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7355 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7356 application. This is the default.
7357
7358 @item show backtrace past-entry
7359 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7360
7361 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7362 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7363 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7364 @cindex backtrace limit
7365 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7366 or zero means unlimited levels.
7367
7368 @item show backtrace limit
7369 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7370 @end table
7371
7372 You can control how file names are displayed.
7373
7374 @table @code
7375 @item set filename-display
7376 @itemx set filename-display relative
7377 @cindex filename-display
7378 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7379
7380 @item set filename-display basename
7381 Display only basename of a filename.
7382
7383 @item set filename-display absolute
7384 Display an absolute filename.
7385
7386 @item show filename-display
7387 Show the current way to display filenames.
7388 @end table
7389
7390 @node Selection
7391 @section Selecting a Frame
7392
7393 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7394 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7395 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7396 of the stack frame just selected.
7397
7398 @table @code
7399 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7400 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7401 @item frame @var{n}
7402 @itemx f @var{n}
7403 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7404 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7405 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7406 @code{main}.
7407
7408 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7409 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7410 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7411 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7412 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7413 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7414 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7415 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7416
7417 @kindex up
7418 @item up @var{n}
7419 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7420 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7421 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7422
7423 @kindex down
7424 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7425 @item down @var{n}
7426 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7427 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7428 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7429 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7430 @end table
7431
7432 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7433 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7434 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7435 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7436
7437 @need 1000
7438 For example:
7439
7440 @smallexample
7441 @group
7442 (@value{GDBP}) up
7443 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7444 at env.c:10
7445 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7446 @end group
7447 @end smallexample
7448
7449 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7450 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7451 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7452 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7453 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7454 for details.
7455
7456 @table @code
7457 @kindex select-frame
7458 @item select-frame
7459 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7460 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7461 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7462 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7463
7464 @kindex down-silently
7465 @kindex up-silently
7466 @item up-silently @var{n}
7467 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7468 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7469 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7470 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7471 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7472 distracting.
7473 @end table
7474
7475 @node Frame Info
7476 @section Information About a Frame
7477
7478 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7479 stack frame.
7480
7481 @table @code
7482 @item frame
7483 @itemx f
7484 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7485 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7486 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7487 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7488 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7489
7490 @kindex info frame
7491 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7492 @item info frame
7493 @itemx info f
7494 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7495 including:
7496
7497 @itemize @bullet
7498 @item
7499 the address of the frame
7500 @item
7501 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7502 @item
7503 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7504 @item
7505 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7506 @item
7507 the address of the frame's arguments
7508 @item
7509 the address of the frame's local variables
7510 @item
7511 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7512 @item
7513 which registers were saved in the frame
7514 @end itemize
7515
7516 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7517 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7518 the usual conventions.
7519
7520 @item info frame @var{addr}
7521 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7522 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7523 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7524 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7525 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7526 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7527
7528 @kindex info args
7529 @item info args
7530 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7531
7532 @item info locals
7533 @kindex info locals
7534 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7535 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7536 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7537
7538 @end table
7539
7540 @node Frame Filter Management
7541 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7542 @cindex managing frame filters
7543
7544 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7545 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7546
7547 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7548 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7549
7550 @table @code
7551 @kindex info frame-filter
7552 @item info frame-filter
7553 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7554 their name, priority and enabled status.
7555
7556 @kindex disable frame-filter
7557 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7558 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7559 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7560 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7561 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7562 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7563 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7564 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7565 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7566 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7567 may be enabled again later.
7568
7569 @kindex enable frame-filter
7570 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7571 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7572 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7573 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7574 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7575 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7576 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7577 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7578 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7579
7580 Example:
7581
7582 @smallexample
7583 (gdb) info frame-filter
7584
7585 global frame-filters:
7586 Priority Enabled Name
7587 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7588 100 Yes Reverse
7589
7590 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7591 Priority Enabled Name
7592 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7593
7594 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7595 Priority Enabled Name
7596 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7597
7598 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7599 (gdb) info frame-filter
7600
7601 global frame-filters:
7602 Priority Enabled Name
7603 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7604 100 Yes Reverse
7605
7606 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7607 Priority Enabled Name
7608 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7609
7610 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7611 Priority Enabled Name
7612 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7613
7614 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7615 (gdb) info frame-filter
7616
7617 global frame-filters:
7618 Priority Enabled Name
7619 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7620 100 Yes Reverse
7621
7622 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7623 Priority Enabled Name
7624 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7625
7626 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7627 Priority Enabled Name
7628 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7629 @end smallexample
7630
7631 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7632 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7633 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7634 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7635 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7636 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7637 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7638
7639 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7640 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7641 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7642 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7643 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7644 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7645 dictionary resides.
7646
7647 Example:
7648
7649 @smallexample
7650 (gdb) info frame-filter
7651
7652 global frame-filters:
7653 Priority Enabled Name
7654 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7655 100 Yes Reverse
7656
7657 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7658 Priority Enabled Name
7659 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7660
7661 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7662 Priority Enabled Name
7663 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7664
7665 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7666 (gdb) info frame-filter
7667
7668 global frame-filters:
7669 Priority Enabled Name
7670 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7671 50 Yes Reverse
7672
7673 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7674 Priority Enabled Name
7675 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7676
7677 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7678 Priority Enabled Name
7679 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7680 @end smallexample
7681 @end table
7682
7683 @node Source
7684 @chapter Examining Source Files
7685
7686 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7687 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7688 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7689 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7690 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7691 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7692 source files by explicit command.
7693
7694 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7695 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7696 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7697
7698 @menu
7699 * List:: Printing source lines
7700 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7701 * Edit:: Editing source files
7702 * Search:: Searching source files
7703 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7704 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7705 @end menu
7706
7707 @node List
7708 @section Printing Source Lines
7709
7710 @kindex list
7711 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7712 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7713 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7714 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7715 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7716
7717 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7718
7719 @table @code
7720 @item list @var{linenum}
7721 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7722 current source file.
7723
7724 @item list @var{function}
7725 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7726 @var{function}.
7727
7728 @item list
7729 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7730 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7731 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7732 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7733 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7734
7735 @item list -
7736 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7737 @end table
7738
7739 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7740 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7741 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7742
7743 @table @code
7744 @kindex set listsize
7745 @item set listsize @var{count}
7746 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7747 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7748 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7749 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7750
7751 @kindex show listsize
7752 @item show listsize
7753 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7754 @end table
7755
7756 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7757 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7758 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7759 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7760 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7761
7762 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7763 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7764 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7765 to specify some source line.
7766
7767 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7768
7769 @table @code
7770 @item list @var{location}
7771 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7772
7773 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7774 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7775 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7776 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7777 the same source file as the first location.
7778
7779 @item list ,@var{last}
7780 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7781
7782 @item list @var{first},
7783 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7784
7785 @item list +
7786 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7787
7788 @item list -
7789 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7790
7791 @item list
7792 As described in the preceding table.
7793 @end table
7794
7795 @node Specify Location
7796 @section Specifying a Location
7797 @cindex specifying location
7798 @cindex location
7799 @cindex source location
7800
7801 @menu
7802 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7803 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7804 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7805 @end menu
7806
7807 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7808 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7809 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7810 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7811 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7812
7813 @node Linespec Locations
7814 @subsection Linespec Locations
7815 @cindex linespec locations
7816
7817 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7818 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7819 specifying a linespec:
7820
7821 @table @code
7822 @item @var{linenum}
7823 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7824
7825 @item -@var{offset}
7826 @itemx +@var{offset}
7827 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7828 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7829 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7830 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7831 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7832 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7833 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7834 linespec.
7835
7836 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7837 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7838 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7839 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7840 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7841 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7842 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7843
7844 @item @var{function}
7845 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7846 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7847
7848 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7849 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7850
7851 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7852 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7853 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7854 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7855 functions in different source files.
7856
7857 @item @var{label}
7858 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7859 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7860 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7861 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7862
7863 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7864 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7865 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7866 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7867 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7868 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7869
7870 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7871 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7872 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7873 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7874 each one of those probes.
7875 @end table
7876
7877 @node Explicit Locations
7878 @subsection Explicit Locations
7879 @cindex explicit locations
7880
7881 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7882 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7883
7884 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7885 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7886 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7887 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7888 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7889
7890 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7891 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7892 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7893 the symbol table to know.
7894
7895 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7896 following table:
7897
7898 @table @code
7899 @item -source @var{filename}
7900 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7901 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7902 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7903 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7904 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7905
7906 @item -function @var{function}
7907 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7908 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7909 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7910 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7911
7912 @item -label @var{label}
7913 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7914 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7915 selected stack frame.
7916
7917 @item -line @var{number}
7918 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7919 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7920 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7921 relative to the current line.
7922 @end table
7923
7924 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7925 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7926
7927 @node Address Locations
7928 @subsection Address Locations
7929 @cindex address locations
7930
7931 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7932 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7933
7934 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7935 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7936 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7937 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7938 source files.
7939
7940 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7941 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7942 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7943 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7944 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7945 of @var{address}:
7946
7947 @table @code
7948 @item @var{expression}
7949 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7950
7951 @item @var{funcaddr}
7952 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7953 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7954 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7955 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7956 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7957 (although the Pascal form also works).
7958
7959 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7960 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7961
7962 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7963 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7964 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7965 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7966 functions with identical names in different source files.
7967 @end table
7968
7969 @node Edit
7970 @section Editing Source Files
7971 @cindex editing source files
7972
7973 @kindex edit
7974 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7975 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7976 The editing program of your choice
7977 is invoked with the current line set to
7978 the active line in the program.
7979 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7980 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7981
7982 @table @code
7983 @item edit @var{location}
7984 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7985 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7986 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7987 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7988 command most commonly used:
7989
7990 @table @code
7991 @item edit @var{number}
7992 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7993
7994 @item edit @var{function}
7995 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7996 @end table
7997
7998 @end table
7999
8000 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8001 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8002 @footnote{
8003 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8004 following command-line syntax:
8005 @smallexample
8006 ex +@var{number} file
8007 @end smallexample
8008 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8009 the file where to start editing.}.
8010 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8011 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8012 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8013 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8014 @smallexample
8015 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8016 export EDITOR
8017 gdb @dots{}
8018 @end smallexample
8019 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8020 @smallexample
8021 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8022 gdb @dots{}
8023 @end smallexample
8024
8025 @node Search
8026 @section Searching Source Files
8027 @cindex searching source files
8028
8029 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8030 regular expression.
8031
8032 @table @code
8033 @kindex search
8034 @kindex forward-search
8035 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8036 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8037 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8038 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8039 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8040 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8041 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8042 @code{fo}.
8043
8044 @kindex reverse-search
8045 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8046 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8047 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8048 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8049 this command as @code{rev}.
8050 @end table
8051
8052 @node Source Path
8053 @section Specifying Source Directories
8054
8055 @cindex source path
8056 @cindex directories for source files
8057 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8058 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8059 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8060 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8061 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8062 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8063 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8064
8065 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8066 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8067 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8068 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8069 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8070 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8071 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8072 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8073 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8074 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8075 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8076
8077 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8078 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8079 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8080 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8081 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8082 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8083
8084 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8085 source files.
8086
8087 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8088 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8089 each line is in the file.
8090
8091 @kindex directory
8092 @kindex dir
8093 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8094 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8095 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8096
8097 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8098 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8099
8100 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8101 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8102 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8103 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8104 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8105 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8106 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8107 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8108 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8109 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8110 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8111 name to look up the sources.
8112
8113 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8114 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8115 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8116 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8117 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8118 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8119 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8120 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8121
8122 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8123 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8124 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8125 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8126 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8127 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8128 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8129
8130 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8131 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8132 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8133 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8134 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8135 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8136 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8137 command.
8138
8139 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8140 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8141 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8142 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8143 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8144 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8145 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8146
8147 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8148 @cindex default source path substitution
8149 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8150 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8151 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8152 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8153 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8154 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8155 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8156 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8157 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8158 together.
8159
8160 @table @code
8161 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8162 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8163 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8164 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8165 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8166 part of absolute file names) or
8167 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8168 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8169
8170 @kindex cdir
8171 @kindex cwd
8172 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8173 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8174 @cindex compilation directory
8175 @cindex current directory
8176 @cindex working directory
8177 @cindex directory, current
8178 @cindex directory, compilation
8179 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8180 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8181 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8182 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8183 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8184 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8185
8186 @item directory
8187 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8188
8189 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8190 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8191
8192 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8193 @kindex set directories
8194 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8195 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8196
8197 @item show directories
8198 @kindex show directories
8199 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8200
8201 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8202 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8203 @kindex set substitute-path
8204 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8205 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8206 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8207
8208 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8209 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8210
8211 @smallexample
8212 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8213 @end smallexample
8214
8215 @noindent
8216 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8217 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8218 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8219
8220 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8221 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8222 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8223 the substitution.
8224
8225 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8226
8227 @smallexample
8228 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8229 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8230 @end smallexample
8231
8232 @noindent
8233 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8234 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8235 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8236 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8237
8238
8239 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8240 @kindex unset substitute-path
8241 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8242 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8243 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8244
8245 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8246
8247 @item show substitute-path [path]
8248 @kindex show substitute-path
8249 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8250 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8251
8252 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8253 rules.
8254
8255 @end table
8256
8257 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8258 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8259 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8260
8261 @enumerate
8262 @item
8263 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8264
8265 @item
8266 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8267 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8268 directories in one command.
8269 @end enumerate
8270
8271 @node Machine Code
8272 @section Source and Machine Code
8273 @cindex source line and its code address
8274
8275 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8276 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8277 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8278 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8279 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8280 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8281 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8282 well as hex.
8283
8284 @table @code
8285 @kindex info line
8286 @item info line @var{location}
8287 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8288 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8289 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8290 @end table
8291
8292 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8293 the object code for the first line of function
8294 @code{m4_changequote}:
8295
8296 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8297 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8298 @smallexample
8299 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8300 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8301 @end smallexample
8302
8303 @noindent
8304 @cindex code address and its source line
8305 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8306 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8307 @smallexample
8308 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8309 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8310 @end smallexample
8311
8312 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8313 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8314 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8315 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8316 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8317 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8318 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8319 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8320 Variables}).
8321
8322 @table @code
8323 @kindex disassemble
8324 @cindex assembly instructions
8325 @cindex instructions, assembly
8326 @cindex machine instructions
8327 @cindex listing machine instructions
8328 @item disassemble
8329 @itemx disassemble /m
8330 @itemx disassemble /s
8331 @itemx disassemble /r
8332 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8333 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8334 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8335 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8336 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8337 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8338 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8339 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8340 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8341 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8342
8343 @table @code
8344 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8345 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8346 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8347 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8348 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8349 @end table
8350
8351 @noindent
8352 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8353 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8354
8355 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8356 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8357
8358 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8359 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8360 @end table
8361
8362 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8363 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8364
8365 @smallexample
8366 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8367 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8368 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8369 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8370 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8371 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8372 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8373 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8374 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8375 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8376 End of assembler dump.
8377 @end smallexample
8378
8379 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8380 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8381 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8382
8383 @smallexample
8384 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8385 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8386 5 @{
8387 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8388 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8389 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8390 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8391 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8392
8393 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8394 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8395 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8396
8397 7 return 0;
8398 8 @}
8399 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8400 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8401 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8402
8403 End of assembler dump.
8404 @end smallexample
8405
8406 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8407 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8408 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8409 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8410 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8411 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8412 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8413 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8414 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8415
8416 @file{foo.h}:
8417
8418 @smallexample
8419 int
8420 foo (int a)
8421 @{
8422 if (a < 0)
8423 return a * 2;
8424 if (a == 0)
8425 return 1;
8426 return a + 10;
8427 @}
8428 @end smallexample
8429
8430 @file{foo.c}:
8431
8432 @smallexample
8433 #include "foo.h"
8434 volatile int x, y;
8435 int
8436 main ()
8437 @{
8438 x = foo (y);
8439 return 0;
8440 @}
8441 @end smallexample
8442
8443 @smallexample
8444 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8445 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8446 5 @{
8447
8448 6 x = foo (y);
8449 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8450 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8451
8452 7 return 0;
8453 8 @}
8454 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8455 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8456 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8457 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8458
8459 End of assembler dump.
8460 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8461 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8462 foo.c:
8463 5 @{
8464 6 x = foo (y);
8465 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8466
8467 foo.h:
8468 4 if (a < 0)
8469 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8470 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8471
8472 6 if (a == 0)
8473 7 return 1;
8474 8 return a + 10;
8475 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8476 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8477 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8478 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8479
8480 foo.c:
8481 6 x = foo (y);
8482 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8483
8484 7 return 0;
8485 8 @}
8486 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8487 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8488
8489 foo.h:
8490 5 return a * 2;
8491 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8492 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8493 End of assembler dump.
8494 @end smallexample
8495
8496 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8497
8498 @smallexample
8499 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8500 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8501 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8502 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8503 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8504 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8505 End of assembler dump.
8506 @end smallexample
8507
8508 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8509 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8510 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8511 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8512
8513 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8514 mnemonics or other syntax.
8515
8516 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8517 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8518 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8519 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8520 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8521
8522 @table @code
8523 @kindex set disassembler-options
8524 @cindex disassembler options
8525 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8526 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8527 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8528 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8529 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8530 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8531 The default value is the empty string.
8532
8533 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8534 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8535 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8536 and S/390.
8537
8538 @kindex show disassembler-options
8539 @item show disassembler-options
8540 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8541 @end table
8542
8543 @table @code
8544 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8545 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8546 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8547 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8548 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8549 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8550
8551 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8552 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8553 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8554 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8555
8556 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8557 @item show disassembly-flavor
8558 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8559 @end table
8560
8561 @table @code
8562 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8563 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8564 @item set disassemble-next-line
8565 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8566 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8567 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8568 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8569 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8570 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8571 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8572 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8573 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8574 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8575 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8576 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8577 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8578 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8579 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8580 instruction.
8581 @end table
8582
8583
8584 @node Data
8585 @chapter Examining Data
8586
8587 @cindex printing data
8588 @cindex examining data
8589 @kindex print
8590 @kindex inspect
8591 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8592 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8593 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8594 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8595 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8596 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8597
8598 @table @code
8599 @item print @var{expr}
8600 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8601 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8602 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8603 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8604 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8605 Formats}.
8606
8607 @item print
8608 @itemx print /@var{f}
8609 @cindex reprint the last value
8610 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8611 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8612 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8613 @end table
8614
8615 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8616 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8617 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8618
8619 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8620 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8621 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8622 Table}.
8623
8624 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8625 @kindex explore
8626 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8627 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8628 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8629 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8630 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8631 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8632 embedded in the higher level data types.
8633
8634 @table @code
8635 @item explore @var{arg}
8636 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8637 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8638 @end table
8639
8640 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8641 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8642 C program as
8643
8644 @smallexample
8645 struct SimpleStruct
8646 @{
8647 int i;
8648 double d;
8649 @};
8650
8651 struct ComplexStruct
8652 @{
8653 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8654 int arr[10];
8655 @};
8656 @end smallexample
8657
8658 @noindent
8659 followed by variable declarations as
8660
8661 @smallexample
8662 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8663 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8664 @end smallexample
8665
8666 @noindent
8667 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8668 @code{explore} command as follows.
8669
8670 @smallexample
8671 (gdb) explore cs
8672 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8673 the following fields:
8674
8675 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8676 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8677
8678 Enter the field number of choice:
8679 @end smallexample
8680
8681 @noindent
8682 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8683 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8684 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8685 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8686 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8687 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8688 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8689 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8690
8691 @smallexample
8692 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8693 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8694 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8695 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8696
8697 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8698 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8699
8700 Press enter to return to parent value:
8701 @end smallexample
8702
8703 @noindent
8704 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8705 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8706 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8707 to explore.
8708
8709 @smallexample
8710 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8711 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8712
8713 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8714
8715 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8716
8717 Press enter to return to parent value:
8718 @end smallexample
8719
8720 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8721 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8722 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8723 level data structure).
8724
8725 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8726 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8727 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8728 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8729 same example as above, your can explore the type
8730 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8731 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8732
8733 @smallexample
8734 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8735 @end smallexample
8736
8737 @noindent
8738 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8739 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8740 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8741 example.
8742
8743 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8744 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8745 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8746 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8747 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8748
8749 @table @code
8750 @item explore value @var{expr}
8751 @cindex explore value
8752 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8753 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8754 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8755 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8756 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8757
8758 @item explore type @var{arg}
8759 @cindex explore type
8760 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8761 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8762 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8763 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8764 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8765 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8766 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8767 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8768 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8769 @end table
8770
8771 @menu
8772 * Expressions:: Expressions
8773 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8774 * Variables:: Program variables
8775 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8776 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8777 * Memory:: Examining memory
8778 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8779 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8780 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8781 * Value History:: Value history
8782 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8783 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8784 * Registers:: Registers
8785 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8786 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8787 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8788 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8789 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8790 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8791 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8792 character set than GDB does
8793 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8794 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8795 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8796 @end menu
8797
8798 @node Expressions
8799 @section Expressions
8800
8801 @cindex expressions
8802 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8803 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8804 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8805 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8806 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8807 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8808 @ref{Compilation}.
8809
8810 @cindex arrays in expressions
8811 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8812 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8813 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8814 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8815 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8816 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8817
8818 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8819 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8820 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8821 languages.
8822
8823 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8824 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8825
8826 @cindex casts, in expressions
8827 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8828 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8829 at that address in memory.
8830 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8831
8832 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8833 to programming languages:
8834
8835 @table @code
8836 @item @@
8837 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8838 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8839
8840 @item ::
8841 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8842 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8843
8844 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8845 @cindex type casting memory
8846 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8847 @cindex casts, to view memory
8848 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8849 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8850 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8851 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8852 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8853 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8854 @end table
8855
8856 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8857 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8858 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8859
8860 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8861 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8862 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8863 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8864 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8865 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8866 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8867
8868 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8869 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8870 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8871 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8872 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8873 as well.
8874
8875 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8876 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8877 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8878 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8879 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8880 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8881 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8882 choices.
8883
8884 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8885 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8886 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8887
8888 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8889 @smallexample
8890 @group
8891 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8892 [0] cancel
8893 [1] all
8894 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8895 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8896 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8897 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8898 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8899 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8900 > 2 4 6
8901 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8902 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8903 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8904 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8905 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8906 breakpoints.
8907 (@value{GDBP})
8908 @end group
8909 @end smallexample
8910
8911 @table @code
8912 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8913 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8914 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8915
8916 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8917 is ambiguous.
8918
8919 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8920 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8921 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8922 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8923 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8924 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8925 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8926 in the use of the menu.
8927
8928 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8929 when an ambiguity is detected.
8930
8931 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8932 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8933
8934 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8935 @item show multiple-symbols
8936 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8937 @end table
8938
8939 @node Variables
8940 @section Program Variables
8941
8942 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8943 in your program.
8944
8945 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8946 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8947
8948 @itemize @bullet
8949 @item
8950 global (or file-static)
8951 @end itemize
8952
8953 @noindent or
8954
8955 @itemize @bullet
8956 @item
8957 visible according to the scope rules of the
8958 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8959 @end itemize
8960
8961 @noindent This means that in the function
8962
8963 @smallexample
8964 foo (a)
8965 int a;
8966 @{
8967 bar (a);
8968 @{
8969 int b = test ();
8970 bar (b);
8971 @}
8972 @}
8973 @end smallexample
8974
8975 @noindent
8976 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8977 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8978 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8979 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8980
8981 @cindex variable name conflict
8982 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8983 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8984 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8985 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8986 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8987 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8988 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8989
8990 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8991 @ifnotinfo
8992 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8993 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8994 @end ifnotinfo
8995 @smallexample
8996 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8997 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8998 @end smallexample
8999
9000 @noindent
9001 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9002 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9003 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9004 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9005
9006 @smallexample
9007 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9008 @end smallexample
9009
9010 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9011 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9012 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9013 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9014 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9015
9016 @smallexample
9017 void
9018 foo (int a)
9019 @{
9020 if (a < 10)
9021 bar (a);
9022 else
9023 process (a); /* Stop here */
9024 @}
9025
9026 int
9027 bar (int a)
9028 @{
9029 foo (a + 5);
9030 @}
9031 @end smallexample
9032
9033 @noindent
9034 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9035 here is what you might see
9036 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9037
9038 @smallexample
9039 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9040 $1 = 10
9041 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9042 $2 = 5
9043 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9044 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9045 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9046 $3 = 5
9047 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9048 $4 = 0
9049 @end smallexample
9050
9051 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9052 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9053 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9054 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9055 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9056
9057 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9058 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9059 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9060 @code{some_global}.
9061
9062 @smallexample
9063 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9064 $1 = 23
9065 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9066 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9067 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9068 $2 = 27
9069 @end smallexample
9070
9071 @cindex wrong values
9072 @cindex variable values, wrong
9073 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9074 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9075 @quotation
9076 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9077 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9078 scope, and just before exit.
9079 @end quotation
9080 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9081 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9082 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9083 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9084 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9085 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9086 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9087 variable definitions may be gone.
9088
9089 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9090 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9091 when compiling.
9092
9093 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9094 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9095 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9096 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9097 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9098 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9099 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9100
9101 @smallexample
9102 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9103 @end smallexample
9104
9105 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9106 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9107 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9108 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9109 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9110
9111 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9112 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9113 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9114 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9115
9116 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9117 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9118 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9119 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9120 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9121
9122 @smallexample
9123 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9124 29 i++;
9125 (gdb) next
9126 30 e (i);
9127 (gdb) print i
9128 $1 = 31
9129 (gdb) print i@@entry
9130 $2 = 30
9131 @end smallexample
9132
9133 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9134 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9135 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9136 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9137 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9138 For program code
9139
9140 @smallexample
9141 char var0[] = "A";
9142 signed char var1[] = "A";
9143 @end smallexample
9144
9145 You get during debugging
9146 @smallexample
9147 (gdb) print var0
9148 $1 = "A"
9149 (gdb) print var1
9150 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9151 @end smallexample
9152
9153 @node Arrays
9154 @section Artificial Arrays
9155
9156 @cindex artificial array
9157 @cindex arrays
9158 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9159 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9160 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9161 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9162 program.
9163
9164 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9165 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9166 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9167 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9168 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9169 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9170 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9171 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9172 example. If a program says
9173
9174 @smallexample
9175 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9176 @end smallexample
9177
9178 @noindent
9179 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9180
9181 @smallexample
9182 p *array@@len
9183 @end smallexample
9184
9185 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9186 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9187 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9188 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9189 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9190
9191 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9192 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9193 The value need not be in memory:
9194 @smallexample
9195 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9196 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9197 @end smallexample
9198
9199 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9200 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9201 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9202 @smallexample
9203 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9204 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9205 @end smallexample
9206
9207 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9208 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9209 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9210 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9211 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9212 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9213 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9214 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9215 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9216 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9217
9218 @smallexample
9219 set $i = 0
9220 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9221 @key{RET}
9222 @key{RET}
9223 @dots{}
9224 @end smallexample
9225
9226 @node Output Formats
9227 @section Output Formats
9228
9229 @cindex formatted output
9230 @cindex output formats
9231 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9232 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9233 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9234 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9235 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9236
9237 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9238 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9239 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9240 letters supported are:
9241
9242 @table @code
9243 @item x
9244 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9245 hexadecimal.
9246
9247 @item d
9248 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9249
9250 @item u
9251 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9252
9253 @item o
9254 Print as integer in octal.
9255
9256 @item t
9257 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9258 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9259 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9260 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9261
9262 @item a
9263 @cindex unknown address, locating
9264 @cindex locate address
9265 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9266 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9267 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9268
9269 @smallexample
9270 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9271 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9272 @end smallexample
9273
9274 @noindent
9275 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9276 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9277
9278 @item c
9279 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9280 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9281 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9282 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9283
9284 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9285 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9286 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9287 data.
9288
9289 @item f
9290 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9291 using typical floating point syntax.
9292
9293 @item s
9294 @cindex printing strings
9295 @cindex printing byte arrays
9296 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9297 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9298 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9299 natural types.
9300
9301 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9302 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9303 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9304 array.
9305
9306 @item z
9307 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9308 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9309 to the size of the integer type.
9310
9311 @item r
9312 @cindex raw printing
9313 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9314 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9315 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9316 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9317 pretty-printer which might exist.
9318 @end table
9319
9320 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9321
9322 @smallexample
9323 p/x $pc
9324 @end smallexample
9325
9326 @noindent
9327 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9328 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9329
9330 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9331 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9332 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9333
9334 @node Memory
9335 @section Examining Memory
9336
9337 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9338 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9339
9340 @cindex examining memory
9341 @table @code
9342 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9343 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9344 @itemx x @var{addr}
9345 @itemx x
9346 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9347 @end table
9348
9349 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9350 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9351 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9352 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9353 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9354
9355 @table @r
9356 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9357 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9358 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9359 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9360 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9361 @c 4.1.2.
9362
9363 @item @var{f}, the display format
9364 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9365 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9366 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9367 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9368 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9369
9370 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9371 The unit size is any of
9372
9373 @table @code
9374 @item b
9375 Bytes.
9376 @item h
9377 Halfwords (two bytes).
9378 @item w
9379 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9380 @item g
9381 Giant words (eight bytes).
9382 @end table
9383
9384 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9385 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9386 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9387 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9388 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9389 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9390 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9391 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9392 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9393 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9394 be altered.
9395
9396 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9397 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9398 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9399 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9400 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9401 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9402 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9403 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9404 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9405 a value from memory).
9406 @end table
9407
9408 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9409 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9410 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9411 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9412 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9413
9414 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9415 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9416 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9417
9418 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9419 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9420 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9421 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9422 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9423
9424 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9425 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9426 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9427 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9428 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9429 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9430 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9431 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9432 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9433
9434 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9435 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9436 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9437 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9438 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9439 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9440
9441 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9442 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9443 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9444 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9445 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9446 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9447 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9448
9449 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9450 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9451
9452 @smallexample
9453 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9454 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9455 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9456 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9457 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9458 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9459 @end smallexample
9460
9461 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9462 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9463 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9464 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9465 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9466 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9467 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9468 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9469 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9470
9471 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9472 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9473 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9474
9475 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9476 @cindex addressable memory unit
9477 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9478 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9479 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9480 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9481 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9482 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9483 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9484 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9485 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9486
9487 @cindex remote memory comparison
9488 @cindex target memory comparison
9489 @cindex verify remote memory image
9490 @cindex verify target memory image
9491 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9492 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9493 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9494 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9495 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9496 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9497
9498 @table @code
9499 @kindex compare-sections
9500 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9501 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9502 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9503 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9504 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9505 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9506
9507 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9508 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9509 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9510 @end table
9511
9512 @node Auto Display
9513 @section Automatic Display
9514 @cindex automatic display
9515 @cindex display of expressions
9516
9517 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9518 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9519 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9520 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9521 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9522 The automatic display looks like this:
9523
9524 @smallexample
9525 2: foo = 38
9526 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9527 @end smallexample
9528
9529 @noindent
9530 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9531 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9532 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9533 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9534 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9535 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9536
9537 @table @code
9538 @kindex display
9539 @item display @var{expr}
9540 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9541 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9542
9543 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9544
9545 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9546 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9547 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9548 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9549 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9550
9551 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9552 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9553 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9554 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9555 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9556 @end table
9557
9558 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9559 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9560 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9561
9562 @table @code
9563 @kindex delete display
9564 @kindex undisplay
9565 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9566 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9567 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9568 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9569 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9570 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9571 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9572
9573 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9574 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9575
9576 @kindex disable display
9577 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9578 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9579 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9580 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9581 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9582 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9583 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9584 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9585
9586 @kindex enable display
9587 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9588 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9589 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9590 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9591 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9592 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9593 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9594
9595 @item display
9596 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9597 done when your program stops.
9598
9599 @kindex info display
9600 @item info display
9601 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9602 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9603 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9604 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9605 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9606 @end table
9607
9608 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9609 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9610 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9611 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9612 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9613 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9614 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9615 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9616 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9617 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9618 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9619
9620 @node Print Settings
9621 @section Print Settings
9622
9623 @cindex format options
9624 @cindex print settings
9625 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9626 and symbols are printed.
9627
9628 @noindent
9629 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9630
9631 @table @code
9632 @kindex set print
9633 @item set print address
9634 @itemx set print address on
9635 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9636 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9637 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9638 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9639 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9640 @code{set print address on}:
9641
9642 @smallexample
9643 @group
9644 (@value{GDBP}) f
9645 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9646 at input.c:530
9647 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9648 @end group
9649 @end smallexample
9650
9651 @item set print address off
9652 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9653 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9654
9655 @smallexample
9656 @group
9657 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9658 (@value{GDBP}) f
9659 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9660 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9661 @end group
9662 @end smallexample
9663
9664 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9665 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9666 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9667 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9668
9669 @kindex show print
9670 @item show print address
9671 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9672 @end table
9673
9674 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9675 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9676 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9677 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9678 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9679 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9680 it prints a symbolic address:
9681
9682 @table @code
9683 @item set print symbol-filename on
9684 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9685 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9686 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9687 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9688
9689 @item set print symbol-filename off
9690 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9691 default.
9692
9693 @item show print symbol-filename
9694 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9695 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9696 @end table
9697
9698 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9699 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9700 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9701
9702 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9703 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9704
9705 @table @code
9706 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9707 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9708 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9709 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9710 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9711 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9712 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9713 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9714
9715 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9716 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9717 symbolic address.
9718 @end table
9719
9720 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9721 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9722 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9723 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9724 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9725 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9726 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9727 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9728
9729 @smallexample
9730 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9731 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9732 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9733 @end smallexample
9734
9735 @quotation
9736 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9737 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9738 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9739 @end quotation
9740
9741 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9742 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9743
9744 @table @code
9745 @item set print symbol on
9746 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9747 one exists.
9748
9749 @item set print symbol off
9750 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9751 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9752 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9753
9754 @item show print symbol
9755 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9756 address.
9757 @end table
9758
9759 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9760
9761 @table @code
9762 @item set print array
9763 @itemx set print array on
9764 @cindex pretty print arrays
9765 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9766 but uses more space. The default is off.
9767
9768 @item set print array off
9769 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9770
9771 @item show print array
9772 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9773 arrays.
9774
9775 @cindex print array indexes
9776 @item set print array-indexes
9777 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9778 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9779 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9780 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9781
9782 @item set print array-indexes off
9783 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9784
9785 @item show print array-indexes
9786 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9787 arrays.
9788
9789 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9790 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9791 @cindex number of array elements to print
9792 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9793 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9794 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9795 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9796 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9797 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9798 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9799 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9800
9801 @item show print elements
9802 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9803 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9804
9805 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9806 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9807 @cindex printing frame argument values
9808 @cindex print all frame argument values
9809 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9810 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9811 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9812 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9813 values are:
9814
9815 @table @code
9816 @item all
9817 The values of all arguments are printed.
9818
9819 @item scalars
9820 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9821 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9822 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9823 only scalar arguments are shown:
9824
9825 @smallexample
9826 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9827 at frame-args.c:23
9828 @end smallexample
9829
9830 @item none
9831 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9832 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9833
9834 @smallexample
9835 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9836 at frame-args.c:23
9837 @end smallexample
9838 @end table
9839
9840 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9841 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9842 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9843 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9844 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9845 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9846 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9847 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9848 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9849 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9850
9851 @item show print frame-arguments
9852 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9853
9854 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9855 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9856
9857 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9858 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9859 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9860 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9861 This is the default.
9862
9863 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9864 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9865
9866 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9867 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9868 @kindex set print entry-values
9869 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9870 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9871 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9872 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9873 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9874
9875 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9876 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9877 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9878 @code{no} setting.
9879
9880 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9881 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
9882 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9883 this information.
9884
9885 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9886
9887 @table @code
9888 @item no
9889 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9890 point.
9891 @smallexample
9892 #0 equal (val=5)
9893 #0 different (val=6)
9894 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9895 #0 born (val=10)
9896 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9897 @end smallexample
9898
9899 @item only
9900 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9901 values are never printed.
9902 @smallexample
9903 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9904 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9905 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9906 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9907 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9908 @end smallexample
9909
9910 @item preferred
9911 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9912 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9913 value for such parameter.
9914 @smallexample
9915 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9916 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9917 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9918 #0 born (val=10)
9919 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9920 @end smallexample
9921
9922 @item if-needed
9923 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9924 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9925 parameter.
9926 @smallexample
9927 #0 equal (val=5)
9928 #0 different (val=6)
9929 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9930 #0 born (val=10)
9931 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9932 @end smallexample
9933
9934 @item both
9935 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9936 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9937 optimizations.
9938 @smallexample
9939 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9940 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9941 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9942 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9943 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9944 @end smallexample
9945
9946 @item compact
9947 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9948 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9949 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9950 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9951 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9952 @smallexample
9953 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9954 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9955 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9956 #0 born (val=10)
9957 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9958 @end smallexample
9959
9960 @item default
9961 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9962 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9963 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9964 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9965 @smallexample
9966 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9967 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9968 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9969 #0 born (val=10)
9970 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9971 @end smallexample
9972 @end table
9973
9974 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9975 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9976
9977 @item show print entry-values
9978 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9979 entry.
9980
9981 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9982 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9983 @cindex repeated array elements
9984 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9985 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9986 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9987 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9988 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9989 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9990 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9991 is 10.
9992
9993 @item show print repeats
9994 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9995 elements.
9996
9997 @item set print null-stop
9998 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9999 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10000 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10001 contain only short strings.
10002 The default is off.
10003
10004 @item show print null-stop
10005 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10006 @sc{null} character.
10007
10008 @item set print pretty on
10009 @cindex print structures in indented form
10010 @cindex indentation in structure display
10011 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10012 per line, like this:
10013
10014 @smallexample
10015 @group
10016 $1 = @{
10017 next = 0x0,
10018 flags = @{
10019 sweet = 1,
10020 sour = 1
10021 @},
10022 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10023 @}
10024 @end group
10025 @end smallexample
10026
10027 @item set print pretty off
10028 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10029
10030 @smallexample
10031 @group
10032 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10033 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10034 @end group
10035 @end smallexample
10036
10037 @noindent
10038 This is the default format.
10039
10040 @item show print pretty
10041 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10042
10043 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10044 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10045 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10046 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10047 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10048 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10049 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10050 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10051
10052 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10053 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10054 international character sets, and is the default.
10055
10056 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10057 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10058
10059 @item set print union on
10060 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10061 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10062 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10063
10064 @item set print union off
10065 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10066 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10067 instead.
10068
10069 @item show print union
10070 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10071 structures and other unions.
10072
10073 For example, given the declarations
10074
10075 @smallexample
10076 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10077 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10078 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10079 Bug_forms;
10080
10081 struct thing @{
10082 Species it;
10083 union @{
10084 Tree_forms tree;
10085 Bug_forms bug;
10086 @} form;
10087 @};
10088
10089 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10090 @end smallexample
10091
10092 @noindent
10093 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10094
10095 @smallexample
10096 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10097 @end smallexample
10098
10099 @noindent
10100 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10101
10102 @smallexample
10103 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10104 @end smallexample
10105
10106 @noindent
10107 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10108 and in Pascal.
10109 @end table
10110
10111 @need 1000
10112 @noindent
10113 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10114
10115 @table @code
10116 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10117 @item set print demangle
10118 @itemx set print demangle on
10119 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10120 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10121 linkage. The default is on.
10122
10123 @item show print demangle
10124 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10125
10126 @item set print asm-demangle
10127 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10128 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10129 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10130 The default is off.
10131
10132 @item show print asm-demangle
10133 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10134 or demangled form.
10135
10136 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10137 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10138 @kindex set demangle-style
10139 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10140 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10141 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10142
10143 @table @code
10144 @item auto
10145 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10146 This is the default.
10147
10148 @item gnu
10149 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10150
10151 @item hp
10152 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10153
10154 @item lucid
10155 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10156
10157 @item arm
10158 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10159 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10160 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10161 require further enhancement to permit that.
10162
10163 @end table
10164 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10165
10166 @item show demangle-style
10167 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10168
10169 @item set print object
10170 @itemx set print object on
10171 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10172 @cindex display derived types
10173 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10174 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10175 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10176 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10177 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10178 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10179 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10180
10181 @item set print object off
10182 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10183 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10184
10185 @item show print object
10186 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10187
10188 @item set print static-members
10189 @itemx set print static-members on
10190 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10191 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10192
10193 @item set print static-members off
10194 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10195
10196 @item show print static-members
10197 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10198
10199 @item set print pascal_static-members
10200 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10201 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10202 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10203 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10204
10205 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10206 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10207
10208 @item show print pascal_static-members
10209 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10210
10211 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10212 @item set print vtbl
10213 @itemx set print vtbl on
10214 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10215 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10216 @cindex VTBL display
10217 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10218 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10219 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10220
10221 @item set print vtbl off
10222 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10223
10224 @item show print vtbl
10225 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10226 @end table
10227
10228 @node Pretty Printing
10229 @section Pretty Printing
10230
10231 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10232 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10233 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10234
10235 @menu
10236 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10237 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10238 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10239 @end menu
10240
10241 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10242 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10243
10244 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10245 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10246 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10247
10248 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10249 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10250 pretty-printers with their names.
10251 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10252 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10253 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10254 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10255
10256 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10257 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10258 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10259 do anything special.
10260
10261 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10262
10263 @itemize @bullet
10264 @item
10265 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10266 all inferiors.
10267
10268 @item
10269 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10270 when debugging that program.
10271 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10272
10273 @item
10274 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10275 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10276 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10277 @end itemize
10278
10279 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10280 pretty-printers are selected,
10281
10282 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10283 for new types.
10284
10285 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10286 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10287
10288 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10289
10290 @smallexample
10291 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10292 $1 = @{
10293 static npos = 4294967295,
10294 _M_dataplus = @{
10295 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10296 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10297 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10298 @},
10299 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10300 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10301 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10302 @}
10303 @}
10304 @end smallexample
10305
10306 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10307
10308 @smallexample
10309 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10310 $2 = "abcd"
10311 @end smallexample
10312
10313 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10314 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10315 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10316
10317 @table @code
10318 @kindex info pretty-printer
10319 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10320 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10321 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10322
10323 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10324 whose pretty-printers to list.
10325 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10326 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10327 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10328 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10329 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10330
10331 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10332 to list.
10333
10334 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10335 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10336 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10337 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10338
10339 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10340 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10341 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10342 @end table
10343
10344 Example:
10345
10346 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10347 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10348 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10349 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10350
10351 @smallexample
10352 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10353 library1.so:
10354 foo
10355 library2.so:
10356 bar
10357 bar1
10358 bar2
10359 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10360 library2.so:
10361 bar
10362 bar1
10363 bar2
10364 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10365 1 printer disabled
10366 2 of 3 printers enabled
10367 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10368 library1.so:
10369 foo [disabled]
10370 library2.so:
10371 bar
10372 bar1
10373 bar2
10374 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10375 1 printer disabled
10376 1 of 3 printers enabled
10377 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10378 library1.so:
10379 foo [disabled]
10380 library2.so:
10381 bar
10382 bar1 [disabled]
10383 bar2
10384 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10385 1 printer disabled
10386 0 of 3 printers enabled
10387 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10388 library1.so:
10389 foo [disabled]
10390 library2.so:
10391 bar [disabled]
10392 bar1 [disabled]
10393 bar2
10394 @end smallexample
10395
10396 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10397 as can each individual subprinter.
10398
10399 @node Value History
10400 @section Value History
10401
10402 @cindex value history
10403 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10404 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10405 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10406 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10407 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10408 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10409 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10410 symbol table.
10411
10412 @cindex @code{$}
10413 @cindex @code{$$}
10414 @cindex history number
10415 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10416 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10417 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10418 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10419 history number.
10420
10421 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10422 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10423 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10424 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10425 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10426 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10427 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10428
10429 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10430 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10431
10432 @smallexample
10433 p *$
10434 @end smallexample
10435
10436 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10437 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10438
10439 @smallexample
10440 p *$.next
10441 @end smallexample
10442
10443 @noindent
10444 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10445 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10446
10447 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10448 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10449
10450 @smallexample
10451 print x
10452 set x=5
10453 @end smallexample
10454
10455 @noindent
10456 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10457 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10458
10459 @table @code
10460 @kindex show values
10461 @item show values
10462 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10463 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10464 values} does not change the history.
10465
10466 @item show values @var{n}
10467 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10468
10469 @item show values +
10470 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10471 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10472 @end table
10473
10474 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10475 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10476
10477 @node Convenience Vars
10478 @section Convenience Variables
10479
10480 @cindex convenience variables
10481 @cindex user-defined variables
10482 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10483 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10484 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10485 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10486 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10487
10488 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10489 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10490 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10491 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10492 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10493
10494 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10495 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10496 For example:
10497
10498 @smallexample
10499 set $foo = *object_ptr
10500 @end smallexample
10501
10502 @noindent
10503 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10504 @code{object_ptr}.
10505
10506 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10507 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10508 value with another assignment at any time.
10509
10510 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10511 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10512 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10513 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10514
10515 @table @code
10516 @kindex show convenience
10517 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10518 @item show convenience
10519 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10520 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10521 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10522
10523 @kindex init-if-undefined
10524 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10525 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10526 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10527 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10528 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10529 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10530 override default values used in a command script.
10531
10532 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10533 any side-effects do not occur.
10534 @end table
10535
10536 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10537 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10538 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10539
10540 @smallexample
10541 set $i = 0
10542 print bar[$i++]->contents
10543 @end smallexample
10544
10545 @noindent
10546 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10547
10548 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10549 values likely to be useful.
10550
10551 @table @code
10552 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10553 @item $_
10554 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10555 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10556 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10557 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10558 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10559 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10560 to the type of @code{$__}.
10561
10562 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10563 @item $__
10564 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10565 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10566 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10567
10568 @item $_exitcode
10569 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10570 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10571 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10572 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10573
10574 @item $_exitsignal
10575 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10576 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10577 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10578 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10579
10580 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10581 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10582 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10583 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10584 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10585
10586 @smallexample
10587 #include <signal.h>
10588
10589 int
10590 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10591 @{
10592 raise (SIGALRM);
10593 return 0;
10594 @}
10595 @end smallexample
10596
10597 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10598 or signalled would be:
10599
10600 @smallexample
10601 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10602 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10603 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10604 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10605 >echo The program has exited\n
10606 >else
10607 >echo The program has signalled\n
10608 >end
10609 >end
10610 (@value{GDBP}) run
10611 Starting program:
10612
10613 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10614 The program no longer exists.
10615 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10616 The program has signalled
10617 @end smallexample
10618
10619 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10620 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10621 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10622 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10623
10624 @smallexample
10625 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10626 The program has exited
10627 @end smallexample
10628
10629 @item $_exception
10630 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10631 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10632
10633 @item $_probe_argc
10634 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10635 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10636
10637 @item $_sdata
10638 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10639 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10640 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10641 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10642 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10643
10644 @item $_siginfo
10645 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10646 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10647 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10648 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10649 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10650
10651 @item $_tlb
10652 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10653 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10654 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10655 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10656 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10657 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10658
10659 @item $_inferior
10660 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10661 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10662
10663 @item $_thread
10664 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10665
10666 @item $_gthread
10667 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10668
10669 @end table
10670
10671 @node Convenience Funs
10672 @section Convenience Functions
10673
10674 @cindex convenience functions
10675 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10676 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10677 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10678 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10679 @value{GDBN}.
10680
10681 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10682 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10683
10684 @table @code
10685
10686 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10687 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10688 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10689 returns zero.
10690
10691 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10692 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10693 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10694 it is @code{void}:
10695
10696 @smallexample
10697 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10698 $1 = void
10699 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10700 $2 = 1
10701 (@value{GDBP}) run
10702 Starting program: ./a.out
10703 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10704 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10705 $3 = 0
10706 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10707 $4 = 0
10708 @end smallexample
10709
10710 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10711 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10712 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10713 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10714 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10715 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10716 anymore.
10717
10718 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10719 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10720
10721 @smallexample
10722 void
10723 foo (void)
10724 @{
10725 @}
10726 @end smallexample
10727
10728 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10729
10730 @smallexample
10731 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10732 $1 = void
10733 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10734 $2 = 1
10735 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10736 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10737 $3 = void
10738 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10739 $4 = 1
10740 @end smallexample
10741
10742 @end table
10743
10744 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10745 @code{Python} support.
10746
10747 @table @code
10748
10749 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10750 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10751 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10752 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10753 Otherwise it returns zero.
10754
10755 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10756 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10757 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10758 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10759 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10760 regular expression support.
10761
10762 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10763 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10764 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10765 Otherwise it returns zero.
10766
10767 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10768 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10769 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10770
10771 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10772 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10773 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10774 Otherwise it returns zero.
10775
10776 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10777 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10778 The default is 1.
10779
10780 Example:
10781
10782 @smallexample
10783 (gdb) backtrace
10784 #0 bottom_func ()
10785 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10786 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10787 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10788 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10789 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10790 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10791 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10792 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10793 $1 = 1
10794 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10795 $1 = 1
10796 @end smallexample
10797
10798 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10799 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10800 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10801 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10802
10803 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10804 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10805 The default is 1.
10806
10807 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10808 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10809 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10810 Otherwise it returns zero.
10811
10812 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10813 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10814 The default is 1.
10815
10816 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10817 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10818 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10819 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10820
10821 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10822 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10823 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10824 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10825
10826 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10827 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10828 The default is 1.
10829
10830 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10831 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10832 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10833 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10834
10835 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10836 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10837 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10838
10839 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10840 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10841 an enumerated type:
10842
10843 @smallexample
10844 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10845 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10846 @end smallexample
10847
10848 @end table
10849
10850 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10851 convenience functions.
10852
10853 @table @code
10854 @item help function
10855 @kindex help function
10856 @cindex show all convenience functions
10857 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10858 @end table
10859
10860 @node Registers
10861 @section Registers
10862
10863 @cindex registers
10864 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10865 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10866 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10867 your machine.
10868
10869 @table @code
10870 @kindex info registers
10871 @item info registers
10872 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10873 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10874
10875 @kindex info all-registers
10876 @cindex floating point registers
10877 @item info all-registers
10878 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10879 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10880
10881 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10882 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10883 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10884 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10885 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10886 @end table
10887
10888 @anchor{standard registers}
10889 @cindex stack pointer register
10890 @cindex program counter register
10891 @cindex process status register
10892 @cindex frame pointer register
10893 @cindex standard registers
10894 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10895 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10896 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10897 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10898 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10899 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10900 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10901 you could print the program counter in hex with
10902
10903 @smallexample
10904 p/x $pc
10905 @end smallexample
10906
10907 @noindent
10908 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10909
10910 @smallexample
10911 x/i $pc
10912 @end smallexample
10913
10914 @noindent
10915 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10916 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10917 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10918 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10919 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10920 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10921 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10922
10923 @smallexample
10924 set $sp += 4
10925 @end smallexample
10926
10927 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10928 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10929 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10930 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10931 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10932 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10933 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10934
10935 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10936 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10937 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10938 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10939 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10940 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10941 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10942
10943 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10944 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10945 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10946 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10947 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10948 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10949 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10950 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10951 prints the data in both formats.
10952
10953 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10954 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10955 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10956 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10957 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10958 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10959 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10960
10961 @smallexample
10962 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10963 $1 = @{
10964 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10965 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10966 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10967 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10968 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10969 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10970 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10971 @}
10972 @end smallexample
10973
10974 @noindent
10975 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10976 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10977 value to a @code{struct} member:
10978
10979 @smallexample
10980 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10981 @end smallexample
10982
10983 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10984 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10985 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10986 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10987 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10988 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10989
10990 @cindex caller-saved registers
10991 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10992 @cindex volatile registers
10993 @cindex <not saved> values
10994 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10995 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10996 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10997 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10998 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10999 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11000 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11001 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11002 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11003 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11004 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11005 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11006 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11007 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11008 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11009 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11010 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11011 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11012 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11013 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11014 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11015 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11016 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11017
11018 @node Floating Point Hardware
11019 @section Floating Point Hardware
11020 @cindex floating point
11021
11022 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11023 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11024
11025 @table @code
11026 @kindex info float
11027 @item info float
11028 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11029 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11030 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11031 the ARM and x86 machines.
11032 @end table
11033
11034 @node Vector Unit
11035 @section Vector Unit
11036 @cindex vector unit
11037
11038 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11039 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11040
11041 @table @code
11042 @kindex info vector
11043 @item info vector
11044 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11045 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11046 @end table
11047
11048 @node OS Information
11049 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11050 @cindex OS information
11051
11052 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11053 you debug your program.
11054
11055 @cindex auxiliary vector
11056 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11057 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11058 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11059 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11060 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11061 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11062 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11063 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11064 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11065 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11066 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11067 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11068
11069 @table @code
11070 @kindex info auxv
11071 @item info auxv
11072 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11073 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11074 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11075 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11076 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11077 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11078 an unrecognized tag.
11079 @end table
11080
11081 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11082 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11083 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11084 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11085 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11086 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11087 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11088
11089 @table @code
11090 @kindex info os
11091 @item info os @var{infotype}
11092
11093 Display OS information of the requested type.
11094
11095 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11096
11097 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11098 @table @code
11099 @kindex info os cpus
11100 @item cpus
11101 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11102 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11103 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11104 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11105 kernel initialization.
11106
11107 @kindex info os files
11108 @item files
11109 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11110 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11111 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11112 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11113
11114 @kindex info os modules
11115 @item modules
11116 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11117 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11118 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11119 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11120 in memory.
11121
11122 @kindex info os msg
11123 @item msg
11124 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11125 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11126 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11127 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11128 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11129 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11130 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11131 the message queue was last changed.
11132
11133 @kindex info os processes
11134 @item processes
11135 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11136 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11137 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11138 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11139 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11140 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11141
11142 @kindex info os procgroups
11143 @item procgroups
11144 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11145 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11146 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11147 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11148 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11149 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11150 and the process group leader is listed first.
11151
11152 @kindex info os semaphores
11153 @item semaphores
11154 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11155 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11156 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11157 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11158 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11159
11160 @kindex info os shm
11161 @item shm
11162 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11163 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11164 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11165 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11166 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11167 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11168 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11169
11170 @kindex info os sockets
11171 @item sockets
11172 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11173 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11174 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11175 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11176 connection.
11177
11178 @kindex info os threads
11179 @item threads
11180 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11181 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11182 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11183 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11184 process is not listed.
11185 @end table
11186
11187 @item info os
11188 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11189 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11190 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11191 types, this command will report an error.
11192 @end table
11193
11194 @node Memory Region Attributes
11195 @section Memory Region Attributes
11196 @cindex memory region attributes
11197
11198 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11199 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11200 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11201 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11202 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11203 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11204 user can override the fetched regions.
11205
11206 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11207 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11208 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11209 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11210 all memory.
11211
11212 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11213 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11214
11215 @table @code
11216 @kindex mem
11217 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11218 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11219 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11220 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11221 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11222 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11223
11224 @item mem auto
11225 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11226 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11227
11228 @kindex delete mem
11229 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11230 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11231 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11232
11233 @kindex disable mem
11234 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11235 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11236 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11237 It may be enabled again later.
11238
11239 @kindex enable mem
11240 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11241 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11242
11243 @kindex info mem
11244 @item info mem
11245 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11246 for each region:
11247
11248 @table @emph
11249 @item Memory Region Number
11250 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11251 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11252 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11253
11254 @item Lo Address
11255 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11256
11257 @item Hi Address
11258 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11259
11260 @item Attributes
11261 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11262 @end table
11263 @end table
11264
11265
11266 @subsection Attributes
11267
11268 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11269 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11270 write accesses to a memory region.
11271
11272 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11273 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11274 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11275
11276 @table @code
11277 @item ro
11278 Memory is read only.
11279 @item wo
11280 Memory is write only.
11281 @item rw
11282 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11283 @end table
11284
11285 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11286 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11287 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11288 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11289 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11290
11291 @table @code
11292 @item 8
11293 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11294 @item 16
11295 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11296 @item 32
11297 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11298 @item 64
11299 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11300 @end table
11301
11302 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11303 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11304 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11305 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11306 @c
11307 @c @table @code
11308 @c @item hwbreak
11309 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11310 @c @item swbreak (default)
11311 @c @end table
11312
11313 @subsubsection Data Cache
11314 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11315 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11316 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11317 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11318 registers.
11319
11320 @table @code
11321 @item cache
11322 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11323 @item nocache
11324 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11325 @end table
11326
11327 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11328 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11329 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11330 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11331 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11332
11333 @table @code
11334 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11335 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11336 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11337 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11338 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11339 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11340 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11341 The default value is @code{on}.
11342 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11343 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11344 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11345 @end table
11346
11347
11348 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11349 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11350 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11351 @c
11352 @c @table @code
11353 @c @item verify
11354 @c @item noverify (default)
11355 @c @end table
11356
11357 @node Dump/Restore Files
11358 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11359 @cindex dump/restore files
11360 @cindex append data to a file
11361 @cindex dump data to a file
11362 @cindex restore data from a file
11363
11364 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11365 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11366 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11367 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11368 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11369 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11370 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11371
11372 @table @code
11373
11374 @kindex dump
11375 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11376 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11377 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11378 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11379
11380 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11381 @table @code
11382 @item binary
11383 Raw binary form.
11384 @item ihex
11385 Intel hex format.
11386 @item srec
11387 Motorola S-record format.
11388 @item tekhex
11389 Tektronix Hex format.
11390 @item verilog
11391 Verilog Hex format.
11392 @end table
11393
11394 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11395 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11396 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11397 form.
11398
11399 @kindex append
11400 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11401 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11402 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11403 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11404 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11405
11406 @kindex restore
11407 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11408 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11409 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11410 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11411 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11412
11413 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11414 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11415 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11416 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11417 from that location.
11418
11419 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11420 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11421 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11422 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11423
11424 @end table
11425
11426 @node Core File Generation
11427 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11428 @cindex dump core from inferior
11429
11430 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11431 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11432 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11433 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11434 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11435 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11436 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11437
11438 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11439 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11440 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11441
11442 @table @code
11443 @kindex gcore
11444 @kindex generate-core-file
11445 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11446 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11447 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11448 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11449 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11450 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11451
11452 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11453 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11454
11455 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11456 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11457 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11458
11459 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11460 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11461 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11462 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11463 Enable or disable the use of the file
11464 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11465 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11466 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11467 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11468
11469 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11470 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11471 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11472 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11473 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11474 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11475 about the bits that can be set in the
11476 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11477 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11478
11479 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11480 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11481 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11482 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11483 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11484 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11485 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11486 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11487 @end table
11488
11489 @node Character Sets
11490 @section Character Sets
11491 @cindex character sets
11492 @cindex charset
11493 @cindex translating between character sets
11494 @cindex host character set
11495 @cindex target character set
11496
11497 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11498 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11499 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11500 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11501 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11502 @dfn{target character set}.
11503
11504 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11505 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11506 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11507 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11508 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11509 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11510 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11511 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11512 character and string literals in expressions.
11513
11514 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11515 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11516 target-charset} command, described below.
11517
11518 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11519 support:
11520
11521 @table @code
11522 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11523 @kindex set target-charset
11524 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11525 list of supported target character sets, type
11526 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11527
11528 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11529 @kindex set host-charset
11530 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11531
11532 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11533 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11534 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11535 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11536 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11537
11538 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11539 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11540 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11541
11542 @item set charset @var{charset}
11543 @kindex set charset
11544 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11545 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11546 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11547 for both host and target.
11548
11549 @item show charset
11550 @kindex show charset
11551 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11552
11553 @item show host-charset
11554 @kindex show host-charset
11555 Show the name of the current host character set.
11556
11557 @item show target-charset
11558 @kindex show target-charset
11559 Show the name of the current target character set.
11560
11561 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11562 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11563 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11564 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11565 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11566 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11567
11568 @item show target-wide-charset
11569 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11570 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11571 @end table
11572
11573 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11574 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11575 @file{charset-test.c}:
11576
11577 @smallexample
11578 #include <stdio.h>
11579
11580 char ascii_hello[]
11581 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11582 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11583 char ibm1047_hello[]
11584 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11585 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11586
11587 main ()
11588 @{
11589 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11590 @}
11591 @end smallexample
11592
11593 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11594 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11595 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11596
11597 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11598
11599 @smallexample
11600 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11601 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11602 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11603 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11604 @dots{}
11605 (@value{GDBP})
11606 @end smallexample
11607
11608 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11609 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11610 strings:
11611
11612 @smallexample
11613 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11614 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11615 (@value{GDBP})
11616 @end smallexample
11617
11618 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11619 initial character set:
11620 @smallexample
11621 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11622 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11623 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11624 (@value{GDBP})
11625 @end smallexample
11626
11627 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11628 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11629 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11630 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11631 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11632
11633 @smallexample
11634 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11635 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11636 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11637 $2 = 72 'H'
11638 (@value{GDBP})
11639 @end smallexample
11640
11641 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11642 literals you use in expressions:
11643
11644 @smallexample
11645 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11646 $3 = 43 '+'
11647 (@value{GDBP})
11648 @end smallexample
11649
11650 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11651 character.
11652
11653 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11654 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11655 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11656
11657 @smallexample
11658 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11659 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11660 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11661 $5 = 200 '\310'
11662 (@value{GDBP})
11663 @end smallexample
11664
11665 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11666 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11667
11668 @smallexample
11669 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11670 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11671 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11672 @end smallexample
11673
11674 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11675 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11676 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11677 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11678 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11679
11680 @smallexample
11681 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11682 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11683 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11684 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11685 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11686 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11687 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11688 $7 = 72 '\110'
11689 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11690 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11691 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11692 $9 = 200 'H'
11693 (@value{GDBP})
11694 @end smallexample
11695
11696 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11697 string literals you use in expressions:
11698
11699 @smallexample
11700 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11701 $10 = 78 '+'
11702 (@value{GDBP})
11703 @end smallexample
11704
11705 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11706 character.
11707
11708 @node Caching Target Data
11709 @section Caching Data of Targets
11710 @cindex caching data of targets
11711
11712 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11713 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11714 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11715 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11716 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11717 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11718 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11719 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11720 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11721 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11722 is executing.
11723 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11724 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11725 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11726 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11727 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11728 in the code segment.
11729 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11730 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11731
11732 @table @code
11733 @kindex set remotecache
11734 @item set remotecache on
11735 @itemx set remotecache off
11736 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11737 with old scripts.
11738
11739 @kindex show remotecache
11740 @item show remotecache
11741 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11742
11743 @kindex set stack-cache
11744 @item set stack-cache on
11745 @itemx set stack-cache off
11746 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11747 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11748
11749 @kindex show stack-cache
11750 @item show stack-cache
11751 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11752
11753 @kindex set code-cache
11754 @item set code-cache on
11755 @itemx set code-cache off
11756 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11757 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11758 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11759
11760 @kindex show code-cache
11761 @item show code-cache
11762 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11763 accesses.
11764
11765 @kindex info dcache
11766 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11767 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11768 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11769 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11770 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11771 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11772
11773 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11774 printed in hex.
11775
11776 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11777 @cindex dcache size
11778 @kindex set dcache size
11779 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11780
11781 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11782 @cindex dcache line-size
11783 @kindex set dcache line-size
11784 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11785 Must be a power of 2.
11786
11787 @item show dcache size
11788 @kindex show dcache size
11789 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11790
11791 @item show dcache line-size
11792 @kindex show dcache line-size
11793 Show default size of dcache lines.
11794
11795 @end table
11796
11797 @node Searching Memory
11798 @section Search Memory
11799 @cindex searching memory
11800
11801 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11802 @code{find} command.
11803
11804 @table @code
11805 @kindex find
11806 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11807 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11808 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11809 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11810 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11811 @end table
11812
11813 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11814 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11815
11816 @table @r
11817 @item @var{s}, search query size
11818 The size of each search query value.
11819
11820 @table @code
11821 @item b
11822 bytes
11823 @item h
11824 halfwords (two bytes)
11825 @item w
11826 words (four bytes)
11827 @item g
11828 giant words (eight bytes)
11829 @end table
11830
11831 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11832 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11833 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11834
11835 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11836 value's type in the current language.
11837 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11838 pattern as a mixture of types.
11839 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11840 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11841 which is typically four bytes.
11842
11843 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11844 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11845 @end table
11846
11847 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11848 (@code{"}).
11849 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11850 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11851
11852 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11853 number of matches found.
11854
11855 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11856 @samp{$_}.
11857 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11858
11859 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11860
11861 @smallexample
11862 void
11863 hello ()
11864 @{
11865 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11866 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11867 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11868 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11869 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11870 @}
11871 @end smallexample
11872
11873 @noindent
11874 you get during debugging:
11875
11876 @smallexample
11877 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11878 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11879 1 pattern found
11880 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11881 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11882 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11883 2 patterns found
11884 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11885 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11886 1 pattern found
11887 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11888 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11889 1 pattern found
11890 (gdb) print $numfound
11891 $1 = 1
11892 (gdb) print $_
11893 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11894 @end smallexample
11895
11896 @node Value Sizes
11897 @section Value Sizes
11898
11899 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11900 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11901 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11902 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11903 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11904
11905 @table @code
11906 @kindex set max-value-size
11907 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11908 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11909 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11910 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11911 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11912
11913 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11914 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11915
11916 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11917 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11918 currently 16 bytes.
11919
11920 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11921 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11922 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11923 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11924 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11925 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11926 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11927 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11928
11929 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11930
11931 @kindex show max-value-size
11932 @item show max-value-size
11933 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11934 allocate for the contents of a value.
11935 @end table
11936
11937 @node Optimized Code
11938 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11939 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11940 @cindex debugging optimized code
11941
11942 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11943 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11944 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11945 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11946 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11947 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11948 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11949
11950 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11951 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11952 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11953 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11954
11955 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11956 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11957 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11958 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11959 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11960 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11961
11962 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11963 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11964 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11965 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11966 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11967
11968 @menu
11969 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11970 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11971 @end menu
11972
11973 @node Inline Functions
11974 @section Inline Functions
11975 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11976
11977 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11978 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11979 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11980 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11981 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11982 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11983 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11984 @code{info frame} command.
11985
11986 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11987 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11988 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11989 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11990 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11991 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11992 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11993 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11994 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11995 local variables in the caller.
11996
11997 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11998 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11999 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12000 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12001 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12002 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12003 instructions are executed.
12004
12005 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12006 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12007 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12008 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12009
12010 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12011 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12012
12013 @itemize @bullet
12014 @item
12015 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12016 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12017 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12018 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12019 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12020 or inside the inlined function instead.
12021
12022 @item
12023 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12024 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12025 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12026 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12027
12028 @end itemize
12029
12030 @node Tail Call Frames
12031 @section Tail Call Frames
12032 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12033
12034 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12035 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12036 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12037 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12038 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12039
12040 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12041 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12042 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12043 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12044 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12045 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12046 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12047
12048 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12049 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12050 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12051 this information.
12052
12053 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12054 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12055
12056 @smallexample
12057 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12058 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12059 (gdb) info frame
12060 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12061 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12062 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12063 source language c++.
12064 Arglist at unknown address.
12065 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12066 @end smallexample
12067
12068 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12069 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12070 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12071 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12072 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12073 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12074
12075 @table @code
12076 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12077 @item set debug entry-values
12078 @kindex set debug entry-values
12079 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12080 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12081 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12082 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12083 result.
12084
12085 @item show debug entry-values
12086 @kindex show debug entry-values
12087 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12088 values at function entry and tail calls.
12089 @end table
12090
12091 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12092 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12093 reference by variable @code{x}):
12094
12095 @smallexample
12096 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12097 void (*x) (void) = c;
12098 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12099 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12100 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12101
12102 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12103 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12104 a () at t.c:3
12105 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12106 (gdb) bt
12107 #0 a () at t.c:3
12108 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12109 @end smallexample
12110
12111 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12112
12113 @smallexample
12114 int i;
12115 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12116 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12117 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12118 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12119 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12120 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12121 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12122 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12123
12124 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12125 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12126 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12127 (gdb) bt
12128 #0 f () at t.c:2
12129 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12130 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12131 @end smallexample
12132
12133 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12134 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12135
12136 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12137 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12138 @set ARROW @click{}
12139 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12140 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12141 @end ifset
12142 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12143 @set ARROW ->
12144 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12145 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12146 @end ifclear
12147
12148 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12149 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12150 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12151
12152 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12153 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12154 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12155 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12156 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12157 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12158
12159 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12160 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12161 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12162 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12163 omitted.
12164
12165 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12166 entry may fail:
12167
12168 @smallexample
12169 int v;
12170 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12171 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12172 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12173 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12174 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12175 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12176
12177 (gdb) bt
12178 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12179 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12180 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12181 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12182 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12183 @end smallexample
12184
12185 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12186 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12187 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12188 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12189 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12190
12191 @node Macros
12192 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12193
12194 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12195 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12196 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12197 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12198 where it was defined.
12199
12200 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12201 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12202 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12203 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12204
12205 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12206 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12207 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12208 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12209 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12210 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12211 see @ref{List}.
12212
12213 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12214 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12215 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12216
12217 @table @code
12218
12219 @kindex macro expand
12220 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12221 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12222 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12223 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12224 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12225 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12226 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12227 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12228 it can be any string of tokens.
12229
12230 @kindex macro exp1
12231 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12232 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12233 @cindex expand macro once
12234 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12235 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12236 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12237 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12238 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12239 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12240 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12241 can be any string of tokens.
12242
12243 @kindex info macro
12244 @cindex macro definition, showing
12245 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12246 @cindex macros, from debug info
12247 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12248 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12249 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12250 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12251 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12252 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12253
12254 @kindex info macros
12255 @item info macros @var{location}
12256 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12257 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12258 command-line where those definitions were established.
12259
12260 @kindex macro define
12261 @cindex user-defined macros
12262 @cindex defining macros interactively
12263 @cindex macros, user-defined
12264 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12265 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12266 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12267 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12268 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12269 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12270 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12271 @var{arglist}.
12272
12273 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12274 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12275 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12276 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12277 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12278
12279 @kindex macro undef
12280 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12281 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12282 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12283 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12284 in the program being debugged.
12285
12286 @kindex macro list
12287 @item macro list
12288 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12289 @end table
12290
12291 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12292 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12293 show our source files:
12294
12295 @smallexample
12296 $ cat sample.c
12297 #include <stdio.h>
12298 #include "sample.h"
12299
12300 #define M 42
12301 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12302
12303 main ()
12304 @{
12305 #define N 28
12306 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12307 #undef N
12308 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12309 #define N 1729
12310 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12311 @}
12312 $ cat sample.h
12313 #define Q <
12314 $
12315 @end smallexample
12316
12317 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12318 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12319 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12320 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12321 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12322 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12323 information.
12324
12325 @smallexample
12326 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12327 $
12328 @end smallexample
12329
12330 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12331
12332 @smallexample
12333 $ gdb -nw sample
12334 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12335 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12336 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12337 (@value{GDBP})
12338 @end smallexample
12339
12340 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12341 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12342 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12343
12344 @smallexample
12345 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12346 3
12347 4 #define M 42
12348 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12349 6
12350 7 main ()
12351 8 @{
12352 9 #define N 28
12353 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12354 11 #undef N
12355 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12356 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12357 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12358 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12359 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12360 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12361 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12362 #define Q <
12363 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12364 expands to: (42 + 1)
12365 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12366 expands to: once (M + 1)
12367 (@value{GDBP})
12368 @end smallexample
12369
12370 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12371 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12372 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12373 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12374
12375 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12376 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12377
12378 @smallexample
12379 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12380 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12381 (@value{GDBP}) run
12382 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12383
12384 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12385 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12386 (@value{GDBP})
12387 @end smallexample
12388
12389 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12390
12391 @smallexample
12392 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12393 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12394 #define N 28
12395 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12396 expands to: 28 < 42
12397 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12398 $1 = 1
12399 (@value{GDBP})
12400 @end smallexample
12401
12402 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12403 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12404 thereof) in force at each point:
12405
12406 @smallexample
12407 (@value{GDBP}) next
12408 Hello, world!
12409 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12410 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12411 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12412 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12413 (@value{GDBP}) next
12414 We're so creative.
12415 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12416 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12417 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12418 #define N 1729
12419 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12420 expands to: 1729 < 42
12421 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12422 $2 = 0
12423 (@value{GDBP})
12424 @end smallexample
12425
12426 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12427 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12428 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12429 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12430
12431 @smallexample
12432 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12433 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12434 -D__STDC__=1
12435 (@value{GDBP})
12436 @end smallexample
12437
12438
12439 @node Tracepoints
12440 @chapter Tracepoints
12441 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12442 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12443
12444 @cindex tracepoints
12445 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12446 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12447 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12448 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12449 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12450 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12451 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12452
12453 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12454 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12455 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12456 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12457 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12458 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12459 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12460 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12461 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12462 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12463 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12464
12465 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12466 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12467 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12468 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12469 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12470 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12471 Packets}.
12472
12473 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12474 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12475 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12476
12477 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12478
12479 @menu
12480 * Set Tracepoints::
12481 * Analyze Collected Data::
12482 * Tracepoint Variables::
12483 * Trace Files::
12484 @end menu
12485
12486 @node Set Tracepoints
12487 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12488
12489 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12490 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12491 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12492 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12493 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12494 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12495 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12496
12497 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12498 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12499 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12500 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12501 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12502 tracepoint was hit.
12503
12504 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12505 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12506 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12507 either.
12508
12509 @cindex fast tracepoints
12510 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12511 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12512 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12513
12514 @cindex static tracepoints
12515 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12516 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12517 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12518 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12519 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12520 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12521 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12522 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12523 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12524 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12525 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12526 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12527 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12528 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12529 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12530 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12531 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12532 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12533 static tracepoint marker.
12534
12535 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12536 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12537
12538 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12539 conditions and actions.
12540
12541 @menu
12542 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12543 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12544 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12545 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12546 * Trace State Variables::
12547 * Tracepoint Actions::
12548 * Listing Tracepoints::
12549 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12550 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12551 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12552 @end menu
12553
12554 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12555 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12556
12557 @table @code
12558 @cindex set tracepoint
12559 @kindex trace
12560 @item trace @var{location}
12561 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12562 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12563 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12564 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12565 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12566 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12567 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12568 in tracing}).
12569 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12570 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12571 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12572 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12573 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12574 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12575 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12576 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12577 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12578 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12579 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12580 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12581
12582 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12583
12584 @smallexample
12585 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12586
12587 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12588
12589 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12590
12591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12592
12593 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12594 @end smallexample
12595
12596 @noindent
12597 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12598
12599 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12600 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12601 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12602 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12603 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12604 information on tracepoint conditions.
12605
12606 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12607 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12608 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12609 @kindex ftrace
12610 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12611 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12612 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12613 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12614 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12615 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12616 message.
12617
12618 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12619 @code{trace}.
12620
12621 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12622 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12623 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12624 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12625 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12626 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12627 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12628 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12629
12630 @example
12631 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12632 @end example
12633
12634 @noindent
12635 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12636 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12637
12638 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12639 @cindex set static tracepoint
12640 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12641 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12642 @kindex strace
12643 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12644 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12645 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12646 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12647 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12648
12649 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12650 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12651 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12652 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12653 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12654 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12655 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12656 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12657 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12658 tracing engine:
12659
12660 @smallexample
12661 main ()
12662 @{
12663 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12664 @}
12665 @end smallexample
12666
12667 @noindent
12668 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12669 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12670
12671 @smallexample
12672 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12673 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12674 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12675 Data: "str %s"
12676 [etc...]
12677 @end smallexample
12678
12679 @noindent
12680 so you may probe the marker above with:
12681
12682 @smallexample
12683 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12684 @end smallexample
12685
12686 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12687 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12688 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12689 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12690 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12691 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12692 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12693 the @samp{Data:} field.
12694
12695 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12696 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12697 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12698
12699 @vindex $tpnum
12700 @cindex last tracepoint number
12701 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12702 @cindex tracepoint number
12703 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12704 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12705
12706 @kindex delete tracepoint
12707 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12708 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12709 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12710 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12711 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12712
12713 Examples:
12714
12715 @smallexample
12716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12717
12718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12719 @end smallexample
12720
12721 @noindent
12722 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12723 @end table
12724
12725 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12726 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12727
12728 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12729
12730 @table @code
12731 @kindex disable tracepoint
12732 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12733 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12734 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12735 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12736 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12737 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12738 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12739 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12740 next trace experiment.
12741
12742 @kindex enable tracepoint
12743 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12744 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12745 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12746 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12747 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12748 next time a trace experiment is run.
12749 @end table
12750
12751 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12752 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12753
12754 @table @code
12755 @kindex passcount
12756 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12757 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12758 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12759 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12760 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12761 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12762 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12763 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12764 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12765 user.
12766
12767 Examples:
12768
12769 @smallexample
12770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12771 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12772
12773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12774 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12777 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12779 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12781 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12782 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12783 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12784 @end smallexample
12785 @end table
12786
12787 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12788 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12789 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12790 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12791
12792 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12793 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12794 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12795 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12796 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12797 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12798 is true.
12799
12800 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12801 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12802 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12803 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12804 just as with breakpoints.
12805
12806 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12807 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12808 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12809 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12810 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12811 accesses, and so forth.
12812
12813 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12814 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12815 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12816 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12817 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12818 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12819 search through.
12820
12821 @smallexample
12822 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12823 @end smallexample
12824
12825 @node Trace State Variables
12826 @subsection Trace State Variables
12827 @cindex trace state variables
12828
12829 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12830 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12831 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12832 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12833 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12834 integers.
12835
12836 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12837 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12838 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12839 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12840
12841 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12842 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12843 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12844 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12845 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12846 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12847 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12848 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12849 variable with the same name.
12850
12851 @table @code
12852
12853 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12854 @kindex tvariable
12855 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12856 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12857 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12858 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12859 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12860 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12861 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12862 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12863 value. The default initial value is 0.
12864
12865 @item info tvariables
12866 @kindex info tvariables
12867 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12868 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12869 currently running.
12870
12871 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12872 @kindex delete tvariable
12873 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12874 are specified.
12875
12876 @end table
12877
12878 @node Tracepoint Actions
12879 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12880
12881 @table @code
12882 @kindex actions
12883 @cindex tracepoint actions
12884 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12885 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12886 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12887 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12888 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12889 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12890 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12891 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12892 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12893 @code{while-stepping}.
12894
12895 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12896 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12897 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12898
12899 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12900 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12901 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12902
12903 @smallexample
12904 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12905
12906 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12907
12908 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12909 @end smallexample
12910
12911 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12912 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12913 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12914 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12915 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12916 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12917 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12918 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12919
12920 @smallexample
12921 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12922 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12923 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12924 > collect bar,baz
12925 > collect $regs
12926 > while-stepping 12
12927 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12928 > end
12929 end
12930 @end smallexample
12931
12932 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12933 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12934 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12935 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12936 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12937 special arguments are supported:
12938
12939 @table @code
12940 @item $regs
12941 Collect all registers.
12942
12943 @item $args
12944 Collect all function arguments.
12945
12946 @item $locals
12947 Collect all local variables.
12948
12949 @item $_ret
12950 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12951 of a backtrace.
12952
12953 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12954 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12955 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
12956 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12957 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12958 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12959
12960 @item $_probe_argc
12961 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12962 tracepoint is located.
12963 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12964
12965 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12966 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12967 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12968 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12969
12970 @item $_sdata
12971 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12972 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12973 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12974 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12975 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12976 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12977 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12978 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12979 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12980
12981 @smallexample
12982 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12983 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12984 @end smallexample
12985
12986 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12987 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12988 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12989 @value{GDBN}.
12990 @end table
12991
12992 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12993 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12994 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12995
12996 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12997 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12998 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12999 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13000 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13001 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13002 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13003 @samp{mystr}.
13004
13005 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13006 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13007
13008 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13009 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13010 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13011 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13012 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13013 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13014 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13015 action were used.
13016
13017 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13018 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13019 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13020 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13021 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13022 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13023
13024 @smallexample
13025 > while-stepping 12
13026 > collect $regs, myglobal
13027 > end
13028 >
13029 @end smallexample
13030
13031 @noindent
13032 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13033 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13034 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13035 @code{stepping}.
13036
13037 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13038 @kindex set default-collect
13039 @cindex default collection action
13040 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13041 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13042 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13043 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13044 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13045 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13046
13047 @item show default-collect
13048 @kindex show default-collect
13049 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13050 tracepoint hit.
13051
13052 @end table
13053
13054 @node Listing Tracepoints
13055 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13056
13057 @table @code
13058 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13059 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13060 @cindex information about tracepoints
13061 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13062 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13063 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13064 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13065 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13066 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13067
13068 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13069 tracing:
13070
13071 @itemize @bullet
13072 @item
13073 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13074
13075 @item
13076 the state about installed on target of each location
13077 @end itemize
13078
13079 @smallexample
13080 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13081 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13082 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13083 while-stepping 20
13084 collect globfoo, $regs
13085 end
13086 collect globfoo2
13087 end
13088 pass count 1200
13089 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13090 collect $eip
13091 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13092 installed on target
13093 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13094 installed on target
13095 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13096 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13097 not installed on target
13098 (@value{GDBP})
13099 @end smallexample
13100
13101 @noindent
13102 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13103 @end table
13104
13105 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13106 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13107
13108 @table @code
13109 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13110 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13111 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13112 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13113 program.
13114
13115 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13116
13117 @table @emph
13118 @item Count
13119 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13120 stable identifier.
13121 @item ID
13122 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13123 @item Enabled or Disabled
13124 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13125 that are not enabled.
13126 @item Address
13127 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13128 @item What
13129 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13130 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13131 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13132 will be left blank.
13133 @end table
13134
13135 @noindent
13136 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13137
13138 @table @emph
13139 @item Data
13140 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13141 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13142 marker call.
13143 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13144 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13145 @end table
13146
13147 @smallexample
13148 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13149 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13150 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13151 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13152 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13153 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13154 Data: str %s
13155 (@value{GDBP})
13156 @end smallexample
13157 @end table
13158
13159 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13160 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13161
13162 @table @code
13163 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13164 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13165 @cindex collected data discarded
13166 @item tstart
13167 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13168 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13169 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13170 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13171 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13172 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13173 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13174 information, and so forth.
13175
13176 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13177 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13178 @item tstop
13179 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13180 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13181 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13182 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13183 needs to be stopped quickly.
13184
13185 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13186 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13187 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13188
13189 @kindex tstatus
13190 @cindex status of trace data collection
13191 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13192 @item tstatus
13193 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13194 collection.
13195 @end table
13196
13197 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13198
13199 @smallexample
13200 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13201 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13202 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13203 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13204 > while-stepping 11
13205 > collect $regs
13206 > end
13207 > end
13208 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13209 [time passes @dots{}]
13210 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13211 @end smallexample
13212
13213 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13214 @cindex disconnected tracing
13215 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13216 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13217 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13218 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13219 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13220 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13221 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13222 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13223
13224 @table @code
13225 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13226 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13227 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13228 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13229 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13230 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13231 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13232 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13233
13234 @item show disconnected-tracing
13235 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13236 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13237
13238 @end table
13239
13240 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13241 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13242 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13243 it will continue after reconnection.
13244
13245 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13246 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13247 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13248 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13249 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13250 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13251 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13252 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13253 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13254 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13255
13256 @cindex circular trace buffer
13257 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13258 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13259 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13260 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13261 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13262 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13263 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13264 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13265 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13266 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13267 the next run.
13268
13269 @table @code
13270 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13271 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13272 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13273 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13274 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13275 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13276 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13277
13278 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13279 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13280 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13281 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13282 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13283 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13284
13285 @end table
13286
13287 @table @code
13288 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13289 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13290 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13291 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13292 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13293 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13294 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13295 likes. This is also the default.
13296
13297 @item show trace-buffer-size
13298 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13299 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13300 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13301 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13302 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13303 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13304 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13305 @end table
13306
13307 @table @code
13308 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13309 @kindex set trace-user
13310
13311 @item show trace-user
13312 @kindex show trace-user
13313
13314 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13315 @kindex set trace-notes
13316 Set the trace run's notes.
13317
13318 @item show trace-notes
13319 @kindex show trace-notes
13320 Show the trace run's notes.
13321
13322 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13323 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13324 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13325 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13326 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13327
13328 @item show trace-stop-notes
13329 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13330 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13331
13332 @end table
13333
13334 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13335 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13336
13337 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13338 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13339 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13340 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13341 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13342 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13343 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13344 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13345 mentioned here.
13346
13347 @itemize @bullet
13348
13349 @item
13350 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13351 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13352 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13353 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13354 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13355 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13356 cannot be collected either.
13357
13358 @item
13359 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13360 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13361 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13362 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13363 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13364 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13365 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13366 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13367 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13368 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13369
13370 @item
13371 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13372 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13373 in a misleading way.
13374
13375 @item
13376 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13377 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13378 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13379 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13380 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13381 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13382 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13383 by @code{ptr}.
13384
13385 @item
13386 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13387 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13388 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13389 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13390 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13391 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13392 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13393 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13394 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13395 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13396 invalid address.
13397
13398 @item
13399 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13400 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13401 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13402 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13403 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13404 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13405 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13406 it to zero.
13407
13408 @end itemize
13409
13410 @node Analyze Collected Data
13411 @section Using the Collected Data
13412
13413 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13414 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13415 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13416 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13417 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13418 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13419 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13420 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13421 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13422 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13423 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13424 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13425 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13426 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13427 the buffer will fail.
13428
13429 @menu
13430 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13431 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13432 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13433 @end menu
13434
13435 @node tfind
13436 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13437
13438 @kindex tfind
13439 @cindex select trace snapshot
13440 @cindex find trace snapshot
13441 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13442 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13443 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13444 snapshot is selected.
13445
13446 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13447
13448 @table @code
13449 @item tfind start
13450 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13451 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13452
13453 @item tfind none
13454 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13455
13456 @item tfind end
13457 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13458
13459 @item tfind
13460 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13461 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13462
13463 @item tfind -
13464 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13465 retracing earlier steps.
13466
13467 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13468 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13469 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13470 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13471 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13472
13473 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13474 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13475 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13476 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13477 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13478
13479 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13480 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13481 addresses (exclusive).
13482
13483 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13484 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13485 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13486
13487 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13488 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13489 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13490 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13491 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13492 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13493 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13494 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13495 @end table
13496
13497 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13498 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13499 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13500 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13501 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13502 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13503 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13504 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13505 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13506 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13507 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13508 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13509 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13510 tracepoint as the current one.
13511
13512 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13513 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13514 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13515 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13516 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13517
13518 @smallexample
13519 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13520 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13521 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13522 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13523 > tfind
13524 > end
13525
13526 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13527 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13528 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13529 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13530 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13531 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13532 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13533 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13534 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13535 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13536 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13537 @end smallexample
13538
13539 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13540 the buffer:
13541
13542 @smallexample
13543 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13544 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13545 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13546 > tfind line
13547 > end
13548
13549 Frame 0, X = 1
13550 Frame 7, X = 2
13551 Frame 13, X = 255
13552 @end smallexample
13553
13554 @node tdump
13555 @subsection @code{tdump}
13556 @kindex tdump
13557 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13558 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13559
13560 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13561 the current trace snapshot.
13562
13563 @smallexample
13564 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13565 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13566 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13567 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13568 > end
13569
13570 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13571
13572 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13573 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13574 at gdb_test.c:444
13575 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13576
13577 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13578 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13579 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13580 d1 0x18 24
13581 d2 0x80 128
13582 d3 0x33 51
13583 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13584 d5 0x22 34
13585 d6 0xe0 224
13586 d7 0x380035 3670069
13587 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13588 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13589 a2 0x100 256
13590 a3 0x322000 3284992
13591 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13592 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13593 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13594 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13595 ps 0x0 0
13596 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13597 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13598 fpstatus 0x0 0
13599 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13600 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13601 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13602 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13603 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13604 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13605 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13606 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13607 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13608
13609 (@value{GDBP})
13610 @end smallexample
13611
13612 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13613 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13614 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13615 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13616
13617 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13618 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13619 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13620 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13621 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13622 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13623 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13624 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13625 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13626 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13627
13628 @node save tracepoints
13629 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13630 @kindex save tracepoints
13631 @kindex save-tracepoints
13632 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13633
13634 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13635 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13636 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13637 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13638 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13639 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13640
13641 @node Tracepoint Variables
13642 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13643 @cindex tracepoint variables
13644 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13645
13646 @table @code
13647 @vindex $trace_frame
13648 @item (int) $trace_frame
13649 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13650 snapshot is selected.
13651
13652 @vindex $tracepoint
13653 @item (int) $tracepoint
13654 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13655
13656 @vindex $trace_line
13657 @item (int) $trace_line
13658 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13659
13660 @vindex $trace_file
13661 @item (char []) $trace_file
13662 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13663
13664 @vindex $trace_func
13665 @item (char []) $trace_func
13666 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13667 @end table
13668
13669 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13670 use @code{output} instead.
13671
13672 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13673 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13674 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13675 which are managed by the target.
13676
13677 @smallexample
13678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13679
13680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13681 > output $trace_file
13682 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13683 > tfind
13684 > end
13685 @end smallexample
13686
13687 @node Trace Files
13688 @section Using Trace Files
13689 @cindex trace files
13690
13691 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13692 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13693 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13694 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13695 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13696
13697 @table @code
13698
13699 @kindex tsave
13700 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13701 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13702 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13703 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13704 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13705 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13706 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13707 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13708 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13709 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13710 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13711 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13712 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13713 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13714 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13715
13716 @kindex target tfile
13717 @kindex tfile
13718 @kindex target ctf
13719 @kindex ctf
13720 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13721 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13722 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13723 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13724 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13725 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13726 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13727 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13728 the host.
13729
13730 @smallexample
13731 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13732 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13733 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13734 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13735 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13736 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13737 i = 0
13738 a = 0
13739 b = 1 '\001'
13740 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13741 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13742 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13743 $1 = 1
13744 @end smallexample
13745
13746 @end table
13747
13748 @node Overlays
13749 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13750 @cindex overlays
13751
13752 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13753 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13754 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13755 use overlays.
13756
13757 @menu
13758 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13759 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13760 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13761 mapped by asking the inferior.
13762 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13763 @end menu
13764
13765 @node How Overlays Work
13766 @section How Overlays Work
13767 @cindex mapped overlays
13768 @cindex unmapped overlays
13769 @cindex load address, overlay's
13770 @cindex mapped address
13771 @cindex overlay area
13772
13773 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13774 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13775 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13776 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13777 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13778
13779 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13780 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13781 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13782 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13783 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13784 largest overlay as well.
13785
13786 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13787 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13788 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13789 there.
13790
13791 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13792 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13793 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13794
13795 @smallexample
13796 @group
13797 Data Instruction Larger
13798 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13799 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13800 | | | | | |
13801 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13802 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13803 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13804 | and heap | | | | | |
13805 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13806 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13807 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13808 | | | | | |
13809 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13810 address | | | | | |
13811 | overlay | <-' | | |
13812 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13813 | | <---. | | load address
13814 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13815 | | | |
13816 +-----------+ | |
13817 +-----------+
13818 | |
13819 +-----------+
13820
13821 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13822 @end group
13823 @end smallexample
13824
13825 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13826 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13827 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13828 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13829 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13830 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13831 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13832 program and the overlay area.
13833
13834 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13835 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13836 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13837 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13838 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13839 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13840 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13841
13842 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13843 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13844 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13845
13846 @itemize @bullet
13847
13848 @item
13849 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13850 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13851 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13852 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13853
13854 @item
13855 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13856 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13857 your program's performance.
13858
13859 @item
13860 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13861 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13862 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13863 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13864 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13865 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13866 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13867
13868 @item
13869 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13870 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13871 instruction and data spaces.
13872
13873 @end itemize
13874
13875 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13876 improved in many ways:
13877
13878 @itemize @bullet
13879
13880 @item
13881 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13882 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13883 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13884 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13885 area in the usual way.
13886
13887 @item
13888 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13889 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13890
13891 @item
13892 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13893 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13894 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13895 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13896 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13897 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13898 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13899
13900 @end itemize
13901
13902
13903 @node Overlay Commands
13904 @section Overlay Commands
13905
13906 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13907 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13908 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13909 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13910 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13911 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13912
13913 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13914 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13915
13916 @table @code
13917 @item overlay off
13918 @kindex overlay
13919 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13920 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13921 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13922 overlay support is disabled.
13923
13924 @item overlay manual
13925 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13926 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13927 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13928 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13929 commands described below.
13930
13931 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13932 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13933 @cindex map an overlay
13934 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13935 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13936 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13937 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13938 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13939 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13940
13941 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13942 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13943 @cindex unmap an overlay
13944 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13945 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13946 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13947 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13948
13949 @item overlay auto
13950 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13951 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13952 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13953 Overlay Debugging}.
13954
13955 @item overlay load-target
13956 @itemx overlay load
13957 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13958 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13959 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13960 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13961 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13962 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13963
13964 @item overlay list-overlays
13965 @itemx overlay list
13966 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13967 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13968 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13969
13970 @end table
13971
13972 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13973 of the function the address falls in:
13974
13975 @smallexample
13976 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13977 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13978 @end smallexample
13979 @noindent
13980 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13981 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13982 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13983 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13984
13985 @smallexample
13986 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13987 No sections are mapped.
13988 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13989 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13990 @end smallexample
13991 @noindent
13992 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13993 name normally:
13994
13995 @smallexample
13996 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13997 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13998 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13999 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14000 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14001 @end smallexample
14002
14003 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14004 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14005 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14006 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14007 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14008
14009 @itemize @bullet
14010 @item
14011 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14012 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14013 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14014 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14015 @item
14016 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14017 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14018 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14019 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14020 breakpoints properly.
14021 @end itemize
14022
14023
14024 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14025 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14026 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14027
14028 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14029 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14030 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14031 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14032 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14033 current state of the overlays.
14034
14035 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14036 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14037
14038 @table @asis
14039
14040 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14041 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14042
14043 @smallexample
14044 struct
14045 @{
14046 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14047 unsigned long vma;
14048
14049 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14050 unsigned long size;
14051
14052 /* The overlay's load address. */
14053 unsigned long lma;
14054
14055 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14056 zero otherwise. */
14057 unsigned long mapped;
14058 @}
14059 @end smallexample
14060
14061 @item @code{_novlys}:
14062 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14063 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14064
14065 @end table
14066
14067 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14068 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14069 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14070 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14071 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14072 currently mapped.
14073
14074 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14075 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14076 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14077 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14078 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14079 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14080 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14081 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14082 are not being executed.
14083
14084 @node Overlay Sample Program
14085 @section Overlay Sample Program
14086 @cindex overlay example program
14087
14088 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14089 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14090 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14091 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14092 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14093 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14094 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14095
14096 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14097 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14098 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14099 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14100
14101 @table @file
14102 @item overlays.c
14103 The main program file.
14104 @item ovlymgr.c
14105 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14106 @item foo.c
14107 @itemx bar.c
14108 @itemx baz.c
14109 @itemx grbx.c
14110 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14111 @item d10v.ld
14112 @itemx m32r.ld
14113 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14114 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14115 @end table
14116
14117 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14118 cross-compiler like this:
14119
14120 @smallexample
14121 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14122 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14123 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14124 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14125 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14126 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14127 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14128 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14129 @end smallexample
14130
14131 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14132 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14133 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14134
14135
14136 @node Languages
14137 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14138 @cindex languages
14139
14140 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14141 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14142 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14143 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14144 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14145 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14146
14147 @cindex working language
14148 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14149 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14150 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14151 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14152 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14153 language}.
14154
14155 @menu
14156 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14157 * Show:: Displaying the language
14158 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14159 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14160 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14161 @end menu
14162
14163 @node Setting
14164 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14165
14166 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14167 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14168 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14169 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14170 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14171 are printed, etc.
14172
14173 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14174 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14175 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14176 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14177 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14178 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14179 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14180 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14181 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14182 Displaying the Language}.
14183
14184 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14185 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14186 another language. In that case, make the
14187 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14188 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14189 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14190
14191 @menu
14192 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14193 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14194 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14195 @end menu
14196
14197 @node Filenames
14198 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14199
14200 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14201 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14202
14203 @table @file
14204 @item .ada
14205 @itemx .ads
14206 @itemx .adb
14207 @itemx .a
14208 Ada source file.
14209
14210 @item .c
14211 C source file
14212
14213 @item .C
14214 @itemx .cc
14215 @itemx .cp
14216 @itemx .cpp
14217 @itemx .cxx
14218 @itemx .c++
14219 C@t{++} source file
14220
14221 @item .d
14222 D source file
14223
14224 @item .m
14225 Objective-C source file
14226
14227 @item .f
14228 @itemx .F
14229 Fortran source file
14230
14231 @item .mod
14232 Modula-2 source file
14233
14234 @item .s
14235 @itemx .S
14236 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14237 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14238 @end table
14239
14240 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14241 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14242
14243 @node Manually
14244 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14245
14246 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14247 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14248 your program.
14249
14250 @kindex set language
14251 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14252 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14253 a language, such as
14254 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14255 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14256
14257 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14258 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14259 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14260 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14261 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14262 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14263 command such as:
14264
14265 @smallexample
14266 print a = b + c
14267 @end smallexample
14268
14269 @noindent
14270 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14271 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14272 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14273 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14274
14275 @node Automatically
14276 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14277
14278 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14279 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14280 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14281 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14282 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14283 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14284 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14285 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14286 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14287
14288 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14289 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14290 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14291 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14292 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14293
14294 @node Show
14295 @section Displaying the Language
14296
14297 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14298 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14299
14300 @table @code
14301 @item show language
14302 @anchor{show language}
14303 @kindex show language
14304 Display the current working language. This is the
14305 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14306 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14307
14308 @item info frame
14309 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14310 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14311 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14312 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14313 information listed here.
14314
14315 @item info source
14316 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14317 Display the source language of this source file.
14318 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14319 information listed here.
14320 @end table
14321
14322 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14323 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14324 with a language explicitly:
14325
14326 @table @code
14327 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14328 @kindex set extension-language
14329 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14330 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14331
14332 @item info extensions
14333 @kindex info extensions
14334 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14335 @end table
14336
14337 @node Checks
14338 @section Type and Range Checking
14339
14340 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14341 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14342 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14343 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14344 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14345 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14346 errors when your program is running.
14347
14348 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14349 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14350 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14351 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14352
14353 @menu
14354 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14355 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14356 @end menu
14357
14358 @cindex type checking
14359 @cindex checks, type
14360 @node Type Checking
14361 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14362
14363 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14364 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14365 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14366 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14367
14368 @smallexample
14369 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14370
14371 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14372 $1 = 2
14373 @exdent but
14374 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14375 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14376 @end smallexample
14377
14378 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14379 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14380
14381 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14382 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14383 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14384 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14385 expressions like the second example above.
14386
14387 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14388 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14389 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14390 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14391 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14392 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14393
14394 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14395
14396 @kindex set check type
14397 @kindex show check type
14398 @table @code
14399 @item set check type on
14400 @itemx set check type off
14401 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14402 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14403 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14404
14405 @item show check type
14406 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14407 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14408 @end table
14409
14410 @cindex range checking
14411 @cindex checks, range
14412 @node Range Checking
14413 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14414
14415 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14416 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14417 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14418 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14419 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14420
14421 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14422 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14423 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14424 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14425
14426 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14427 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14428 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14429 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14430 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14431 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14432
14433 @smallexample
14434 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14435 @end smallexample
14436
14437 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14438 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14439 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14440
14441 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14442
14443 @kindex set check range
14444 @kindex show check range
14445 @table @code
14446 @item set check range auto
14447 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14448 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14449 each language.
14450
14451 @item set check range on
14452 @itemx set check range off
14453 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14454 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14455 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14456 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14457
14458 @item set check range warn
14459 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14460 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14461 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14462 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14463 systems).
14464
14465 @item show range
14466 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14467 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14468 @end table
14469
14470 @node Supported Languages
14471 @section Supported Languages
14472
14473 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14474 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14475 @c This is false ...
14476 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14477 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14478 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14479 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14480 language.
14481
14482 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14483 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14484 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14485 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14486 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14487 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14488 language reference or tutorial.
14489
14490 @menu
14491 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14492 * D:: D
14493 * Go:: Go
14494 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14495 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14496 * Fortran:: Fortran
14497 * Pascal:: Pascal
14498 * Rust:: Rust
14499 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14500 * Ada:: Ada
14501 @end menu
14502
14503 @node C
14504 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14505
14506 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14507 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14508
14509 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14510 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14511 together.
14512
14513 @cindex C@t{++}
14514 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14515 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14516 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14517 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14518 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14519 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14520 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14521
14522 @menu
14523 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14524 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14525 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14526 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14527 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14528 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14529 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14530 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14531 @end menu
14532
14533 @node C Operators
14534 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14535
14536 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14537
14538 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14539 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14540 often defined on groups of types.
14541
14542 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14543
14544 @itemize @bullet
14545
14546 @item
14547 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14548 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14549
14550 @item
14551 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14552 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14553
14554 @item
14555 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14556
14557 @item
14558 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14559
14560 @end itemize
14561
14562 @noindent
14563 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14564 in order of increasing precedence:
14565
14566 @table @code
14567 @item ,
14568 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14569 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14570 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14571
14572 @item =
14573 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14574 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14575
14576 @item @var{op}=
14577 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14578 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14579 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14580 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14581 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14582
14583 @item ?:
14584 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14585 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14586 should be of an integral type.
14587
14588 @item ||
14589 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14590
14591 @item &&
14592 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14593
14594 @item |
14595 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14596
14597 @item ^
14598 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14599
14600 @item &
14601 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14602
14603 @item ==@r{, }!=
14604 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14605 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14606
14607 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14608 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14609 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14610 and non-zero for true.
14611
14612 @item <<@r{, }>>
14613 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14614
14615 @item @@
14616 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14617
14618 @item +@r{, }-
14619 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14620 pointer types.
14621
14622 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14623 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14624 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14625 integral types.
14626
14627 @item ++@r{, }--
14628 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14629 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14630 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14631 operation takes place.
14632
14633 @item *
14634 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14635 @code{++}.
14636
14637 @item &
14638 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14639
14640 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14641 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14642 to examine the address
14643 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14644 stored.
14645
14646 @item -
14647 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14648 precedence as @code{++}.
14649
14650 @item !
14651 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14652 @code{++}.
14653
14654 @item ~
14655 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14656 @code{++}.
14657
14658
14659 @item .@r{, }->
14660 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14661 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14662 pointer based on the stored type information.
14663 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14664
14665 @item .*@r{, }->*
14666 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14667
14668 @item []
14669 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14670 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14671
14672 @item ()
14673 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14674
14675 @item ::
14676 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14677 and @code{class} types.
14678
14679 @item ::
14680 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14681 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14682 above.
14683 @end table
14684
14685 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14686 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14687 predefined meaning.
14688
14689 @node C Constants
14690 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14691
14692 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14693
14694 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14695 following ways:
14696
14697 @itemize @bullet
14698 @item
14699 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14700 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14701 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14702 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14703 @code{long} value.
14704
14705 @item
14706 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14707 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14708 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14709 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14710 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14711 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14712 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14713 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14714 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14715 constant.
14716
14717 @item
14718 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14719 integral equivalents.
14720
14721 @item
14722 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14723 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14724 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14725 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14726 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14727 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14728 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14729 @samp{\n} for newline.
14730
14731 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14732 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14733 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14734 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14735
14736 @item
14737 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14738 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14739 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14740 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14741 characters.
14742
14743 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14744 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14745 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14746
14747 @item
14748 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14749 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14750
14751 @item
14752 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14753 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14754 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14755 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14756 @end itemize
14757
14758 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14759 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14760
14761 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14762 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14763
14764 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14765 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14766 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14767 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14768 @quotation
14769 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14770 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14771 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14772 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14773 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14774 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14775 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14776 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14777 @end quotation
14778
14779 @enumerate
14780
14781 @cindex member functions
14782 @item
14783 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14784
14785 @smallexample
14786 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14787 @end smallexample
14788
14789 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14790 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14791 @item
14792 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14793 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14794 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14795 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14796 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14797
14798 @cindex call overloaded functions
14799 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14800 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14801 @item
14802 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14803 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14804 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14805 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14806 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14807 default arguments.
14808
14809 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14810 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14811 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14812 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14813 number of function arguments.
14814
14815 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14816 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14817 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14818
14819 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14820 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14821 @smallexample
14822 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14823 @end smallexample
14824
14825 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14826 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14827
14828 @cindex reference declarations
14829 @item
14830 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
14831 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
14832 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
14833
14834 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14835 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14836 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14837 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14838 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14839
14840 @item
14841 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14842 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14843 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14844 necessary, for example in an expression like
14845 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14846 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14847 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14848
14849 @item
14850 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14851 specification.
14852 @end enumerate
14853
14854 @node C Defaults
14855 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14856
14857 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14858
14859 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14860 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14861 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14862 selects the working language.
14863
14864 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14865 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14866 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14867 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14868 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14869 for further details.
14870
14871 @node C Checks
14872 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14873
14874 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14875
14876 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14877 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14878 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14879 constants to pointers.
14880
14881 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14882 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14883 that is not itself an array.
14884
14885 @node Debugging C
14886 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14887
14888 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14889 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14890 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14891 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14892
14893 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14894 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14895 ,Expressions}.
14896
14897 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14898 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14899
14900 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14901
14902 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14903 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14904
14905 @table @code
14906 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14907 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14908 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14909 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14910 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14911 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14912
14913 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14914 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14915 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14916 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14917 classes.
14918 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14919
14920 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14921 @item catch throw
14922 @itemx catch rethrow
14923 @itemx catch catch
14924 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14925 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14926
14927 @cindex inheritance
14928 @item ptype @var{typename}
14929 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14930 @var{typename}.
14931 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14932
14933 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14934 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14935 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14936 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14937 multiple inheritance is in use.
14938
14939 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14940 @item demangle @var{name}
14941 Demangle @var{name}.
14942 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14943
14944 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14945 @item set print demangle
14946 @itemx show print demangle
14947 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14948 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14949 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14950 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14951 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14952
14953 @item set print object
14954 @itemx show print object
14955 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14956 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14957
14958 @item set print vtbl
14959 @itemx show print vtbl
14960 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14961 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14962 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14963 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14964
14965 @kindex set overload-resolution
14966 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14967 @item set overload-resolution on
14968 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14969 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14970 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14971 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14972 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14973 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14974
14975 @item set overload-resolution off
14976 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14977 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14978 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14979 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14980 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14981 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14982 argument types.
14983
14984 @kindex show overload-resolution
14985 @item show overload-resolution
14986 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14987
14988 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14989 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14990 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14991 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14992 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14993 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14994 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14995 @end table
14996
14997 @node Decimal Floating Point
14998 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14999 @cindex decimal floating point format
15000
15001 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15002 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15003 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15004 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15005
15006 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15007 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15008 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15009 configured target.
15010
15011 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15012 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15013 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15014
15015 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15016 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15017 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15018
15019 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15020 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15021 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15022
15023 @node D
15024 @subsection D
15025
15026 @cindex D
15027 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15028 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15029 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15030
15031 @node Go
15032 @subsection Go
15033
15034 @cindex Go (programming language)
15035 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15036 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15037
15038 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15039
15040 @table @code
15041 @cindex current Go package
15042 @item The current Go package
15043 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15044 specifying global variables and functions.
15045
15046 For example, given the program:
15047
15048 @example
15049 package main
15050 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15051 func main () @{
15052 // ...
15053 @}
15054 @end example
15055
15056 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15057
15058 @example
15059 (gdb) p myglob
15060 (gdb) p main.myglob
15061 @end example
15062
15063 @cindex builtin Go types
15064 @item Builtin Go types
15065 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15066 as a string.
15067
15068 @cindex builtin Go functions
15069 @item Builtin Go functions
15070 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15071 function and handles it internally.
15072
15073 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15074 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15075 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15076 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15077 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15078 @end table
15079
15080 @node Objective-C
15081 @subsection Objective-C
15082
15083 @cindex Objective-C
15084 This section provides information about some commands and command
15085 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15086 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15087 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15088
15089 @menu
15090 * Method Names in Commands::
15091 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15092 @end menu
15093
15094 @node Method Names in Commands
15095 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15096
15097 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15098 names as line specifications:
15099
15100 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15101 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15102 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15103 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15104 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15105 @itemize
15106 @item @code{clear}
15107 @item @code{break}
15108 @item @code{info line}
15109 @item @code{jump}
15110 @item @code{list}
15111 @end itemize
15112
15113 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15114
15115 @smallexample
15116 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15117 @end smallexample
15118
15119 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15120 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15121 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15122 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15123 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15124 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15125 debugged, enter:
15126
15127 @smallexample
15128 break -[Fruit create]
15129 @end smallexample
15130
15131 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15132 enter:
15133
15134 @smallexample
15135 list +[NSText initialize]
15136 @end smallexample
15137
15138 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15139 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15140 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15141 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15142
15143 @smallexample
15144 break create
15145 @end smallexample
15146
15147 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15148 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15149 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15150 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15151 none apply.
15152
15153 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15154 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15155
15156 @smallexample
15157 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15158 @end smallexample
15159
15160 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15161 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15162 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15163 @kindex print-object
15164 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15165
15166 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15167
15168 @smallexample
15169 print -[@var{object} hash]
15170 @end smallexample
15171
15172 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15173 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15174 @noindent
15175 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15176 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15177 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15178 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15179 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15180 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15181
15182 @node OpenCL C
15183 @subsection OpenCL C
15184
15185 @cindex OpenCL C
15186 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15187
15188 @menu
15189 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15190 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15191 * OpenCL C Operators::
15192 @end menu
15193
15194 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15195 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15196
15197 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15198 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15199 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15200 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15201 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15202
15203 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15204 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15205
15206 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15207 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15208 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15209 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15210
15211 @node OpenCL C Operators
15212 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15213
15214 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15215 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15216 vector data types.
15217
15218 @node Fortran
15219 @subsection Fortran
15220 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15221
15222 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15223 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15224
15225 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15226 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15227 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15228 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15229 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15230 underscore.
15231
15232 @menu
15233 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15234 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15235 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15236 @end menu
15237
15238 @node Fortran Operators
15239 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15240
15241 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15242
15243 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15244 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15245 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15246
15247 @table @code
15248 @item **
15249 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15250 of the second one.
15251
15252 @item :
15253 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15254 represent a section of array.
15255
15256 @item %
15257 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15258 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15259 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15260 union type.
15261 @end table
15262
15263 @node Fortran Defaults
15264 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15265
15266 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15267
15268 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15269 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15270 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15271 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15272
15273 @node Special Fortran Commands
15274 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15275
15276 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15277
15278 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15279 such as displaying common blocks.
15280
15281 @table @code
15282 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15283 @kindex info common
15284 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15285 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15286 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15287 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15288 printed.
15289 @end table
15290
15291 @node Pascal
15292 @subsection Pascal
15293
15294 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15295 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15296 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15297 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15298 syntax.
15299
15300 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15301 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15302 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15303
15304 @node Rust
15305 @subsection Rust
15306
15307 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15308 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15309 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15310 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15311
15312 @itemize @bullet
15313 @item
15314 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15315 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15316 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15317
15318 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15319 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15320 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15321 @samp{B}.
15322
15323 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15324 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15325
15326 @item
15327 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15328 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15329 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15330 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15331 @samp{K::x::y}.
15332
15333 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15334 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15335 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15336 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15337 scope.
15338
15339 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15340 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15341
15342 @item
15343 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15344 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15345
15346 @item
15347 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15348
15349 @item
15350 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15351 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15352 never be destroyed.
15353
15354 @item
15355 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15356 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15357 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15358
15359 @item
15360 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15361 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15362 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15363 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15364 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15365 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15366 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15367 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15368
15369 @item
15370 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15371 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15372 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15373 @itemize @bullet
15374
15375 @item
15376 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15377
15378 @item
15379 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15380
15381 @item
15382 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15383
15384 @item
15385 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15386 type names.
15387
15388 @item
15389 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15390
15391 @item
15392 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15393 available in the crate.
15394 @end itemize
15395 @end itemize
15396
15397 @node Modula-2
15398 @subsection Modula-2
15399
15400 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15401
15402 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15403 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15404 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15405 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15406 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15407 table.
15408
15409 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15410 @menu
15411 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15412 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15413 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15414 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15415 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15416 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15417 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15418 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15419 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15420 @end menu
15421
15422 @node M2 Operators
15423 @subsubsection Operators
15424 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15425
15426 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15427 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15428 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15429 following definitions hold:
15430
15431 @itemize @bullet
15432
15433 @item
15434 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15435 their subranges.
15436
15437 @item
15438 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15439
15440 @item
15441 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15442
15443 @item
15444 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15445 @var{type}}.
15446
15447 @item
15448 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15449
15450 @item
15451 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15452
15453 @item
15454 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15455 @end itemize
15456
15457 @noindent
15458 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15459 increasing precedence:
15460
15461 @table @code
15462 @item ,
15463 Function argument or array index separator.
15464
15465 @item :=
15466 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15467 @var{value}.
15468
15469 @item <@r{, }>
15470 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15471 types.
15472
15473 @item <=@r{, }>=
15474 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15475 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15476 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15477
15478 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15479 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15480 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15481 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15482 comment character.
15483
15484 @item IN
15485 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15486 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15487
15488 @item OR
15489 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15490
15491 @item AND@r{, }&
15492 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15493
15494 @item @@
15495 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15496
15497 @item +@r{, }-
15498 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15499 and difference on set types.
15500
15501 @item *
15502 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15503 on set types.
15504
15505 @item /
15506 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15507 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15508
15509 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15510 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15511 precedence as @code{*}.
15512
15513 @item -
15514 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15515
15516 @item ^
15517 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15518
15519 @item NOT
15520 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15521 @code{^}.
15522
15523 @item .
15524 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15525 precedence as @code{^}.
15526
15527 @item []
15528 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15529
15530 @item ()
15531 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15532 as @code{^}.
15533
15534 @item ::@r{, }.
15535 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15536 @end table
15537
15538 @quotation
15539 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15540 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15541 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15542 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15543 @end quotation
15544
15545
15546 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15547 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15548 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15549
15550 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15551 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15552
15553 @table @var
15554
15555 @item a
15556 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15557
15558 @item c
15559 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15560
15561 @item i
15562 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15563
15564 @item m
15565 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15566 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15567 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15568
15569 @item n
15570 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15571
15572 @item r
15573 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15574
15575 @item t
15576 represents a type.
15577
15578 @item v
15579 represents a variable.
15580
15581 @item x
15582 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15583 explanation of the function for details.
15584 @end table
15585
15586 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15587
15588 @table @code
15589 @item ABS(@var{n})
15590 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15591
15592 @item CAP(@var{c})
15593 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15594 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15595
15596 @item CHR(@var{i})
15597 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15598
15599 @item DEC(@var{v})
15600 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15601
15602 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15603 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15604 new value.
15605
15606 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15607 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15608 set.
15609
15610 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15611 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15612
15613 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15614 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15615
15616 @item INC(@var{v})
15617 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15618
15619 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15620 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15621 new value.
15622
15623 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15624 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15625 there. Returns the new set.
15626
15627 @item MAX(@var{t})
15628 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15629
15630 @item MIN(@var{t})
15631 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15632
15633 @item ODD(@var{i})
15634 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15635
15636 @item ORD(@var{x})
15637 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15638 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15639 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15640 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15641
15642 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15643 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15644 variable or a type.
15645
15646 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15647 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15648
15649 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15650 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15651 variable or a type.
15652
15653 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15654 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15655 @end table
15656
15657 @quotation
15658 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15659 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15660 an error.
15661 @end quotation
15662
15663 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15664 @node M2 Constants
15665 @subsubsection Constants
15666
15667 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15668 ways:
15669
15670 @itemize @bullet
15671
15672 @item
15673 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15674 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15675 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15676 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15677
15678 @item
15679 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15680 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15681 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15682 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15683 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15684 digits.
15685
15686 @item
15687 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15688 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15689 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15690 followed by a @samp{C}.
15691
15692 @item
15693 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15694 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15695 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15696 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15697 sequences.
15698
15699 @item
15700 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15701
15702 @item
15703 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15704 @code{FALSE}.
15705
15706 @item
15707 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15708
15709 @item
15710 Set constants are not yet supported.
15711 @end itemize
15712
15713 @node M2 Types
15714 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15715 @cindex Modula-2 types
15716
15717 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15718 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15719 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15720 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15721 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15722 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15723
15724 The first example contains the following section of code:
15725
15726 @smallexample
15727 VAR
15728 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15729 r: [20..40] ;
15730 @end smallexample
15731
15732 @noindent
15733 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15734 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15735
15736 @smallexample
15737 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15738 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15739 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15740 SET OF CHAR
15741 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15742 21
15743 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15744 [20..40]
15745 @end smallexample
15746
15747 @noindent
15748 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15749
15750 @smallexample
15751 VAR
15752 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15753 @end smallexample
15754
15755 @noindent
15756 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15757
15758 @smallexample
15759 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15760 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15761 @end smallexample
15762
15763 @noindent
15764 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15765 expressions using the debugger.
15766
15767 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15768 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15769
15770 @smallexample
15771 VAR
15772 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15773 @end smallexample
15774
15775 @smallexample
15776 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15777 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15778 @end smallexample
15779
15780 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15781 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15782 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15783 above.
15784
15785 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15786
15787 @smallexample
15788 TYPE
15789 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15790 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15791 VAR
15792 s: t ;
15793 BEGIN
15794 s := blue ;
15795 @end smallexample
15796
15797 @noindent
15798 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15799 and value of a variable.
15800
15801 @smallexample
15802 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15803 $1 = blue
15804 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15805 type = [blue..yellow]
15806 @end smallexample
15807
15808 @noindent
15809 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15810 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15811 their @code{C} counterparts.
15812
15813 @smallexample
15814 VAR
15815 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15816 BEGIN
15817 s[1] := 1 ;
15818 @end smallexample
15819
15820 @smallexample
15821 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15822 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15823 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15824 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15825 @end smallexample
15826
15827 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15828 pointer types as shown in this example:
15829
15830 @smallexample
15831 VAR
15832 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15833 BEGIN
15834 NEW(s) ;
15835 s^[1] := 1 ;
15836 @end smallexample
15837
15838 @noindent
15839 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15840
15841 @smallexample
15842 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15843 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15844 @end smallexample
15845
15846 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15847 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15848 types:
15849
15850 @smallexample
15851 TYPE
15852 foo = RECORD
15853 f1: CARDINAL ;
15854 f2: CHAR ;
15855 f3: myarray ;
15856 END ;
15857
15858 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15859 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15860 VAR
15861 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15862 @end smallexample
15863
15864 @noindent
15865 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15866 below.
15867
15868 @smallexample
15869 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15870 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15871 f1 : CARDINAL;
15872 f2 : CHAR;
15873 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15874 END
15875 @end smallexample
15876
15877 @node M2 Defaults
15878 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15879 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15880
15881 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15882 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15883 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15884 selected the working language.
15885
15886 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15887 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15888 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15889 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15890
15891 @node Deviations
15892 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15893 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15894
15895 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15896 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15897
15898 @itemize @bullet
15899 @item
15900 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15901 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15902 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15903 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15904 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15905 returned a pointer.)
15906
15907 @item
15908 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15909 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15910 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15911 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15912
15913 @item
15914 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15915 argument.
15916
15917 @item
15918 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15919 @end itemize
15920
15921 @node M2 Checks
15922 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15923 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15924
15925 @quotation
15926 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15927 range checking.
15928 @end quotation
15929 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15930
15931 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15932
15933 @itemize @bullet
15934 @item
15935 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15936 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15937
15938 @item
15939 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15940 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15941 @end itemize
15942
15943 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15944 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15945
15946 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15947 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15948
15949 @node M2 Scope
15950 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15951 @cindex scope
15952 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15953 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15954 @ifinfo
15955 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15956 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15957 @end ifinfo
15958 @ifnotinfo
15959 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15960 @end ifnotinfo
15961
15962 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15963 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15964 similar syntax:
15965
15966 @smallexample
15967
15968 @var{module} . @var{id}
15969 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15970 @end smallexample
15971
15972 @noindent
15973 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15974 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15975 identifier within your program, except another module.
15976
15977 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15978 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15979 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15980 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15981
15982 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15983 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15984 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15985 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15986 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15987 @var{module}.
15988
15989 @node GDB/M2
15990 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15991
15992 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15993 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15994 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15995 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15996 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15997 analogue in Modula-2.
15998
15999 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16000 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16001 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16002 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16003 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16004 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16005
16006 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16007 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16008 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16009
16010 @node Ada
16011 @subsection Ada
16012 @cindex Ada
16013
16014 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16015 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16016 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16017 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16018 to be difficult.
16019
16020
16021 @cindex expressions in Ada
16022 @menu
16023 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16024 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16025 in @value{GDBN}.
16026 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16027 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16028 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16029 subprograms.
16030 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16031 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16032 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16033 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16034 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16035 Profile
16036 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16037 @end menu
16038
16039 @node Ada Mode Intro
16040 @subsubsection Introduction
16041 @cindex Ada mode, general
16042
16043 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16044 syntax, with some extensions.
16045 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16046
16047 @itemize @bullet
16048 @item
16049 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16050 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16051 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16052 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16053
16054 @item
16055 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16056 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16057
16058 @item
16059 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16060 @end itemize
16061
16062 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16063 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16064 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16065 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16066 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16067
16068 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16069 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16070 was translated from an Ada source file.
16071
16072 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16073 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16074 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16075 middle (to allow based literals).
16076
16077 @node Omissions from Ada
16078 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16079 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16080
16081 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16082
16083 @itemize @bullet
16084 @item
16085 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16086
16087 @itemize @minus
16088 @item
16089 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16090 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16091
16092 @item
16093 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16094
16095 @item
16096 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16097
16098 @item
16099 @t{'Tag}.
16100
16101 @item
16102 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16103 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16104
16105 @item
16106 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16107 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16108
16109 @item
16110 @t{'Address}.
16111 @end itemize
16112
16113 @item
16114 The names in
16115 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16116 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16117 not currently available.
16118
16119 @item
16120 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16121 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16122 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16123 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16124 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16125 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16126 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16127 indeterminate values.
16128
16129 @item
16130 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16131 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16132 are not implemented.
16133
16134 @item
16135 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16136 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16137 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16138 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16139 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16140
16141 @smallexample
16142 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16143 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16144 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16145 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16146 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16147 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16148 @end smallexample
16149
16150 Changing a
16151 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16152 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16153 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16154 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16155 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16156 declared to have a type such as:
16157
16158 @smallexample
16159 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16160 Id : Integer;
16161 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16162 end record;
16163 @end smallexample
16164
16165 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16166 assignments:
16167
16168 @smallexample
16169 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16170 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16171 @end smallexample
16172
16173 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16174 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16175 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16176 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16177 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16178 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16179 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16180 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16181
16182 @item
16183 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16184
16185 @item
16186 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16187 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16188 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16189 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16190 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16191 the proper resolution.
16192
16193 @item
16194 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16195
16196 @item
16197 Entry calls are not implemented.
16198
16199 @item
16200 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16201 formats are not supported.
16202
16203 @item
16204 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16205
16206 @item
16207 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16208 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16209 context.
16210 Should your program
16211 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16212 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16213 @end itemize
16214
16215 @node Additions to Ada
16216 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16217 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16218
16219 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16220 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16221
16222 @itemize @bullet
16223 @item
16224 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16225 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16226 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16227 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16228 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16229 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16230 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16231 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16232
16233 @item
16234 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16235 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16236 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16237
16238 @item
16239 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16240 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16241
16242 @item
16243 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16244 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16245 @end itemize
16246
16247 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16248 additions specific to Ada:
16249
16250 @itemize @bullet
16251 @item
16252 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16253 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16254
16255 @smallexample
16256 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16257 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16258 @end smallexample
16259
16260 @item
16261 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16262 the value of its right-hand operand.
16263 This allows, for example,
16264 complex conditional breaks:
16265
16266 @smallexample
16267 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16268 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16269 @end smallexample
16270
16271 @item
16272 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16273 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16274 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16275 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16276 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16277 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16278 in strings. For example,
16279 @smallexample
16280 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16281 @end smallexample
16282 @noindent
16283 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16284 after each period.
16285
16286 @item
16287 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16288 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16289 to write
16290
16291 @smallexample
16292 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16293 @end smallexample
16294
16295 @item
16296 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16297 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16298 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16299 of 3 might print as
16300
16301 @smallexample
16302 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16303 @end smallexample
16304
16305 @noindent
16306 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16307 clause.
16308
16309 @item
16310 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16311 multi-character subsequence of
16312 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16313 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16314 in place of @t{a'length}.
16315
16316 @item
16317 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16318 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16319 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16320 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16321 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16322 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16323 For example,
16324 @smallexample
16325 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16326 @end smallexample
16327
16328 @item
16329 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16330 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16331 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16332 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16333 object.
16334
16335 @end itemize
16336
16337 @node Overloading support for Ada
16338 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16339 @cindex overloading, Ada
16340
16341 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16342 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16343 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16344 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16345 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16346 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16347
16348 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16349 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16350 use, for instance:
16351
16352 @smallexample
16353 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16354 Multiple matches for f
16355 [0] cancel
16356 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16357 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16358 >
16359 @end smallexample
16360
16361 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16362 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16363 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16364
16365 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16366 case:
16367
16368 @table @code
16369
16370 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16371 @item set ada print-signatures
16372 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16373 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16374 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16375
16376 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16377 @item show ada print-signatures
16378 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16379 overloads selection menu.
16380 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16381
16382 @end table
16383
16384 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16385 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16386
16387 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16388 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16389 before reaching the main procedure.
16390 As defined in the Ada Reference
16391 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16392 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16393 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16394 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16395
16396 @node Ada Exceptions
16397 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16398
16399 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16400
16401 @table @code
16402 @kindex info exceptions
16403 @item info exceptions
16404 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16405 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16406 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16407 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16408 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16409 @end table
16410
16411 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16412 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16413 argument.
16414
16415 @smallexample
16416 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16417 All defined Ada exceptions:
16418 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16419 program_error: 0x613d20
16420 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16421 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16422 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16423 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16424 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16425 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16426 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16427 @end smallexample
16428
16429 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16430 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16431
16432 @node Ada Tasks
16433 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16434 @cindex Ada, tasking
16435
16436 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16437 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16438
16439 @table @code
16440 @kindex info tasks
16441 @item info tasks
16442 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16443
16444
16445 @smallexample
16446 @iftex
16447 @leftskip=0.5cm
16448 @end iftex
16449 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16450 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16451 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16452 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16453 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16454 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16455
16456 @end smallexample
16457
16458 @noindent
16459 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16460 task currently being inspected.
16461
16462 @table @asis
16463 @item ID
16464 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16465
16466 @item TID
16467 The Ada task ID.
16468
16469 @item P-ID
16470 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16471
16472 @item Pri
16473 The base priority of the task.
16474
16475 @item State
16476 Current state of the task.
16477
16478 @table @code
16479 @item Unactivated
16480 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16481 executing.
16482
16483 @item Runnable
16484 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16485 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16486
16487 @item Terminated
16488 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16489 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16490 terminated themselves.
16491
16492 @item Child Activation Wait
16493 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16494
16495 @item Accept Statement
16496 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16497
16498 @item Waiting on entry call
16499 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16500
16501 @item Async Select Wait
16502 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16503 select statement.
16504
16505 @item Delay Sleep
16506 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16507 alternative open.
16508
16509 @item Child Termination Wait
16510 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16511 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16512 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16513
16514 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16515 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16516 finish terminating.
16517
16518 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16519 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16520 @end table
16521
16522 @item Name
16523 Name of the task in the program.
16524
16525 @end table
16526
16527 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16528 @item info task @var{taskno}
16529 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16530 the following example:
16531 @smallexample
16532 @iftex
16533 @leftskip=0.5cm
16534 @end iftex
16535 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16536 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16537 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16538 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16539 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16540 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16541 Name: task_1
16542 Thread: 0x807f378
16543 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16544 Base Priority: 15
16545 State: Runnable
16546 @end smallexample
16547
16548 @item task
16549 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16550 @cindex current Ada task ID
16551 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16552
16553 @smallexample
16554 @iftex
16555 @leftskip=0.5cm
16556 @end iftex
16557 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16558 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16559 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16560 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16561 (@value{GDBP}) task
16562 [Current task is 2]
16563 @end smallexample
16564
16565 @item task @var{taskno}
16566 @cindex Ada task switching
16567 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16568 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16569 from the current task to the given task.
16570
16571 @smallexample
16572 @iftex
16573 @leftskip=0.5cm
16574 @end iftex
16575 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16576 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16577 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16578 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16579 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16580 [Switching to task 1]
16581 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16582 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16583 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16584 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16585 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16586 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16587 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16588 @end smallexample
16589
16590 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16591 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16592 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16593 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16594 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16595 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16596 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16597 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16598 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16599
16600 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16601 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16602 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16603 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16604 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16605
16606 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16607 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16608 program.
16609
16610 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16611 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16612 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16613
16614 For example,
16615
16616 @smallexample
16617 @iftex
16618 @leftskip=0.5cm
16619 @end iftex
16620 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16621 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16622 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16623 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16624 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16625 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16626 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16627 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16628 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16629 Continuing.
16630 task # 1 running
16631 task # 2 running
16632
16633 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16634 15 flush;
16635 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16636 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16637 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16638 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16639 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16640 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16641 @end smallexample
16642 @end table
16643
16644 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16645 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16646 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16647
16648 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16649 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16650 the platform being used.
16651 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16652 switching is not supported.
16653
16654 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16655 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16656 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16657 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16658 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16659 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16660
16661 @node Ravenscar Profile
16662 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16663 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16664
16665 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16666 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16667 requirements.
16668
16669 @table @code
16670 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16671 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16672 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16673 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16674 Profile. This is the default.
16675
16676 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16677 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16678 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16679 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16680 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16681 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16682 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16683
16684 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16685 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16686 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16687 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16688
16689 @end table
16690
16691 @node Ada Glitches
16692 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16693 @cindex Ada, problems
16694
16695 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16696 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16697 @value{GDBN},
16698 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16699 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16700
16701 @itemize @bullet
16702 @item
16703 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16704 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16705
16706 @item
16707 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16708 argument lists are treated as positional).
16709
16710 @item
16711 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16712
16713 @item
16714 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16715 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16716 the host machine.
16717
16718 @item
16719 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16720 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16721 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16722 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16723 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16724 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16725 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16726 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16727 you can usually resolve the confusion
16728 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16729 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16730 @end itemize
16731
16732 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16733 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16734 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16735 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16736 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16737 enabled.
16738
16739 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16740 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16741 @table @code
16742
16743 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16744 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16745 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16746 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16747 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16748 This is the default.
16749
16750 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16751 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16752 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16753 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16754 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16755 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16756 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16757
16758 @end table
16759
16760 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16761 @cindex GNAT encoding
16762 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16763 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16764 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16765 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16766 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16767 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16768
16769 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16770 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16771 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16772 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16773 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16774 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16775 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16776 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16777
16778 @table @code
16779
16780 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16781 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16782 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16783 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16784
16785 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16786 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16787 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16788
16789 @end table
16790
16791 @node Unsupported Languages
16792 @section Unsupported Languages
16793
16794 @cindex unsupported languages
16795 @cindex minimal language
16796 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16797 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16798 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16799 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16800 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16801 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16802
16803 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16804 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16805 language.
16806
16807 @node Symbols
16808 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16809
16810 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16811 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16812 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16813 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16814 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16815 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16816 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16817
16818 @cindex symbol names
16819 @cindex names of symbols
16820 @cindex quoting names
16821 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16822 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16823 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16824 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16825 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16826 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16827 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16828 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16829
16830 @smallexample
16831 p 'foo.c'::x
16832 @end smallexample
16833
16834 @noindent
16835 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16836
16837 @table @code
16838 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16839 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16840 @kindex set case-sensitive
16841 @item set case-sensitive on
16842 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16843 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16844 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16845 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16846 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16847 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16848 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16849 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16850 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16851 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16852 case-insensitive matches.
16853
16854 @kindex show case-sensitive
16855 @item show case-sensitive
16856 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16857 lookups.
16858
16859 @kindex set print type methods
16860 @item set print type methods
16861 @itemx set print type methods on
16862 @itemx set print type methods off
16863 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16864 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16865 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16866 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16867 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16868 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16869
16870 @kindex show print type methods
16871 @item show print type methods
16872 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16873 classes.
16874
16875 @kindex set print type typedefs
16876 @item set print type typedefs
16877 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16878 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16879
16880 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16881 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16882 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16883 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16884 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16885 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16886 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16887 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16888 types.
16889
16890 @kindex show print type typedefs
16891 @item show print type typedefs
16892 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16893 printing classes.
16894
16895 @kindex info address
16896 @cindex address of a symbol
16897 @item info address @var{symbol}
16898 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16899 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16900 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16901 is always stored.
16902
16903 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16904 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16905 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16906
16907 @kindex info symbol
16908 @cindex symbol from address
16909 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16910 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16911 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16912 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16913 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16914
16915 @smallexample
16916 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16917 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16918 @end smallexample
16919
16920 @noindent
16921 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16922 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16923
16924 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16925 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16926
16927 @smallexample
16928 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16929 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16930 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16931 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16932 @end smallexample
16933
16934 @kindex demangle
16935 @cindex demangle
16936 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16937 Demangle @var{name}.
16938 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16939 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16940
16941 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16942 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16943
16944 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16945 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16946
16947 @kindex whatis
16948 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16949 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16950 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16951 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16952
16953 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16954 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16955 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16956
16957 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16958 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16959 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16960 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16961 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16962 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16963 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16964 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16965 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16966
16967 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16968 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16969 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16970 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16971 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16972 unroll it.
16973
16974 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16975 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16976 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16977
16978 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16979 Available flags are:
16980
16981 @table @code
16982 @item r
16983 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16984 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16985 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16986
16987 @item m
16988 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16989
16990 @item M
16991 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16992 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16993
16994 @item t
16995 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16996 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16997 names are substituted when printing other types.
16998
16999 @item T
17000 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17001 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17002 @end table
17003
17004 @kindex ptype
17005 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17006 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17007 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17008 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17009
17010 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17011 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17012 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17013 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17014 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17015 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17016 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17017 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17018
17019 For example, for this variable declaration:
17020
17021 @smallexample
17022 typedef double real_t;
17023 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17024 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17025 complex_t var;
17026 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17027 @end smallexample
17028
17029 @noindent
17030 the two commands give this output:
17031
17032 @smallexample
17033 @group
17034 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17035 type = complex_t
17036 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17037 type = struct complex @{
17038 real_t real;
17039 double imag;
17040 @}
17041 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17042 type = struct complex
17043 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17044 type = struct complex
17045 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17046 type = struct complex @{
17047 real_t real;
17048 double imag;
17049 @}
17050 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17051 type = real_t *
17052 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17053 type = double *
17054 @end group
17055 @end smallexample
17056
17057 @noindent
17058 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17059 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17060
17061 @cindex incomplete type
17062 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17063 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17064 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17065 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17066 given these declarations:
17067
17068 @smallexample
17069 struct foo;
17070 struct foo *fooptr;
17071 @end smallexample
17072
17073 @noindent
17074 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17075
17076 @smallexample
17077 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17078 $1 = <incomplete type>
17079 @end smallexample
17080
17081 @noindent
17082 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17083 completely specified.
17084
17085 @kindex info types
17086 @item info types @var{regexp}
17087 @itemx info types
17088 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17089 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17090 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17091 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17092 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17093 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17094 name is @code{value}.
17095
17096 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17097 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17098 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17099
17100 @kindex info type-printers
17101 @item info type-printers
17102 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17103 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17104 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17105 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17106 type printers.
17107
17108 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17109
17110 @kindex enable type-printer
17111 @kindex disable type-printer
17112 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17113 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17114 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17115
17116 @kindex info scope
17117 @cindex local variables
17118 @item info scope @var{location}
17119 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17120 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17121 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17122 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17123 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17124
17125 @smallexample
17126 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17127 Scope for command_line_handler:
17128 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17129 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17130 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17131 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17132 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17133 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17134 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17135 @end smallexample
17136
17137 @noindent
17138 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17139 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17140 collect}.
17141
17142 @kindex info source
17143 @item info source
17144 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17145 the function containing the current point of execution:
17146 @itemize @bullet
17147 @item
17148 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17149 @item
17150 the directory it was compiled in,
17151 @item
17152 its length, in lines,
17153 @item
17154 which programming language it is written in,
17155 @item
17156 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17157 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17158 @item
17159 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17160 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17161 @item
17162 whether the debugging information includes information about
17163 preprocessor macros.
17164 @end itemize
17165
17166
17167 @kindex info sources
17168 @item info sources
17169 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17170 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17171 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17172
17173 @kindex info functions
17174 @item info functions
17175 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17176
17177 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17178 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17179 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17180 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17181 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17182 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17183 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17184 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17185
17186 @kindex info variables
17187 @item info variables
17188 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17189 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17190
17191 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17192 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17193 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17194 @var{regexp}.
17195
17196 @kindex info classes
17197 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17198 @item info classes
17199 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17200 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17201 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17202 expression.
17203
17204 @kindex info selectors
17205 @item info selectors
17206 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17207 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17208 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17209 expression.
17210
17211 @ignore
17212 This was never implemented.
17213 @kindex info methods
17214 @item info methods
17215 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17216 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17217 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17218 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17219 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17220 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17221 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17222 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17223 @end ignore
17224
17225 @cindex opaque data types
17226 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17227 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17228 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17229 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17230 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17231 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17232 another source file. The default is on.
17233
17234 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17235 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17236
17237 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17238 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17239 is printed as follows:
17240 @smallexample
17241 @{<no data fields>@}
17242 @end smallexample
17243
17244 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17245 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17246 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17247
17248 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17249 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17250 @item set print symbol-loading
17251 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17252 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17253 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17254 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17255 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17256 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17257 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17258 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17259 can be annoying.
17260 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17261 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17262 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17263 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17264
17265 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17266 @item show print symbol-loading
17267 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17268 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17269
17270 @kindex maint print symbols
17271 @cindex symbol dump
17272 @kindex maint print psymbols
17273 @cindex partial symbol dump
17274 @kindex maint print msymbols
17275 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17276 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17277 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17278 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17279 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17280 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17281 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17282 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17283 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17284 that objfile.
17285 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17286 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17287 @code{main}.
17288 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17289 source file.
17290
17291 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17292 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17293 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17294 tables.
17295 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17296 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17297 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17298 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17299 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17300 ``ELF symbols''.
17301
17302 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17303 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17304
17305 @kindex maint info symtabs
17306 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17307 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17308 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17309 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17310 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17311 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17312 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17313
17314 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17315 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17316 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17317 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17318 structure in more detail. For example:
17319
17320 @smallexample
17321 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17322 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17323 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17324 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17325 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17326 readin no
17327 fullname (null)
17328 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17329 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17330 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17331 dependencies (none)
17332 @}
17333 @}
17334 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17335 (@value{GDBP})
17336 @end smallexample
17337 @noindent
17338 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17339 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17340 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17341 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17342 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17343
17344 @smallexample
17345 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17346 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17347 line 1574.
17348 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17349 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17350 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17351 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17352 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17353 dirname (null)
17354 fullname (null)
17355 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17356 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17357 debugformat DWARF 2
17358 @}
17359 @}
17360 (@value{GDBP})
17361 @end smallexample
17362
17363 @kindex maint info line-table
17364 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17365 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17366 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17367
17368 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17369 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17370 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17371
17372 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17373 @cindex symbol cache size
17374 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17375 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17376 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17377 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17378 with different sizes.
17379
17380 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17381 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17382 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17383
17384 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17385 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17386 @item maint print symbol-cache
17387 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17388 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17389
17390 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17391 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17392 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17393 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17394 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17395
17396 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17397 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17398 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17399 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17400 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17401 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17402
17403 @end table
17404
17405 @node Altering
17406 @chapter Altering Execution
17407
17408 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17409 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17410 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17411 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17412 program.
17413
17414 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17415 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17416 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17417
17418 @menu
17419 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17420 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17421 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17422 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17423 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17424 * Patching:: Patching your program
17425 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17426 @end menu
17427
17428 @node Assignment
17429 @section Assignment to Variables
17430
17431 @cindex assignment
17432 @cindex setting variables
17433 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17434 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17435
17436 @smallexample
17437 print x=4
17438 @end smallexample
17439
17440 @noindent
17441 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17442 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17443 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17444 information on operators in supported languages.
17445
17446 @kindex set variable
17447 @cindex variables, setting
17448 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17449 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17450 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17451 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17452 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17453
17454 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17455 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17456 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17457 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17458 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17459 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17460 command @code{set width}:
17461
17462 @smallexample
17463 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17464 type = double
17465 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17466 $4 = 13
17467 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17468 Invalid syntax in expression.
17469 @end smallexample
17470
17471 @noindent
17472 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17473 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17474
17475 @smallexample
17476 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17477 @end smallexample
17478
17479 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17480 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17481 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17482 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17483 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17484 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17485
17486 @smallexample
17487 @group
17488 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17489 type = double
17490 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17491 $1 = 1
17492 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17493 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17494 $2 = 1
17495 (@value{GDBP}) r
17496 The program being debugged has been started already.
17497 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17498 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17499 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17500 Invalid bfd target.
17501 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17502 The current BFD target is "=4".
17503 @end group
17504 @end smallexample
17505
17506 @noindent
17507 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17508 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17509 @code{g}, use
17510
17511 @smallexample
17512 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17513 @end smallexample
17514
17515 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17516 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17517 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17518 same length or shorter.
17519 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17520 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17521
17522 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17523 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17524 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17525 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17526 and representation in memory), and
17527
17528 @smallexample
17529 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17530 @end smallexample
17531
17532 @noindent
17533 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17534
17535 @node Jumping
17536 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17537
17538 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17539 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17540 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17541
17542 @table @code
17543 @kindex jump
17544 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17545 @item jump @var{location}
17546 @itemx j @var{location}
17547 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17548 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17549 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17550 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17551 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17552
17553 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17554 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17555 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17556 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17557 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17558 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17559 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17560 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17561 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17562 @end table
17563
17564 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17565 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17566 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17567 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17568 example,
17569
17570 @smallexample
17571 set $pc = 0x485
17572 @end smallexample
17573
17574 @noindent
17575 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17576 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17577 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17578
17579 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17580 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17581 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17582 detail.
17583
17584 @c @group
17585 @node Signaling
17586 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17587 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17588
17589 @table @code
17590 @kindex signal
17591 @item signal @var{signal}
17592 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17593 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17594 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17595 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17596
17597 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17598 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17599 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17600 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17601 signal.
17602
17603 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17604 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17605 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17606 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17607 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17608 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17609 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17610 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17611
17612 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17613 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17614 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17615 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17616 passes the signal directly to your program.
17617
17618 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17619 after executing the command.
17620
17621 @kindex queue-signal
17622 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17623 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17624 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17625 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17626 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17627 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17628 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17629 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17630 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17631
17632 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17633 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17634 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17635 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17636 @code{continue} command.
17637
17638 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17639 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17640 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17641 (@pxref{Signals}).
17642 @end table
17643 @c @end group
17644
17645 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17646 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17647
17648 @node Returning
17649 @section Returning from a Function
17650
17651 @table @code
17652 @cindex returning from a function
17653 @kindex return
17654 @item return
17655 @itemx return @var{expression}
17656 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17657 command. If you give an
17658 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17659 value.
17660 @end table
17661
17662 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17663 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17664 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17665 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17666
17667 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17668 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17669 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17670 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17671 of functions.
17672
17673 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17674 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17675 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17676 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17677 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17678
17679 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17680 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17681 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17682 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17683 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17684 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17685 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17686 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17687 assignment into the right register(s).
17688
17689 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17690 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17691 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17692 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17693 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17694 into a @code{long long int}:
17695
17696 @smallexample
17697 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17698 29 return 31;
17699 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17700 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17701 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17702 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17703 (@value{GDBP})
17704 @end smallexample
17705
17706 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17707 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17708 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17709 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17710 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17711 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17712 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17713 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17714
17715 @smallexample
17716 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17717 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17718 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17719 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17720 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17721 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17722 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17723 (@value{GDBP})
17724 @end smallexample
17725
17726 @node Calling
17727 @section Calling Program Functions
17728
17729 @table @code
17730 @cindex calling functions
17731 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17732 @item print @var{expr}
17733 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17734 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17735 debugged.
17736
17737 @kindex call
17738 @item call @var{expr}
17739 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17740 returned values.
17741
17742 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17743 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17744 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17745 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17746 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17747 value history.
17748 @end table
17749
17750 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17751 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17752 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17753 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17754
17755 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17756 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17757 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17758 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17759 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17760 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17761 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17762 in that case is controlled by the
17763 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17764
17765 @table @code
17766 @item set unwindonsignal
17767 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17768 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17769 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17770 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17771 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17772 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17773 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17774 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17775 received.
17776
17777 @item show unwindonsignal
17778 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17779 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17780 @value{GDBN}.
17781
17782 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17783 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17784 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17785 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17786 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17787 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17788 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17789 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17790 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17791 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17792
17793 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17794 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17795 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17796 @value{GDBN}.
17797
17798 @end table
17799
17800 @cindex weak alias functions
17801 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17802 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17803 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17804 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17805 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17806 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17807 function instead.
17808
17809 @node Patching
17810 @section Patching Programs
17811
17812 @cindex patching binaries
17813 @cindex writing into executables
17814 @cindex writing into corefiles
17815
17816 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17817 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17818 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17819 patching your program's binary.
17820
17821 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17822 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17823 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17824 repairs.
17825
17826 @table @code
17827 @kindex set write
17828 @item set write on
17829 @itemx set write off
17830 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17831 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17832 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17833
17834 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17835 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17836 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17837
17838 @item show write
17839 @kindex show write
17840 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17841 as well as reading.
17842 @end table
17843
17844 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17845 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17846 @cindex injecting code
17847 @cindex writing into executables
17848 @cindex compiling code
17849
17850 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17851 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17852 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17853 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17854
17855 @table @code
17856 @kindex compile code
17857 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17858 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17859 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17860 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17861 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17862 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17863 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17864 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17865 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17866 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17867 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17868 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17869
17870 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17871 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17872 E.g.:
17873
17874 @smallexample
17875 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17876 @end smallexample
17877
17878 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17879 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17880 from actual source code. E.g.:
17881
17882 @smallexample
17883 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17884 @end smallexample
17885
17886 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17887 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17888 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17889 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17890 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17891 editor.
17892
17893 @smallexample
17894 compile code
17895 >printf ("hello\n");
17896 >printf ("world\n");
17897 >end
17898 @end smallexample
17899
17900 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17901 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17902 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17903 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17904 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17905 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17906 inferior symbols otherwise.
17907
17908 @kindex compile file
17909 @item compile file @var{filename}
17910 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17911 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17912
17913 @smallexample
17914 compile file /home/user/example.c
17915 @end smallexample
17916 @end table
17917
17918 @table @code
17919 @item compile print @var{expr}
17920 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17921 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17922 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17923 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17924 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17925 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17926 Formats}.
17927
17928 @item compile print
17929 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17930 @cindex reprint the last value
17931 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17932 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17933 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17934 multiple-line editor.
17935 @end table
17936
17937 @noindent
17938 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17939
17940 @table @code
17941 @anchor{set debug compile}
17942 @item set debug compile
17943 @cindex compile command debugging info
17944 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17945 injecting the code. The default is off.
17946
17947 @item show debug compile
17948 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17949 compiling and injecting the code.
17950 @end table
17951
17952 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17953
17954 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17955 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17956 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17957 injecting process.
17958
17959 @noindent
17960 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17961
17962 @table @asis
17963 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17964 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17965 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17966 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17967
17968 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17969 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17970 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17971 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17972 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17973 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17974 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17975 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17976
17977 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17978 @end table
17979
17980 @noindent
17981 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17982
17983 @table @code
17984 @item set compile-args
17985 @cindex compile command options override
17986 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17987 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17988 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17989 compilation.
17990
17991 @item show compile-args
17992 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17993 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17994 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17995 @end table
17996
17997 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17998
17999 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18000 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18001 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18002
18003 @table @asis
18004 @item C code examples and caveats
18005 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18006 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18007 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18008 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18009 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18010
18011 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18012 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18013 much like any other normal debugging session.
18014
18015 @smallexample
18016 void function1 (void)
18017 @{
18018 int i = 42;
18019 printf ("function 1\n");
18020 @}
18021
18022 void function2 (void)
18023 @{
18024 int j = 12;
18025 function1 ();
18026 @}
18027
18028 int main(void)
18029 @{
18030 int k = 6;
18031 int *p;
18032 function2 ();
18033 return 0;
18034 @}
18035 @end smallexample
18036
18037 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18038 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18039 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18040
18041 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18042 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18043 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18044 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18045 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18046
18047 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18048 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18049 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18050 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18051 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18052 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18053 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18054 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18055 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18056 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18057
18058 @smallexample
18059 compile code k = 3;
18060 @end smallexample
18061
18062 @noindent
18063 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18064 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18065 @code{compile} command changes it.
18066
18067 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18068 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18069 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18070 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18071 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18072
18073 @smallexample
18074 compile code j = 3;
18075 @end smallexample
18076
18077 @noindent
18078 will result in a compilation error message.
18079
18080 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18081 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18082 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18083
18084 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18085 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18086 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18087 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18088
18089 @smallexample
18090 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18091 @end smallexample
18092
18093 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18094 command has completed:
18095
18096 @smallexample
18097 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18098 @end smallexample
18099
18100 @noindent
18101 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18102 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18103 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18104 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18105 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18106
18107 @smallexample
18108 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18109 @end smallexample
18110
18111 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18112 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18113 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18114 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18115 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18116 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18117 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18118 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18119
18120 @smallexample
18121 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18122 @end smallexample
18123
18124 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18125 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18126 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18127 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18128 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18129 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18130 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18131
18132 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18133 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18134 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18135 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18136 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18137 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18138
18139 @smallexample
18140 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18141 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18142 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18143 Compilation failed.
18144 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18145 42
18146 @end smallexample
18147
18148 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18149 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18150 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18151 will print to the console.
18152 @end table
18153
18154 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18155
18156 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
18157 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
18158 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
18159 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
18160 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
18161 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18162 target architecture and operating system.
18163
18164 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18165 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18166 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18167 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18168 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18169 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18170 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18171
18172 @node GDB Files
18173 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18174
18175 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18176 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18177 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18178 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18179
18180 @menu
18181 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18182 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18183 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18184 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18185 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18186 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18187 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18188 @end menu
18189
18190 @node Files
18191 @section Commands to Specify Files
18192
18193 @cindex symbol table
18194 @cindex core dump file
18195
18196 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18197 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18198 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18199 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18200
18201 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18202 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18203 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18204 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18205 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18206 new files are useful.
18207
18208 @table @code
18209 @cindex executable file
18210 @kindex file
18211 @item file @var{filename}
18212 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18213 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18214 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18215 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18216 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18217 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18218 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18219 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18220
18221 @cindex unlinked object files
18222 @cindex patching object files
18223 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18224 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18225 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18226 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18227 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18228 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18229 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18230 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18231
18232 @item file
18233 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18234 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18235
18236 @kindex exec-file
18237 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18238 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18239 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18240 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18241 discard information on the executable file.
18242
18243 @kindex symbol-file
18244 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18245 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18246 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18247 table and program to run from the same file.
18248
18249 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18250 program's symbol table.
18251
18252 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18253 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18254 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18255 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18256 @value{GDBN}.
18257
18258 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18259 executing it once.
18260
18261 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18262 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18263 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18264 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18265 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18266 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18267 optimized code.
18268
18269 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18270 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18271 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18272 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18273 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18274
18275 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18276 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18277 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18278 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18279 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18280 Warnings and Messages}.)
18281
18282 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18283 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18284 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18285 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18286 in stabs format.
18287
18288 @kindex readnow
18289 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18290 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18291 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18292 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18293 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18294 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18295 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18296 entire symbol table available.
18297
18298 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18299 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18300 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18301 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18302 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18303 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18304 @c files.
18305
18306 @kindex core-file
18307 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18308 @itemx core
18309 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18310 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18311 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18312 executable file itself for other parts.
18313
18314 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18315 to be used.
18316
18317 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18318 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18319 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18320 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18321 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18322
18323 @kindex add-symbol-file
18324 @cindex dynamic linking
18325 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18326 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18327 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18328 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18329 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18330 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18331 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18332 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18333 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18334 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18335 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18336 @var{address} as an expression.
18337
18338 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18339 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18340 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18341 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18342
18343 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18344
18345 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18346 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18347 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18348 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18349 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18350 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18351 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18352 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18353 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18354
18355 @itemize @bullet
18356 @item
18357 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18358 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18359 @item
18360 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18361 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18362 @item
18363 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18364 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18365 @end itemize
18366
18367 @noindent
18368 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18369 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18370 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18371 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18372 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18373 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18374 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18375 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18376 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18377 way.
18378
18379 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18380
18381 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18382 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18383 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18384 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18385 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18386 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18387
18388 @smallexample
18389 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18390 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18391 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18392 (y or n) y
18393 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18394 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18395 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18396 (gdb)
18397 @end smallexample
18398
18399
18400 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18401
18402 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18403 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18404 @cindex load symbols from memory
18405 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18406 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18407 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18408 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18409 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18410 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18411 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18412 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18413 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18414
18415 @kindex section
18416 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18417 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18418 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18419 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18420 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18421 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18422 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18423 their addresses.
18424
18425 @kindex info files
18426 @kindex info target
18427 @item info files
18428 @itemx info target
18429 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18430 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18431 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18432 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18433 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18434 current ones.
18435
18436 @kindex maint info sections
18437 @item maint info sections
18438 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18439 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18440 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18441 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18442 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18443 may be arbitrarily combined):
18444
18445 @table @code
18446 @item ALLOBJ
18447 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18448 @item @var{sections}
18449 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18450 @item @var{section-flags}
18451 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18452 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18453 @table @code
18454 @item ALLOC
18455 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18456 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18457 @item LOAD
18458 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18459 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18460 @item RELOC
18461 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18462 @item READONLY
18463 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18464 @item CODE
18465 Section contains executable code only.
18466 @item DATA
18467 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18468 @item ROM
18469 Section will reside in ROM.
18470 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18471 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18472 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18473 Section is not empty.
18474 @item NEVER_LOAD
18475 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18476 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18477 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18478 COFF shared library information.
18479 @item IS_COMMON
18480 Section contains common symbols.
18481 @end table
18482 @end table
18483 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18484 @cindex read-only sections
18485 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18486 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18487 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18488 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18489 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18490 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18491 enhancement to debugging performance.
18492
18493 The default is off.
18494
18495 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18496 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18497 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18498 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18499
18500 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18501 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18502 @end table
18503
18504 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18505 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18506 name and remembers it that way.
18507
18508 @cindex shared libraries
18509 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18510 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18511 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18512 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18513
18514 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18515 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18516
18517 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18518 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18519 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18520 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18521 debugging a core file).
18522
18523 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18524 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18525 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18526
18527 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18528 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18529 particularly large or there are many of them.
18530
18531 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18532 commands:
18533
18534 @table @code
18535 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18536 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18537 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18538 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18539 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18540 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18541 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18542 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18543
18544 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18545 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18546 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18547 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18548 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18549 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18550 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18551 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18552 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18553
18554 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18555 @item show auto-solib-add
18556 Display the current autoloading mode.
18557 @end table
18558
18559 @cindex load shared library
18560 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18561 command:
18562
18563 @table @code
18564 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18565 @kindex info share
18566 @item info share @var{regex}
18567 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18568 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18569 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18570 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18571
18572 @kindex info dll
18573 @item info dll @var{regex}
18574 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18575
18576 @kindex sharedlibrary
18577 @kindex share
18578 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18579 @itemx share @var{regex}
18580 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18581 Unix regular expression.
18582 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18583 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18584 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18585 loaded.
18586
18587 @item nosharedlibrary
18588 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18589 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18590 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18591 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18592 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18593 discarded.
18594 @end table
18595
18596 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18597 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18598 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18599 Catchpoints}).
18600
18601 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18602 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18603 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18604 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18605
18606 @table @code
18607 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18608 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18609 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18610 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18611 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18612 shared library.
18613
18614 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18615 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18616 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18617 library events happen.
18618 @end table
18619
18620 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18621 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18622 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18623 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18624 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18625 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18626 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18627 not.
18628
18629 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18630 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18631 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18632 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18633 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18634
18635 @table @code
18636 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18637 @cindex system root, alternate
18638 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18639 @kindex set sysroot
18640 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18641 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18642 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18643 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18644 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18645 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18646 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18647 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18648 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18649 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18650 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18651 @var{path}.
18652
18653 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18654 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18655 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18656 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18657 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18658 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18659 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18660 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18661 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18662 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18663 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18664 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18665 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18666 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18667
18668 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18669 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18670 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18671 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18672 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18673
18674 @smallexample
18675 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18676 @end smallexample
18677
18678 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18679 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18680 system:
18681
18682 @smallexample
18683 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18684 @end smallexample
18685
18686 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18687 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18688 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18689 colons:
18690
18691 @smallexample
18692 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18693 @end smallexample
18694
18695 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18696 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18697 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18698 @samp{z}):
18699
18700 @smallexample
18701 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18702 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18703 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18704 @end smallexample
18705
18706 @noindent
18707 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18708 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18709 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18710
18711 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18712 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18713
18714 @smallexample
18715 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18716 @end smallexample
18717
18718 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18719 if you don't want or need to.
18720
18721 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18722 sysroot}.
18723
18724 @cindex default system root
18725 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18726 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18727 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18728 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18729 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18730 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18731 location.
18732
18733 @kindex show sysroot
18734 @item show sysroot
18735 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18736
18737 @kindex set solib-search-path
18738 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18739 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18740 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18741 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18742 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18743 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18744 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18745 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18746 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18747 of shared library symbols.
18748
18749 @kindex show solib-search-path
18750 @item show solib-search-path
18751 Display the current shared library search path.
18752
18753 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18754 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18755 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18756 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18757 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18758
18759 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18760 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18761 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18762 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18763 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18764 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18765 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18766 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18767 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18768 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18769 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18770 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18771 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18772 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18773 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18774 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18775 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18776 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18777 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18778 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18779 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18780 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18781
18782 @table @code
18783 @item unix
18784 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18785 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18786 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18787 the forward slash.
18788
18789 @item dos-based
18790 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18791 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18792 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18793 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18794 considered directory separators.
18795
18796 @item auto
18797 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18798 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18799 This is the default.
18800 @end table
18801 @end table
18802
18803 @cindex file name canonicalization
18804 @cindex base name differences
18805 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18806 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18807 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18808 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18809 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18810 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18811 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18812 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18813 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18814 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18815 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18816 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18817 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18818 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18819 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18820
18821 @table @code
18822 @item set basenames-may-differ
18823 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18824 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18825
18826 @item show basenames-may-differ
18827 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18828 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18829 @end table
18830
18831 @node File Caching
18832 @section File Caching
18833 @cindex caching of opened files
18834 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18835
18836 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18837 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18838 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18839 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18840
18841 @table @code
18842 @kindex maint info bfds
18843 @item maint info bfds
18844 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18845 @value{GDBN}.
18846
18847 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18848 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18849 @kindex bfd caching
18850 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18851 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18852 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18853 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18854 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18855 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18856 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18857 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18858 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18859
18860 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18861 @kindex bfd caching
18862 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18863 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18864
18865 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18866 @kindex bfd caching
18867 @item show debug bfd-cache
18868 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18869 @end table
18870
18871 @node Separate Debug Files
18872 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18873 @cindex separate debugging information files
18874 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18875 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18876 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18877 @cindex global debugging information directories
18878 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18879 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18880
18881 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18882 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18883 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18884 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18885 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18886 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18887 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18888
18889 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18890 file:
18891
18892 @itemize @bullet
18893 @item
18894 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18895 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18896 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18897 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18898 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18899 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18900 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18901 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18902
18903 @item
18904 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18905 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18906 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18907 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18908 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18909 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18910 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18911 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18912 below.
18913 @end itemize
18914
18915 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18916 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18917
18918 @itemize @bullet
18919 @item
18920 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18921 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18922 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18923 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18924 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18925
18926 @item
18927 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18928 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18929 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18930 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18931 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18932 hex characters, not 10.)
18933 @end itemize
18934
18935 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18936 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18937 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18938 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18939 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18940 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18941
18942 @itemize @minus
18943 @item
18944 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18945 @item
18946 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18947 @item
18948 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18949 @item
18950 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18951 @end itemize
18952
18953 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18954 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18955 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18956 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18957 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18958
18959 @table @code
18960
18961 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18962 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18963 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18964 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18965 concatenating them by a path separator.
18966
18967 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18968 @item show debug-file-directory
18969 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18970 information files.
18971
18972 @end table
18973
18974 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18975 @cindex debug link sections
18976 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18977 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18978
18979 @itemize
18980 @item
18981 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18982 a zero byte,
18983 @item
18984 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18985 boundary within the section, and
18986 @item
18987 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18988 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18989 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18990 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18991 @end itemize
18992
18993 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18994 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18995 described above.
18996
18997 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18998 @cindex build ID sections
18999 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19000 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19001 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19002 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19003 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19004 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19005 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19006 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19007 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19008
19009 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19010 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19011 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19012 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19013 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19014 in an ordinary executable.
19015
19016 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19017 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19018 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19019 following commands:
19020
19021 @smallexample
19022 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19023 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19024 @end smallexample
19025
19026 @noindent
19027 These commands remove the debugging
19028 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19029 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19030 two files:
19031
19032 @itemize @bullet
19033 @item
19034 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19035 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19036
19037 @smallexample
19038 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19039 @end smallexample
19040
19041 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19042 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19043 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19044 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19045
19046 @item
19047 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19048 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19049 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19050 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19051 @end itemize
19052
19053 @noindent
19054
19055 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19056 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19057 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19058
19059 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19060 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19061 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19062 @c different ways!
19063 @ifhtml
19064 @display
19065 @html
19066 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19067 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19068 @end html
19069 @end display
19070 @end ifhtml
19071 @ifnothtml
19072 @display
19073 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19074 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19075 @end display
19076 @end ifnothtml
19077
19078 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19079 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19080 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19081 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19082 CRC.
19083
19084 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19085 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19086 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19087 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19088 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19089
19090 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19091 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19092 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19093 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19094 @code{0xffffffff}.
19095
19096 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19097 @smallexample
19098 unsigned long
19099 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19100 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19101 @{
19102 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19103 @{
19104 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19105 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19106 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19107 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19108 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19109 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19110 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19111 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19112 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19113 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19114 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19115 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19116 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19117 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19118 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19119 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19120 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19121 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19122 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19123 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19124 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19125 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19126 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19127 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19128 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19129 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19130 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19131 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19132 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19133 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19134 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19135 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19136 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19137 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19138 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19139 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19140 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19141 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19142 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19143 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19144 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19145 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19146 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19147 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19148 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19149 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19150 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19151 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19152 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19153 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19154 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19155 0x2d02ef8d
19156 @};
19157 unsigned char *end;
19158
19159 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19160 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19161 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19162 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19163 @}
19164 @end smallexample
19165
19166 @noindent
19167 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19168
19169 @node MiniDebugInfo
19170 @section Debugging information in a special section
19171 @cindex separate debug sections
19172 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19173
19174 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19175 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19176 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19177 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19178
19179 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19180 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19181 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19182 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19183 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19184 debugging information might be included in the section.
19185
19186 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19187 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19188 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19189
19190 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19191 standard utilities:
19192
19193 @smallexample
19194 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19195 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19196 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19197 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19198
19199 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19200 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19201 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19202 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19203 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19204 | sort > funcsyms
19205
19206 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19207 # table.
19208 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19209
19210 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19211 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19212
19213 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19214 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19215 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19216 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19217
19218 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19219 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19220
19221 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19222 # original binary.
19223 xz mini_debuginfo
19224 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19225 @end smallexample
19226
19227 @node Index Files
19228 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19229 @cindex index files
19230 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19231
19232 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19233 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19234 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19235 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19236 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19237 startup.
19238
19239 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19240 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19241 using @command{objcopy}.
19242
19243 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19244
19245 @table @code
19246 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19247 @kindex save gdb-index
19248 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19249 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19250 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19251 @var{directory}.
19252 @end table
19253
19254 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19255 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19256
19257 @smallexample
19258 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19259 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19260 @end smallexample
19261
19262 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19263 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19264 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19265 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19266 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19267 The default is @code{off}.
19268 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19269 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19270
19271 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19272 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19273
19274 @smallexample
19275 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19276 @end smallexample
19277
19278 Instead you must do, for example,
19279
19280 @smallexample
19281 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19282 @end smallexample
19283
19284 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19285 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19286 currently work for programs using Ada.
19287
19288 @node Symbol Errors
19289 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19290
19291 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19292 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19293 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19294 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19295 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19296 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19297 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19298 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19299 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19300 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19301 Messages}).
19302
19303 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19304
19305 @table @code
19306 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19307
19308 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19309 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19310 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19311 in its outer scope blocks.
19312
19313 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19314 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19315 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19316 function.
19317
19318 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19319
19320 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19321 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19322 do so.
19323
19324 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19325 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19326 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19327 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19328 Messages}.)
19329
19330 @item bad block start address patched
19331
19332 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19333 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19334 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19335
19336 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19337 starting on the previous source line.
19338
19339 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19340
19341 @cindex foo
19342 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19343 larger than the size of the string table.
19344
19345 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19346 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19347 with this name.
19348
19349 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19350
19351 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19352 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19353 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19354
19355 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19356 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19357 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19358 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19359 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19360 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19361
19362 @item stub type has NULL name
19363
19364 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19365
19366 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19367 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19368 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19369 it.
19370
19371 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19372
19373 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19374
19375 @end table
19376
19377 @node Data Files
19378 @section GDB Data Files
19379
19380 @cindex prefix for data files
19381 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19382 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19383
19384 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19385 is currently using.
19386
19387 @table @code
19388 @kindex set data-directory
19389 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19390 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19391 to @var{directory}.
19392
19393 @kindex show data-directory
19394 @item show data-directory
19395 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19396 @end table
19397
19398 @cindex default data directory
19399 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19400 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19401 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19402 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19403 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19404 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19405 location.
19406
19407 The data directory may also be specified with the
19408 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19409 @xref{Mode Options}.
19410
19411 @node Targets
19412 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19413
19414 @cindex debugging target
19415 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19416
19417 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19418 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19419 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19420 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19421 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19422 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19423 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19424 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19425
19426 @cindex target architecture
19427 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19428 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19429 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19430 command.
19431
19432 @table @code
19433 @kindex set architecture
19434 @kindex show architecture
19435 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19436 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19437 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19438 supported architectures.
19439
19440 @item show architecture
19441 Show the current target architecture.
19442
19443 @item set processor
19444 @itemx processor
19445 @kindex set processor
19446 @kindex show processor
19447 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19448 and @code{show architecture}.
19449 @end table
19450
19451 @menu
19452 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19453 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19454 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19455 @end menu
19456
19457 @node Active Targets
19458 @section Active Targets
19459
19460 @cindex stacking targets
19461 @cindex active targets
19462 @cindex multiple targets
19463
19464 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19465 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19466 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19467 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19468 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19469 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19470 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19471 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19472 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19473
19474 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19475 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19476 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19477 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19478
19479 @node Target Commands
19480 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19481
19482 @table @code
19483 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19484 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19485 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19486 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19487 protocol of the target machine.
19488
19489 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19490 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19491 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19492
19493 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19494 after executing the command.
19495
19496 @kindex help target
19497 @item help target
19498 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19499 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19500 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19501
19502 @item help target @var{name}
19503 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19504 select it.
19505
19506 @kindex set gnutarget
19507 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19508 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19509 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19510 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19511 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19512 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19513
19514 @quotation
19515 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19516 you must know the actual BFD name.
19517 @end quotation
19518
19519 @noindent
19520 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19521
19522 @kindex show gnutarget
19523 @item show gnutarget
19524 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19525 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19526 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19527 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19528 @end table
19529
19530 @cindex common targets
19531 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19532 configuration):
19533
19534 @table @code
19535 @kindex target
19536 @item target exec @var{program}
19537 @cindex executable file target
19538 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19539 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19540
19541 @item target core @var{filename}
19542 @cindex core dump file target
19543 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19544 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19545
19546 @item target remote @var{medium}
19547 @cindex remote target
19548 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19549 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19550 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19551
19552 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19553 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19554
19555 @smallexample
19556 target remote /dev/ttya
19557 @end smallexample
19558
19559 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19560 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19561 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19562 clobbered by the download.
19563
19564 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19565 @cindex built-in simulator target
19566 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19567 In general,
19568 @smallexample
19569 target sim
19570 load
19571 run
19572 @end smallexample
19573 @noindent
19574 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19575 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19576 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19577 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19578 Processors}.
19579
19580 @item target native
19581 @cindex native target
19582 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19583 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19584 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19585 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19586
19587 @end table
19588
19589 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19590 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19591
19592 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19593 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19594 various aspects of this process.
19595
19596 @table @code
19597
19598 @item set hash
19599 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19600 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19601 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19602 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19603 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19604 monitor.
19605
19606 @item show hash
19607 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19608 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19609
19610 @item set debug monitor
19611 @kindex set debug monitor
19612 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19613 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19614 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19615
19616 @item show debug monitor
19617 @kindex show debug monitor
19618 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19619 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19620 @end table
19621
19622 @table @code
19623
19624 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19625 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19626 @anchor{load}
19627 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19628 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19629 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19630 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19631 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19632 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19633
19634 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19635 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19636 target is @dots{}}''
19637
19638 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19639 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19640 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19641 specifies a fixed address.
19642 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19643
19644 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
19645 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
19646 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
19647
19648 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19649 load programs into flash memory.
19650
19651 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19652 @end table
19653
19654 @table @code
19655
19656 @kindex flash-erase
19657 @item flash-erase
19658 @anchor{flash-erase}
19659
19660 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
19661
19662 @end table
19663
19664 @node Byte Order
19665 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19666
19667 @cindex choosing target byte order
19668 @cindex target byte order
19669
19670 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19671 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19672 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19673 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19674 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19675 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19676
19677 @table @code
19678 @kindex set endian
19679 @item set endian big
19680 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19681
19682 @item set endian little
19683 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19684
19685 @item set endian auto
19686 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19687 executable.
19688
19689 @item show endian
19690 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19691
19692 @end table
19693
19694 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19695 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19696 target system.
19697
19698
19699 @node Remote Debugging
19700 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19701 @cindex remote debugging
19702
19703 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19704 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19705 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19706 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19707 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19708
19709 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19710 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19711 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19712 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19713 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19714 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19715
19716 Other remote targets may be available in your
19717 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19718
19719 @menu
19720 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19721 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19722 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19723 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19724 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19725 @end menu
19726
19727 @node Connecting
19728 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19729 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19730 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19731 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19732 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19733 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19734 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19735
19736 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19737 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19738 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19739 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19740
19741 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19742
19743 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19744 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19745 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19746 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19747
19748 @table @asis
19749
19750 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19751 @item Result of detach or program exit
19752 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19753 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19754 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19755
19756 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19757 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19758 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19759 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19760
19761 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19762 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19763 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19764 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19765
19766 @item Specifying the program to debug
19767 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19768 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19769 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19770 target.
19771
19772 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19773 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19774 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19775
19776 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19777 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19778 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19779 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19780
19781 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19782 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19783 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19784 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19785 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19786 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19787 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19788 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19789 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19790
19791 @item The @code{run} command
19792 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19793 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19794 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19795 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19796 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19797
19798 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19799 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19800 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19801 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19802 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19803
19804 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19805 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19806 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19807 @code{target remote} mode.
19808
19809 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19810 @item Attaching
19811 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19812 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19813 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19814
19815 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19816 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19817 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19818 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19819 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19820
19821 @end table
19822
19823 @anchor{Host and target files}
19824 @subsection Host and Target Files
19825 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19826 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19827
19828 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19829 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19830 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19831 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19832 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19833
19834 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19835 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19836 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19837 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19838 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19839
19840 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19841 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19842 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19843 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19844 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19845 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19846 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19847 target libraries.
19848
19849 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19850 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19851 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19852 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19853 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19854 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19855 programs.
19856
19857 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19858 @cindex remote connection commands
19859 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19860 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19861 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19862 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19863 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19864 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19865 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19866
19867 @table @code
19868
19869 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19870 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19871 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19872 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19873 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19874
19875 @smallexample
19876 target remote /dev/ttyb
19877 @end smallexample
19878
19879 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19880 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19881 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19882 @code{target} command.
19883
19884 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19885 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19886 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19887 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19888 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19889 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19890 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19891 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19892 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19893 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19894 target.
19895
19896 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19897 @code{manyfarms}:
19898
19899 @smallexample
19900 target remote manyfarms:2828
19901 @end smallexample
19902
19903 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19904 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19905 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19906 port 1234 on your local machine:
19907
19908 @smallexample
19909 target remote :1234
19910 @end smallexample
19911 @noindent
19912
19913 Note that the colon is still required here.
19914
19915 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19916 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19917 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19918 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19919 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19920
19921 @smallexample
19922 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19923 @end smallexample
19924
19925 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19926 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19927 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19928 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19929
19930 @item target remote | @var{command}
19931 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19932 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19933 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19934 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19935 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19936 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19937 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19938 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19939 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19940
19941 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19942 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19943 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19944
19945 @end table
19946
19947 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19948 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19949 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19950 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19951 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19952 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19953 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19954
19955 @smallexample
19956 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19957 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19958 @end smallexample
19959
19960 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19961 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19962 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19963 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19964
19965 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19966 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19967
19968 @table @code
19969 @kindex detach (remote)
19970 @item detach
19971 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19972 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19973 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19974 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19975 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19976 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19977 still connected to the target.
19978
19979 @kindex disconnect
19980 @item disconnect
19981 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19982 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19983 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19984 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19985 another target.
19986
19987 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19988 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19989 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19990 @kindex monitor
19991 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19992 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19993 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19994 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19995 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19996 and implement.
19997 @end table
19998
19999 @node File Transfer
20000 @section Sending files to a remote system
20001 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20002 @cindex file transfer
20003 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20004
20005 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20006 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20007 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20008 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20009 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20010 the only way to upload or download files.
20011
20012 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20013
20014 @table @code
20015 @kindex remote put
20016 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20017 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20018 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20019
20020 @kindex remote get
20021 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20022 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20023 on the host system.
20024
20025 @kindex remote delete
20026 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20027 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20028
20029 @end table
20030
20031 @node Server
20032 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20033
20034 @kindex gdbserver
20035 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20036 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20037 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20038 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20039 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20040
20041 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20042 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20043 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20044 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20045 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20046 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20047 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20048 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20049 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20050 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20051 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20052 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20053 choice for debugging.
20054
20055 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20056 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20057 protocol.
20058
20059 @quotation
20060 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20061 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20062 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20063 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20064 @code{gdbserver}.
20065 @end quotation
20066
20067 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20068 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20069 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20070 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20071
20072 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20073 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20074 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20075 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20076 system does all the symbol handling.
20077
20078 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20079 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20080 syntax is:
20081
20082 @smallexample
20083 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20084 @end smallexample
20085
20086 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20087 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20088 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20089 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20090 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20091 @file{/dev/com1}:
20092
20093 @smallexample
20094 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20095 @end smallexample
20096
20097 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20098 with it.
20099
20100 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20101
20102 @smallexample
20103 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20104 @end smallexample
20105
20106 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20107 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20108 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20109 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20110 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20111 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20112 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20113 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20114 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20115 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20116 @code{target remote} command.
20117
20118 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20119 with ssh:
20120
20121 @smallexample
20122 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20123 @end smallexample
20124
20125 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20126 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20127 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20128 You could elide it if you want to.
20129
20130 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20131 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20132 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20133 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20134
20135 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20136 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20137 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20138 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20139
20140 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20141 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20142
20143 @smallexample
20144 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20145 @end smallexample
20146
20147 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20148 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20149
20150 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20151 @value{GDBN} attach command
20152 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20153
20154 @pindex pidof
20155 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20156 @code{pidof} utility:
20157
20158 @smallexample
20159 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20160 @end smallexample
20161
20162 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20163 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20164 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20165
20166 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20167
20168 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20169 port.
20170
20171 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20172 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20173 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20174 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20175 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20176 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20177 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20178 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20179
20180 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20181 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20182 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20183
20184 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20185 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20186 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20187 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20188 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20189 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20190 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20191 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20192 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20193 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20194 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20195 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20196
20197 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20198 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20199
20200 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20201 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20202 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20203 program. For more information,
20204 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20205
20206 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20207 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20208 status information about the debugging process.
20209 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20210 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20211 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20212 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20213
20214 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20215 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20216 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20217 Possible options are:
20218
20219 @table @code
20220 @item none
20221 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20222 @item all
20223 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20224 @item timestamps
20225 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20226 @end table
20227
20228 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20229 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20230
20231 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20232 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20233 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20234 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20235 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20236
20237 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20238 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20239 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20240 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20241
20242 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20243 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20244 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20245 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20246
20247 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20248 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20249 environment:
20250
20251 @smallexample
20252 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20253 @end smallexample
20254
20255 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20256
20257 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20258 @itemize
20259
20260 @item
20261 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20262
20263 @item
20264 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20265 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20266 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20267 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20268 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20269 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20270
20271 @item
20272 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20273 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20274 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20275 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20276 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20277 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20278 program is already on the target.
20279
20280 @end itemize
20281
20282 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20283 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20284 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20285
20286 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20287 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20288 Here are the available commands.
20289
20290 @table @code
20291 @item monitor help
20292 List the available monitor commands.
20293
20294 @item monitor set debug 0
20295 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20296 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20297
20298 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20299 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20300 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20301 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20302
20303 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20304 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20305 Possible options are:
20306
20307 @table @code
20308 @item none
20309 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20310 @item all
20311 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20312 @item timestamps
20313 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20314 @end table
20315
20316 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20317 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20318
20319 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20320 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20321 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20322 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20323 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20324 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20325
20326 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20327 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20328
20329 @item monitor exit
20330 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20331 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20332 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20333 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20334 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20335
20336 @end table
20337
20338 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20339 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20340
20341 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20342 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20343
20344 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20345 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20346 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20347 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20348 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20349 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20350 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20351 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20352 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20353 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20354 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20355 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20356
20357 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20358
20359 @table @code
20360 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20361
20362 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20363 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20364 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20365
20366 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20367
20368 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20369 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20370 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20371 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20372 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20373 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20374
20375 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20376
20377 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20378 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20379 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20380 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20381 command for that. For example:
20382
20383 @smallexample
20384 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20385 @end smallexample
20386
20387 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20388 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20389 @end table
20390
20391 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20392 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20393 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20394 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20395 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20396 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20397 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20398 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20399 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20400 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20401
20402 @smallexample
20403 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20404 @end smallexample
20405
20406 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20407
20408 @smallexample
20409 $ gdb myprogram
20410 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20411 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20412 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20413 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20414 @end smallexample
20415
20416 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20417 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20418 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20419 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20420 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20421 tracing.
20422
20423 @node Remote Configuration
20424 @section Remote Configuration
20425
20426 @kindex set remote
20427 @kindex show remote
20428 This section documents the configuration options available when
20429 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20430 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20431 system-call-allowed}.
20432
20433 @table @code
20434 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20435 @cindex address size for remote targets
20436 @cindex bits in remote address
20437 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20438 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20439 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20440 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20441
20442 @item show remoteaddresssize
20443 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20444
20445 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20446 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20447 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20448 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20449 remote targets.
20450
20451 @item show serial baud
20452 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20453
20454 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20455 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20456 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20457
20458 @item show serial parity
20459 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20460
20461 @item set remotebreak
20462 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20463 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20464 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20465 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20466 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20467 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20468 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20469 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20470
20471 @item show remotebreak
20472 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20473 interrupt the remote program.
20474
20475 @item set remoteflow on
20476 @itemx set remoteflow off
20477 @kindex set remoteflow
20478 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20479 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20480
20481 @item show remoteflow
20482 @kindex show remoteflow
20483 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20484
20485 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20486 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20487 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20488 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20489 @code{ascii}.
20490
20491 @item show remotelogbase
20492 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20493 protocol.
20494
20495 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20496 @cindex record serial communications on file
20497 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20498 default is not to record at all.
20499
20500 @item show remotelogfile.
20501 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20502 serial communications.
20503
20504 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20505 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20506 @cindex remote timeout
20507 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20508 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20509
20510 @item show remotetimeout
20511 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20512 responses.
20513
20514 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20515 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20516 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20517 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20518 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20519 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20520 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20521 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20522
20523 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20524 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20525 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20526 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20527 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20528 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20529 as unlimited.
20530
20531 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20532 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20533 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20534
20535 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20536 @itemx show remote exec-file
20537 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20538 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20539 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20540 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20541 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20542 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20543
20544 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20545 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20546 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20547 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20548 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20549 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20550 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20551 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20552 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20553 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20554
20555 @item show interrupt-sequence
20556 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20557 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20558 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20559 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20560
20561 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20562 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20563 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20564 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20565 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20566 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20567
20568 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20569 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20570 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20571
20572 @kindex set tcp
20573 @kindex show tcp
20574 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20575 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20576 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20577 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20578 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20579 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20580 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20581 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20582 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20583
20584 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20585 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20586
20587 @item show tcp auto-retry
20588 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20589
20590 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20591 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20592 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20593 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20594 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20595 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20596 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20597 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20598 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20599 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20600 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20601
20602 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20603 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20604 @end table
20605
20606 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20607 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20608 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20609 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20610 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20611 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20612 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20613 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20614 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20615
20616 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20617 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20618 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20619 @value{GDBN} developers.
20620
20621 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20622 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20623 are:
20624
20625 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20626 @item Command Name
20627 @tab Remote Packet
20628 @tab Related Features
20629
20630 @item @code{fetch-register}
20631 @tab @code{p}
20632 @tab @code{info registers}
20633
20634 @item @code{set-register}
20635 @tab @code{P}
20636 @tab @code{set}
20637
20638 @item @code{binary-download}
20639 @tab @code{X}
20640 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20641
20642 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20643 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20644 @tab @code{info auxv}
20645
20646 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20647 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20648 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20649
20650 @item @code{attach}
20651 @tab @code{vAttach}
20652 @tab @code{attach}
20653
20654 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20655 @tab @code{vCont}
20656 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20657
20658 @item @code{run}
20659 @tab @code{vRun}
20660 @tab @code{run}
20661
20662 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20663 @tab @code{Z0}
20664 @tab @code{break}
20665
20666 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20667 @tab @code{Z1}
20668 @tab @code{hbreak}
20669
20670 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20671 @tab @code{Z2}
20672 @tab @code{watch}
20673
20674 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20675 @tab @code{Z3}
20676 @tab @code{rwatch}
20677
20678 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20679 @tab @code{Z4}
20680 @tab @code{awatch}
20681
20682 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20683 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20684 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20685
20686 @item @code{target-features}
20687 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20688 @tab @code{set architecture}
20689
20690 @item @code{library-info}
20691 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20692 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20693
20694 @item @code{memory-map}
20695 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20696 @tab @code{info mem}
20697
20698 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20699 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20700 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20701
20702 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20703 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20704 @tab @code{info spu}
20705
20706 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20707 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20708 @tab @code{info spu}
20709
20710 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20711 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20712 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20713
20714 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20715 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20716 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20717
20718 @item @code{threads}
20719 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20720 @tab @code{info threads}
20721
20722 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20723 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20724 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20725
20726 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20727 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20728 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20729
20730 @item @code{search-memory}
20731 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20732 @tab @code{find}
20733
20734 @item @code{supported-packets}
20735 @tab @code{qSupported}
20736 @tab Remote communications parameters
20737
20738 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20739 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20740 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20741
20742 @item @code{pass-signals}
20743 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20744 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20745
20746 @item @code{program-signals}
20747 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20748 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20749
20750 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20751 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20752 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20753
20754 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20755 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20756 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20757
20758 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20759 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20760 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20761
20762 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20763 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20764 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20765
20766 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20767 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20768 @tab @code{remote delete}
20769
20770 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20771 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20772 @tab Host I/O
20773
20774 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20775 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20776 @tab Host I/O
20777
20778 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20779 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20780 @tab Host I/O
20781
20782 @item @code{noack-packet}
20783 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20784 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20785
20786 @item @code{osdata}
20787 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20788 @tab @code{info os}
20789
20790 @item @code{query-attached}
20791 @tab @code{qAttached}
20792 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20793
20794 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20795 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20796 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20797
20798 @item @code{trace-status}
20799 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20800 @tab @code{tstatus}
20801
20802 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20803 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20804 @tab Traceframe info
20805
20806 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20807 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20808 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20809
20810 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20811 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20812 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20813
20814 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20815 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20816 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20817
20818 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20819 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20820 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20821
20822 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20823 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20824 @tab @code{break}
20825
20826 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20827 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20828 @tab @code{hbreak}
20829
20830 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20831 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20832 @tab @code{fork}
20833
20834 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20835 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20836 @tab @code{vfork}
20837
20838 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20839 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20840 @tab @code{exec}
20841
20842 @item @code{thread-events}
20843 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20844 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20845
20846 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20847 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20848 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20849
20850 @end multitable
20851
20852 @node Remote Stub
20853 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20854
20855 @cindex debugging stub, example
20856 @cindex remote stub, example
20857 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20858 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20859 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20860 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20861 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20862 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20863 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20864 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20865
20866 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20867 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20868 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20869 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20870 program, you need:
20871
20872 @enumerate
20873 @item
20874 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20875 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20876 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20877
20878 @item
20879 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20880 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20881
20882 @item
20883 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20884 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20885 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20886 documentation.
20887 @end enumerate
20888
20889 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20890 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20891 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20892
20893 @table @emph
20894 @item On the host,
20895 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20896 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20897 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20898
20899 @item On the target,
20900 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20901 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20902 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20903
20904 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20905 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20906 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20907 @end table
20908
20909 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20910 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20911 @sc{sparc} boards.
20912
20913 @cindex remote serial stub list
20914 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20915
20916 @table @code
20917
20918 @item i386-stub.c
20919 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20920 @cindex Intel
20921 @cindex i386
20922 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20923
20924 @item m68k-stub.c
20925 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20926 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20927 @cindex m680x0
20928 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20929
20930 @item sh-stub.c
20931 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20932 @cindex Renesas
20933 @cindex SH
20934 For Renesas SH architectures.
20935
20936 @item sparc-stub.c
20937 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20938 @cindex Sparc
20939 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20940
20941 @item sparcl-stub.c
20942 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20943 @cindex Fujitsu
20944 @cindex SparcLite
20945 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20946
20947 @end table
20948
20949 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20950 recently added stubs.
20951
20952 @menu
20953 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20954 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20955 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20956 @end menu
20957
20958 @node Stub Contents
20959 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20960
20961 @cindex remote serial stub
20962 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20963 subroutines:
20964
20965 @table @code
20966 @item set_debug_traps
20967 @findex set_debug_traps
20968 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20969 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20970 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20971 program's startup code.
20972
20973 @item handle_exception
20974 @findex handle_exception
20975 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20976 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20977 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20978 run when a trap is triggered.
20979
20980 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20981 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20982 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20983 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20984 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20985 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20986 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20987 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20988 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20989 machine.
20990
20991 @item breakpoint
20992 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20993 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20994 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20995 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20996 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20997 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20998 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20999 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21000 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21001 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21002 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21003
21004 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21005 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21006 start of your debugging session.
21007 @end table
21008
21009 @node Bootstrapping
21010 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21011
21012 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21013 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21014 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21015 debugging target machine.
21016
21017 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21018 serial port.
21019
21020 @table @code
21021 @item int getDebugChar()
21022 @findex getDebugChar
21023 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21024 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21025 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21026
21027 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21028 @findex putDebugChar
21029 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21030 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21031 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21032 @end table
21033
21034 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21035 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21036 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21037 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21038 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21039 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21040 remote system to stop.
21041
21042 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21043 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21044 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21045 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21046
21047 Other routines you need to supply are:
21048
21049 @table @code
21050 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21051 @findex exceptionHandler
21052 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21053 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21054 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21055 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21056 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21057 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21058 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21059 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21060 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21061 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21062 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21063 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21064 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21065
21066 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21067 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21068 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21069 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21070 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21071
21072 @item void flush_i_cache()
21073 @findex flush_i_cache
21074 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21075 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21076 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21077
21078 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21079 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21080 @end table
21081
21082 @noindent
21083 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21084
21085 @table @code
21086 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21087 @findex memset
21088 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21089 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21090 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21091 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21092 @end table
21093
21094 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21095 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21096 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21097 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21098
21099
21100 @node Debug Session
21101 @subsection Putting it All Together
21102
21103 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21104 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21105 steps.
21106
21107 @enumerate
21108 @item
21109 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21110 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21111 @display
21112 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21113 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21114 @end display
21115
21116 @item
21117 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21118 procedure is called:
21119
21120 @smallexample
21121 set_debug_traps();
21122 breakpoint();
21123 @end smallexample
21124
21125 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21126 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21127 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21128 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21129 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21130 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21131 progress.
21132
21133 @item
21134 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21135 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21136
21137 @smallexample
21138 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21139 @end smallexample
21140
21141 @noindent
21142 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21143 function in your program, that function is called when
21144 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21145 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21146 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21147
21148 @item
21149 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21150 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21151
21152 @item
21153 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21154 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21155
21156 @item
21157 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21158 @c document that. FIXME.
21159 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21160 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21161
21162 @item
21163 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21164 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21165
21166 @end enumerate
21167
21168 @node Configurations
21169 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21170
21171 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21172 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21173 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21174
21175 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21176 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21177 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21178 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21179 are quite different from each other.
21180
21181 @menu
21182 * Native::
21183 * Embedded OS::
21184 * Embedded Processors::
21185 * Architectures::
21186 @end menu
21187
21188 @node Native
21189 @section Native
21190
21191 This section describes details specific to particular native
21192 configurations.
21193
21194 @menu
21195 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21196 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21197 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21198 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21199 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21200 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21201 @end menu
21202
21203 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21204 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21205
21206 @cindex libkvm
21207 @cindex kernel memory image
21208 @cindex kernel crash dump
21209
21210 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21211 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21212 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21213 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21214 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21215 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21216 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21217 @code{kvm} target:
21218
21219 @smallexample
21220 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21221 @end smallexample
21222
21223 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21224 argument:
21225
21226 @smallexample
21227 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21228 @end smallexample
21229
21230 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21231 available:
21232
21233 @table @code
21234 @kindex kvm
21235 @item kvm pcb
21236 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21237
21238 @item kvm proc
21239 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21240 modern FreeBSD systems.
21241 @end table
21242
21243 @node SVR4 Process Information
21244 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21245 @cindex /proc
21246 @cindex examine process image
21247 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21248
21249 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21250 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21251 process using file-system subroutines.
21252
21253 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21254 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21255 information about the process running your program, or about any
21256 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21257 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21258
21259 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21260 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21261
21262 @table @code
21263 @kindex info proc
21264 @cindex process ID
21265 @item info proc
21266 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21267 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21268 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21269 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21270 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21271 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21272 executable file's absolute file name.
21273
21274 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21275 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21276 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21277 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21278 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21279 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21280
21281 @item info proc cmdline
21282 @cindex info proc cmdline
21283 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21284 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21285
21286 @item info proc cwd
21287 @cindex info proc cwd
21288 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21289 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21290
21291 @item info proc exe
21292 @cindex info proc exe
21293 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21294 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21295
21296 @item info proc mappings
21297 @cindex memory address space mappings
21298 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21299 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21300 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21301 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21302 memory access rights to that range.
21303
21304 @item info proc stat
21305 @itemx info proc status
21306 @cindex process detailed status information
21307 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21308 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21309 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21310 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21311 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21312 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21313 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21314
21315 @item info proc all
21316 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21317 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21318
21319 @ignore
21320 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21321 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21322 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21323 @kindex info proc times
21324 @item info proc times
21325 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21326 its children.
21327
21328 @kindex info proc id
21329 @item info proc id
21330 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21331 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21332 @end ignore
21333
21334 @item set procfs-trace
21335 @kindex set procfs-trace
21336 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21337 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21338
21339 @item show procfs-trace
21340 @kindex show procfs-trace
21341 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21342
21343 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21344 @kindex set procfs-file
21345 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21346 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21347 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21348 standard output.
21349
21350 @item show procfs-file
21351 @kindex show procfs-file
21352 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21353
21354 @item proc-trace-entry
21355 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21356 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21357 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21358 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21359 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21360 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21361 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21362 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21363 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21364
21365 @item info pidlist
21366 @kindex info pidlist
21367 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21368 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21369 processes and all the threads within each process.
21370
21371 @item info meminfo
21372 @kindex info meminfo
21373 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21374 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21375 @end table
21376
21377 @node DJGPP Native
21378 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21379 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21380 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21381 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21382
21383 @cindex DPMI
21384 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21385 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21386 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21387 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21388
21389 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21390 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21391 subsection describes those commands.
21392
21393 @table @code
21394 @kindex info dos
21395 @item info dos
21396 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21397 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21398
21399 @kindex sysinfo
21400 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21401 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21402 @item info dos sysinfo
21403 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21404 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21405 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21406
21407 @cindex GDT
21408 @cindex LDT
21409 @cindex IDT
21410 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21411 @cindex descriptor tables display
21412 @item info dos gdt
21413 @itemx info dos ldt
21414 @itemx info dos idt
21415 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21416 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21417 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21418 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21419 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21420 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21421 rights.
21422
21423 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21424 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21425 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21426 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21427 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21428
21429 @cindex garbled pointers
21430 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21431 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21432 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21433 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21434 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21435 debugged program's data segment:
21436
21437 @smallexample
21438 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21439 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21440 @end smallexample
21441
21442 @noindent
21443 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21444 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21445
21446 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21447 @item info dos pde
21448 @itemx info dos pte
21449 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21450 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21451 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21452 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21453 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21454 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21455 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21456 that is currently in use.
21457
21458 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21459 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21460 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21461 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21462 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21463 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21464 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21465
21466 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21467 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21468 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21469 controller.
21470
21471 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21472
21473 @cindex physical address from linear address
21474 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21475 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21476 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21477 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21478 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21479 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21480 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21481
21482 @smallexample
21483 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21484 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21485 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21486 @end smallexample
21487
21488 @noindent
21489 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21490 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21491 attributes of that page.
21492
21493 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21494 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21495 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21496 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21497 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21498 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21499
21500 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21501 transfer buffer:
21502
21503 @smallexample
21504 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21505 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21506 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21507 @end smallexample
21508
21509 @noindent
21510 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21511 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21512 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21513 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21514 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21515
21516 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21517 @end table
21518
21519 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21520 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21521 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21522 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21523
21524 @table @code
21525 @kindex set com1base
21526 @kindex set com1irq
21527 @kindex set com2base
21528 @kindex set com2irq
21529 @kindex set com3base
21530 @kindex set com3irq
21531 @kindex set com4base
21532 @kindex set com4irq
21533 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21534 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21535 port.
21536
21537 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21538 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21539 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21540
21541 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21542 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21543 other 3 COM ports.
21544
21545 @kindex show com1base
21546 @kindex show com1irq
21547 @kindex show com2base
21548 @kindex show com2irq
21549 @kindex show com3base
21550 @kindex show com3irq
21551 @kindex show com4base
21552 @kindex show com4irq
21553 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21554 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21555 lines used by the COM ports.
21556
21557 @item info serial
21558 @kindex info serial
21559 @cindex DOS serial port status
21560 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21561 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21562 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21563 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21564 @end table
21565
21566
21567 @node Cygwin Native
21568 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21569 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21570 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21571 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21572
21573 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21574 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21575
21576 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21577 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21578 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21579 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21580 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21581 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21582 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21583 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21584
21585 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21586 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21587 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21588
21589 @table @code
21590 @kindex info w32
21591 @item info w32
21592 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21593 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21594
21595 @item info w32 selector
21596 This command displays information returned by
21597 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21598 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21599 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21600 Without argument, this command displays information
21601 about the six segment registers.
21602
21603 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21604 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21605 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21606 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21607
21608 @kindex signal-event
21609 @item signal-event @var{id}
21610 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21611 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21612
21613 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21614 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21615 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21616 (for x86_64 versions):
21617
21618 @itemize @minus
21619 @item
21620 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21621 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21622 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21623
21624 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21625 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21626 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21627 to attach.
21628
21629 @item
21630 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21631 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21632 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21633 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21634 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21635 @end itemize
21636
21637 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21638 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21639 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21640 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21641 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21642 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21643 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21644 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21645 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21646 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21647 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21648
21649 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21650 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21651 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21652 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21653
21654 @kindex set new-console
21655 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21656 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21657 be started in a new console on next start.
21658 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21659 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21660
21661 @kindex show new-console
21662 @item show new-console
21663 Displays whether a new console is used
21664 when the debuggee is started.
21665
21666 @kindex set new-group
21667 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21668 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21669 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21670 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21671 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21672
21673 @kindex show new-group
21674 @item show new-group
21675 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21676
21677 @kindex set debugevents
21678 @item set debugevents
21679 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21680 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21681 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21682 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21683 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21684
21685 @kindex set debugexec
21686 @item set debugexec
21687 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21688 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21689
21690 @kindex set debugexceptions
21691 @item set debugexceptions
21692 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21693 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21694
21695 @kindex set debugmemory
21696 @item set debugmemory
21697 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21698 and writes by the debugger.
21699
21700 @kindex set shell
21701 @item set shell
21702 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21703 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21704
21705 @kindex show shell
21706 @item show shell
21707 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21708
21709 @end table
21710
21711 @menu
21712 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21713 @end menu
21714
21715 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21716 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21717 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21718 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21719
21720 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21721 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21722 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21723 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21724 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21725 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21726 ``minimal symbols''.
21727
21728 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21729 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21730 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21731 program run once to completion.
21732
21733 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21734
21735 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21736 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21737 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21738 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21739 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21740 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21741 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21742 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21743 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21744
21745 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21746 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21747 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21748 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21749 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21750 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21751
21752 @smallexample
21753 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21754 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21755
21756 Non-debugging symbols:
21757 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21758 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21759 @end smallexample
21760
21761 @smallexample
21762 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21763 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21764
21765 Non-debugging symbols:
21766 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21767 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21768 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21769 [etc...]
21770 @end smallexample
21771
21772 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21773
21774 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21775 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21776 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21777 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21778 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21779 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21780 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21781
21782 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21783 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21784 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21785 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21786 problem:
21787
21788 @smallexample
21789 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21790 $1 = 268572168
21791 @end smallexample
21792
21793 @smallexample
21794 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21795 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21796 @end smallexample
21797
21798 And two possible solutions:
21799
21800 @smallexample
21801 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21802 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21803 @end smallexample
21804
21805 @smallexample
21806 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21807 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21808 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21809 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21810 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21811 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21812 @end smallexample
21813
21814 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21815 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21816 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21817 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21818 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21819
21820 @smallexample
21821 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21822 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21823 @end smallexample
21824
21825 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21826 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21827 safe.
21828
21829 @node Hurd Native
21830 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21831 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21832
21833 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21834 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21835
21836 @table @code
21837 @item set signals
21838 @itemx set sigs
21839 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21840 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21841 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21842 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21843 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21844 @code{signals}.
21845
21846 @item show signals
21847 @itemx show sigs
21848 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21849 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21850 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21851
21852 @item set signal-thread
21853 @itemx set sigthread
21854 @kindex set signal-thread
21855 @kindex set sigthread
21856 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21857 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21858 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21859 signal-thread}.
21860
21861 @item show signal-thread
21862 @itemx show sigthread
21863 @kindex show signal-thread
21864 @kindex show sigthread
21865 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21866 delivered a signal.
21867
21868 @item set stopped
21869 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21870 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21871 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21872 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21873
21874 @item show stopped
21875 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21876 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21877 stopped.
21878
21879 @item set exceptions
21880 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21881 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21882 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21883 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21884 trapping on.
21885
21886 @item show exceptions
21887 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21888 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21889
21890 @item set task pause
21891 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21892 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21893 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21894 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21895 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21896 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21897 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21898 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21899 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21900
21901 @item show task pause
21902 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21903 Show the current state of task suspension.
21904
21905 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21906 @cindex task suspend count
21907 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21908 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21909 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21910
21911 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21912 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21913
21914 @item set task exception-port
21915 @itemx set task excp
21916 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21917 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21918 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21919 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21920
21921 @item set noninvasive
21922 @cindex noninvasive task options
21923 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21924 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21925 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21926 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21927
21928 @item info send-rights
21929 @itemx info receive-rights
21930 @itemx info port-rights
21931 @itemx info port-sets
21932 @itemx info dead-names
21933 @itemx info ports
21934 @itemx info psets
21935 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21936 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21937 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21938 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21939 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21940 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21941 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21942 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21943 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21944
21945 @item set thread pause
21946 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21947 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21948 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21949 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21950 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21951 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21952 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21953 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21954 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21955 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21956 only the current thread.
21957
21958 @item show thread pause
21959 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21960 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21961
21962 @item set thread run
21963 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21964
21965 @item show thread run
21966 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21967
21968 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21969 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21970 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21971 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21972 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21973 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21974 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21975
21976 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21977 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21978 detaching.
21979
21980 @item set thread exception-port
21981 @itemx set thread excp
21982 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21983 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21984 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21985
21986 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21987 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21988 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21989 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21990
21991 @item set thread default
21992 @itemx show thread default
21993 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21994 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21995 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21996 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21997 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21998 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21999 the non-default commands.
22000 @end table
22001
22002 @node Darwin
22003 @subsection Darwin
22004 @cindex Darwin
22005
22006 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22007
22008 @table @code
22009 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22010 @kindex set debug darwin
22011 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22012 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22013
22014 @item show debug darwin
22015 @kindex show debug darwin
22016 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22017
22018 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22019 @kindex set debug mach-o
22020 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22021 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22022 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22023 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22024 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22025 usage.
22026
22027 @item show debug mach-o
22028 @kindex show debug mach-o
22029 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22030
22031 @item set mach-exceptions on
22032 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22033 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22034 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22035 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22036 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22037 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22038
22039 @item show mach-exceptions
22040 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22041 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22042 @end table
22043
22044
22045 @node Embedded OS
22046 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22047
22048 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22049 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22050 architectures.
22051
22052 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22053 various real-time operating systems.
22054
22055 @node Embedded Processors
22056 @section Embedded Processors
22057
22058 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22059 configurations.
22060
22061 @cindex send command to simulator
22062 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22063 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22064
22065 @table @code
22066 @item sim @var{command}
22067 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22068 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22069 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22070 acceptable commands.
22071 @end table
22072
22073
22074 @menu
22075 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22076 * ARM:: ARM
22077 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22078 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22079 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22080 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22081 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22082 * CRIS:: CRIS
22083 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22084 @end menu
22085
22086 @node ARC
22087 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22088 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22089 @cindex ARC specific commands
22090 @cindex ARC600
22091 @cindex ARC700
22092 @cindex ARC EM
22093 @cindex ARC HS
22094
22095 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22096
22097 @table @code
22098 @item set debug arc
22099 @kindex set debug arc
22100 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22101 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22102
22103 @item show debug arc
22104 @kindex show debug arc
22105 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22106
22107 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22108 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22109 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22110
22111 @end table
22112
22113 @node ARM
22114 @subsection ARM
22115
22116 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22117
22118 @table @code
22119 @item set arm disassembler
22120 @kindex set arm
22121 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22122 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22123
22124 @item show arm disassembler
22125 @kindex show arm
22126 Show the current disassembly style.
22127
22128 @item set arm apcs32
22129 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22130 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22131
22132 @item show arm apcs32
22133 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22134
22135 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22136 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22137 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22138
22139 @table @code
22140 @item auto
22141 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22142 @item softfpa
22143 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22144 processors.
22145 @item fpa
22146 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22147 @item softvfp
22148 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22149 @item vfp
22150 VFP co-processor.
22151 @end table
22152
22153 @item show arm fpu
22154 Show the current type of the FPU.
22155
22156 @item set arm abi
22157 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22158
22159 @item show arm abi
22160 Show the currently used ABI.
22161
22162 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22163 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22164 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22165 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22166 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22167 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22168 register).
22169
22170 @item show arm fallback-mode
22171 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22172
22173 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22174 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22175 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22176 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22177 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22178
22179 @item show arm force-mode
22180 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22181
22182 @item set debug arm
22183 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22184 target support subsystem.
22185
22186 @item show debug arm
22187 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22188 @end table
22189
22190 @table @code
22191 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22192 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22193
22194 @table @code
22195 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22196 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22197 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22198 The default value is @code{all}.
22199
22200 @table @code
22201 @item none
22202 @item demon
22203 @item angel
22204 @item redboot
22205 @item all
22206 @end table
22207 @end table
22208 @end table
22209
22210 @node M68K
22211 @subsection M68k
22212
22213 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22214
22215 @node MicroBlaze
22216 @subsection MicroBlaze
22217 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22218 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22219
22220 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22221 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22222 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22223 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22224 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22225 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22226 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22227 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22228 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22229 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22230 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22231
22232 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22233
22234 @table @code
22235 @item target remote :1234
22236 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22237 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22238
22239 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22240 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22241 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22242
22243 @item load
22244 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22245
22246 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22247 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22248
22249 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22250 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22251 @end table
22252
22253 @node MIPS Embedded
22254 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22255
22256 @noindent
22257 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22258
22259 @table @code
22260 @item set mipsfpu double
22261 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22262 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22263 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22264 @itemx show mipsfpu
22265 @kindex set mipsfpu
22266 @kindex show mipsfpu
22267 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22268 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22269 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22270 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22271 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22272 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22273 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22274 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22275 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22276 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22277 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22278 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22279 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22280
22281 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22282 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22283 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22284
22285 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22286 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22287 @end table
22288
22289 @node PowerPC Embedded
22290 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22291
22292 @cindex DVC register
22293 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22294 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22295
22296 @smallexample
22297 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22298 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22299 @end smallexample
22300
22301 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22302 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22303 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22304 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22305 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22306 or newer.
22307
22308 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22309 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22310 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22311 watching variables of scalar types.
22312
22313 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22314 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22315
22316 @smallexample
22317 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22318 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22319 @end smallexample
22320
22321 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22322 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22323
22324 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22325 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22326 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22327 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22328 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22329 use the @code{break-range} command.
22330
22331 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22332
22333 @table @code
22334 @kindex break-range
22335 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22336 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22337 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22338 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22339 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22340 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22341 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22342 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22343 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22344
22345 @kindex set powerpc
22346 @item set powerpc soft-float
22347 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22348 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22349 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22350 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22351
22352 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22353 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22354 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22355 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22356 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22357 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22358 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22359 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22360
22361 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22362 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22363 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22364 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22365 address of its first byte.
22366
22367 @end table
22368
22369 @node AVR
22370 @subsection Atmel AVR
22371 @cindex AVR
22372
22373 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22374 following AVR-specific commands:
22375
22376 @table @code
22377 @item info io_registers
22378 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22379 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22380 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22381 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22382 @end table
22383
22384 @node CRIS
22385 @subsection CRIS
22386 @cindex CRIS
22387
22388 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22389 following CRIS-specific commands:
22390
22391 @table @code
22392 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22393 @cindex CRIS version
22394 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22395 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22396 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22397
22398 @item show cris-version
22399 Show the current CRIS version.
22400
22401 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22402 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22403 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22404 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22405 @code{R59}.
22406
22407 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22408 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22409
22410 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22411 @cindex CRIS mode
22412 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22413 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22414 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22415
22416 @item show cris-mode
22417 Show the current CRIS mode.
22418 @end table
22419
22420 @node Super-H
22421 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22422 @cindex Super-H
22423
22424 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22425 commands:
22426
22427 @table @code
22428 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22429 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22430 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22431 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22432 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22433 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22434 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22435 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22436 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22437 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22438 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22439 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22440
22441 @item show sh calling-convention
22442 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22443 Show the current calling convention setting.
22444
22445 @end table
22446
22447
22448 @node Architectures
22449 @section Architectures
22450
22451 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22452 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22453
22454 @menu
22455 * AArch64::
22456 * i386::
22457 * Alpha::
22458 * MIPS::
22459 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22460 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22461 * PowerPC::
22462 * Nios II::
22463 @end menu
22464
22465 @node AArch64
22466 @subsection AArch64
22467 @cindex AArch64 support
22468
22469 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22470 following special commands:
22471
22472 @table @code
22473 @item set debug aarch64
22474 @kindex set debug aarch64
22475 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22476 messages are to be displayed.
22477
22478 @item show debug aarch64
22479 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22480
22481 @end table
22482
22483 @node i386
22484 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22485
22486 @table @code
22487 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22488 @kindex set struct-convention
22489 @cindex struct return convention
22490 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22491 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22492 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22493 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22494 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22495 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22496 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22497 be returned in a register.
22498
22499 @item show struct-convention
22500 @kindex show struct-convention
22501 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22502 from functions.
22503 @end table
22504
22505
22506 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22507 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22508
22509 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22510 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22511 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22512 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22513 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22514 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22515 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22516
22517 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22518 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22519 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22520 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22521 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22522 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22523
22524 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22525 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22526 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22527
22528 @smallexample
22529 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22530 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22531 @end smallexample
22532
22533 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22534 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22535 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22536 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22537 the pointer.
22538
22539 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22540 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22541 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22542 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22543 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22544
22545 @table @code
22546 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22547 @kindex show mpx bound
22548 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22549
22550 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22551 @kindex set mpx bound
22552 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22553 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22554 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22555 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22556 @end table
22557
22558 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
22559 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
22560 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
22561 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
22562
22563 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
22564 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
22565 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
22566 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
22567 function.
22568
22569 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
22570 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
22571 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
22572 continuing the execution. For example:
22573
22574 @smallexample
22575 $ break *upper
22576 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
22577 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
22578 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
22579 $ print $bnd0
22580 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
22581 @end smallexample
22582
22583 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
22584 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
22585 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
22586
22587 @node Alpha
22588 @subsection Alpha
22589
22590 See the following section.
22591
22592 @node MIPS
22593 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22594
22595 @cindex stack on Alpha
22596 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22597 @cindex Alpha stack
22598 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22599 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22600 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22601 find the beginning of a function.
22602
22603 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22604 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22605 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22606 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22607 commands:
22608
22609 @table @code
22610 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22611 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22612 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22613 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22614 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22615 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22616 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22617 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22618
22619 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22620 Display the current limit.
22621 @end table
22622
22623 @noindent
22624 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22625 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22626
22627 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22628 programs:
22629
22630 @table @code
22631 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22632 @kindex set mips abi
22633 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22634 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22635 values of @var{arg} are:
22636
22637 @table @samp
22638 @item auto
22639 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22640 default).
22641 @item o32
22642 @item o64
22643 @item n32
22644 @item n64
22645 @item eabi32
22646 @item eabi64
22647 @end table
22648
22649 @item show mips abi
22650 @kindex show mips abi
22651 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22652
22653 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22654 @kindex set mips compression
22655 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22656 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22657 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22658 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22659 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22660 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22661 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22662 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22663 provided by the executable.
22664
22665 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22666 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22667 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22668 identified as such.
22669
22670 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22671 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22672 implicitly from an executable.
22673
22674 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22675 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22676 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22677 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22678 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22679
22680 @item show mips compression
22681 @kindex show mips compression
22682 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22683 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22684
22685 @item set mipsfpu
22686 @itemx show mipsfpu
22687 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22688
22689 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22690 @kindex set mips mask-address
22691 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22692 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22693 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22694 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22695 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22696
22697 @item show mips mask-address
22698 @kindex show mips mask-address
22699 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22700 not.
22701
22702 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22703 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22704 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22705 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22706 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22707 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22708
22709 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22710 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22711 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22712
22713 @item set debug mips
22714 @kindex set debug mips
22715 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22716 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22717
22718 @item show debug mips
22719 @kindex show debug mips
22720 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22721 @end table
22722
22723
22724 @node HPPA
22725 @subsection HPPA
22726 @cindex HPPA support
22727
22728 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22729 following special commands:
22730
22731 @table @code
22732 @item set debug hppa
22733 @kindex set debug hppa
22734 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22735 messages are to be displayed.
22736
22737 @item show debug hppa
22738 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22739
22740 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22741 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22742 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22743 given @var{address}.
22744
22745 @end table
22746
22747
22748 @node SPU
22749 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22750 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22751 @cindex SPU
22752
22753 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22754 it provides the following special commands:
22755
22756 @table @code
22757 @item info spu event
22758 @kindex info spu
22759 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22760 and pending event status.
22761
22762 @item info spu signal
22763 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22764 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22765 notification channels.
22766
22767 @item info spu mailbox
22768 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22769 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22770 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22771
22772 @item info spu dma
22773 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22774 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22775 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22776
22777 @item info spu proxydma
22778 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22779 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22780 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22781
22782 @end table
22783
22784 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22785 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22786 special commands:
22787
22788 @table @code
22789 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22790 @kindex set spu
22791 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22792 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22793 function. The default is @code{off}.
22794
22795 @item show spu stop-on-load
22796 @kindex show spu
22797 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22798
22799 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22800 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22801 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22802 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22803 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22804 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22805
22806 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22807 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22808
22809 @end table
22810
22811 @node PowerPC
22812 @subsection PowerPC
22813 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22814
22815 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22816 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22817 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22818 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22819 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22820
22821 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22822 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22823 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22824
22825 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22826 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22827
22828 @node Nios II
22829 @subsection Nios II
22830 @cindex Nios II architecture
22831
22832 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22833 it provides the following special commands:
22834
22835 @table @code
22836
22837 @item set debug nios2
22838 @kindex set debug nios2
22839 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22840 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22841
22842 @item show debug nios2
22843 @kindex show debug nios2
22844 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22845 @end table
22846
22847 @node Controlling GDB
22848 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22849
22850 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22851 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22852 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22853 described here.
22854
22855 @menu
22856 * Prompt:: Prompt
22857 * Editing:: Command editing
22858 * Command History:: Command history
22859 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22860 * Numbers:: Numbers
22861 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22862 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22863 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22864 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22865 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22866 @end menu
22867
22868 @node Prompt
22869 @section Prompt
22870
22871 @cindex prompt
22872
22873 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22874 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22875 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22876 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22877 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22878 which one you are talking to.
22879
22880 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22881 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22882 or a prompt that does not.
22883
22884 @table @code
22885 @kindex set prompt
22886 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22887 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22888
22889 @kindex show prompt
22890 @item show prompt
22891 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22892 @end table
22893
22894 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22895 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22896 are:
22897
22898 @table @code
22899 @kindex set extended-prompt
22900 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22901 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22902 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22903 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22904 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22905 is displayed.
22906
22907 For example:
22908
22909 @smallexample
22910 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22911 @end smallexample
22912
22913 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22914 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22915
22916 @kindex show extended-prompt
22917 @item show extended-prompt
22918 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22919 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22920 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22921 @end table
22922
22923 @node Editing
22924 @section Command Editing
22925 @cindex readline
22926 @cindex command line editing
22927
22928 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22929 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22930 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22931 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22932 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22933 debugging sessions.
22934
22935 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22936 command @code{set}.
22937
22938 @table @code
22939 @kindex set editing
22940 @cindex editing
22941 @item set editing
22942 @itemx set editing on
22943 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22944
22945 @item set editing off
22946 Disable command line editing.
22947
22948 @kindex show editing
22949 @item show editing
22950 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22951 @end table
22952
22953 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22954 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22955 @end ifset
22956 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22957 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22958 @end ifclear
22959 for more details about the Readline
22960 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22961 encouraged to read that chapter.
22962
22963 @node Command History
22964 @section Command History
22965 @cindex command history
22966
22967 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22968 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22969 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22970 history facility.
22971
22972 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22973 package, to provide the history facility.
22974 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22975 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22976 @end ifset
22977 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22978 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22979 @end ifclear
22980 for the detailed description of the History library.
22981
22982 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22983 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22984 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22985 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22986 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22987 pressed on a line by itself.
22988
22989 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22990 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22991 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22992 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22993
22994 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22995 history.
22996
22997 @table @code
22998 @cindex history substitution
22999 @cindex history file
23000 @kindex set history filename
23001 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23002 @item set history filename @var{fname}
23003 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23004 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23005 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23006 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
23007 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
23008 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23009 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23010 is not set.
23011
23012 @cindex save command history
23013 @kindex set history save
23014 @item set history save
23015 @itemx set history save on
23016 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23017 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
23018
23019 @item set history save off
23020 Stop recording command history in a file.
23021
23022 @cindex history size
23023 @kindex set history size
23024 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23025 @item set history size @var{size}
23026 @itemx set history size unlimited
23027 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23028 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23029 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23030 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23031 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23032 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23033
23034 @cindex remove duplicate history
23035 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
23036 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23037 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23038 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23039 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23040 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23041 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
23042 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
23043 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23044
23045 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23046 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
23047
23048 @end table
23049
23050 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23051 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23052 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23053 @end ifset
23054 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23055 @xref{Event Designators},
23056 @end ifclear
23057 for more details.
23058
23059 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23060 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23061 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23062 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23063 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23064 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23065 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23066 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23067
23068 The commands to control history expansion are:
23069
23070 @table @code
23071 @item set history expansion on
23072 @itemx set history expansion
23073 @kindex set history expansion
23074 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23075
23076 @item set history expansion off
23077 Disable history expansion.
23078
23079 @c @group
23080 @kindex show history
23081 @item show history
23082 @itemx show history filename
23083 @itemx show history save
23084 @itemx show history size
23085 @itemx show history expansion
23086 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23087 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23088 @c @end group
23089 @end table
23090
23091 @table @code
23092 @kindex show commands
23093 @cindex show last commands
23094 @cindex display command history
23095 @item show commands
23096 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23097
23098 @item show commands @var{n}
23099 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23100
23101 @item show commands +
23102 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23103 @end table
23104
23105 @node Screen Size
23106 @section Screen Size
23107 @cindex size of screen
23108 @cindex screen size
23109 @cindex pagination
23110 @cindex page size
23111 @cindex pauses in output
23112
23113 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23114 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23115 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23116 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23117 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23118 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23119 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23120 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23121
23122 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23123 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23124 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23125 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23126 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23127 width} commands:
23128
23129 @table @code
23130 @kindex set height
23131 @kindex set width
23132 @kindex show width
23133 @kindex show height
23134 @item set height @var{lpp}
23135 @itemx set height unlimited
23136 @itemx show height
23137 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23138 @itemx set width unlimited
23139 @itemx show width
23140 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23141 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23142 commands display the current settings.
23143
23144 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23145 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23146 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23147 buffer.
23148
23149 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23150 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23151
23152 @item set pagination on
23153 @itemx set pagination off
23154 @kindex set pagination
23155 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23156 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23157 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23158 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23159
23160 @item show pagination
23161 @kindex show pagination
23162 Show the current pagination mode.
23163 @end table
23164
23165 @node Numbers
23166 @section Numbers
23167 @cindex number representation
23168 @cindex entering numbers
23169
23170 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23171 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23172 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23173 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23174 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23175 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23176 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23177 both input and output with the commands described below.
23178
23179 @table @code
23180 @kindex set input-radix
23181 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23182 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23183 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23184 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23185 example, any of
23186
23187 @smallexample
23188 set input-radix 012
23189 set input-radix 10.
23190 set input-radix 0xa
23191 @end smallexample
23192
23193 @noindent
23194 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23195 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23196 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23197 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23198 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23199 change the radix.
23200
23201 @kindex set output-radix
23202 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23203 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23204 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23205 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23206
23207 @kindex show input-radix
23208 @item show input-radix
23209 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23210
23211 @kindex show output-radix
23212 @item show output-radix
23213 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23214
23215 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23216 @itemx show radix
23217 @kindex set radix
23218 @kindex show radix
23219 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23220 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23221 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23222 default value of 10.
23223
23224 @end table
23225
23226 @node ABI
23227 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23228
23229 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23230 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23231 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23232 current ABI.
23233
23234 @cindex OS ABI
23235 @kindex set osabi
23236 @kindex show osabi
23237 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23238
23239 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23240 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23241 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23242 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23243 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23244 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23245 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23246 platform provides.
23247
23248 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23249 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23250 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23251 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23252
23253 @table @code
23254 @item show osabi
23255 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23256
23257 @item set osabi
23258 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23259
23260 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23261 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23262 @end table
23263
23264 @cindex float promotion
23265
23266 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23267 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23268 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23269 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23270 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23271 @code{double} and then passed.
23272
23273 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23274 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23275 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23276
23277 @table @code
23278 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23279 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23280 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23281 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23282 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23283
23284 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23285 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23286 functions.
23287
23288 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23289 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23290 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23291 @end table
23292
23293 @kindex set cp-abi
23294 @kindex show cp-abi
23295 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23296 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23297 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23298 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23299 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23300 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23301 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23302 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23303 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23304 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23305 ``auto''.
23306
23307 @table @code
23308 @item show cp-abi
23309 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23310
23311 @item set cp-abi
23312 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23313
23314 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23315 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23316 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23317 @end table
23318
23319 @node Auto-loading
23320 @section Automatically loading associated files
23321 @cindex auto-loading
23322
23323 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23324 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23325 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23326 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23327 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23328 sources).
23329
23330 @menu
23331 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23332 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23333
23334 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23335 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23336 @end menu
23337
23338 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23339 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23340 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23341
23342 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23343 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23344 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23345
23346 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23347 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23348
23349 @table @code
23350 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23351 @kindex set auto-load off
23352 @item set auto-load off
23353 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23354 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23355 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23356 @smallexample
23357 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23358 @end smallexample
23359
23360 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23361 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23362 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23363 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23364 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23365 @code{set auto-load no}.
23366
23367 @anchor{show auto-load}
23368 @kindex show auto-load
23369 @item show auto-load
23370 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23371 or disabled.
23372
23373 @smallexample
23374 (gdb) show auto-load
23375 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23376 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23377 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23378 is on.
23379 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23380 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23381 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23382 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23383 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23384 @end smallexample
23385
23386 @anchor{info auto-load}
23387 @kindex info auto-load
23388 @item info auto-load
23389 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23390 not.
23391
23392 @smallexample
23393 (gdb) info auto-load
23394 gdb-scripts:
23395 Loaded Script
23396 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23397 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23398 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23399 loaded.
23400 python-scripts:
23401 Loaded Script
23402 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23403 @end smallexample
23404 @end table
23405
23406 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23407
23408 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23409 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23410 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23411 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23412 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23413 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23414 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23415 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23416 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23417 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23418 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23419 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23420 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23421 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23422 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23423 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23424 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23425 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23426 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23427 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23428 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23429 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23430 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23431 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23432 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23433 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23434 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23435 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23436 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23437 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23438 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23439 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23440 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23441 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23442 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23443 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23444 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23445 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23446 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23447 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23448 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23449 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23450 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23451 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23452 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23453 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23454 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23455 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23456 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23457 @end multitable
23458
23459 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23460 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23461 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23462
23463 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23464 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23465 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23466
23467 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23468 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23469
23470 @table @code
23471 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23472 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23473 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23474 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23475 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23476
23477 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23478 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23479 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23480 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23481 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23482
23483 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23484 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23485 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23486 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23487 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23488 @end table
23489
23490 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23491 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23492 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23493
23494 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23495
23496 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23497 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23498
23499 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23500 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23501 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23502 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23503 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23504 library.
23505
23506 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23507 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23508
23509 @table @code
23510 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23511 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23512 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23513 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23514
23515 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23516 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23517 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23518 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23519 enabled or disabled.
23520
23521 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23522 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23523 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23524 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23525 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23526 @end table
23527
23528 @node Auto-loading safe path
23529 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23530 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23531
23532 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23533 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23534 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23535 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23536 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23537
23538 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23539 get loaded:
23540
23541 @smallexample
23542 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23543 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23544 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23545 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23546 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23547 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23548 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23549 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23550 @end smallexample
23551
23552 @noindent
23553 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23554 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23555
23556 @smallexample
23557 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23558 @end smallexample
23559
23560 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23561
23562 @table @code
23563 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23564 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23565 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23566 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23567 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23568 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23569 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23570 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23571 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23572 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23573
23574 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23575 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23576 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23577
23578 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23579 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23580 @item show auto-load safe-path
23581 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23582 scripts.
23583
23584 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23585 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23586 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23587 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23588 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23589 by the host platform path separator in use.
23590 @end table
23591
23592 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23593 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23594 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23595 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23596 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23597
23598 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23599 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23600 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23601 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23602 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23603 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23604 init file in the current directory
23605 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23606
23607 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23608 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23609
23610 @table @asis
23611 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23612 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23613 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23614 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23615
23616 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23617 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23618 @value{GDBN} session.
23619
23620 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23621 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23622 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23623 from trusted sources.
23624
23625 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23626 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23627 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23628 trusted sources.
23629 @end table
23630
23631 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23632 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23633
23634 @table @asis
23635 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23636 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23637
23638 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23639 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23640 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23641 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23642 @end table
23643
23644 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23645 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23646 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23647 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23648 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23649 recommended to be entered.
23650
23651 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23652 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23653 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23654
23655 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23656 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23657 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23658 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23659 be printed.
23660
23661 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23662 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23663 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23664
23665 @smallexample
23666 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23667 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23668 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23669 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23670 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23671 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23672 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23673 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23674 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23675 @end smallexample
23676
23677 @table @code
23678 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23679 @kindex set debug auto-load
23680 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23681 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23682
23683 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23684 @kindex show debug auto-load
23685 @item show debug auto-load
23686 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23687 on or off.
23688 @end table
23689
23690 @node Messages/Warnings
23691 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23692
23693 @cindex verbose operation
23694 @cindex optional warnings
23695 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23696 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23697 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23698 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23699
23700 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23701 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23702 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23703
23704 @table @code
23705 @kindex set verbose
23706 @item set verbose on
23707 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23708
23709 @item set verbose off
23710 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23711
23712 @kindex show verbose
23713 @item show verbose
23714 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23715 @end table
23716
23717 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23718 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23719 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23720 Symbol Files}).
23721
23722 @table @code
23723
23724 @kindex set complaints
23725 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23726 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23727 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23728 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23729 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23730
23731 @kindex show complaints
23732 @item show complaints
23733 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23734
23735 @end table
23736
23737 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23738 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23739 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23740 you try to run a program which is already running:
23741
23742 @smallexample
23743 (@value{GDBP}) run
23744 The program being debugged has been started already.
23745 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23746 @end smallexample
23747
23748 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23749 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23750
23751 @table @code
23752
23753 @kindex set confirm
23754 @cindex flinching
23755 @cindex confirmation
23756 @cindex stupid questions
23757 @item set confirm off
23758 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23759 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23760 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23761
23762 @item set confirm on
23763 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23764
23765 @kindex show confirm
23766 @item show confirm
23767 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23768
23769 @end table
23770
23771 @cindex command tracing
23772 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23773 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23774 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23775 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23776
23777 @table @code
23778 @kindex set trace-commands
23779 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23780 @item set trace-commands on
23781 Enable command tracing.
23782 @item set trace-commands off
23783 Disable command tracing.
23784 @item show trace-commands
23785 Display the current state of command tracing.
23786 @end table
23787
23788 @node Debugging Output
23789 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23790 @cindex optional debugging messages
23791
23792 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23793 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23794 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23795 section documents those commands.
23796
23797 @table @code
23798 @kindex set exec-done-display
23799 @item set exec-done-display
23800 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23801 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23802 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23803 @kindex show exec-done-display
23804 @item show exec-done-display
23805 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23806 notification.
23807 @kindex set debug
23808 @cindex ARM AArch64
23809 @item set debug aarch64
23810 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23811 The default is off.
23812 @kindex show debug
23813 @item show debug aarch64
23814 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23815 ARM AArch64.
23816 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23817 @cindex architecture debugging info
23818 @item set debug arch
23819 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23820 @item show debug arch
23821 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23822 @item set debug aix-solib
23823 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23824 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23825 support module. The default is off.
23826 @item show debug aix-thread
23827 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23828 @item set debug aix-thread
23829 @cindex AIX threads
23830 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23831 module.
23832 @item show debug aix-thread
23833 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23834 @item set debug check-physname
23835 @cindex physname
23836 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23837 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23838 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23839 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23840 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23841 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23842 @item show debug check-physname
23843 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23844 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23845 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23846 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23847 exported symbols. The default is off.
23848 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23849 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23850 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23851 @item set debug dwarf-die
23852 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23853 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23854 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23855 A value of zero turns off the display.
23856 @item show debug dwarf-die
23857 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23858 @item set debug dwarf-line
23859 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23860 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23861 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23862 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23863 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23864 @item show debug dwarf-line
23865 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23866 @item set debug dwarf-read
23867 @cindex DWARF Reading
23868 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23869 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23870 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23871 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23872 @item show debug dwarf-read
23873 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23874 @item set debug displaced
23875 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23876 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23877 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23878 @item show debug displaced
23879 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23880 related to displaced stepping.
23881 @item set debug event
23882 @cindex event debugging info
23883 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23884 default is off.
23885 @item show debug event
23886 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23887 info.
23888 @item set debug expression
23889 @cindex expression debugging info
23890 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23891 expression parsing. The default is off.
23892 @item show debug expression
23893 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23894 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23895 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
23896 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23897 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23898 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
23899 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23900 @item set debug frame
23901 @cindex frame debugging info
23902 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23903 default is off.
23904 @item show debug frame
23905 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23906 info.
23907 @item set debug gnu-nat
23908 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23909 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23910 @item show debug gnu-nat
23911 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23912 @item set debug infrun
23913 @cindex inferior debugging info
23914 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23915 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23916 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23917 @item show debug infrun
23918 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23919 @item set debug jit
23920 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23921 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23922 @item show debug jit
23923 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23924 @item set debug lin-lwp
23925 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23926 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23927 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23928 @item show debug lin-lwp
23929 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23930 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23931 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23932 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23933 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23934 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23935 @item set debug mach-o
23936 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23937 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23938 processing. The default is off.
23939 @item show debug mach-o
23940 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23941 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23942 @item set debug notification
23943 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23944 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23945 The default is off.
23946 @item show debug notification
23947 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23948 @item set debug observer
23949 @cindex observer debugging info
23950 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23951 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23952 @item show debug observer
23953 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23954 @item set debug overload
23955 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23956 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23957 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23958 is off.
23959 @item show debug overload
23960 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23961 debugging info.
23962 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23963 @cindex debug expression parser
23964 @item set debug parser
23965 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23966 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23967 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23968 details. The default is off.
23969 @item show debug parser
23970 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23971 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23972 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23973 @cindex debug remote protocol
23974 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23975 @cindex display remote packets
23976 @item set debug remote
23977 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23978 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23979 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23980 @item show debug remote
23981 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23982 @item set debug serial
23983 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23984 default is off.
23985 @item show debug serial
23986 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23987 info.
23988 @item set debug solib-frv
23989 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23990 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23991 @item show debug solib-frv
23992 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23993 messages.
23994 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23995 @cindex symbol lookup
23996 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23997 The default is 0 (off).
23998 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23999 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24000 @item show debug symbol-lookup
24001 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24002 @item set debug symfile
24003 @cindex symbol file functions
24004 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24005 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
24006 @item show debug symfile
24007 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24008 @item set debug symtab-create
24009 @cindex symbol table creation
24010 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24011 The default is 0 (off).
24012 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24013 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24014 @item show debug symtab-create
24015 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24016 @item set debug target
24017 @cindex target debugging info
24018 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24019 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24020 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24021 value of large memory transfers.
24022 @item show debug target
24023 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24024 info.
24025 @item set debug timestamp
24026 @cindex timestampping debugging info
24027 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24028 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24029 message.
24030 @item show debug timestamp
24031 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24032 debugging info.
24033 @item set debug varobj
24034 @cindex variable object debugging info
24035 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24036 info. The default is off.
24037 @item show debug varobj
24038 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24039 debugging info.
24040 @item set debug xml
24041 @cindex XML parser debugging
24042 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24043 @item show debug xml
24044 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24045 @end table
24046
24047 @node Other Misc Settings
24048 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24049 @cindex miscellaneous settings
24050
24051 @table @code
24052 @kindex set interactive-mode
24053 @item set interactive-mode
24054 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24055 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24056 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24057 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24058 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24059 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24060 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24061 is, non-interactively otherwise.
24062
24063 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24064 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24065 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24066 inside a cygwin window.
24067
24068 @kindex show interactive-mode
24069 @item show interactive-mode
24070 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24071 @end table
24072
24073 @node Extending GDB
24074 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24075 @cindex extending GDB
24076
24077 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24078 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24079 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24080 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24081 being debugged.
24082
24083 @menu
24084 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24085 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24086 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24087 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24088 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24089 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24090 @end menu
24091
24092 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24093 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24094 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24095 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24096 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24097 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24098
24099 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24100 setting:
24101
24102 @table @code
24103 @kindex set script-extension
24104 @kindex show script-extension
24105 @item set script-extension off
24106 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24107
24108 @item set script-extension soft
24109 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24110 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24111 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24112 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24113
24114 @item set script-extension strict
24115 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24116 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24117 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24118
24119 @item show script-extension
24120 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24121
24122 @end table
24123
24124 @node Sequences
24125 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24126
24127 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24128 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24129 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24130 files.
24131
24132 @menu
24133 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24134 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24135 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24136 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24137 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24138 @end menu
24139
24140 @node Define
24141 @subsection User-defined Commands
24142
24143 @cindex user-defined command
24144 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24145 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24146 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24147 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24148 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24149 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24150
24151 @smallexample
24152 define adder
24153 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24154 end
24155 @end smallexample
24156
24157 @noindent
24158 To execute the command use:
24159
24160 @smallexample
24161 adder 1 2 3
24162 @end smallexample
24163
24164 @noindent
24165 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24166 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24167 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24168 functions calls.
24169
24170 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24171 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24172 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24173 been passed.
24174
24175 @smallexample
24176 define adder
24177 if $argc == 2
24178 print $arg0 + $arg1
24179 end
24180 if $argc == 3
24181 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24182 end
24183 end
24184 @end smallexample
24185
24186 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24187 to process a variable number of arguments:
24188
24189 @smallexample
24190 define adder
24191 set $i = 0
24192 set $sum = 0
24193 while $i < $argc
24194 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24195 set $i = $i + 1
24196 end
24197 print $sum
24198 end
24199 @end smallexample
24200
24201 @table @code
24202
24203 @kindex define
24204 @item define @var{commandname}
24205 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24206 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24207 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24208 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24209 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24210 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24211
24212 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24213 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24214 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24215
24216 @kindex document
24217 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24218 @item document @var{commandname}
24219 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24220 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24221 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24222 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24223 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24224 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24225
24226 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24227 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24228 does not change the documentation.
24229
24230 @kindex dont-repeat
24231 @cindex don't repeat command
24232 @item dont-repeat
24233 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24234 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24235 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24236
24237 @kindex help user-defined
24238 @item help user-defined
24239 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24240 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24241 included (if any).
24242
24243 @kindex show user
24244 @item show user
24245 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24246 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24247 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24248 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24249 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24250
24251 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24252 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24253 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24254 @item show max-user-call-depth
24255 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24256 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24257 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24258 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24259 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24260 @end table
24261
24262 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24263 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24264
24265 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24266 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24267 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24268
24269 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24270 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24271 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24272 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24273
24274 @node Hooks
24275 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24276 @cindex command hooks
24277 @cindex hooks, for commands
24278 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24279
24280 @kindex hook
24281 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24282 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24283 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24284 before that command.
24285
24286 @cindex hooks, post-command
24287 @kindex hookpost
24288 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24289 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24290 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24291 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24292 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24293
24294 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24295 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24296
24297 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24298 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24299
24300 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24301 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24302 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24303 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24304 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24305
24306 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24307 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24308 you could define:
24309
24310 @smallexample
24311 define hook-stop
24312 handle SIGALRM nopass
24313 end
24314
24315 define hook-run
24316 handle SIGALRM pass
24317 end
24318
24319 define hook-continue
24320 handle SIGALRM pass
24321 end
24322 @end smallexample
24323
24324 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24325 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24326 you could define:
24327
24328 @smallexample
24329 define hook-echo
24330 echo <<<---
24331 end
24332
24333 define hookpost-echo
24334 echo --->>>\n
24335 end
24336
24337 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24338 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24339 (@value{GDBP})
24340
24341 @end smallexample
24342
24343 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24344 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24345 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24346 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24347 @c or not?
24348 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24349 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24350 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24351
24352 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24353 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24354 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24355
24356 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24357 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24358
24359 @node Command Files
24360 @subsection Command Files
24361
24362 @cindex command files
24363 @cindex scripting commands
24364 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24365 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24366 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24367 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24368 terminal.
24369
24370 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24371 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24372 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24373 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24374 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24375
24376 @table @code
24377 @kindex source
24378 @cindex execute commands from a file
24379 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24380 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24381 @end table
24382
24383 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24384 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24385 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24386 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24387 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24388
24389 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24390 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24391 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24392 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24393 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24394 is not relevant to scripts.
24395
24396 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24397 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24398 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24399 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24400 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24401 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24402 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24403 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24404 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24405 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24406 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24407 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24408 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24409 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24410
24411 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24412 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24413 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24414
24415 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24416 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24417 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24418 when called from command files.
24419
24420 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24421 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24422 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24423 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24424 the next command.
24425
24426 @smallexample
24427 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24428 @end smallexample
24429
24430 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24431 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24432 would be directed to @file{log}.
24433
24434 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24435 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24436 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24437 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24438 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24439 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24440 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24441 conditionally, etc.
24442
24443 @table @code
24444 @kindex if
24445 @kindex else
24446 @item if
24447 @itemx else
24448 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24449 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24450 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24451 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24452 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24453 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24454 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24455
24456 @kindex while
24457 @item while
24458 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24459 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24460 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24461 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24462 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24463 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24464
24465 @kindex loop_break
24466 @item loop_break
24467 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24468 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24469 line.
24470
24471 @kindex loop_continue
24472 @item loop_continue
24473 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24474 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24475 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24476 the controlling expression.
24477
24478 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24479 @item end
24480 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24481 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24482 @end table
24483
24484
24485 @node Output
24486 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24487
24488 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24489 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24490 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24491 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24492 want.
24493
24494 @table @code
24495 @kindex echo
24496 @item echo @var{text}
24497 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24498 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24499 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24500 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24501 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24502 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24503 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24504 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24505 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24506 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24507 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24508
24509 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24510 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24511
24512 @smallexample
24513 echo This is some text\n\
24514 which is continued\n\
24515 onto several lines.\n
24516 @end smallexample
24517
24518 produces the same output as
24519
24520 @smallexample
24521 echo This is some text\n
24522 echo which is continued\n
24523 echo onto several lines.\n
24524 @end smallexample
24525
24526 @kindex output
24527 @item output @var{expression}
24528 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24529 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24530 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24531 on expressions.
24532
24533 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24534 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24535 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24536 Formats}, for more information.
24537
24538 @kindex printf
24539 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24540 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24541 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24542 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24543 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24544 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24545 executing the code below:
24546
24547 @smallexample
24548 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24549 @end smallexample
24550
24551 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24552 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24553 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24554 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24555 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24556 printed.
24557
24558 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24559
24560 @smallexample
24561 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24562 @end smallexample
24563
24564 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24565 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24566 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24567
24568 @itemize @bullet
24569 @item
24570 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24571
24572 @item
24573 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24574 width.
24575
24576 @item
24577 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24578 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24579
24580 @item
24581 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24582 supported.
24583
24584 @item
24585 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24586
24587 @item
24588 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24589 @end itemize
24590
24591 @noindent
24592 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24593 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24594 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24595 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24596
24597 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24598 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24599 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24600 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24601 supported.
24602
24603 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24604 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24605 together with a floating point specifier.
24606 letters:
24607
24608 @itemize @bullet
24609 @item
24610 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24611
24612 @item
24613 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24614
24615 @item
24616 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24617 @end itemize
24618
24619 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24620 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24621 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24622
24623 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24624 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24625
24626 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24627 @smallexample
24628 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24629 @end smallexample
24630
24631 @anchor{eval}
24632 @kindex eval
24633 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24634 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24635 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24636
24637 @end table
24638
24639 @node Auto-loading sequences
24640 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24641 @cindex native script auto-loading
24642
24643 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24644 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24645 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24646 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24647
24648 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24649 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24650
24651 @table @code
24652 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24653 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24654 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24655 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24656
24657 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24658 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24659 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24660 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24661 disabled.
24662
24663 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24664 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24665 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24666 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24667 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24668 auto-loaded.
24669 @end table
24670
24671 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24672 matching names are printed.
24673
24674 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24675 @include python.texi
24676
24677 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24678 @include guile.texi
24679
24680 @node Auto-loading extensions
24681 @section Auto-loading extensions
24682 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24683
24684 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24685 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24686 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24687 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24688 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24689
24690 @menu
24691 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24692 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24693 * Which flavor to choose?::
24694 @end menu
24695
24696 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24697 debugging commands and features.
24698
24699 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24700 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24701 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24702 for more information.
24703 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24704 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24705
24706 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24707 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24708
24709 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24710 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24711 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24712 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24713 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24714
24715 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24716 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24717 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24718 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24719
24720 @table @code
24721 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24722 GDB's own command language
24723 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24724 Python
24725 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24726 Guile
24727 @end table
24728
24729 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24730 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24731 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24732 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24733 script in the specified extension language.
24734
24735 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24736 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24737
24738 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24739 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24740
24741 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24742 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24743 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24744 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24745 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24746 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24747
24748 @table @code
24749 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24750 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24751 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24752 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24753 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24754 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24755
24756 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24757 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24758
24759 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24760 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24761 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24762 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24763
24764 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24765 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24766 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24767 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24768 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24769 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24770 platform.
24771
24772 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24773 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24774 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24775
24776 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24777 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24778 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24779 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24780
24781 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24782 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24783 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24784 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24785 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24786 @end table
24787
24788 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24789 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24790 @var{objfile} is opened.
24791 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24792 is evaluated more than once.
24793
24794 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24795 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24796 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24797
24798 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24799 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24800 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24801 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24802 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24803 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24804 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24805
24806 The following entries are supported:
24807
24808 @table @code
24809 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24810 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24811 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24812 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24813 @end table
24814
24815 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24816
24817 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24818 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24819 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24820 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24821 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24822
24823 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24824 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24825
24826 @example
24827 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24828 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24829 asm("\
24830 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24831 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24832 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24833 .popsection \n\
24834 ");
24835 @end example
24836
24837 @noindent
24838 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24839 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24840
24841 @example
24842 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24843 @end example
24844
24845 The script name may include directories if desired.
24846
24847 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24848 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24849
24850 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24851 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24852 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24853 will remove duplicates.
24854
24855 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24856
24857 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24858 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24859 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24860 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24861 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24862 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24863 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24864 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24865 on its name.
24866
24867 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24868 testsuite.
24869
24870 @example
24871 #include "symcat.h"
24872 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24873 asm(
24874 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24875 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24876 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24877 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24878 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24879 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24880 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24881 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24882 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24883 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24884 ".byte 0\n"
24885 ".popsection\n"
24886 );
24887 @end example
24888
24889 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24890 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24891 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24892 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24893
24894 @node Which flavor to choose?
24895 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24896
24897 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24898 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24899
24900 @noindent
24901 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24902
24903 @itemize @bullet
24904 @item
24905 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24906
24907 @item
24908 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24909
24910 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24911 in the source search path.
24912 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24913 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24914
24915 @item
24916 Doesn't require source code additions.
24917 @end itemize
24918
24919 @noindent
24920 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24921
24922 @itemize @bullet
24923 @item
24924 Works with static linking.
24925
24926 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24927 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24928 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24929 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24930 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24931
24932 @item
24933 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24934
24935 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24936 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24937
24938 @item
24939 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24940
24941 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24942 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24943 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24944 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24945 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24946 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24947 @end itemize
24948
24949 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24950 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24951
24952 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24953 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24954 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24955
24956 @subsection Python comes first
24957
24958 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24959 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24960 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24961 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24962 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24963 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24964 pretty-printed form of a value).
24965 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24966 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24967 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24968
24969 @node Aliases
24970 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24971 @cindex aliases for commands
24972
24973 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24974 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24975 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24976 that involves less typing.
24977
24978 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24979 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24980 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24981
24982 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24983 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24984 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24985
24986 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24987
24988 @table @code
24989
24990 @kindex alias
24991 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24992
24993 @end table
24994
24995 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24996 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24997 underscores.
24998
24999 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25000 that is being aliased.
25001
25002 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25003 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
25004 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25005
25006 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25007 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25008
25009 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25010 of a command so that there is less to type.
25011 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25012 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25013 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25014 The following will accomplish this.
25015
25016 @smallexample
25017 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
25018 @end smallexample
25019
25020 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25021 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25022 for it with the @samp{document} command.
25023 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25024
25025 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25026 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25027 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25028 of a command.
25029
25030 @smallexample
25031 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25032 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25033 (gdb) set p elms 20
25034 (gdb) show p elms
25035 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25036 @end smallexample
25037
25038 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25039 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25040 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25041
25042 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25043 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25044
25045 @smallexample
25046 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25047 @end smallexample
25048
25049 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25050 alias for a more complex command.
25051 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25052
25053 @smallexample
25054 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25055 (gdb) spe 20
25056 @end smallexample
25057
25058 @node Interpreters
25059 @chapter Command Interpreters
25060 @cindex command interpreters
25061
25062 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25063 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25064 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25065
25066 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25067 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25068 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25069 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25070
25071 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25072 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25073 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25074 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25075
25076 @table @code
25077 @item console
25078 @cindex console interpreter
25079 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25080 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25081 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25082
25083 @item mi
25084 @cindex mi interpreter
25085 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25086 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25087 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25088 Interface}.
25089
25090 @item mi2
25091 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25092 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25093
25094 @item mi1
25095 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25096 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25097
25098 @end table
25099
25100 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25101
25102 @kindex interpreter-exec
25103 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25104 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25105 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25106
25107 @smallexample
25108 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25109 @end smallexample
25110
25111 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25112 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25113
25114 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25115 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25116 permanently.
25117
25118 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25119
25120 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25121 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25122 device (usually a tty).
25123
25124 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25125 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25126 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25127 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25128 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25129 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25130 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25131 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25132 the separate MI interpreter.
25133
25134 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25135 @code{new-ui} command:
25136
25137 @kindex new-ui
25138 @cindex new user interface
25139 @smallexample
25140 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25141 @end smallexample
25142
25143 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25144 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25145 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25146 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25147 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25148 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25149
25150 @smallexample
25151 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25152 @end smallexample
25153
25154 @noindent
25155 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25156
25157 @node TUI
25158 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25159 @cindex TUI
25160 @cindex Text User Interface
25161
25162 @menu
25163 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25164 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25165 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25166 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25167 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25168 @end menu
25169
25170 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25171 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25172 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25173 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25174 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25175 is available.
25176
25177 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25178 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25179 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25180 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25181 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25182 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25183
25184 @node TUI Overview
25185 @section TUI Overview
25186
25187 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25188
25189 @table @emph
25190 @item command
25191 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25192 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25193 managed using readline.
25194
25195 @item source
25196 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25197 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25198
25199 @item assembly
25200 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25201
25202 @item register
25203 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25204 when their values change.
25205 @end table
25206
25207 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25208 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25209 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25210 indicates the breakpoint type:
25211
25212 @table @code
25213 @item B
25214 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25215
25216 @item b
25217 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25218
25219 @item H
25220 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25221
25222 @item h
25223 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25224 @end table
25225
25226 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25227
25228 @table @code
25229 @item +
25230 Breakpoint is enabled.
25231
25232 @item -
25233 Breakpoint is disabled.
25234 @end table
25235
25236 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25237 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25238 changes.
25239
25240 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25241 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25242 layouts:
25243
25244 @itemize @bullet
25245 @item
25246 source only,
25247
25248 @item
25249 assembly only,
25250
25251 @item
25252 source and assembly,
25253
25254 @item
25255 source and registers, or
25256
25257 @item
25258 assembly and registers.
25259 @end itemize
25260
25261 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25262
25263 @table @emph
25264 @item target
25265 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25266 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25267
25268 @item process
25269 Gives the current process or thread number.
25270 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25271
25272 @item function
25273 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25274 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25275 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25276 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25277
25278 @item line
25279 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25280 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25281
25282 @item pc
25283 Indicates the current program counter address.
25284 @end table
25285
25286 @node TUI Keys
25287 @section TUI Key Bindings
25288 @cindex TUI key bindings
25289
25290 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25291 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25292 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25293 @end ifset
25294 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25295 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25296 @end ifclear
25297 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25298 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25299
25300 @table @kbd
25301 @kindex C-x C-a
25302 @item C-x C-a
25303 @kindex C-x a
25304 @itemx C-x a
25305 @kindex C-x A
25306 @itemx C-x A
25307 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25308 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25309 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25310 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25311 The screen is then refreshed.
25312
25313 @kindex C-x 1
25314 @item C-x 1
25315 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25316 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25317 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25318
25319 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25320
25321 @kindex C-x 2
25322 @item C-x 2
25323 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25324 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25325 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25326 previous layout and the new one.
25327
25328 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25329
25330 @kindex C-x o
25331 @item C-x o
25332 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25333 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25334 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25335
25336 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25337
25338 @kindex C-x s
25339 @item C-x s
25340 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25341 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25342 @end table
25343
25344 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25345
25346 @table @asis
25347 @kindex PgUp
25348 @item @key{PgUp}
25349 Scroll the active window one page up.
25350
25351 @kindex PgDn
25352 @item @key{PgDn}
25353 Scroll the active window one page down.
25354
25355 @kindex Up
25356 @item @key{Up}
25357 Scroll the active window one line up.
25358
25359 @kindex Down
25360 @item @key{Down}
25361 Scroll the active window one line down.
25362
25363 @kindex Left
25364 @item @key{Left}
25365 Scroll the active window one column left.
25366
25367 @kindex Right
25368 @item @key{Right}
25369 Scroll the active window one column right.
25370
25371 @kindex C-L
25372 @item @kbd{C-L}
25373 Refresh the screen.
25374 @end table
25375
25376 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25377 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25378 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25379 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25380 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25381
25382 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25383 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25384 @cindex TUI single key mode
25385
25386 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25387 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25388 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25389
25390 @table @kbd
25391 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25392 @item c
25393 continue
25394
25395 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25396 @item d
25397 down
25398
25399 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25400 @item f
25401 finish
25402
25403 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25404 @item n
25405 next
25406
25407 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25408 @item q
25409 exit the SingleKey mode.
25410
25411 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25412 @item r
25413 run
25414
25415 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25416 @item s
25417 step
25418
25419 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25420 @item u
25421 up
25422
25423 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25424 @item v
25425 info locals
25426
25427 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25428 @item w
25429 where
25430 @end table
25431
25432 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25433 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25434 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25435 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25436 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25437 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25438
25439
25440 @node TUI Commands
25441 @section TUI-specific Commands
25442 @cindex TUI commands
25443
25444 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25445 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25446 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25447 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25448
25449 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25450 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25451 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25452 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25453 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25454
25455 @table @code
25456 @item tui enable
25457 @kindex tui enable
25458 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25459 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25460 otherwise a default layout is used.
25461
25462 @item tui disable
25463 @kindex tui disable
25464 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25465
25466 @item info win
25467 @kindex info win
25468 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25469
25470 @item layout @var{name}
25471 @kindex layout
25472 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25473 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25474 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25475
25476 @table @code
25477 @item next
25478 Display the next layout.
25479
25480 @item prev
25481 Display the previous layout.
25482
25483 @item src
25484 Display the source and command windows.
25485
25486 @item asm
25487 Display the assembly and command windows.
25488
25489 @item split
25490 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25491
25492 @item regs
25493 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25494 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25495 register, assembler, and command windows.
25496 @end table
25497
25498 @item focus @var{name}
25499 @kindex focus
25500 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25501 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25502
25503 @table @code
25504 @item next
25505 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25506
25507 @item prev
25508 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25509
25510 @item src
25511 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25512
25513 @item asm
25514 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25515
25516 @item regs
25517 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25518
25519 @item cmd
25520 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25521 @end table
25522
25523 @item refresh
25524 @kindex refresh
25525 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25526
25527 @item tui reg @var{group}
25528 @kindex tui reg
25529 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25530 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25531 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25532 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25533 following groups are available on most targets:
25534 @table @code
25535 @item next
25536 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25537 through all of the available register groups.
25538
25539 @item prev
25540 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25541 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25542 @var{next}.
25543
25544 @item general
25545 Display the general registers.
25546 @item float
25547 Display the floating point registers.
25548 @item system
25549 Display the system registers.
25550 @item vector
25551 Display the vector registers.
25552 @item all
25553 Display all registers.
25554 @end table
25555
25556 @item update
25557 @kindex update
25558 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25559
25560 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25561 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25562 @kindex winheight
25563 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25564 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25565 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25566 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25567 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25568
25569 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25570 @kindex tabset
25571 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25572 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25573 assembly windows.
25574 @end table
25575
25576 @node TUI Configuration
25577 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25578 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25579
25580 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25581
25582 @table @code
25583 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25584 @kindex set tui border-kind
25585 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25586 The possible values are the following:
25587 @table @code
25588 @item space
25589 Use a space character to draw the border.
25590
25591 @item ascii
25592 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25593
25594 @item acs
25595 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25596 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25597 @end table
25598
25599 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25600 @kindex set tui border-mode
25601 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25602 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25603 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25604 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25605 @table @code
25606 @item normal
25607 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25608
25609 @item standout
25610 Use standout mode.
25611
25612 @item reverse
25613 Use reverse video mode.
25614
25615 @item half
25616 Use half bright mode.
25617
25618 @item half-standout
25619 Use half bright and standout mode.
25620
25621 @item bold
25622 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25623
25624 @item bold-standout
25625 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25626 @end table
25627 @end table
25628
25629 @node Emacs
25630 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25631
25632 @cindex Emacs
25633 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25634 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25635 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25636 @value{GDBN}.
25637
25638 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25639 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25640 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25641 created Emacs buffer.
25642 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25643
25644 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25645 things:
25646
25647 @itemize @bullet
25648 @item
25649 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25650 the GUD buffer.
25651
25652 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25653 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25654
25655 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25656 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25657 in this way.
25658
25659 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25660 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25661 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25662 stop.
25663
25664 @item
25665 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25666
25667 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25668 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25669 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25670 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25671 and the source.
25672
25673 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25674 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25675 @end itemize
25676
25677 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25678 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25679 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25680 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25681
25682 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25683 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25684 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25685 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25686 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25687 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25688 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25689 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25690 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25691
25692 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25693 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25694 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25695 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25696
25697 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25698 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25699 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25700 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25701 one you want.
25702
25703 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25704 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25705
25706 @table @kbd
25707 @item C-h m
25708 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25709
25710 @item C-c C-s
25711 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25712 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25713
25714 @item C-c C-n
25715 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25716 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25717 to show the current file and location.
25718
25719 @item C-c C-i
25720 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25721 display window accordingly.
25722
25723 @item C-c C-f
25724 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25725 @code{finish} command.
25726
25727 @item C-c C-r
25728 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25729 command.
25730
25731 @item C-c <
25732 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25733 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25734 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25735
25736 @item C-c >
25737 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25738 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25739 @end table
25740
25741 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25742 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25743
25744 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25745 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25746 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25747 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25748 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25749 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25750 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25751
25752 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25753 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25754 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25755 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25756 frame.
25757
25758 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25759 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25760 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25761 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25762 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25763 to correspond properly with the code.
25764
25765 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25766 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25767 Emacs Manual}).
25768
25769 @node GDB/MI
25770 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25771
25772 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25773
25774 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25775 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25776 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25777 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25778 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25779 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25780
25781 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25782 in the form of a reference manual.
25783
25784 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25785 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25786 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25787
25788 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25789
25790 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25791 This chapter uses the following notation:
25792
25793 @itemize @bullet
25794 @item
25795 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25796
25797 @item
25798 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25799 it may or may not be given.
25800
25801 @item
25802 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25803 may repeat zero or more times.
25804
25805 @item
25806 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25807 may repeat one or more times.
25808
25809 @item
25810 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25811 @end itemize
25812
25813 @ignore
25814 @heading Dependencies
25815 @end ignore
25816
25817 @menu
25818 * GDB/MI General Design::
25819 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25820 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25821 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25822 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25823 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25824 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25825 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25826 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25827 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25828 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25829 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25830 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25831 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25832 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25833 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25834 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25835 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25836 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25837 @ignore
25838 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25839 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25840 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25841 @end ignore
25842 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25843 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25844 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25845 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25846 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25847 @end menu
25848
25849 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25850 @node GDB/MI General Design
25851 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25852 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25853
25854 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25855 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25856 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25857 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25858 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25859 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25860 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25861 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25862 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25863 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25864
25865 The important examples of notifications are:
25866 @itemize @bullet
25867
25868 @item
25869 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25870 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25871 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25872 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25873 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25874 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25875 command itself was successfully executed.
25876
25877 @item
25878 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25879 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25880 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25881 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25882 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25883 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25884
25885 @item
25886 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25887 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25888 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25889 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25890 orthogonal frontend design.
25891
25892 @end itemize
25893
25894 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25895 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25896 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25897 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25898 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25899 the user interface.
25900
25901
25902 @menu
25903 * Context management::
25904 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25905 * Thread groups::
25906 @end menu
25907
25908 @node Context management
25909 @subsection Context management
25910
25911 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25912
25913 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25914 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25915 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25916 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25917 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25918 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25919 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25920 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25921 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25922
25923 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25924 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25925 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25926 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25927 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25928 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25929 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25930 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25931 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25932 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25933 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25934
25935 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25936 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25937 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25938 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
25939 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
25940 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
25941 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
25942 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
25943 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
25944 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25945
25946 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25947 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25948 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25949 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25950 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25951 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25952 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25953 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25954 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25955 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25956 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25957 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25958 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25959 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25960 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25961 @samp{--frame} options.
25962
25963 @subsubsection Language
25964
25965 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25966 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25967 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25968 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25969 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25970 For instance:
25971
25972 @smallexample
25973 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25974 ^done,value="4"
25975 (gdb)
25976 @end smallexample
25977
25978 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25979 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25980 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25981
25982 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25983 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25984
25985 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25986 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25987 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25988 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25989 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25990 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25991 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25992 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25993 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25994
25995 @table @code
25996 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25997 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25998 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25999
26000 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26001 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26002 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26003
26004 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26005 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26006 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26007 MI commands even while the target is running.
26008
26009 @item -gdb-show mi-async
26010 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26011 @end table
26012
26013 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26014 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26015 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26016 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
26017 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
26018 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26019
26020 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26021 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26022 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26023 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
26024 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26025 are running.
26026
26027 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26028 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26029 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26030 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
26031 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
26032 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26033 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26034 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
26035 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26036 @samp{--thread} option).
26037
26038 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26039 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
26040 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26041 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26042
26043 @node Thread groups
26044 @subsection Thread groups
26045 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26046 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26047 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26048 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
26049 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26050
26051 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26052 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26053 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26054 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26055 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26056 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26057 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26058 into processes.
26059
26060 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26061 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26062 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26063 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26064 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26065 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26066 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26067 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26068 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26069 the members of specific thread group.
26070
26071 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26072 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26073 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26074 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26075 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26076 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26077 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26078 after attaching to that thread group.
26079
26080 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26081 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26082 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26083 such thread groups.
26084
26085 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26086 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26087 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26088
26089 @menu
26090 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26091 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26092 @end menu
26093
26094 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26095 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26096
26097 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26098 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26099 @table @code
26100 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26101 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26102
26103 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26104 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26105 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26106
26107 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26108 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26109 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26110
26111 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26112 "any sequence of digits"
26113
26114 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26115 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26116
26117 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26118 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26119
26120 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26121 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26122
26123 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26124 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26125 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26126
26127 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26128 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26129
26130 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26131 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26132 @end table
26133
26134 @noindent
26135 Notes:
26136
26137 @itemize @bullet
26138 @item
26139 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26140 output is described below.
26141
26142 @item
26143 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26144 finishes.
26145
26146 @item
26147 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26148 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26149 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26150 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26151 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26152 @end itemize
26153
26154 Pragmatics:
26155
26156 @itemize @bullet
26157 @item
26158 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26159
26160 @item
26161 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26162 @end itemize
26163
26164 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26165 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26166
26167 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26168 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26169 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26170 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26171 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26172 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26173
26174 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26175 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26176 @var{token}.
26177
26178 @table @code
26179 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26180 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26181
26182 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26183 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26184
26185 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26186 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26187
26188 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26189 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26190
26191 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26192 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26193
26194 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26195 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26196
26197 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26198 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26199
26200 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26201 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26202
26203 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26204 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26205
26206 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26207 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26208 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26209
26210 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26211 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26212
26213 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26214 @code{ @var{string} }
26215
26216 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26217 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26218
26219 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26220 @code{@var{c-string}}
26221
26222 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26223 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26224
26225 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26226 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26227 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26228
26229 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26230 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26231
26232 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26233 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26234
26235 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26236 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26237
26238 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26239 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26240
26241 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26242 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26243
26244 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26245 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26246 @end table
26247
26248 @noindent
26249 Notes:
26250
26251 @itemize @bullet
26252 @item
26253 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26254
26255 @item
26256 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26257 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26258 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26259 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26260 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26261 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26262 prior command.
26263
26264 @item
26265 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26266 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26267 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26268 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26269
26270 @item
26271 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26272 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26273 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26274 @samp{*}.
26275
26276 @item
26277 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26278 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26279 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26280 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26281
26282 @item
26283 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26284 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26285 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26286 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26287
26288 @item
26289 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26290 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26291 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26292
26293 @item
26294 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26295 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26296 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26297 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26298
26299 @item
26300 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26301 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26302 @var{values}.
26303
26304
26305 @end itemize
26306
26307 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26308 details about the various output records.
26309
26310 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26311 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26312 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26313
26314 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26315 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26316
26317 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26318 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26319 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26320 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26321 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26322 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26323
26324 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26325 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26326 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26327
26328 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26329 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26330 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26331 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26332
26333 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26334 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26335
26336 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26337 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26338 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26339 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26340 might change.
26341
26342 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26343 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26344 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26345 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26346
26347 @itemize @bullet
26348 @item
26349 New MI commands may be added.
26350
26351 @item
26352 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26353
26354 @item
26355 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26356 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26357
26358 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26359 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26360
26361 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26362 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26363 @end itemize
26364
26365 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26366 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26367 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26368 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26369 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26370
26371 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26372 @c version?
26373
26374 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26375 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26376 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26377 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26378 @cindex mailing lists
26379
26380 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26381 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26382 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26383
26384 @menu
26385 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26386 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26387 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26388 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26389 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26390 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26391 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26392 @end menu
26393
26394 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26395 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26396
26397 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26398 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26399 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26400 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26401
26402 @table @code
26403 @findex ^done
26404 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26405 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26406 values.
26407
26408 @item "^running"
26409 @findex ^running
26410 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26411 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26412 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26413 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26414 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26415 which threads are resumed.
26416
26417 @item "^connected"
26418 @findex ^connected
26419 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26420
26421 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26422 @findex ^error
26423 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26424 the corresponding error message.
26425
26426 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26427 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26428 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26429
26430 @table @samp
26431 @item "undefined-command"
26432 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26433 @end table
26434
26435 @item "^exit"
26436 @findex ^exit
26437 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26438
26439 @end table
26440
26441 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26442 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26443
26444 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26445 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26446 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26447 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26448 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26449
26450 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26451 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26452 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26453 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26454 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26455
26456 @table @code
26457 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26458 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26459 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26460
26461 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26462 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26463 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26464 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26465
26466 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26467 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26468 internals.
26469 @end table
26470
26471 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26472 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26473
26474 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26475 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26476 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26477 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26478 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26479 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26480
26481 The following is the list of possible async records:
26482
26483 @table @code
26484
26485 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26486 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26487 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26488 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26489 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26490 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26491 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26492 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26493 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26494 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26495 it run freely.
26496
26497 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26498 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26499 following values:
26500
26501 @table @code
26502 @item breakpoint-hit
26503 A breakpoint was reached.
26504 @item watchpoint-trigger
26505 A watchpoint was triggered.
26506 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26507 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26508 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26509 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26510 @item function-finished
26511 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26512 @item location-reached
26513 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26514 @item watchpoint-scope
26515 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26516 @item end-stepping-range
26517 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26518 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26519 @item exited-signalled
26520 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26521 @item exited
26522 The inferior exited.
26523 @item exited-normally
26524 The inferior exited normally.
26525 @item signal-received
26526 A signal was received by the inferior.
26527 @item solib-event
26528 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26529 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26530 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26531 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26532 @item fork
26533 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26534 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26535 @item vfork
26536 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26537 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26538 @item syscall-entry
26539 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26540 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26541 @item syscall-return
26542 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26543 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26544 @item exec
26545 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26546 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26547 @end table
26548
26549 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26550 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26551 Depending on whether all-stop
26552 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26553 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26554 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26555 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26556 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26557 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26558 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26559 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26560 if such information is not available.
26561
26562 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26563 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26564 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26565 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26566 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26567 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26568 cannot be used in any way.
26569
26570 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26571 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26572 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26573 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26574 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26575 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26576
26577 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26578 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26579 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26580 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26581 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26582 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26583
26584 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26585 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26586 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26587 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26588 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26589
26590 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26591 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
26592 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26593 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26594 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26595 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26596 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26597 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
26598 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26599
26600 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26601 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26602
26603 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26604 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26605 that thread.
26606
26607 @item =library-loaded,...
26608 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26609 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26610 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
26611 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26612 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26613 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26614 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26615 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26616 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26617 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26618 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26619 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26620 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
26621 to this library.
26622
26623 @item =library-unloaded,...
26624 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26625 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26626 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26627 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26628 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26629 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26630 thread groups.
26631
26632 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26633 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26634 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26635 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26636 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26637
26638 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26639 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26640 initial value @var{initial}.
26641
26642 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26643 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26644 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26645 trace state variables are deleted.
26646
26647 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26648 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26649 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26650 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26651 value of trace state variable is known.
26652
26653 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26654 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26655 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26656 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26657 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26658 user.
26659
26660 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26661 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26662 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26663
26664 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26665 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26666
26667 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26668 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26669 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26670 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26671 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26672
26673 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26674 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26675 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
26676 for existing method and format values.
26677
26678 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26679 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26680 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26681 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26682 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26683 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26684
26685 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26686 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26687 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26688 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26689 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26690 executable code.
26691 @end table
26692
26693 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26694 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26695
26696 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26697 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26698 following fields:
26699
26700 @table @code
26701 @item number
26702 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26703 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26704 @samp{1.2}.
26705
26706 @item type
26707 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26708 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26709
26710 @item catch-type
26711 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26712 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26713
26714 @item disp
26715 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26716 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26717 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26718
26719 @item enabled
26720 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26721 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26722 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26723
26724 @item addr
26725 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26726 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26727 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26728 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26729 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26730
26731 @item func
26732 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26733 If not known, this field is not present.
26734
26735 @item filename
26736 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26737 If not known, this field is not present.
26738
26739 @item fullname
26740 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26741 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26742
26743 @item line
26744 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26745 If not known, this field is not present.
26746
26747 @item at
26748 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26749 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26750 by a symbol name.
26751
26752 @item pending
26753 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26754 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26755
26756 @item evaluated-by
26757 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26758 @samp{target}.
26759
26760 @item thread
26761 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26762 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26763
26764 @item task
26765 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26766 field will hold the task identifier.
26767
26768 @item cond
26769 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26770
26771 @item ignore
26772 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26773
26774 @item enable
26775 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26776
26777 @item traceframe-usage
26778 FIXME.
26779
26780 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26781 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26782
26783 @item mask
26784 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26785
26786 @item pass
26787 A tracepoint's pass count.
26788
26789 @item original-location
26790 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26791 This field is optional.
26792
26793 @item times
26794 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26795
26796 @item installed
26797 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26798 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26799 is not.
26800
26801 @item what
26802 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26803
26804 @end table
26805
26806 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26807 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26808
26809 @smallexample
26810 -> -break-insert main
26811 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26812 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26813 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26814 times="0"@}
26815 <- (gdb)
26816 @end smallexample
26817
26818 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26819 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26820
26821 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26822 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26823 fields:
26824
26825 @table @code
26826 @item level
26827 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26828 zero. This field is always present.
26829
26830 @item func
26831 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26832 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26833
26834 @item addr
26835 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26836
26837 @item file
26838 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26839 address. This field may be absent.
26840
26841 @item line
26842 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26843 may be absent.
26844
26845 @item from
26846 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26847 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26848
26849 @end table
26850
26851 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26852 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26853
26854 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26855 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26856
26857 @table @code
26858 @item id
26859 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26860 always present.
26861
26862 @item target-id
26863 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26864
26865 @item details
26866 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26867 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26868 frontend. This field is optional.
26869
26870 @item state
26871 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26872 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26873
26874 @item core
26875 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26876 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26877 @end table
26878
26879 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26880 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26881
26882 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26883 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26884 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26885 the @code{exception-name} field.
26886
26887 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26888 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26889 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26890 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26891
26892 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26893 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26894 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26895 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26896
26897 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26898 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26899
26900 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26901
26902 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26903 information of the breakpoint.
26904
26905 @smallexample
26906 -> -break-insert main
26907 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26908 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26909 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26910 times="0"@}
26911 <- (gdb)
26912 @end smallexample
26913
26914 @subheading Program Execution
26915
26916 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26917 reason that execution stopped.
26918
26919 @smallexample
26920 -> -exec-run
26921 <- ^running
26922 <- (gdb)
26923 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26924 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26925 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26926 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26927 <- (gdb)
26928 -> -exec-continue
26929 <- ^running
26930 <- (gdb)
26931 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26932 <- (gdb)
26933 @end smallexample
26934
26935 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26936
26937 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26938
26939 @smallexample
26940 -> (gdb)
26941 <- -gdb-exit
26942 <- ^exit
26943 @end smallexample
26944
26945 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26946 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26947 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26948 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26949 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26950 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26951
26952 @subheading A Bad Command
26953
26954 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26955
26956 @smallexample
26957 -> -rubbish
26958 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26959 <- (gdb)
26960 @end smallexample
26961
26962
26963 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26964 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26965 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26966
26967 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26968 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26969
26970 @subheading Motivation
26971
26972 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26973
26974 @subheading Introduction
26975
26976 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26977
26978 @subheading Commands
26979
26980 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26981
26982 @subsubheading Synopsis
26983
26984 @smallexample
26985 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26986 @end smallexample
26987
26988 @subsubheading Result
26989
26990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26991
26992 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26993
26994 @subsubheading Example
26995
26996 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26997 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26998
26999
27000 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27001 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27002 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27003
27004 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27005 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27006 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27007 breakpoints.
27008
27009 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27010 @findex -break-after
27011
27012 @subsubheading Synopsis
27013
27014 @smallexample
27015 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27016 @end smallexample
27017
27018 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27019 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27020 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27021 @samp{-break-list} command below.
27022
27023 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27024
27025 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27026
27027 @subsubheading Example
27028
27029 @smallexample
27030 (gdb)
27031 -break-insert main
27032 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27033 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27034 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27035 times="0"@}
27036 (gdb)
27037 -break-after 1 3
27038 ~
27039 ^done
27040 (gdb)
27041 -break-list
27042 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27043 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27044 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27045 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27046 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27047 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27048 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27049 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27050 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27051 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27052 (gdb)
27053 @end smallexample
27054
27055 @ignore
27056 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27057 @findex -break-catch
27058 @end ignore
27059
27060 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27061 @findex -break-commands
27062
27063 @subsubheading Synopsis
27064
27065 @smallexample
27066 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27067 @end smallexample
27068
27069 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27070 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27071 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27072 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27073 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27074 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27075
27076 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27077
27078 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27079
27080 @subsubheading Example
27081
27082 @smallexample
27083 (gdb)
27084 -break-insert main
27085 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27086 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27087 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27088 times="0"@}
27089 (gdb)
27090 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27091 ^done
27092 (gdb)
27093 @end smallexample
27094
27095 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27096 @findex -break-condition
27097
27098 @subsubheading Synopsis
27099
27100 @smallexample
27101 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27102 @end smallexample
27103
27104 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27105 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27106 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27107 command below).
27108
27109 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27110
27111 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27112
27113 @subsubheading Example
27114
27115 @smallexample
27116 (gdb)
27117 -break-condition 1 1
27118 ^done
27119 (gdb)
27120 -break-list
27121 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27122 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27123 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27124 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27125 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27126 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27127 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27128 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27129 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27130 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27131 (gdb)
27132 @end smallexample
27133
27134 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27135 @findex -break-delete
27136
27137 @subsubheading Synopsis
27138
27139 @smallexample
27140 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27141 @end smallexample
27142
27143 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27144 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27145
27146 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27147
27148 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27149
27150 @subsubheading Example
27151
27152 @smallexample
27153 (gdb)
27154 -break-delete 1
27155 ^done
27156 (gdb)
27157 -break-list
27158 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27159 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27160 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27161 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27162 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27163 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27164 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27165 body=[]@}
27166 (gdb)
27167 @end smallexample
27168
27169 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27170 @findex -break-disable
27171
27172 @subsubheading Synopsis
27173
27174 @smallexample
27175 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27176 @end smallexample
27177
27178 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27179 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27180
27181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27182
27183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27184
27185 @subsubheading Example
27186
27187 @smallexample
27188 (gdb)
27189 -break-disable 2
27190 ^done
27191 (gdb)
27192 -break-list
27193 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27194 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27195 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27196 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27197 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27198 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27199 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27200 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27201 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27202 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27203 (gdb)
27204 @end smallexample
27205
27206 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27207 @findex -break-enable
27208
27209 @subsubheading Synopsis
27210
27211 @smallexample
27212 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27213 @end smallexample
27214
27215 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27216
27217 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27218
27219 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27220
27221 @subsubheading Example
27222
27223 @smallexample
27224 (gdb)
27225 -break-enable 2
27226 ^done
27227 (gdb)
27228 -break-list
27229 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27230 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27231 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27232 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27233 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27234 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27235 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27236 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27237 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27238 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27239 (gdb)
27240 @end smallexample
27241
27242 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27243 @findex -break-info
27244
27245 @subsubheading Synopsis
27246
27247 @smallexample
27248 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27249 @end smallexample
27250
27251 @c REDUNDANT???
27252 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27253
27254 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27255 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27256 table.
27257
27258 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27259
27260 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27261
27262 @subsubheading Example
27263 N.A.
27264
27265 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27266 @findex -break-insert
27267 @anchor{-break-insert}
27268
27269 @subsubheading Synopsis
27270
27271 @smallexample
27272 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27273 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27274 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27275 @end smallexample
27276
27277 @noindent
27278 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27279
27280 @table @var
27281 @item linespec location
27282 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27283
27284 @item explicit location
27285 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27286 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27287 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27288
27289 @table @samp
27290 @item --source @var{filename}
27291 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27292 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27293
27294 @item --function @var{function}
27295 The name of a function or method.
27296
27297 @item --label @var{label}
27298 The name of a label.
27299
27300 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27301 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27302 @end table
27303
27304 @item address location
27305 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27306 @end table
27307
27308 @noindent
27309 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27310
27311 @table @samp
27312 @item -t
27313 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27314 @item -h
27315 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27316 @item -f
27317 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27318 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27319 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27320 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27321 cannot be parsed.
27322 @item -d
27323 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27324 @item -a
27325 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27326 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27327 @item -c @var{condition}
27328 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27329 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27330 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27331 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27332 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27333 @var{thread-id}.
27334 @end table
27335
27336 @subsubheading Result
27337
27338 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27339 resulting breakpoint.
27340
27341 Note: this format is open to change.
27342 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27343
27344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27345
27346 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27347 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27348
27349 @subsubheading Example
27350
27351 @smallexample
27352 (gdb)
27353 -break-insert main
27354 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27355 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27356 times="0"@}
27357 (gdb)
27358 -break-insert -t foo
27359 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27360 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27361 times="0"@}
27362 (gdb)
27363 -break-list
27364 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27365 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27366 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27367 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27368 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27369 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27370 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27371 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27372 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27373 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27374 times="0"@},
27375 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27376 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27377 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27378 times="0"@}]@}
27379 (gdb)
27380 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27381 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27382 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27383 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27384 @c times="0"@}
27385 @c (gdb)
27386 @end smallexample
27387
27388 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27389 @findex -dprintf-insert
27390
27391 @subsubheading Synopsis
27392
27393 @smallexample
27394 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27395 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27396 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27397 [ @var{argument} ]
27398 @end smallexample
27399
27400 @noindent
27401 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27402 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27403
27404 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27405
27406 @table @samp
27407 @item -t
27408 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27409 @item -f
27410 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27411 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27412 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27413 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27414 cannot be parsed.
27415 @item -d
27416 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27417 @item -c @var{condition}
27418 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27419 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27420 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27421 to @var{ignore-count}.
27422 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27423 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27424 @var{thread-id}.
27425 @end table
27426
27427 @subsubheading Result
27428
27429 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27430 resulting breakpoint.
27431
27432 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27433
27434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27435
27436 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27437
27438 @subsubheading Example
27439
27440 @smallexample
27441 (gdb)
27442 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27443 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27444 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27445 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27446 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27447 original-location="foo"@}
27448 (gdb)
27449 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27450 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27451 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27452 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27453 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27454 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27455 (gdb)
27456 @end smallexample
27457
27458 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27459 @findex -break-list
27460
27461 @subsubheading Synopsis
27462
27463 @smallexample
27464 -break-list
27465 @end smallexample
27466
27467 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27468
27469 @table @samp
27470 @item Number
27471 number of the breakpoint
27472 @item Type
27473 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27474 @item Disposition
27475 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27476 or @samp{nokeep}
27477 @item Enabled
27478 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27479 @item Address
27480 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27481 @item What
27482 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27483 name, line number
27484 @item Thread-groups
27485 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27486 @item Times
27487 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27488 @end table
27489
27490 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27491 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27492
27493 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27494
27495 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27496
27497 @subsubheading Example
27498
27499 @smallexample
27500 (gdb)
27501 -break-list
27502 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27503 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27504 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27505 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27506 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27507 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27508 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27509 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27510 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27511 times="0"@},
27512 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27513 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27514 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27515 (gdb)
27516 @end smallexample
27517
27518 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27519
27520 @smallexample
27521 (gdb)
27522 -break-list
27523 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27524 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27525 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27526 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27527 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27528 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27529 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27530 body=[]@}
27531 (gdb)
27532 @end smallexample
27533
27534 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27535 @findex -break-passcount
27536
27537 @subsubheading Synopsis
27538
27539 @smallexample
27540 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27541 @end smallexample
27542
27543 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27544 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27545 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27546 command @samp{passcount}.
27547
27548 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27549 @findex -break-watch
27550
27551 @subsubheading Synopsis
27552
27553 @smallexample
27554 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27555 @end smallexample
27556
27557 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27558 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27559 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27560 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27561 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27562 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27563 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27564 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27565
27566 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27567 breakpoints inserted.
27568
27569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27570
27571 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27572 @samp{rwatch}.
27573
27574 @subsubheading Example
27575
27576 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27577
27578 @smallexample
27579 (gdb)
27580 -break-watch x
27581 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27582 (gdb)
27583 -exec-continue
27584 ^running
27585 (gdb)
27586 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27587 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27588 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27589 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27590 (gdb)
27591 @end smallexample
27592
27593 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27594 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27595 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27596
27597 @smallexample
27598 (gdb)
27599 -break-watch C
27600 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27601 (gdb)
27602 -exec-continue
27603 ^running
27604 (gdb)
27605 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27606 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27607 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27608 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27609 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27610 (gdb)
27611 -exec-continue
27612 ^running
27613 (gdb)
27614 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27615 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27616 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27617 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27618 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27619 (gdb)
27620 @end smallexample
27621
27622 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27623 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27624 deleted.
27625
27626 @smallexample
27627 (gdb)
27628 -break-watch C
27629 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27630 (gdb)
27631 -break-list
27632 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27633 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27634 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27635 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27636 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27637 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27638 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27639 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27640 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27641 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27642 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27643 times="1"@},
27644 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27645 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27646 (gdb)
27647 -exec-continue
27648 ^running
27649 (gdb)
27650 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27651 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27652 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27653 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27654 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27655 (gdb)
27656 -break-list
27657 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27658 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27659 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27660 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27661 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27662 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27663 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27664 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27665 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27666 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27667 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27668 times="1"@},
27669 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27670 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27671 (gdb)
27672 -exec-continue
27673 ^running
27674 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27675 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27676 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27677 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27678 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27679 (gdb)
27680 -break-list
27681 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27682 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27683 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27684 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27685 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27686 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27687 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27688 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27689 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27690 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27691 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27692 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27693 (gdb)
27694 @end smallexample
27695
27696
27697 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27698 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27699 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27700
27701 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27702 catchpoints.
27703
27704 @menu
27705 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27706 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27707 @end menu
27708
27709 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27710 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27711
27712 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27713 @findex -catch-load
27714
27715 @subsubheading Synopsis
27716
27717 @smallexample
27718 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27719 @end smallexample
27720
27721 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27722 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27723 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27724 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27725 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27726
27727
27728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27729
27730 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27731
27732 @subsubheading Example
27733
27734 @smallexample
27735 -catch-load -t foo.so
27736 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27737 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27738 (gdb)
27739 @end smallexample
27740
27741
27742 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27743 @findex -catch-unload
27744
27745 @subsubheading Synopsis
27746
27747 @smallexample
27748 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27749 @end smallexample
27750
27751 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27752 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27753 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27754 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27755 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27756
27757 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27758
27759 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27760
27761 @subsubheading Example
27762
27763 @smallexample
27764 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27765 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27766 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27767 (gdb)
27768 @end smallexample
27769
27770 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27771 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27772
27773 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27774 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27775
27776 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27777 @findex -catch-assert
27778
27779 @subsubheading Synopsis
27780
27781 @smallexample
27782 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27783 @end smallexample
27784
27785 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27786
27787 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27788
27789 @table @samp
27790 @item -c @var{condition}
27791 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27792 @item -d
27793 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27794 @item -t
27795 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27796 @end table
27797
27798 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27799
27800 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27801
27802 @subsubheading Example
27803
27804 @smallexample
27805 -catch-assert
27806 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27807 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27808 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27809 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27810 (gdb)
27811 @end smallexample
27812
27813 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27814 @findex -catch-exception
27815
27816 @subsubheading Synopsis
27817
27818 @smallexample
27819 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27820 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27821 @end smallexample
27822
27823 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27824 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27825 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27826 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27827 catchpoints.
27828
27829 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27830
27831 @table @samp
27832 @item -c @var{condition}
27833 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27834 @item -d
27835 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27836 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27837 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27838 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27839 @item -t
27840 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27841 @item -u
27842 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27843 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27844 @end table
27845
27846 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27847
27848 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27849 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27850
27851 @subsubheading Example
27852
27853 @smallexample
27854 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27855 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27856 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27857 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27858 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27859 (gdb)
27860 @end smallexample
27861
27862 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27863 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27864 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27865
27866 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27867 @findex -exec-arguments
27868
27869
27870 @subsubheading Synopsis
27871
27872 @smallexample
27873 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27874 @end smallexample
27875
27876 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27877 @samp{-exec-run}.
27878
27879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27880
27881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27882
27883 @subsubheading Example
27884
27885 @smallexample
27886 (gdb)
27887 -exec-arguments -v word
27888 ^done
27889 (gdb)
27890 @end smallexample
27891
27892
27893 @ignore
27894 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27895 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27896
27897 @subsubheading Synopsis
27898
27899 @smallexample
27900 -exec-show-arguments
27901 @end smallexample
27902
27903 Print the arguments of the program.
27904
27905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27906
27907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27908
27909 @subsubheading Example
27910 N.A.
27911 @end ignore
27912
27913
27914 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27915 @findex -environment-cd
27916
27917 @subsubheading Synopsis
27918
27919 @smallexample
27920 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27921 @end smallexample
27922
27923 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27924
27925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27926
27927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27928
27929 @subsubheading Example
27930
27931 @smallexample
27932 (gdb)
27933 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27934 ^done
27935 (gdb)
27936 @end smallexample
27937
27938
27939 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27940 @findex -environment-directory
27941
27942 @subsubheading Synopsis
27943
27944 @smallexample
27945 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27946 @end smallexample
27947
27948 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27949 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27950 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27951 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27952 occurs as normal.
27953 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27954 multiple directories in a single command
27955 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27956 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27957 If blanks are needed as
27958 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27959 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27960 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27961 character must not be used
27962 in any directory name.
27963 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27964
27965 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27966
27967 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27968
27969 @subsubheading Example
27970
27971 @smallexample
27972 (gdb)
27973 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27974 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27975 (gdb)
27976 -environment-directory ""
27977 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27978 (gdb)
27979 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27980 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27981 (gdb)
27982 -environment-directory -r
27983 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27984 (gdb)
27985 @end smallexample
27986
27987
27988 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27989 @findex -environment-path
27990
27991 @subsubheading Synopsis
27992
27993 @smallexample
27994 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27995 @end smallexample
27996
27997 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27998 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27999 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28000 supplied in addition to the
28001 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28002 occurs as normal.
28003 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28004 multiple directories in a single command
28005 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28006 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28007 If blanks are needed as
28008 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28009 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28010 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28011 character must not be used
28012 in any directory name.
28013 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28014
28015
28016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28017
28018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28019
28020 @subsubheading Example
28021
28022 @smallexample
28023 (gdb)
28024 -environment-path
28025 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
28026 (gdb)
28027 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28028 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28029 (gdb)
28030 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28031 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28032 (gdb)
28033 @end smallexample
28034
28035
28036 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28037 @findex -environment-pwd
28038
28039 @subsubheading Synopsis
28040
28041 @smallexample
28042 -environment-pwd
28043 @end smallexample
28044
28045 Show the current working directory.
28046
28047 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28048
28049 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28050
28051 @subsubheading Example
28052
28053 @smallexample
28054 (gdb)
28055 -environment-pwd
28056 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28057 (gdb)
28058 @end smallexample
28059
28060 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28061 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28062 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28063
28064
28065 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28066 @findex -thread-info
28067
28068 @subsubheading Synopsis
28069
28070 @smallexample
28071 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28072 @end smallexample
28073
28074 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28075 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28076 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28077 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28078 current thread.
28079
28080 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28081
28082 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28083 about all threads.
28084
28085 @subsubheading Result
28086
28087 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
28088 defined for a given thread:
28089
28090 @table @samp
28091 @item current
28092 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28093
28094 @item id
28095 The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
28096
28097 @item target-id
28098 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
28099
28100 @item details
28101 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
28102 field is optional.
28103
28104 @item name
28105 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28106 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28107 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28108 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28109 field is omitted.
28110
28111 @item frame
28112 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
28113
28114 @item state
28115 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
28116 values:
28117
28118 @table @code
28119 @item stopped
28120 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
28121 threads.
28122
28123 @item running
28124 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
28125 threads.
28126
28127 @end table
28128
28129 @item core
28130 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
28131 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
28132
28133 @end table
28134
28135 @subsubheading Example
28136
28137 @smallexample
28138 -thread-info
28139 ^done,threads=[
28140 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28141 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28142 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28143 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28144 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28145 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28146 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28147 state="running"@}],
28148 current-thread-id="1"
28149 (gdb)
28150 @end smallexample
28151
28152 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28153 @findex -thread-list-ids
28154
28155 @subsubheading Synopsis
28156
28157 @smallexample
28158 -thread-list-ids
28159 @end smallexample
28160
28161 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28162 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28163 threads.
28164
28165 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28166 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28167
28168 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28169
28170 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28171
28172 @subsubheading Example
28173
28174 @smallexample
28175 (gdb)
28176 -thread-list-ids
28177 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28178 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28179 (gdb)
28180 @end smallexample
28181
28182
28183 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28184 @findex -thread-select
28185
28186 @subsubheading Synopsis
28187
28188 @smallexample
28189 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28190 @end smallexample
28191
28192 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28193 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28194 topmost frame for that thread.
28195
28196 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28197 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28198
28199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28200
28201 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28202
28203 @subsubheading Example
28204
28205 @smallexample
28206 (gdb)
28207 -exec-next
28208 ^running
28209 (gdb)
28210 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28211 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28212 (gdb)
28213 -thread-list-ids
28214 ^done,
28215 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28216 number-of-threads="3"
28217 (gdb)
28218 -thread-select 3
28219 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28220 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28221 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28222 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28223 (gdb)
28224 @end smallexample
28225
28226 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28227 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28228 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28229
28230 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28231 @findex -ada-task-info
28232
28233 @subsubheading Synopsis
28234
28235 @smallexample
28236 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28237 @end smallexample
28238
28239 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28240 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28241
28242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28243
28244 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28245 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28246
28247 @subsubheading Result
28248
28249 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28250 defined for each Ada task:
28251
28252 @table @samp
28253 @item current
28254 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28255
28256 @item id
28257 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28258
28259 @item task-id
28260 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28261
28262 @item thread-id
28263 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28264 task.
28265
28266 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28267 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28268 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28269
28270 @item parent-id
28271 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28272 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28273
28274 @item priority
28275 The base priority of the task.
28276
28277 @item state
28278 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28279 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28280
28281 @item name
28282 The name of the task.
28283
28284 @end table
28285
28286 @subsubheading Example
28287
28288 @smallexample
28289 -ada-task-info
28290 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28291 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28292 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28293 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28294 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28295 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28296 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28297 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28298 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28299 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28300 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28301 (gdb)
28302 @end smallexample
28303
28304 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28305 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28306 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28307
28308 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28309 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28310 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28311 other cases.
28312
28313 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28314 @findex -exec-continue
28315
28316 @subsubheading Synopsis
28317
28318 @smallexample
28319 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28320 @end smallexample
28321
28322 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28323 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28324 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28325 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28326 @itemize @bullet
28327 @item
28328 breakpoints or watchpoints
28329 @item
28330 signals or exceptions
28331 @item
28332 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28333 @item
28334 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28335 @end itemize
28336 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28337 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28338 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28339 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28340 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28341 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28342
28343 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28344
28345 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28346
28347 @subsubheading Example
28348
28349 @smallexample
28350 -exec-continue
28351 ^running
28352 (gdb)
28353 @@Hello world
28354 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28355 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28356 line="13"@}
28357 (gdb)
28358 @end smallexample
28359
28360
28361 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28362 @findex -exec-finish
28363
28364 @subsubheading Synopsis
28365
28366 @smallexample
28367 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28368 @end smallexample
28369
28370 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28371 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28372 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28373 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28374 function was called.
28375
28376 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28377
28378 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28379
28380 @subsubheading Example
28381
28382 Function returning @code{void}.
28383
28384 @smallexample
28385 -exec-finish
28386 ^running
28387 (gdb)
28388 @@hello from foo
28389 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28390 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28391 (gdb)
28392 @end smallexample
28393
28394 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28395 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28396 value itself.
28397
28398 @smallexample
28399 -exec-finish
28400 ^running
28401 (gdb)
28402 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28403 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28404 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28405 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28406 (gdb)
28407 @end smallexample
28408
28409
28410 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28411 @findex -exec-interrupt
28412
28413 @subsubheading Synopsis
28414
28415 @smallexample
28416 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28417 @end smallexample
28418
28419 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28420 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28421 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28422 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28423 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28424
28425 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28426 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28427 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28428 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28429
28430 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28431 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28432 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28433 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28434
28435 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28436
28437 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28438
28439 @subsubheading Example
28440
28441 @smallexample
28442 (gdb)
28443 111-exec-continue
28444 111^running
28445
28446 (gdb)
28447 222-exec-interrupt
28448 222^done
28449 (gdb)
28450 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28451 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28452 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28453 (gdb)
28454
28455 (gdb)
28456 -exec-interrupt
28457 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28458 (gdb)
28459 @end smallexample
28460
28461 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28462 @findex -exec-jump
28463
28464 @subsubheading Synopsis
28465
28466 @smallexample
28467 -exec-jump @var{location}
28468 @end smallexample
28469
28470 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28471 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28472 different forms of @var{location}.
28473
28474 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28475
28476 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28477
28478 @subsubheading Example
28479
28480 @smallexample
28481 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28482 *running,thread-id="all"
28483 ^running
28484 @end smallexample
28485
28486
28487 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28488 @findex -exec-next
28489
28490 @subsubheading Synopsis
28491
28492 @smallexample
28493 -exec-next [--reverse]
28494 @end smallexample
28495
28496 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28497 of the next source line is reached.
28498
28499 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28500 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28501 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28502 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28503 source line where the function was called.
28504
28505
28506 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28507
28508 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28509
28510 @subsubheading Example
28511
28512 @smallexample
28513 -exec-next
28514 ^running
28515 (gdb)
28516 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28517 (gdb)
28518 @end smallexample
28519
28520
28521 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28522 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28523
28524 @subsubheading Synopsis
28525
28526 @smallexample
28527 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28528 @end smallexample
28529
28530 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28531 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28532 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28533 printed as well.
28534
28535 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28536 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28537 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28538 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28539 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28540
28541 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28542
28543 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28544
28545 @subsubheading Example
28546
28547 @smallexample
28548 (gdb)
28549 -exec-next-instruction
28550 ^running
28551
28552 (gdb)
28553 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28554 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28555 (gdb)
28556 @end smallexample
28557
28558
28559 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28560 @findex -exec-return
28561
28562 @subsubheading Synopsis
28563
28564 @smallexample
28565 -exec-return
28566 @end smallexample
28567
28568 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28569 Displays the new current frame.
28570
28571 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28572
28573 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28574
28575 @subsubheading Example
28576
28577 @smallexample
28578 (gdb)
28579 200-break-insert callee4
28580 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28581 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28582 (gdb)
28583 000-exec-run
28584 000^running
28585 (gdb)
28586 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28587 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28588 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28589 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28590 (gdb)
28591 205-break-delete
28592 205^done
28593 (gdb)
28594 111-exec-return
28595 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28596 args=[@{name="strarg",
28597 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28598 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28599 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28600 (gdb)
28601 @end smallexample
28602
28603
28604 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28605 @findex -exec-run
28606
28607 @subsubheading Synopsis
28608
28609 @smallexample
28610 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28611 @end smallexample
28612
28613 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28614 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28615 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28616 the program has exited exceptionally.
28617
28618 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28619 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28620 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28621 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28622 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28623
28624 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28625 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28626 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28627 (@pxref{Starting}).
28628
28629 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28630
28631 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28632
28633 @subsubheading Examples
28634
28635 @smallexample
28636 (gdb)
28637 -break-insert main
28638 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28639 (gdb)
28640 -exec-run
28641 ^running
28642 (gdb)
28643 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28644 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28645 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28646 (gdb)
28647 @end smallexample
28648
28649 @noindent
28650 Program exited normally:
28651
28652 @smallexample
28653 (gdb)
28654 -exec-run
28655 ^running
28656 (gdb)
28657 x = 55
28658 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28659 (gdb)
28660 @end smallexample
28661
28662 @noindent
28663 Program exited exceptionally:
28664
28665 @smallexample
28666 (gdb)
28667 -exec-run
28668 ^running
28669 (gdb)
28670 x = 55
28671 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28672 (gdb)
28673 @end smallexample
28674
28675 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28676 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28677
28678 @smallexample
28679 (gdb)
28680 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28681 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28682 @end smallexample
28683
28684
28685 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28686
28687
28688 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28689 @findex -exec-step
28690
28691 @subsubheading Synopsis
28692
28693 @smallexample
28694 -exec-step [--reverse]
28695 @end smallexample
28696
28697 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28698 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28699 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28700 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28701 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28702 previously executed source line.
28703
28704 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28705
28706 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28707
28708 @subsubheading Example
28709
28710 Stepping into a function:
28711
28712 @smallexample
28713 -exec-step
28714 ^running
28715 (gdb)
28716 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28717 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28718 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28719 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28720 (gdb)
28721 @end smallexample
28722
28723 Regular stepping:
28724
28725 @smallexample
28726 -exec-step
28727 ^running
28728 (gdb)
28729 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28730 (gdb)
28731 @end smallexample
28732
28733
28734 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28735 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28736
28737 @subsubheading Synopsis
28738
28739 @smallexample
28740 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28741 @end smallexample
28742
28743 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28744 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28745 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28746 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28747 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28748 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28749 as well.
28750
28751 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28752
28753 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28754
28755 @subsubheading Example
28756
28757 @smallexample
28758 (gdb)
28759 -exec-step-instruction
28760 ^running
28761
28762 (gdb)
28763 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28764 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28765 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28766 (gdb)
28767 -exec-step-instruction
28768 ^running
28769
28770 (gdb)
28771 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28772 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28773 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28774 (gdb)
28775 @end smallexample
28776
28777
28778 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28779 @findex -exec-until
28780
28781 @subsubheading Synopsis
28782
28783 @smallexample
28784 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28785 @end smallexample
28786
28787 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28788 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28789 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28790 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28791
28792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28793
28794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28795
28796 @subsubheading Example
28797
28798 @smallexample
28799 (gdb)
28800 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28801 ^running
28802 (gdb)
28803 x = 55
28804 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28805 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28806 (gdb)
28807 @end smallexample
28808
28809 @ignore
28810 @subheading -file-clear
28811 Is this going away????
28812 @end ignore
28813
28814 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28815 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28816 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28817
28818 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28819 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28820
28821 @smallexample
28822 -enable-frame-filters
28823 @end smallexample
28824
28825 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28826 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28827 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28828 request that this functionality be enabled.
28829
28830 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28831
28832 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28833 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28834
28835 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28836 @findex -stack-info-frame
28837
28838 @subsubheading Synopsis
28839
28840 @smallexample
28841 -stack-info-frame
28842 @end smallexample
28843
28844 Get info on the selected frame.
28845
28846 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28847
28848 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28849 (without arguments).
28850
28851 @subsubheading Example
28852
28853 @smallexample
28854 (gdb)
28855 -stack-info-frame
28856 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28857 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28858 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28859 (gdb)
28860 @end smallexample
28861
28862 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28863 @findex -stack-info-depth
28864
28865 @subsubheading Synopsis
28866
28867 @smallexample
28868 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28869 @end smallexample
28870
28871 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28872 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28873
28874 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28875
28876 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28877
28878 @subsubheading Example
28879
28880 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28881
28882 @smallexample
28883 (gdb)
28884 -stack-info-depth
28885 ^done,depth="12"
28886 (gdb)
28887 -stack-info-depth 4
28888 ^done,depth="4"
28889 (gdb)
28890 -stack-info-depth 12
28891 ^done,depth="12"
28892 (gdb)
28893 -stack-info-depth 11
28894 ^done,depth="11"
28895 (gdb)
28896 -stack-info-depth 13
28897 ^done,depth="12"
28898 (gdb)
28899 @end smallexample
28900
28901 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28902 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28903 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28904
28905 @subsubheading Synopsis
28906
28907 @smallexample
28908 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28909 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28910 @end smallexample
28911
28912 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28913 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28914 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28915 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28916 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28917 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28918 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28919 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28920
28921 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28922 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28923 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28924 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28925 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28926 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28927
28928 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28929 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28930 are still displayed, however.
28931
28932 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28933 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28934
28935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28936
28937 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28938 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28939 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28940
28941 @subsubheading Example
28942
28943 @smallexample
28944 (gdb)
28945 -stack-list-frames
28946 ^done,
28947 stack=[
28948 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28949 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28950 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28951 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28952 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28953 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28954 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28955 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28956 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28957 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28958 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28959 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28960 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28961 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28962 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28963 (gdb)
28964 -stack-list-arguments 0
28965 ^done,
28966 stack-args=[
28967 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28968 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28969 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28970 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28971 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28972 (gdb)
28973 -stack-list-arguments 1
28974 ^done,
28975 stack-args=[
28976 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28977 frame=@{level="1",
28978 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28979 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28980 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28981 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28982 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28983 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28984 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28985 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28986 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28987 (gdb)
28988 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28989 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28990 (gdb)
28991 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28992 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28993 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28994 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28995 (gdb)
28996 @end smallexample
28997
28998 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28999
29000
29001 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29002 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29003 @findex -stack-list-frames
29004
29005 @subsubheading Synopsis
29006
29007 @smallexample
29008 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29009 @end smallexample
29010
29011 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29012 following info:
29013
29014 @table @samp
29015 @item @var{level}
29016 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29017 @item @var{addr}
29018 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29019 @item @var{func}
29020 Function name.
29021 @item @var{file}
29022 File name of the source file where the function lives.
29023 @item @var{fullname}
29024 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29025 @item @var{line}
29026 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29027 @item @var{from}
29028 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29029 if the frame's function is not known.
29030 @end table
29031
29032 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29033 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29034 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29035 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29036 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29037 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29038 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29039 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29040 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29041
29042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29043
29044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29045
29046 @subsubheading Example
29047
29048 Full stack backtrace:
29049
29050 @smallexample
29051 (gdb)
29052 -stack-list-frames
29053 ^done,stack=
29054 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29055 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29056 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29057 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29058 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29059 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29060 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29061 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29062 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29063 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29064 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29065 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29066 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29067 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29068 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29069 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29070 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29071 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29072 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29073 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29074 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29075 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29076 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29077 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29078 (gdb)
29079 @end smallexample
29080
29081 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29082
29083 @smallexample
29084 (gdb)
29085 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29086 ^done,stack=
29087 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29088 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29089 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29090 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29091 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29092 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29093 (gdb)
29094 @end smallexample
29095
29096 Show a single frame:
29097
29098 @smallexample
29099 (gdb)
29100 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29101 ^done,stack=
29102 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29103 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29104 (gdb)
29105 @end smallexample
29106
29107
29108 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29109 @findex -stack-list-locals
29110 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29111
29112 @subsubheading Synopsis
29113
29114 @smallexample
29115 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29116 @end smallexample
29117
29118 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29119 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29120 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29121 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29122 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29123 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29124 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29125 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29126 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29127 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29128
29129 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29130 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29131 variables are still displayed, however.
29132
29133 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29134 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29135
29136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29137
29138 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29139
29140 @subsubheading Example
29141
29142 @smallexample
29143 (gdb)
29144 -stack-list-locals 0
29145 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29146 (gdb)
29147 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29148 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29149 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29150 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29151 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29152 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29153 (gdb)
29154 @end smallexample
29155
29156 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29157 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29158 @findex -stack-list-variables
29159
29160 @subsubheading Synopsis
29161
29162 @smallexample
29163 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29164 @end smallexample
29165
29166 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29167 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29168 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29169 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29170 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29171 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29172 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29173
29174 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29175 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29176 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29177
29178 @subsubheading Example
29179
29180 @smallexample
29181 (gdb)
29182 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29183 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29184 (gdb)
29185 @end smallexample
29186
29187
29188 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29189 @findex -stack-select-frame
29190
29191 @subsubheading Synopsis
29192
29193 @smallexample
29194 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29195 @end smallexample
29196
29197 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29198 the stack.
29199
29200 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29201 option to every command.
29202
29203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29204
29205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29206 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29207
29208 @subsubheading Example
29209
29210 @smallexample
29211 (gdb)
29212 -stack-select-frame 2
29213 ^done
29214 (gdb)
29215 @end smallexample
29216
29217 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29218 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29219 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29220
29221 @ignore
29222
29223 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29224
29225 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29226 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29227 used by @code{Insight}.
29228
29229 The two main reasons for that are:
29230
29231 @enumerate 1
29232 @item
29233 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29234
29235 @item
29236 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29237 now).
29238 @end enumerate
29239
29240 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29241 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29242 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29243 hints about their use.
29244
29245 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29246 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29247 least, the following operations:
29248
29249 @itemize @bullet
29250 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29251 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29252 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29253 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29254 @end itemize
29255
29256 @end ignore
29257
29258 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29259
29260 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29261
29262 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29263 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29264 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29265 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29266 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29267 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29268 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29269 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29270 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29271 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29272 object, or to change display format.
29273
29274 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29275 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29276 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29277 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29278 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29279 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29280 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29281 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29282 child will be created.
29283
29284 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29285 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29286 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29287 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29288 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29289
29290 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29291 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29292 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29293 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29294 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29295 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29296 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29297 variables that frontend has created.
29298
29299 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29300 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29301 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29302 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29303 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29304 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29305 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29306 implicitly updated.
29307
29308 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29309 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29310 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29311 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29312 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29313 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29314 frame. Consider this example:
29315
29316 @smallexample
29317 void do_work(...)
29318 @{
29319 struct work_state state;
29320
29321 if (...)
29322 do_work(...);
29323 @}
29324 @end smallexample
29325
29326 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29327 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29328 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29329 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29330 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29331
29332 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29333 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29334 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29335 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29336 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29337 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29338
29339 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29340 access this functionality:
29341
29342 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29343 @item @strong{Operation}
29344 @tab @strong{Description}
29345
29346 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29347 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29348 @item @code{-var-create}
29349 @tab create a variable object
29350 @item @code{-var-delete}
29351 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29352 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29353 @tab set the display format of this variable
29354 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29355 @tab show the display format of this variable
29356 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29357 @tab tells how many children this object has
29358 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29359 @tab return a list of the object's children
29360 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29361 @tab show the type of this variable object
29362 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29363 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29364 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29365 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29366 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29367 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29368 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29369 @tab get the value of this variable
29370 @item @code{-var-assign}
29371 @tab set the value of this variable
29372 @item @code{-var-update}
29373 @tab update the variable and its children
29374 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29375 @tab set frozeness attribute
29376 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29377 @tab set range of children to display on update
29378 @end multitable
29379
29380 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29381 how it can be used.
29382
29383 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29384
29385 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29386 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29387
29388 @smallexample
29389 -enable-pretty-printing
29390 @end smallexample
29391
29392 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29393 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29394 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29395 request that this functionality be enabled.
29396
29397 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29398
29399 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29400 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29401
29402 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29403 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29404
29405 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29406 @findex -var-create
29407
29408 @subsubheading Synopsis
29409
29410 @smallexample
29411 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29412 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29413 @end smallexample
29414
29415 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29416 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29417 register.
29418
29419 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29420 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29421 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29422 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29423 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29424
29425 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29426 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29427 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29428 object must be created.
29429
29430 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29431 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29432
29433 @itemize @bullet
29434 @item
29435 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29436
29437 @item
29438 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29439
29440 @item
29441 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29442 @end itemize
29443
29444 @cindex dynamic varobj
29445 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29446 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29447 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29448 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29449 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29450 compatibility for existing clients.
29451
29452 @subsubheading Result
29453
29454 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29455 are:
29456
29457 @table @samp
29458 @item name
29459 The name of the varobj.
29460
29461 @item numchild
29462 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29463 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29464 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29465
29466 @item value
29467 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29468 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29469 will not be interesting.
29470
29471 @item type
29472 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29473 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29474 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29475 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29476 @emph{declared} one.
29477
29478 @item thread-id
29479 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29480 thread's global identifier.
29481
29482 @item has_more
29483 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29484 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29485
29486 @item dynamic
29487 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29488 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29489 then this attribute will not be present.
29490
29491 @item displayhint
29492 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29493 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29494 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29495 @end table
29496
29497 Typical output will look like this:
29498
29499 @smallexample
29500 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29501 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29502 @end smallexample
29503
29504
29505 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29506 @findex -var-delete
29507
29508 @subsubheading Synopsis
29509
29510 @smallexample
29511 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29512 @end smallexample
29513
29514 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29515 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29516
29517 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29518
29519
29520 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29521 @findex -var-set-format
29522
29523 @subsubheading Synopsis
29524
29525 @smallexample
29526 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29527 @end smallexample
29528
29529 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29530 @var{format-spec}.
29531
29532 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29533 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29534
29535 @smallexample
29536 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29537 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29538 @end smallexample
29539
29540 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29541 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29542 for pointers, etc.).
29543
29544 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29545 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29546 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29547 zero-hexadecimal format.
29548
29549 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29550 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29551
29552 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29553 @findex -var-show-format
29554
29555 @subsubheading Synopsis
29556
29557 @smallexample
29558 -var-show-format @var{name}
29559 @end smallexample
29560
29561 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29562
29563 @smallexample
29564 @var{format} @expansion{}
29565 @var{format-spec}
29566 @end smallexample
29567
29568
29569 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29570 @findex -var-info-num-children
29571
29572 @subsubheading Synopsis
29573
29574 @smallexample
29575 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29576 @end smallexample
29577
29578 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29579
29580 @smallexample
29581 numchild=@var{n}
29582 @end smallexample
29583
29584 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29585 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29586 be available.
29587
29588
29589 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29590 @findex -var-list-children
29591
29592 @subsubheading Synopsis
29593
29594 @smallexample
29595 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29596 @end smallexample
29597 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29598
29599 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29600 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29601 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29602 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29603 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29604 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29605 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29606 and unions.
29607
29608 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29609 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29610 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29611 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29612 reported.
29613
29614 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29615 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29616 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29617 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29618 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29619 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29620 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29621 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29622 the visible items.
29623
29624 For each child the following results are returned:
29625
29626 @table @var
29627
29628 @item name
29629 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29630
29631 @item exp
29632 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29633 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29634
29635 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29636 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29637
29638 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29639 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29640 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29641 type and value are not present.
29642
29643 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29644 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29645 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29646
29647 @item numchild
29648 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29649 0.
29650
29651 @item type
29652 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29653 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29654 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29655 @emph{declared} one.
29656
29657 @item value
29658 If values were requested, this is the value.
29659
29660 @item thread-id
29661 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29662 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29663
29664 @item frozen
29665 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29666
29667 @item displayhint
29668 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29669 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29670 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29671
29672 @item dynamic
29673 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29674 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29675 then this attribute will not be present.
29676
29677 @end table
29678
29679 The result may have its own attributes:
29680
29681 @table @samp
29682 @item displayhint
29683 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29684 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29685 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29686
29687 @item has_more
29688 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29689 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29690 @end table
29691
29692 @subsubheading Example
29693
29694 @smallexample
29695 (gdb)
29696 -var-list-children n
29697 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29698 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29699 (gdb)
29700 -var-list-children --all-values n
29701 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29702 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29703 @end smallexample
29704
29705
29706 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29707 @findex -var-info-type
29708
29709 @subsubheading Synopsis
29710
29711 @smallexample
29712 -var-info-type @var{name}
29713 @end smallexample
29714
29715 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29716 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29717 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29718
29719 @smallexample
29720 type=@var{typename}
29721 @end smallexample
29722
29723
29724 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29725 @findex -var-info-expression
29726
29727 @subsubheading Synopsis
29728
29729 @smallexample
29730 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29731 @end smallexample
29732
29733 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29734 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29735 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29736
29737 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29738 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29739
29740 @smallexample
29741 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29742 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29743 @end smallexample
29744
29745 @noindent
29746 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29747 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29748
29749 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29750 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29751 is of limited use.
29752
29753 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29754 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29755
29756 @subsubheading Synopsis
29757
29758 @smallexample
29759 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29760 @end smallexample
29761
29762 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29763 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29764 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29765 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29766 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29767 watchpoint from a variable object.
29768
29769 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29770 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29771
29772 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29773 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29774 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29775 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29776 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29777 @smallexample
29778 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29779 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29780 @end smallexample
29781
29782 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29783 @findex -var-show-attributes
29784
29785 @subsubheading Synopsis
29786
29787 @smallexample
29788 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29789 @end smallexample
29790
29791 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29792
29793 @smallexample
29794 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29795 @end smallexample
29796
29797 @noindent
29798 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29799
29800 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29801 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29802
29803 @subsubheading Synopsis
29804
29805 @smallexample
29806 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29807 @end smallexample
29808
29809 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29810 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29811 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29812 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29813 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29814 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29815 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29816
29817 @smallexample
29818 value=@var{value}
29819 @end smallexample
29820
29821 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29822 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29823
29824 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29825 @findex -var-assign
29826
29827 @subsubheading Synopsis
29828
29829 @smallexample
29830 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29831 @end smallexample
29832
29833 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29834 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29835 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29836 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29837
29838 @subsubheading Example
29839
29840 @smallexample
29841 (gdb)
29842 -var-assign var1 3
29843 ^done,value="3"
29844 (gdb)
29845 -var-update *
29846 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29847 (gdb)
29848 @end smallexample
29849
29850 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29851 @findex -var-update
29852
29853 @subsubheading Synopsis
29854
29855 @smallexample
29856 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29857 @end smallexample
29858
29859 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29860 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29861 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29862 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29863 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29864 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29865 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29866 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29867 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29868 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29869 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29870 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29871 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29872
29873 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29874 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29875 diagnostic.
29876
29877 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29878 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29879
29880 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29881 @samp{changelist}.
29882
29883 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29884
29885 @table @samp
29886 @item name
29887 The name of the varobj.
29888
29889 @item value
29890 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29891 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29892
29893 @item in_scope
29894 @anchor{-var-update}
29895 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29896
29897 @table @code
29898 @item "true"
29899 The variable object's current value is valid.
29900
29901 @item "false"
29902 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29903 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29904 scope.
29905
29906 @item "invalid"
29907 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29908 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29909 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29910 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29911 objects.
29912 @end table
29913
29914 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29915 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29916
29917 @item type_changed
29918 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29919 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29920 be @samp{false}.
29921
29922 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29923 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29924 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29925 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29926 unset.
29927
29928 @item new_type
29929 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29930 hold the new type.
29931
29932 @item new_num_children
29933 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29934 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29935
29936 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29937 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29938 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29939 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29940 children which may be available.
29941
29942 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29943 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29944 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29945 only happen at the end of the update range).
29946
29947 @item displayhint
29948 The display hint, if any.
29949
29950 @item has_more
29951 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29952 available outside the varobj's update range.
29953
29954 @item dynamic
29955 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29956 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29957 then this attribute will not be present.
29958
29959 @item new_children
29960 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29961 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29962 be listed in this attribute.
29963 @end table
29964
29965 @subsubheading Example
29966
29967 @smallexample
29968 (gdb)
29969 -var-assign var1 3
29970 ^done,value="3"
29971 (gdb)
29972 -var-update --all-values var1
29973 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29974 type_changed="false"@}]
29975 (gdb)
29976 @end smallexample
29977
29978 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29979 @findex -var-set-frozen
29980 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29981
29982 @subsubheading Synopsis
29983
29984 @smallexample
29985 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29986 @end smallexample
29987
29988 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29989 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29990 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29991 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29992 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29993 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29994 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29995 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29996 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29997 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29998 @code{-var-update} does.
29999
30000 @subsubheading Example
30001
30002 @smallexample
30003 (gdb)
30004 -var-set-frozen V 1
30005 ^done
30006 (gdb)
30007 @end smallexample
30008
30009 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30010 @findex -var-set-update-range
30011 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30012
30013 @subsubheading Synopsis
30014
30015 @smallexample
30016 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30017 @end smallexample
30018
30019 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30020 @code{-var-update}.
30021
30022 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30023 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30024 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30025 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30026
30027 @subsubheading Example
30028
30029 @smallexample
30030 (gdb)
30031 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
30032 ^done
30033 @end smallexample
30034
30035 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30036 @findex -var-set-visualizer
30037 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30038
30039 @subsubheading Synopsis
30040
30041 @smallexample
30042 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30043 @end smallexample
30044
30045 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30046
30047 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30048 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30049
30050 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30051 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30052 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30053 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30054 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30055 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30056 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30057
30058 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30059 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30060 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30061 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30062
30063 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30064 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30065 can be used to check this.
30066
30067 @subsubheading Example
30068
30069 Resetting the visualizer:
30070
30071 @smallexample
30072 (gdb)
30073 -var-set-visualizer V None
30074 ^done
30075 @end smallexample
30076
30077 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30078
30079 @smallexample
30080 (gdb)
30081 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30082 ^done
30083 @end smallexample
30084
30085 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30086 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30087
30088 @smallexample
30089 (gdb)
30090 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30091 ^done
30092 @end smallexample
30093
30094 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30095 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30096 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30097
30098 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30099 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30100 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30101 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30102
30103 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30104 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30105
30106 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30107 @c @subheading -data-assign
30108 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30109 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30110 @c set variable
30111 @c @subsubheading Example
30112 @c N.A.
30113
30114 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30115 @findex -data-disassemble
30116
30117 @subsubheading Synopsis
30118
30119 @smallexample
30120 -data-disassemble
30121 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30122 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30123 -- @var{mode}
30124 @end smallexample
30125
30126 @noindent
30127 Where:
30128
30129 @table @samp
30130 @item @var{start-addr}
30131 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30132 @item @var{end-addr}
30133 is the end address
30134 @item @var{filename}
30135 is the name of the file to disassemble
30136 @item @var{linenum}
30137 is the line number to disassemble around
30138 @item @var{lines}
30139 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30140 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30141 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30142 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30143 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30144 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30145 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30146 are displayed.
30147 @item @var{mode}
30148 is one of:
30149 @itemize @bullet
30150 @item 0 disassembly only
30151 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30152 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30153 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30154 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30155 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30156 @end itemize
30157
30158 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30159 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30160 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30161 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30162 @end table
30163
30164 @subsubheading Result
30165
30166 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30167 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30168 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30169
30170 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30171 following fields:
30172
30173 @table @code
30174 @item address
30175 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30176
30177 @item func-name
30178 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30179
30180 @item offset
30181 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30182
30183 @item inst
30184 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30185
30186 @item opcodes
30187 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30188 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30189
30190 @end table
30191
30192 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30193 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30194
30195 @table @code
30196 @item line
30197 The line number within @samp{file}.
30198
30199 @item file
30200 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30201 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30202 used.
30203
30204 @item fullname
30205 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30206 using the source file search path
30207 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30208 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30209
30210 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30211 present in the debug information.
30212
30213 @item line_asm_insn
30214 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30215 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30216 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30217 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30218 @samp{opcodes}.
30219
30220 @end table
30221
30222 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30223 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30224 adjust its format.
30225
30226 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30227
30228 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30229
30230 @subsubheading Example
30231
30232 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30233
30234 @smallexample
30235 (gdb)
30236 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30237 ^done,
30238 asm_insns=[
30239 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30240 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30241 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30242 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30243 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30244 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30245 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30246 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30247 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30248 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30249 (gdb)
30250 @end smallexample
30251
30252 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30253 @code{main}.
30254
30255 @smallexample
30256 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30257 ^done,asm_insns=[
30258 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30259 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30260 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30261 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30262 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30263 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30264 [@dots{}]
30265 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30266 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30267 (gdb)
30268 @end smallexample
30269
30270 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30271
30272 @smallexample
30273 (gdb)
30274 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30275 ^done,asm_insns=[
30276 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30277 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30278 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30279 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30280 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30281 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30282 (gdb)
30283 @end smallexample
30284
30285 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30286
30287 @smallexample
30288 (gdb)
30289 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30290 ^done,asm_insns=[
30291 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30292 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30293 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30294 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30295 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30296 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30297 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30298 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30299 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30300 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30301 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30302 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30303 (gdb)
30304 @end smallexample
30305
30306
30307 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30308 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30309
30310 @subsubheading Synopsis
30311
30312 @smallexample
30313 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30314 @end smallexample
30315
30316 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30317 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30318 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30319
30320 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30321
30322 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30323 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30324 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30325
30326 @subsubheading Example
30327
30328 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30329 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30330 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30331 output.
30332
30333 @smallexample
30334 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30335 211^done,value="1"
30336 (gdb)
30337 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30338 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30339 (gdb)
30340 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30341 411^done,value="4"
30342 (gdb)
30343 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30344 511^done,value="4"
30345 (gdb)
30346 @end smallexample
30347
30348
30349 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30350 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30351
30352 @subsubheading Synopsis
30353
30354 @smallexample
30355 -data-list-changed-registers
30356 @end smallexample
30357
30358 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30359
30360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30361
30362 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30363 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30364
30365 @subsubheading Example
30366
30367 On a PPC MBX board:
30368
30369 @smallexample
30370 (gdb)
30371 -exec-continue
30372 ^running
30373
30374 (gdb)
30375 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30376 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30377 line="5"@}
30378 (gdb)
30379 -data-list-changed-registers
30380 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30381 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30382 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30383 (gdb)
30384 @end smallexample
30385
30386
30387 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30388 @findex -data-list-register-names
30389
30390 @subsubheading Synopsis
30391
30392 @smallexample
30393 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30394 @end smallexample
30395
30396 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30397 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30398 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30399 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30400 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30401 include empty register names.
30402
30403 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30404
30405 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30406 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30407 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30408
30409 @subsubheading Example
30410
30411 For the PPC MBX board:
30412 @smallexample
30413 (gdb)
30414 -data-list-register-names
30415 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30416 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30417 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30418 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30419 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30420 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30421 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30422 (gdb)
30423 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30424 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30425 (gdb)
30426 @end smallexample
30427
30428 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30429 @findex -data-list-register-values
30430
30431 @subsubheading Synopsis
30432
30433 @smallexample
30434 -data-list-register-values
30435 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30436 @end smallexample
30437
30438 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30439 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30440 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30441 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30442 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30443 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30444
30445 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30446
30447 @table @code
30448 @item x
30449 Hexadecimal
30450 @item o
30451 Octal
30452 @item t
30453 Binary
30454 @item d
30455 Decimal
30456 @item r
30457 Raw
30458 @item N
30459 Natural
30460 @end table
30461
30462 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30463
30464 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30465 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30466
30467 @subsubheading Example
30468
30469 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30470 don't appear in the actual output):
30471
30472 @smallexample
30473 (gdb)
30474 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30475 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30476 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30477 (gdb)
30478 -data-list-register-values x
30479 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30480 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30481 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30482 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30483 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30484 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30485 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30486 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30487 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30488 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30489 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30490 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30491 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30492 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30493 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30494 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30495 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30496 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30497 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30498 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30499 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30500 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30501 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30502 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30503 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30504 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30505 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30506 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30507 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30508 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30509 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30510 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30511 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30512 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30513 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30514 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30515 (gdb)
30516 @end smallexample
30517
30518
30519 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30520 @findex -data-read-memory
30521
30522 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30523
30524 @subsubheading Synopsis
30525
30526 @smallexample
30527 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30528 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30529 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30530 @end smallexample
30531
30532 @noindent
30533 where:
30534
30535 @table @samp
30536 @item @var{address}
30537 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30538 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30539 quoted using the C convention.
30540
30541 @item @var{word-format}
30542 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30543 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30544 ,Output Formats}).
30545
30546 @item @var{word-size}
30547 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30548
30549 @item @var{nr-rows}
30550 The number of rows in the output table.
30551
30552 @item @var{nr-cols}
30553 The number of columns in the output table.
30554
30555 @item @var{aschar}
30556 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30557 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30558 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30559 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30560
30561 @item @var{byte-offset}
30562 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30563 @end table
30564
30565 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30566 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30567 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30568 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30569 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30570 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30571 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30572 @samp{addr}.
30573
30574 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30575 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30576 @samp{prev-page}.
30577
30578 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30579
30580 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30581 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30582
30583 @subsubheading Example
30584
30585 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30586 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30587 word. Display each word in hex.
30588
30589 @smallexample
30590 (gdb)
30591 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30592 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30593 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30594 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30595 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30596 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30597 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30598 (gdb)
30599 @end smallexample
30600
30601 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30602 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30603
30604 @smallexample
30605 (gdb)
30606 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30607 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30608 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30609 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30610 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30611 (gdb)
30612 @end smallexample
30613
30614 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30615 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30616 used as the non-printable character.
30617
30618 @smallexample
30619 (gdb)
30620 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30621 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30622 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30623 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30624 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30625 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30626 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30627 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30628 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30629 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30630 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30631 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30632 (gdb)
30633 @end smallexample
30634
30635 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30636 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30637
30638 @subsubheading Synopsis
30639
30640 @smallexample
30641 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30642 @var{address} @var{count}
30643 @end smallexample
30644
30645 @noindent
30646 where:
30647
30648 @table @samp
30649 @item @var{address}
30650 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30651 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30652 quoted using the C convention.
30653
30654 @item @var{count}
30655 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30656 literal.
30657
30658 @item @var{offset}
30659 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30660 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30661 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30662 arithmetics itself.
30663
30664 @end table
30665
30666 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30667 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30668 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30669 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30670 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30671 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30672
30673 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30674 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30675 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30676 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30677 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30678 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30679 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30680 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30681
30682 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30683 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30684 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30685 and has the following fields:
30686
30687 @table @code
30688 @item begin
30689 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30690
30691 @item end
30692 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30693
30694 @item offset
30695 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30696 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30697
30698 @item contents
30699 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30700
30701 @end table
30702
30703
30704
30705 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30706
30707 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30708
30709 @subsubheading Example
30710
30711 @smallexample
30712 (gdb)
30713 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30714 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30715 end="0xbffff15e",
30716 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30717 (gdb)
30718 @end smallexample
30719
30720
30721 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30722 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30723
30724 @subsubheading Synopsis
30725
30726 @smallexample
30727 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30728 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30729 @end smallexample
30730
30731 @noindent
30732 where:
30733
30734 @table @samp
30735 @item @var{address}
30736 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30737 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30738 be quoted using the C convention.
30739
30740 @item @var{contents}
30741 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30742 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30743
30744 @item @var{count}
30745 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30746 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30747 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30748 @var{count} memory units.
30749
30750 @end table
30751
30752 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30753
30754 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30755
30756 @subsubheading Example
30757
30758 @smallexample
30759 (gdb)
30760 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30761 ^done
30762 (gdb)
30763 @end smallexample
30764
30765 @smallexample
30766 (gdb)
30767 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30768 ^done
30769 (gdb)
30770 @end smallexample
30771
30772 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30773 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30774 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30775
30776 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30777 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30778
30779 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30780 @findex -trace-find
30781
30782 @subsubheading Synopsis
30783
30784 @smallexample
30785 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30786 @end smallexample
30787
30788 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30789 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30790 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30791
30792 @table @samp
30793
30794 @item none
30795 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30796
30797 @item frame-number
30798 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30799 that index.
30800
30801 @item tracepoint-number
30802 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30803 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30804
30805 @item pc
30806 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30807 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30808 address.
30809
30810 @item pc-inside-range
30811 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30812 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30813 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30814
30815 @item pc-outside-range
30816 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30817 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30818 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30819
30820 @item line
30821 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30822 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30823 the specified location.
30824
30825 @end table
30826
30827 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30828 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30829
30830 @table @samp
30831 @item found
30832 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30833 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30834
30835 @item traceframe
30836 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30837 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30838
30839 @item tracepoint
30840 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30841 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30842
30843 @item frame
30844 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30845 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30846 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30847
30848 @end table
30849
30850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30851
30852 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30853
30854 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30855 @findex -trace-define-variable
30856
30857 @subsubheading Synopsis
30858
30859 @smallexample
30860 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30861 @end smallexample
30862
30863 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30864 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30865 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30866 with the @samp{$} character.
30867
30868 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30869
30870 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30871
30872 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30873 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30874
30875 @subsubheading Synopsis
30876
30877 @smallexample
30878 -trace-frame-collected
30879 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30880 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30881 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30882 [--memory-contents]
30883 @end smallexample
30884
30885 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30886 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30887 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30888 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30889 See the output description table below for more details.
30890
30891 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30892 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30893 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30894 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30895 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30896
30897 For instance, if the actions were
30898 @smallexample
30899 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30900 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30901 @end smallexample
30902
30903 @noindent
30904 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30905 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30906 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30907 objects would be computed expressions.
30908
30909 An example output would be:
30910
30911 @smallexample
30912 (gdb)
30913 -trace-frame-collected
30914 ^done,
30915 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30916 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30917 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30918 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30919 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30920 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30921 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30922 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30923 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30924 ...
30925 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30926 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30927 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30928 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30929 (gdb)
30930 @end smallexample
30931
30932 Where:
30933
30934 @table @code
30935 @item explicit-variables
30936 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30937 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30938 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30939 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30940 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30941 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30942 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30943 arrays, structures and unions.
30944
30945 @item computed-expressions
30946 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30947 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30948 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30949 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30950
30951 @item registers
30952 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30953 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30954 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30955 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30956 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30957
30958 @item tvars
30959 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30960 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30961 current value are returned.
30962
30963 @item memory
30964 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30965 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30966 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30967
30968 @table @code
30969 @item address
30970 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30971
30972 @item length
30973 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30974
30975 @item contents
30976 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30977 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30978
30979 @end table
30980
30981 @end table
30982
30983 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30984
30985 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30986
30987 @subsubheading Example
30988
30989 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30990 @findex -trace-list-variables
30991
30992 @subsubheading Synopsis
30993
30994 @smallexample
30995 -trace-list-variables
30996 @end smallexample
30997
30998 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30999 table has the following fields:
31000
31001 @table @samp
31002 @item name
31003 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31004
31005 @item initial
31006 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31007 field is always present.
31008
31009 @item current
31010 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31011 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31012 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31013 presently running.
31014
31015 @end table
31016
31017 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31018
31019 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31020
31021 @subsubheading Example
31022
31023 @smallexample
31024 (gdb)
31025 -trace-list-variables
31026 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31027 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31028 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31029 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31030 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31031 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31032 (gdb)
31033 @end smallexample
31034
31035 @subheading -trace-save
31036 @findex -trace-save
31037
31038 @subsubheading Synopsis
31039
31040 @smallexample
31041 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31042 @end smallexample
31043
31044 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31045 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31046 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31047 to perform the save.
31048
31049 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
31050 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31051 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31052
31053 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31054
31055 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31056
31057
31058 @subheading -trace-start
31059 @findex -trace-start
31060
31061 @subsubheading Synopsis
31062
31063 @smallexample
31064 -trace-start
31065 @end smallexample
31066
31067 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31068 have any fields.
31069
31070 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31071
31072 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31073
31074 @subheading -trace-status
31075 @findex -trace-status
31076
31077 @subsubheading Synopsis
31078
31079 @smallexample
31080 -trace-status
31081 @end smallexample
31082
31083 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31084 the following fields:
31085
31086 @table @samp
31087
31088 @item supported
31089 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31090 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31091 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31092 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31093 started. This field is always present.
31094
31095 @item running
31096 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31097 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31098 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31099
31100 @item stop-reason
31101 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31102 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31103 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31104 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31105 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31106 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31107 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31108 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31109 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31110
31111 @item stopping-tracepoint
31112 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31113 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31114 @samp{passcount}.
31115
31116 @item frames
31117 @itemx frames-created
31118 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31119 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31120 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31121 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31122
31123 @item buffer-size
31124 @itemx buffer-free
31125 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31126 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31127
31128 @item circular
31129 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31130 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31131 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31132 and may fill up.
31133
31134 @item disconnected
31135 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31136 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31137 that the trace run will stop.
31138
31139 @item trace-file
31140 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31141 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31142
31143 @end table
31144
31145 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31146
31147 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31148
31149 @subheading -trace-stop
31150 @findex -trace-stop
31151
31152 @subsubheading Synopsis
31153
31154 @smallexample
31155 -trace-stop
31156 @end smallexample
31157
31158 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31159 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31160 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31161
31162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31163
31164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31165
31166
31167 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31168 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31169 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31170
31171
31172 @ignore
31173 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31174 @findex -symbol-info-address
31175
31176 @subsubheading Synopsis
31177
31178 @smallexample
31179 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31180 @end smallexample
31181
31182 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31183
31184 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31185
31186 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31187
31188 @subsubheading Example
31189 N.A.
31190
31191
31192 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31193 @findex -symbol-info-file
31194
31195 @subsubheading Synopsis
31196
31197 @smallexample
31198 -symbol-info-file
31199 @end smallexample
31200
31201 Show the file for the symbol.
31202
31203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31204
31205 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31206 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31207
31208 @subsubheading Example
31209 N.A.
31210
31211
31212 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31213 @findex -symbol-info-function
31214
31215 @subsubheading Synopsis
31216
31217 @smallexample
31218 -symbol-info-function
31219 @end smallexample
31220
31221 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31222
31223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31224
31225 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31226
31227 @subsubheading Example
31228 N.A.
31229
31230
31231 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31232 @findex -symbol-info-line
31233
31234 @subsubheading Synopsis
31235
31236 @smallexample
31237 -symbol-info-line
31238 @end smallexample
31239
31240 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31241
31242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31243
31244 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31245 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31246
31247 @subsubheading Example
31248 N.A.
31249
31250
31251 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31252 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31253
31254 @subsubheading Synopsis
31255
31256 @smallexample
31257 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31258 @end smallexample
31259
31260 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31261
31262 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31263
31264 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31265
31266 @subsubheading Example
31267 N.A.
31268
31269
31270 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31271 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31272
31273 @subsubheading Synopsis
31274
31275 @smallexample
31276 -symbol-list-functions
31277 @end smallexample
31278
31279 List the functions in the executable.
31280
31281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31282
31283 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31284 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31285
31286 @subsubheading Example
31287 N.A.
31288 @end ignore
31289
31290
31291 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31292 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31293
31294 @subsubheading Synopsis
31295
31296 @smallexample
31297 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31298 @end smallexample
31299
31300 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31301 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31302 ascending PC order.
31303
31304 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31305
31306 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31307
31308 @subsubheading Example
31309 @smallexample
31310 (gdb)
31311 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31312 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31313 (gdb)
31314 @end smallexample
31315
31316
31317 @ignore
31318 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31319 @findex -symbol-list-types
31320
31321 @subsubheading Synopsis
31322
31323 @smallexample
31324 -symbol-list-types
31325 @end smallexample
31326
31327 List all the type names.
31328
31329 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31330
31331 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31332 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31333
31334 @subsubheading Example
31335 N.A.
31336
31337
31338 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31339 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31340
31341 @subsubheading Synopsis
31342
31343 @smallexample
31344 -symbol-list-variables
31345 @end smallexample
31346
31347 List all the global and static variable names.
31348
31349 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31350
31351 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31352
31353 @subsubheading Example
31354 N.A.
31355
31356
31357 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31358 @findex -symbol-locate
31359
31360 @subsubheading Synopsis
31361
31362 @smallexample
31363 -symbol-locate
31364 @end smallexample
31365
31366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31367
31368 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31369
31370 @subsubheading Example
31371 N.A.
31372
31373
31374 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31375 @findex -symbol-type
31376
31377 @subsubheading Synopsis
31378
31379 @smallexample
31380 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31381 @end smallexample
31382
31383 Show type of @var{variable}.
31384
31385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31386
31387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31388 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31389
31390 @subsubheading Example
31391 N.A.
31392 @end ignore
31393
31394
31395 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31396 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31397 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31398
31399 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31400 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31401
31402 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31403 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31404
31405 @subsubheading Synopsis
31406
31407 @smallexample
31408 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31409 @end smallexample
31410
31411 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31412 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31413 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31414 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31415 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31416 notification.
31417
31418 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31419
31420 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31421
31422 @subsubheading Example
31423
31424 @smallexample
31425 (gdb)
31426 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31427 ^done
31428 (gdb)
31429 @end smallexample
31430
31431
31432 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31433 @findex -file-exec-file
31434
31435 @subsubheading Synopsis
31436
31437 @smallexample
31438 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31439 @end smallexample
31440
31441 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31442 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31443 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31444 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31445 notification.
31446
31447 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31448
31449 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31450
31451 @subsubheading Example
31452
31453 @smallexample
31454 (gdb)
31455 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31456 ^done
31457 (gdb)
31458 @end smallexample
31459
31460
31461 @ignore
31462 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31463 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31464
31465 @subsubheading Synopsis
31466
31467 @smallexample
31468 -file-list-exec-sections
31469 @end smallexample
31470
31471 List the sections of the current executable file.
31472
31473 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31474
31475 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31476 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31477 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31478
31479 @subsubheading Example
31480 N.A.
31481 @end ignore
31482
31483
31484 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31485 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31486
31487 @subsubheading Synopsis
31488
31489 @smallexample
31490 -file-list-exec-source-file
31491 @end smallexample
31492
31493 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31494 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31495 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31496 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31497
31498 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31499
31500 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31501
31502 @subsubheading Example
31503
31504 @smallexample
31505 (gdb)
31506 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31507 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31508 (gdb)
31509 @end smallexample
31510
31511
31512 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31513 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31514
31515 @subsubheading Synopsis
31516
31517 @smallexample
31518 -file-list-exec-source-files
31519 @end smallexample
31520
31521 List the source files for the current executable.
31522
31523 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31524 name) of a source file.
31525
31526 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31527
31528 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31529 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31530
31531 @subsubheading Example
31532 @smallexample
31533 (gdb)
31534 -file-list-exec-source-files
31535 ^done,files=[
31536 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31537 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31538 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31539 (gdb)
31540 @end smallexample
31541
31542 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31543 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31544
31545 @subsubheading Synopsis
31546
31547 @smallexample
31548 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
31549 @end smallexample
31550
31551 List the shared libraries in the program.
31552 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
31553 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31554
31555 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31556
31557 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
31558 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
31559 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
31560 library. Each range has the following fields:
31561
31562 @table @samp
31563 @item from
31564 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
31565 @item to
31566 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
31567 @end table
31568
31569 @subsubheading Example
31570 @smallexample
31571 (gdb)
31572 -file-list-exec-source-files
31573 ^done,shared-libraries=[
31574 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
31575 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
31576 (gdb)
31577 @end smallexample
31578
31579
31580 @ignore
31581 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31582 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31583
31584 @subsubheading Synopsis
31585
31586 @smallexample
31587 -file-list-symbol-files
31588 @end smallexample
31589
31590 List symbol files.
31591
31592 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31593
31594 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31595
31596 @subsubheading Example
31597 N.A.
31598 @end ignore
31599
31600
31601 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31602 @findex -file-symbol-file
31603
31604 @subsubheading Synopsis
31605
31606 @smallexample
31607 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31608 @end smallexample
31609
31610 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31611 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31612 produced, except for a completion notification.
31613
31614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31615
31616 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31617
31618 @subsubheading Example
31619
31620 @smallexample
31621 (gdb)
31622 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31623 ^done
31624 (gdb)
31625 @end smallexample
31626
31627 @ignore
31628 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31629 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31630 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31631
31632 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31633
31634 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31635
31636 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31637
31638 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31639
31640 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31641
31642 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31643
31644 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31645
31646 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31647
31648 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31649 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31650 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31651
31652 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31653
31654 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31655
31656 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31657
31658 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31659 @end ignore
31660
31661
31662 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31663 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31664 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31665
31666
31667 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31668 @findex -target-attach
31669
31670 @subsubheading Synopsis
31671
31672 @smallexample
31673 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31674 @end smallexample
31675
31676 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31677 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31678 group, the id previously returned by
31679 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31680
31681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31682
31683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31684
31685 @subsubheading Example
31686 @smallexample
31687 (gdb)
31688 -target-attach 34
31689 =thread-created,id="1"
31690 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31691 ^done
31692 (gdb)
31693 @end smallexample
31694
31695 @ignore
31696 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31697 @findex -target-compare-sections
31698
31699 @subsubheading Synopsis
31700
31701 @smallexample
31702 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31703 @end smallexample
31704
31705 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31706 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31707
31708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31709
31710 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31711
31712 @subsubheading Example
31713 N.A.
31714 @end ignore
31715
31716
31717 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31718 @findex -target-detach
31719
31720 @subsubheading Synopsis
31721
31722 @smallexample
31723 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31724 @end smallexample
31725
31726 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31727 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31728 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31729
31730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31731
31732 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31733
31734 @subsubheading Example
31735
31736 @smallexample
31737 (gdb)
31738 -target-detach
31739 ^done
31740 (gdb)
31741 @end smallexample
31742
31743
31744 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31745 @findex -target-disconnect
31746
31747 @subsubheading Synopsis
31748
31749 @smallexample
31750 -target-disconnect
31751 @end smallexample
31752
31753 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31754 generally not resumed.
31755
31756 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31757
31758 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31759
31760 @subsubheading Example
31761
31762 @smallexample
31763 (gdb)
31764 -target-disconnect
31765 ^done
31766 (gdb)
31767 @end smallexample
31768
31769
31770 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31771 @findex -target-download
31772
31773 @subsubheading Synopsis
31774
31775 @smallexample
31776 -target-download
31777 @end smallexample
31778
31779 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31780 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31781
31782 @table @samp
31783 @item section
31784 The name of the section.
31785 @item section-sent
31786 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31787 @item section-size
31788 The size of the section.
31789 @item total-sent
31790 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31791 @item total-size
31792 The size of the overall executable to download.
31793 @end table
31794
31795 @noindent
31796 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31797 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31798
31799 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31800 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31801
31802 @table @samp
31803 @item section
31804 The name of the section.
31805 @item section-size
31806 The size of the section.
31807 @item total-size
31808 The size of the overall executable to download.
31809 @end table
31810
31811 @noindent
31812 At the end, a summary is printed.
31813
31814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31815
31816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31817
31818 @subsubheading Example
31819
31820 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31821 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31822
31823 @smallexample
31824 (gdb)
31825 -target-download
31826 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31827 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31828 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31829 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31830 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31831 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31832 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31833 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31834 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31835 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31836 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31837 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31838 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31839 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31840 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31841 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31842 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31843 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31844 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31845 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31846 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31847 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31848 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31849 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31850 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31851 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31852 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31853 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31854 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31855 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31856 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31857 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31858 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31859 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31860 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31861 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31862 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31863 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31864 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31865 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31866 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31867 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31868 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31869 write-rate="429"
31870 (gdb)
31871 @end smallexample
31872
31873
31874 @ignore
31875 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31876 @findex -target-exec-status
31877
31878 @subsubheading Synopsis
31879
31880 @smallexample
31881 -target-exec-status
31882 @end smallexample
31883
31884 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31885 not, for instance).
31886
31887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31888
31889 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31890
31891 @subsubheading Example
31892 N.A.
31893
31894
31895 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31896 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31897
31898 @subsubheading Synopsis
31899
31900 @smallexample
31901 -target-list-available-targets
31902 @end smallexample
31903
31904 List the possible targets to connect to.
31905
31906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31907
31908 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31909
31910 @subsubheading Example
31911 N.A.
31912
31913
31914 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31915 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31916
31917 @subsubheading Synopsis
31918
31919 @smallexample
31920 -target-list-current-targets
31921 @end smallexample
31922
31923 Describe the current target.
31924
31925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31926
31927 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31928 other things).
31929
31930 @subsubheading Example
31931 N.A.
31932
31933
31934 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31935 @findex -target-list-parameters
31936
31937 @subsubheading Synopsis
31938
31939 @smallexample
31940 -target-list-parameters
31941 @end smallexample
31942
31943 @c ????
31944 @end ignore
31945
31946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31947
31948 No equivalent.
31949
31950 @subsubheading Example
31951 N.A.
31952
31953 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
31954 @findex -target-flash-erase
31955
31956 @subsubheading Synopsis
31957
31958 @smallexample
31959 -target-flash-erase
31960 @end smallexample
31961
31962 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
31963
31964 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
31965
31966 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
31967 addresses and memory region sizes.
31968
31969 @smallexample
31970 (gdb)
31971 -target-flash-erase
31972 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
31973 (gdb)
31974 @end smallexample
31975
31976 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31977 @findex -target-select
31978
31979 @subsubheading Synopsis
31980
31981 @smallexample
31982 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31983 @end smallexample
31984
31985 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31986
31987 @table @samp
31988 @item @var{type}
31989 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31990 @item @var{parameters}
31991 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31992 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31993 @end table
31994
31995 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31996 which the target program is, in the following form:
31997
31998 @smallexample
31999 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32000 args=[@var{arg list}]
32001 @end smallexample
32002
32003 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32004
32005 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32006
32007 @subsubheading Example
32008
32009 @smallexample
32010 (gdb)
32011 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
32012 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32013 (gdb)
32014 @end smallexample
32015
32016 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32017 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32018 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32019
32020
32021 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32022 @findex -target-file-put
32023
32024 @subsubheading Synopsis
32025
32026 @smallexample
32027 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32028 @end smallexample
32029
32030 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32031 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32032
32033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32034
32035 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32036
32037 @subsubheading Example
32038
32039 @smallexample
32040 (gdb)
32041 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
32042 ^done
32043 (gdb)
32044 @end smallexample
32045
32046
32047 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32048 @findex -target-file-get
32049
32050 @subsubheading Synopsis
32051
32052 @smallexample
32053 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32054 @end smallexample
32055
32056 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32057 on the host system.
32058
32059 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32060
32061 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32062
32063 @subsubheading Example
32064
32065 @smallexample
32066 (gdb)
32067 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
32068 ^done
32069 (gdb)
32070 @end smallexample
32071
32072
32073 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32074 @findex -target-file-delete
32075
32076 @subsubheading Synopsis
32077
32078 @smallexample
32079 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32080 @end smallexample
32081
32082 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32083
32084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32085
32086 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32087
32088 @subsubheading Example
32089
32090 @smallexample
32091 (gdb)
32092 -target-file-delete remotefile
32093 ^done
32094 (gdb)
32095 @end smallexample
32096
32097
32098 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32099 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32100 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32101
32102 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32103 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
32104
32105 @subsubheading Synopsis
32106
32107 @smallexample
32108 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32109 @end smallexample
32110
32111 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32112 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32113 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32114
32115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32116
32117 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32118
32119 @subsubheading Result
32120
32121 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32122 defined for each exception:
32123
32124 @table @samp
32125 @item name
32126 The name of the exception.
32127
32128 @item address
32129 The address of the exception.
32130
32131 @end table
32132
32133 @subsubheading Example
32134
32135 @smallexample
32136 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32137 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32138 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32139 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32140 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32141 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32142 @end smallexample
32143
32144 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32145
32146 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32147 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32148 Catchpoint Commands}.
32149
32150
32151 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32152 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32153 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32154
32155 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32156 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32157 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32158 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32159
32160 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32161 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32162 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32163
32164 @subsubheading Synopsis
32165
32166 @smallexample
32167 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32168 @end smallexample
32169
32170 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32171
32172 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32173 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32174 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32175 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32176 dash.
32177
32178 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32179
32180 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32181
32182 @subsubheading Result
32183
32184 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32185
32186 @table @samp
32187 @item exists
32188 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32189 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32190
32191 @end table
32192
32193 @subsubheading Example
32194
32195 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32196
32197 @smallexample
32198 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32199 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32200 @end smallexample
32201
32202 @noindent
32203 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32204 to the debugger:
32205
32206 @smallexample
32207 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32208 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32209 @end smallexample
32210
32211 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32212 @findex -list-features
32213 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32214
32215 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32216 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32217 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32218 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32219 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32220 startup.
32221
32222 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32223 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32224 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32225 is given below.
32226
32227 Example output:
32228
32229 @smallexample
32230 (gdb) -list-features
32231 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32232 @end smallexample
32233
32234 The current list of features is:
32235
32236 @ftable @samp
32237 @item frozen-varobjs
32238 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32239 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32240 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32241 @item pending-breakpoints
32242 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32243 command.
32244 @item python
32245 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32246 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32247 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32248 @item thread-info
32249 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32250 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32251 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32252 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32253 @item breakpoint-notifications
32254 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32255 CLI will be announced via async records.
32256 @item ada-task-info
32257 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32258 @item language-option
32259 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32260 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32261 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32262 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32263 @item undefined-command-error-code
32264 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32265 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32266 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32267 @item exec-run-start-option
32268 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32269 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32270 @end ftable
32271
32272 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32273 @findex -list-target-features
32274
32275 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32276 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32277 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32278 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32279 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32280 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32281 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32282 Example output:
32283
32284 @smallexample
32285 (gdb) -list-target-features
32286 ^done,result=["async"]
32287 @end smallexample
32288
32289 The current list of features is:
32290
32291 @table @samp
32292 @item async
32293 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32294 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32295 while the target is running.
32296
32297 @item reverse
32298 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32299 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32300
32301 @end table
32302
32303 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32304 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32305 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32306
32307 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32308
32309 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32310 @findex -gdb-exit
32311
32312 @subsubheading Synopsis
32313
32314 @smallexample
32315 -gdb-exit
32316 @end smallexample
32317
32318 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32319
32320 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32321
32322 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32323
32324 @subsubheading Example
32325
32326 @smallexample
32327 (gdb)
32328 -gdb-exit
32329 ^exit
32330 @end smallexample
32331
32332
32333 @ignore
32334 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32335 @findex -exec-abort
32336
32337 @subsubheading Synopsis
32338
32339 @smallexample
32340 -exec-abort
32341 @end smallexample
32342
32343 Kill the inferior running program.
32344
32345 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32346
32347 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32348
32349 @subsubheading Example
32350 N.A.
32351 @end ignore
32352
32353
32354 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32355 @findex -gdb-set
32356
32357 @subsubheading Synopsis
32358
32359 @smallexample
32360 -gdb-set
32361 @end smallexample
32362
32363 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32364 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32365
32366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32367
32368 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32369
32370 @subsubheading Example
32371
32372 @smallexample
32373 (gdb)
32374 -gdb-set $foo=3
32375 ^done
32376 (gdb)
32377 @end smallexample
32378
32379
32380 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32381 @findex -gdb-show
32382
32383 @subsubheading Synopsis
32384
32385 @smallexample
32386 -gdb-show
32387 @end smallexample
32388
32389 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32390
32391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32392
32393 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32394
32395 @subsubheading Example
32396
32397 @smallexample
32398 (gdb)
32399 -gdb-show annotate
32400 ^done,value="0"
32401 (gdb)
32402 @end smallexample
32403
32404 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32405
32406
32407 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32408 @findex -gdb-version
32409
32410 @subsubheading Synopsis
32411
32412 @smallexample
32413 -gdb-version
32414 @end smallexample
32415
32416 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32417
32418 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32419
32420 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32421 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32422
32423 @subsubheading Example
32424
32425 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32426 @c box in TeX.
32427 @smallexample
32428 (gdb)
32429 -gdb-version
32430 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32431 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32432 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32433 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32434 ~ certain conditions.
32435 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32436 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32437 ~ details.
32438 ~This GDB was configured as
32439 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32440 ^done
32441 (gdb)
32442 @end smallexample
32443
32444 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32445 @findex -list-thread-groups
32446
32447 @subheading Synopsis
32448
32449 @smallexample
32450 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32451 @end smallexample
32452
32453 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32454 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32455 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32456 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32457 top-level thread groups.
32458
32459 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32460 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32461 available on the target.
32462
32463 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32464 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32465 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32466 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32467 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32468 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32469 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32470 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32471
32472 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32473 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32474 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32475 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32476 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32477 @samp{threads} field.
32478
32479 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32480 the following caveats:
32481
32482 @itemize @bullet
32483 @item
32484 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32485 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32486 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32487
32488 @item
32489 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32490 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32491 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32492 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32493 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32494 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32495
32496 @end itemize
32497
32498 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32499 have the following fields:
32500
32501 @table @code
32502 @item id
32503 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32504 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32505 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32506
32507 @item type
32508 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32509 valid type.
32510
32511 @item pid
32512 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32513 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32514
32515 @item exit-code
32516 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32517 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32518 only if the process is not running.
32519
32520 @item num_children
32521 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32522 absent for an available thread group.
32523
32524 @item threads
32525 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32526 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32527 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32528
32529 @item cores
32530 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32531 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32532 such information is not available.
32533
32534 @item executable
32535 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32536 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32537 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32538
32539 @end table
32540
32541 @subheading Example
32542
32543 @smallexample
32544 @value{GDBP}
32545 -list-thread-groups
32546 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32547 -list-thread-groups 17
32548 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32549 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32550 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32551 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32552 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32553 -list-thread-groups --available
32554 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32555 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32556 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32557 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32558 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32559 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32560 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32561 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32562 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32563 @end smallexample
32564
32565 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32566 @findex -info-os
32567
32568 @subsubheading Synopsis
32569
32570 @smallexample
32571 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32572 @end smallexample
32573
32574 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32575 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32576 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32577 of data of that type.
32578
32579 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32580 system.
32581
32582 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32583
32584 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32585
32586 @subsubheading Example
32587
32588 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32589 like this:
32590
32591 @smallexample
32592 @value{GDBP}
32593 -info-os
32594 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32595 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32596 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32597 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32598 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32599 col2="CPUs"@},
32600 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32601 col2="File descriptors"@},
32602 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32603 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32604 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32605 col2="Message queues"@},
32606 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32607 col2="Processes"@},
32608 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32609 col2="Process groups"@},
32610 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32611 col2="Semaphores"@},
32612 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32613 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32614 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32615 col2="Sockets"@},
32616 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32617 col2="Threads"@}]
32618 @value{GDBP}
32619 -info-os processes
32620 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32621 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32622 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32623 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32624 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32625 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32626 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32627 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32628 ...
32629 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32630 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32631 (gdb)
32632 @end smallexample
32633
32634 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32635 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32636 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32637 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32638 @code{info os} omits it.)
32639
32640 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32641 @findex -add-inferior
32642
32643 @subheading Synopsis
32644
32645 @smallexample
32646 -add-inferior
32647 @end smallexample
32648
32649 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32650 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32651 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32652 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32653 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32654 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32655
32656 @subheading Example
32657
32658 @smallexample
32659 @value{GDBP}
32660 -add-inferior
32661 ^done,inferior="i3"
32662 @end smallexample
32663
32664 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32665 @findex -interpreter-exec
32666
32667 @subheading Synopsis
32668
32669 @smallexample
32670 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32671 @end smallexample
32672 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32673
32674 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32675
32676 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32677
32678 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32679
32680 @subheading Example
32681
32682 @smallexample
32683 (gdb)
32684 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32685 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32686 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32687 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32688 ^done
32689 (gdb)
32690 @end smallexample
32691
32692 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32693 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32694
32695 @subheading Synopsis
32696
32697 @smallexample
32698 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32699 @end smallexample
32700
32701 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32702
32703 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32704
32705 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32706
32707 @subheading Example
32708
32709 @smallexample
32710 (gdb)
32711 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32712 ^done
32713 (gdb)
32714 @end smallexample
32715
32716 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32717 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32718
32719 @subheading Synopsis
32720
32721 @smallexample
32722 -inferior-tty-show
32723 @end smallexample
32724
32725 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32726
32727 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32728
32729 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32730
32731 @subheading Example
32732
32733 @smallexample
32734 (gdb)
32735 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32736 ^done
32737 (gdb)
32738 -inferior-tty-show
32739 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32740 (gdb)
32741 @end smallexample
32742
32743 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32744 @findex -enable-timings
32745
32746 @subheading Synopsis
32747
32748 @smallexample
32749 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32750 @end smallexample
32751
32752 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32753 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32754 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32755 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32756
32757 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32758
32759 No equivalent.
32760
32761 @subheading Example
32762
32763 @smallexample
32764 (gdb)
32765 -enable-timings
32766 ^done
32767 (gdb)
32768 -break-insert main
32769 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32770 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32771 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32772 times="0"@},
32773 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32774 (gdb)
32775 -enable-timings no
32776 ^done
32777 (gdb)
32778 -exec-run
32779 ^running
32780 (gdb)
32781 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32782 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32783 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32784 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32785 (gdb)
32786 @end smallexample
32787
32788 @node Annotations
32789 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32790
32791 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32792 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32793 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32794 relatively high level.
32795
32796 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32797 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32798
32799 @ignore
32800 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32801 @end ignore
32802
32803 @menu
32804 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32805 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32806 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32807 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32808 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32809 * Annotations for Running::
32810 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32811 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32812 @end menu
32813
32814 @node Annotations Overview
32815 @section What is an Annotation?
32816 @cindex annotations
32817
32818 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32819 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32820 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32821 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32822 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32823 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32824 cannot contain newline characters.
32825
32826 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32827 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32828 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32829 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32830 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32831 means those three characters as output.
32832
32833 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32834 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32835 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32836 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32837 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32838 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32839 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32840 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32841 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32842
32843 @table @code
32844 @kindex set annotate
32845 @item set annotate @var{level}
32846 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32847 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32848
32849 @item show annotate
32850 @kindex show annotate
32851 Show the current annotation level.
32852 @end table
32853
32854 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32855
32856 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32857
32858 @smallexample
32859 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32860 GNU gdb 6.0
32861 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32862 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32863 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32864 under certain conditions.
32865 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32866 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32867 for details.
32868 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32869
32870 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32871 (@value{GDBP})
32872 ^Z^Zprompt
32873 @kbd{quit}
32874
32875 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32876 $
32877 @end smallexample
32878
32879 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32880 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32881 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32882 output from @value{GDBN}.
32883
32884 @node Server Prefix
32885 @section The Server Prefix
32886 @cindex server prefix
32887
32888 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32889 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32890 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32891 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32892 a transparent manner.
32893
32894 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32895 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32896 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32897 @code{print} command.
32898
32899 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32900 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32901
32902 @node Prompting
32903 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32904
32905 @cindex annotations for prompts
32906 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32907 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32908 over, etc.
32909
32910 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32911 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32912 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32913 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32914 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32915 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32916 features the following annotations:
32917
32918 @smallexample
32919 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32920 ^Z^Zprompt
32921 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32922 @end smallexample
32923
32924 The input types are
32925
32926 @table @code
32927 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32928 @findex prompt annotation
32929 @findex post-prompt annotation
32930 @item prompt
32931 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32932
32933 @findex pre-commands annotation
32934 @findex commands annotation
32935 @findex post-commands annotation
32936 @item commands
32937 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32938 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32939
32940 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32941 @findex overload-choice annotation
32942 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32943 @item overload-choice
32944 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32945
32946 @findex pre-query annotation
32947 @findex query annotation
32948 @findex post-query annotation
32949 @item query
32950 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32951
32952 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32953 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32954 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32955 @item prompt-for-continue
32956 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32957 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32958 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32959 presence of annotations.
32960 @end table
32961
32962 @node Errors
32963 @section Errors
32964 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32965
32966 @findex quit annotation
32967 @smallexample
32968 ^Z^Zquit
32969 @end smallexample
32970
32971 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32972
32973 @findex error annotation
32974 @smallexample
32975 ^Z^Zerror
32976 @end smallexample
32977
32978 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32979
32980 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32981 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32982 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32983 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32984 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32985 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32986 to the top level.
32987
32988 @findex error-begin annotation
32989 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32990
32991 @smallexample
32992 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32993 @end smallexample
32994
32995 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32996 message.
32997
32998 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32999 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33000 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33001
33002 @node Invalidation
33003 @section Invalidation Notices
33004
33005 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33006 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33007 changed.
33008
33009 @table @code
33010 @findex frames-invalid annotation
33011 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33012
33013 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33014 have changed.
33015
33016 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33017 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33018
33019 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33020 deleted a breakpoint.
33021 @end table
33022
33023 @node Annotations for Running
33024 @section Running the Program
33025 @cindex annotations for running programs
33026
33027 @findex starting annotation
33028 @findex stopping annotation
33029 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33030 @code{step} or @code{continue},
33031
33032 @smallexample
33033 ^Z^Zstarting
33034 @end smallexample
33035
33036 is output. When the program stops,
33037
33038 @smallexample
33039 ^Z^Zstopped
33040 @end smallexample
33041
33042 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33043 annotations describe how the program stopped.
33044
33045 @table @code
33046 @findex exited annotation
33047 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33048 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33049 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33050
33051 @findex signalled annotation
33052 @findex signal-name annotation
33053 @findex signal-name-end annotation
33054 @findex signal-string annotation
33055 @findex signal-string-end annotation
33056 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
33057 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33058 annotation continues:
33059
33060 @smallexample
33061 @var{intro-text}
33062 ^Z^Zsignal-name
33063 @var{name}
33064 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33065 @var{middle-text}
33066 ^Z^Zsignal-string
33067 @var{string}
33068 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33069 @var{end-text}
33070 @end smallexample
33071
33072 @noindent
33073 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33074 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33075 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33076 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33077 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33078
33079 @findex signal annotation
33080 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33081 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33082 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33083 terminated with it.
33084
33085 @findex breakpoint annotation
33086 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33087 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33088
33089 @findex watchpoint annotation
33090 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33091 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33092 @end table
33093
33094 @node Source Annotations
33095 @section Displaying Source
33096 @cindex annotations for source display
33097
33098 @findex source annotation
33099 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33100
33101 @smallexample
33102 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33103 @end smallexample
33104
33105 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33106 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33107 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33108 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33109 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33110 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33111 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33112 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33113 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33114 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33115 depend on the language).
33116
33117 @node JIT Interface
33118 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33119 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33120 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33121
33122 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33123 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33124 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33125 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33126
33127 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33128 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33129 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33130 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33131 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33132 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33133
33134 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33135 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33136 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33137 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33138 LLVM JIT.
33139
33140 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33141 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33142 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33143 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33144 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33145 out about additional code.
33146
33147 @menu
33148 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33149 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33150 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33151 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33152 @end menu
33153
33154 @node Declarations
33155 @section JIT Declarations
33156
33157 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33158 implement the interface:
33159
33160 @smallexample
33161 typedef enum
33162 @{
33163 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33164 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33165 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33166 @} jit_actions_t;
33167
33168 struct jit_code_entry
33169 @{
33170 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33171 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33172 const char *symfile_addr;
33173 uint64_t symfile_size;
33174 @};
33175
33176 struct jit_descriptor
33177 @{
33178 uint32_t version;
33179 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33180 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33181 uint32_t action_flag;
33182 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33183 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33184 @};
33185
33186 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33187 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33188
33189 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33190 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33191 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33192 @end smallexample
33193
33194 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33195 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33196 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33197
33198 @node Registering Code
33199 @section Registering Code
33200
33201 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33202
33203 @itemize @bullet
33204 @item
33205 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33206 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33207
33208 @item
33209 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33210 file.
33211
33212 @item
33213 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33214
33215 @item
33216 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33217
33218 @item
33219 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33220 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33221 @end itemize
33222
33223 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33224 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33225 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33226 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33227
33228 @node Unregistering Code
33229 @section Unregistering Code
33230
33231 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33232
33233 @itemize @bullet
33234 @item
33235 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33236
33237 @item
33238 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33239
33240 @item
33241 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33242 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33243 @end itemize
33244
33245 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33246 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33247
33248 @node Custom Debug Info
33249 @section Custom Debug Info
33250 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33251 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33252
33253 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33254 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33255 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33256 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33257 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33258 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33259 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33260 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33261 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33262
33263 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33264 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33265 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33266 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33267 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33268 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33269 compiler.
33270
33271 @menu
33272 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33273 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33274 @end menu
33275
33276 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33277 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33278 @kindex jit-reader-load
33279 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33280
33281 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33282 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33283
33284 @table @code
33285 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33286 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33287 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33288 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33289 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33290 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33291 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33292
33293 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33294 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33295 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33296 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33297 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33298
33299 @item jit-reader-unload
33300 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33301
33302 @end table
33303
33304 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33305 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33306 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33307
33308 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33309 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33310
33311 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33312 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33313 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33314 the system include directory.
33315
33316 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33317 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33318 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33319
33320 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33321 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33322
33323 @findex gdb_init_reader
33324 @smallexample
33325 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33326 @end smallexample
33327
33328 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33329
33330 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33331 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33332 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33333 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33334 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33335 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33336
33337 @smallexample
33338 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33339 @{
33340 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33341 int reader_version;
33342
33343 /* For use by the reader. */
33344 void *priv_data;
33345
33346 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33347 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33348 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33349 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33350 @};
33351 @end smallexample
33352
33353 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33354 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33355
33356 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33357 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33358 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33359 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33360 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33361 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33362 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33363 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33364 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33365 target's address space.
33366
33367 @node In-Process Agent
33368 @chapter In-Process Agent
33369 @cindex debugging agent
33370 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33371 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33372 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33373 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33374 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33375 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33376 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33377 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33378 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33379 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33380 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33381 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33382 behavior without interrupting it.
33383
33384 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33385 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33386 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33387 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33388 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33389 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33390 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33391 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33392 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33393
33394 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33395 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33396 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33397 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33398
33399 @anchor{Control Agent}
33400 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33401 debugging with the following commands:
33402
33403 @table @code
33404 @kindex set agent on
33405 @item set agent on
33406 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33407 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33408 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33409 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33410 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33411 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33412
33413 @kindex set agent off
33414 @item set agent off
33415 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33416 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33417
33418 @kindex show agent
33419 @item show agent
33420 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33421 the in-process agent.
33422 @end table
33423
33424 @menu
33425 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33426 @end menu
33427
33428 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33429 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33430 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33431
33432 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33433 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33434 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33435 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33436 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33437 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33438 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33439 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33440 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33441
33442 @menu
33443 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33444 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33445 @end menu
33446
33447 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33448 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33449 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33450
33451 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33452 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33453
33454 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33455 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33456 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33457 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33458
33459 @enumerate
33460 @item
33461 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33462 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33463 @item
33464 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33465 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33466 the other one.
33467 @end enumerate
33468
33469 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33470
33471 @enumerate
33472 @item
33473 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33474 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33475 @anchor{agent expression object}
33476 @item
33477 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33478 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33479 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33480 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33481 @item
33482 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33483 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33484
33485 @end enumerate
33486
33487 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33488 object:
33489
33490 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33491 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33492 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33493 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33494 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33495 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33496 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33497 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33498 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33499 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33500 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33501 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33502 memory address for collecting.
33503 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33504 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33505 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33506 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33507 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33508 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33509 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33510 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33511 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33512 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33513 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33514 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33515 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33516 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33517 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33518 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33519 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33520 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33521 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33522 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33523 @ref{agent expression object}
33524 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33525 @ref{agent expression object}
33526 @item actions @tab variable
33527 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33528 @end multitable
33529
33530 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33531 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33532 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33533
33534 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33535 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33536
33537 @table @samp
33538
33539 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33540 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33541 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33542 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33543 in IPA finally.
33544
33545 Replies:
33546 @table @samp
33547 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33548 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33549 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33550 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33551 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33552 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33553 @item E @var{NN}
33554 for an error
33555
33556 @end table
33557
33558 @item close
33559 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33560 is about to kill inferiors.
33561
33562 @item qTfSTM
33563 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33564 @item qTsSTM
33565 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33566 @item qTSTMat
33567 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33568 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33569 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33570
33571 Replies:
33572 @table @samp
33573 @item E @var{NN}
33574 for an error
33575 @end table
33576 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33577 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33578 @end table
33579
33580 @node GDB Bugs
33581 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33582 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33583 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33584
33585 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33586
33587 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33588 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33589 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33590 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33591
33592 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33593 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33594
33595 @menu
33596 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33597 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33598 @end menu
33599
33600 @node Bug Criteria
33601 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33602 @cindex bug criteria
33603
33604 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33605
33606 @itemize @bullet
33607 @cindex fatal signal
33608 @cindex debugger crash
33609 @cindex crash of debugger
33610 @item
33611 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33612 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33613
33614 @cindex error on valid input
33615 @item
33616 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33617 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33618 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33619
33620 @cindex invalid input
33621 @item
33622 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33623 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33624 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33625 for traditional practice''.
33626
33627 @item
33628 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33629 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33630 @end itemize
33631
33632 @node Bug Reporting
33633 @section How to Report Bugs
33634 @cindex bug reports
33635 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33636
33637 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33638 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33639 contact that organization first.
33640
33641 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33642 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33643 distribution.
33644 @c should add a web page ref...
33645
33646 @ifset BUGURL
33647 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33648 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33649 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33650 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33651 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33652 be used.
33653
33654 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33655 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33656 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33657 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33658
33659 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33660 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33661 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33662 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33663 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33664 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33665 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33666 bug reports to the mailing list.
33667 @end ifset
33668 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33669 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33670 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33671 @end ifclear
33672 @end ifset
33673
33674 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33675 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33676 fact or leave it out, state it!
33677
33678 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33679 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33680 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33681 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33682 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33683 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33684 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33685 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33686 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33687
33688 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33689 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33690 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33691 self-contained.
33692
33693 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33694 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33695 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33696 bugs properly.
33697
33698 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33699
33700 @itemize @bullet
33701 @item
33702 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33703 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33704 version}.
33705
33706 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33707 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33708
33709 @item
33710 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33711 version number.
33712
33713 @item
33714 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33715 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33716 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33717 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33718
33719 @item
33720 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33721 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33722
33723 @item
33724 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33725 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33726 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33727 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33728 those compilers.
33729
33730 @item
33731 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33732 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33733 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33734 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33735
33736 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33737 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33738
33739 @item
33740 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33741 reproduce the bug.
33742
33743 @item
33744 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33745 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33746
33747 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33748 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33749 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33750 a chance to make a mistake.
33751
33752 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33753 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33754 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33755 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33756 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33757 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33758 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33759 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33760
33761 @pindex script
33762 @cindex recording a session script
33763 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33764 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33765 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33766 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33767
33768 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33769 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33770
33771 @item
33772 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33773 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33774 it by context, not by line number.
33775
33776 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33777 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33778
33779 @end itemize
33780
33781 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33782
33783 @itemize @bullet
33784 @item
33785 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33786
33787 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33788 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33789 changes will not affect it.
33790
33791 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33792 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33793 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33794 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33795
33796 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33797 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33798 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33799 less time, and so on.
33800
33801 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33802 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33803
33804 @item
33805 A patch for the bug.
33806
33807 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33808 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33809 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33810 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33811
33812 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33813 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33814 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33815 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33816
33817 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33818 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33819 help us to understand.
33820
33821 @item
33822 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33823
33824 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33825 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33826 @end itemize
33827
33828 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33829 @c and consists of the two following files:
33830 @c rluser.texi
33831 @c hsuser.texi
33832 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33833 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33834 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33835 @include rluser.texi
33836 @include hsuser.texi
33837 @end ifclear
33838
33839 @node In Memoriam
33840 @appendix In Memoriam
33841
33842 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33843 contributors:
33844
33845 @table @code
33846 @item Fred Fish
33847 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33848 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33849 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33850
33851 @item Michael Snyder
33852 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33853 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33854 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33855 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33856 @end table
33857
33858 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33859 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33860
33861 @node Formatting Documentation
33862 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33863
33864 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33865 @cindex reference card
33866 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33867 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33868 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33869 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33870 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33871 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33872
33873 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33874 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33875
33876 @smallexample
33877 make refcard.dvi
33878 @end smallexample
33879
33880 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33881 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33882 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33883 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33884 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33885
33886 @cindex documentation
33887
33888 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33889 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33890 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33891 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33892 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33893 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33894
33895 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33896 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33897 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33898 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33899 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33900 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33901 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33902 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33903
33904 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33905 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33906 @code{makeinfo}.
33907
33908 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33909 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33910 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33911
33912 @smallexample
33913 cd gdb
33914 make gdb.info
33915 @end smallexample
33916
33917 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33918 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33919 Texinfo definitions file.
33920
33921 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33922 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33923 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33924 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33925 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33926 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33927 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33928
33929 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33930 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33931 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33932 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33933 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33934 directory.
33935
33936 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33937 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33938 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33939 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33940
33941 @smallexample
33942 make gdb.dvi
33943 @end smallexample
33944
33945 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33946
33947 @node Installing GDB
33948 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33949 @cindex installation
33950
33951 @menu
33952 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33953 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33954 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33955 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33956 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33957 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33958 @end menu
33959
33960 @node Requirements
33961 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33962 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33963
33964 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33965 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33966
33967 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33968 @table @asis
33969 @item ISO C90 compiler
33970 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33971 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33972
33973 @end table
33974
33975 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33976 @table @asis
33977 @item Expat
33978 @anchor{Expat}
33979 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33980 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33981 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33982 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33983 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33984 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33985
33986 Expat is used for:
33987
33988 @itemize @bullet
33989 @item
33990 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33991 @item
33992 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33993 @item
33994 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33995 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33996 @item
33997 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33998 @item
33999 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34000 @item
34001 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34002 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34003 @end itemize
34004
34005 @item zlib
34006 @cindex compressed debug sections
34007 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34008 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34009 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34010 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34011 information in such binaries.
34012
34013 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34014 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34015 @url{http://zlib.net}.
34016
34017 @item iconv
34018 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34019 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34020 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34021 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34022
34023 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34024 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34025 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34026 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34027
34028 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34029 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34030 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34031
34032 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34033 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34034 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34035 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34036 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34037 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34038 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34039 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34040 @end table
34041
34042 @node Running Configure
34043 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34044 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34045 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34046 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34047 build the @code{gdb} program.
34048 @iftex
34049 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34050 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34051 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34052 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34053 @end iftex
34054
34055 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34056 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34057 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34058
34059 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34060 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34061
34062 @table @code
34063 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34064 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34065
34066 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34067 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34068
34069 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34070 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34071
34072 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34073 @sc{gnu} include files
34074
34075 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34076 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34077
34078 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34079 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34080
34081 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34082 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34083
34084 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34085 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34086
34087 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34088 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34089 @end table
34090
34091 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34092 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34093 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34094
34095 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34096 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34097 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34098 argument.
34099
34100 For example:
34101
34102 @smallexample
34103 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34104 ./configure @var{host}
34105 make
34106 @end smallexample
34107
34108 @noindent
34109 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34110 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34111 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34112 correct value by examining your system.)
34113
34114 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34115 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34116 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34117 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34118
34119 @need 750
34120 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34121 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34122 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34123
34124 @smallexample
34125 sh configure @var{host}
34126 @end smallexample
34127
34128 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34129 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34130 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34131 @file{configure}
34132 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34133 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34134
34135 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34136 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34137 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34138 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34139 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34140 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34141 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34142 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34143 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34144
34145 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34146 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34147 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34148 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34149 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34150
34151 @node Separate Objdir
34152 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34153
34154 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34155 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34156 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34157 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34158 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34159 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34160 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34161 program specified there.
34162
34163 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34164 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34165 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34166 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34167 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34168 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34169
34170 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34171 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34172
34173 @smallexample
34174 @group
34175 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34176 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34177 cd ../gdb-sun4
34178 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34179 make
34180 @end group
34181 @end smallexample
34182
34183 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34184 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34185 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34186 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34187 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34188 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34189
34190 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34191 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34192 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34193 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34194 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34195
34196 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34197 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34198 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34199 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34200 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34201 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34202
34203 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34204 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34205 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34206
34207 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34208 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34209 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34210 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34211 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34212
34213 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34214 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34215 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34216 with each other.
34217
34218 @node Config Names
34219 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34220
34221 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34222 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34223 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34224 of information in the following pattern:
34225
34226 @smallexample
34227 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34228 @end smallexample
34229
34230 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34231 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34232 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34233
34234 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34235 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34236 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34237 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34238 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34239 abbreviations---for example:
34240
34241 @smallexample
34242 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34243 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34244 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34245 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34246 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34247 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34248 % sh config.sub sun4
34249 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34250 % sh config.sub sun3
34251 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34252 % sh config.sub i986v
34253 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34254 @end smallexample
34255
34256 @noindent
34257 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34258 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34259
34260 @node Configure Options
34261 @section @file{configure} Options
34262
34263 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34264 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34265 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34266 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34267
34268 @smallexample
34269 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34270 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34271 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34272 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34273 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34274 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34275 @var{host}
34276 @end smallexample
34277
34278 @noindent
34279 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34280 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34281 @samp{--}.
34282
34283 @table @code
34284 @item --help
34285 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34286
34287 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34288 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34289 @file{@var{dir}}.
34290
34291 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34292 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34293 @file{@var{dir}}.
34294
34295 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34296 @need 2000
34297 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34298 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34299 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34300 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34301 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34302 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34303 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34304 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34305 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34306 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34307 @var{dirname}.
34308
34309 @item --norecursion
34310 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34311 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34312
34313 @item --target=@var{target}
34314 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34315 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34316 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34317
34318 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34319
34320 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34321 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34322
34323 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34324 @end table
34325
34326 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34327 needed for special purposes only.
34328
34329 @node System-wide configuration
34330 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34331 @cindex system-wide init file
34332
34333 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34334 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34335 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34336
34337 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34338
34339 @table @code
34340 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34341 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34342 @var{file}.
34343 @end table
34344
34345 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34346 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34347
34348 @itemize @bullet
34349 @item
34350 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34351 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34352 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34353 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34354 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34355 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34356
34357 @item
34358 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34359 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34360 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34361 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34362 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34363 @end itemize
34364
34365 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34366 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34367 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34368 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34369 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34370 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34371 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34372 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34373 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34374 reread.
34375
34376 @menu
34377 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34378 @end menu
34379
34380 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34381 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34382 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34383
34384 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34385 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34386 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34387 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34388 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34389 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34390
34391 The following scripts are currently available:
34392 @itemize @bullet
34393
34394 @item @file{elinos.py}
34395 @pindex elinos.py
34396 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34397 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34398 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34399 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34400 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34401 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34402
34403 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34404 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34405 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34406 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34407 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34408 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34409
34410 @end itemize
34411
34412 @node Maintenance Commands
34413 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34414 @cindex maintenance commands
34415 @cindex internal commands
34416
34417 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34418 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34419 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34420 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34421 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34422
34423 @table @code
34424 @kindex maint agent
34425 @kindex maint agent-eval
34426 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34427 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34428 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34429 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34430 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34431 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34432 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34433 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34434 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34435 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34436 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34437 addition and return the sum.
34438 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34439 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34440
34441 @kindex maint agent-printf
34442 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34443 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34444 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34445 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34446 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34447
34448 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34449 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34450 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34451 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34452 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34453 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34454 is shown:
34455
34456 @table @code
34457 @item breakpoint
34458 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34459
34460 @item watchpoint
34461 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34462
34463 @item longjmp
34464 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34465 @code{longjmp} calls.
34466
34467 @item longjmp resume
34468 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34469
34470 @item until
34471 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34472
34473 @item finish
34474 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34475
34476 @item shlib events
34477 Shared library events.
34478
34479 @end table
34480
34481 @kindex maint info btrace
34482 @item maint info btrace
34483 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34484
34485 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34486 @item maint btrace packet-history
34487 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34488 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34489 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34490 recording format.
34491
34492 @table @code
34493 @item bts
34494 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34495 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34496
34497 @table @asis
34498 @item Block number
34499 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34500 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34501 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34502 @end table
34503
34504 @item pt
34505 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34506 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34507 information is printed:
34508
34509 @table @asis
34510 @item Packet number
34511 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34512 @item Trace offset
34513 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34514 @item Packet opcode and payload
34515 @end table
34516 @end table
34517
34518 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34519 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34520 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34521 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34522 needed.
34523
34524 @kindex maint btrace clear
34525 @item maint btrace clear
34526 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34527 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34528
34529 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34530 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34531 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34532 buffer.
34533
34534 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34535 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34536 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34537 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34538 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34539 packet history.
34540
34541 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34542 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34543 @cindex displaced stepping support
34544 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34545 @item set displaced-stepping
34546 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34547 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34548 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34549 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34550 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34551 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34552
34553 @table @code
34554 @item set displaced-stepping on
34555 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34556 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34557
34558 @item set displaced-stepping off
34559 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34560 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34561
34562 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34563 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34564 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34565 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34566 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34567 @end table
34568
34569 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34570 @item maint check-psymtabs
34571 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34572 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34573
34574 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34575 @item maint check-symtabs
34576 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34577
34578 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34579 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34580 Expand symbol tables.
34581 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34582 names matching @var{regexp}.
34583
34584 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34585 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34586 @cindex demangler crashes
34587 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34588 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34589 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34590 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34591 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34592 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34593 option to terminate the current session.
34594
34595 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34596 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34597 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34598
34599 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34600 @item maint cplus namespace
34601 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34602
34603 @kindex maint deprecate
34604 @kindex maint undeprecate
34605 @cindex deprecated commands
34606 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34607 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34608 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34609 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34610 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34611 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34612 the replacement as part of the warning.
34613
34614 @kindex maint dump-me
34615 @item maint dump-me
34616 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34617 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34618 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34619 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34620
34621 @kindex maint internal-error
34622 @kindex maint internal-warning
34623 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34624 @cindex demangler crashes
34625 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34626 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34627 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34628
34629 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34630 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34631 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34632 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34633 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34634 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34635 @value{GDBN} session.
34636
34637 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34638 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34639
34640 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34641
34642 @smallexample
34643 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34644 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34645 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34646 debugging may prove unreliable.
34647 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34648 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34649 (@value{GDBP})
34650 @end smallexample
34651
34652 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34653 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34654 @cindex demangler crashes
34655
34656 @kindex maint set internal-error
34657 @kindex maint show internal-error
34658 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34659 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34660 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34661 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34662 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34663 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34664 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34665 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34666 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34667 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34668 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34669 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34670 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34671 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34672 described in the table below.
34673
34674 @table @samp
34675 @item quit
34676 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34677 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34678
34679 @item corefile
34680 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34681 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34682 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34683 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34684 disabled.
34685 @end table
34686
34687 @kindex maint packet
34688 @item maint packet @var{text}
34689 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34690 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34691 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34692 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34693 checksum.
34694
34695 @kindex maint print architecture
34696 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34697 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34698 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34699
34700 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34701 @item maint print c-tdesc
34702 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34703 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34704 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34705
34706 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34707 @item maint print dummy-frames
34708 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34709
34710 @smallexample
34711 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34712 @dots{}
34713 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34714 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34715 58 return (a + b);
34716 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34717 @dots{}
34718 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34719 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34720 (@value{GDBP})
34721 @end smallexample
34722
34723 Takes an optional file parameter.
34724
34725 @kindex maint print registers
34726 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34727 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34728 @kindex maint print register-groups
34729 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34730 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34731 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34732 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34733 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34734 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34735 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34736
34737 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34738 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34739 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34740 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34741 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34742 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34743 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34744 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34745
34746 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34747 write the information.
34748
34749 @kindex maint print reggroups
34750 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34751 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34752 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34753 information.
34754
34755 The register groups info looks like this:
34756
34757 @smallexample
34758 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34759 Group Type
34760 general user
34761 float user
34762 all user
34763 vector user
34764 system user
34765 save internal
34766 restore internal
34767 @end smallexample
34768
34769 @kindex flushregs
34770 @item flushregs
34771 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34772
34773 @kindex maint print objfiles
34774 @cindex info for known object files
34775 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34776 Print a dump of all known object files.
34777 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34778 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34779 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34780
34781 @kindex maint print user-registers
34782 @cindex user registers
34783 @item maint print user-registers
34784 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34785 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34786 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34787 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34788 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34789 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34790 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34791
34792 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34793 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34794 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34795 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34796 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34797 matching @var{regexp}.
34798 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34799 and the full path if known.
34800 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34801
34802 @kindex maint print statistics
34803 @cindex bcache statistics
34804 @item maint print statistics
34805 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34806 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34807 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34808 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34809 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34810 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34811 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34812 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34813 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34814 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34815 lengths.
34816
34817 @kindex maint print target-stack
34818 @cindex target stack description
34819 @item maint print target-stack
34820 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34821 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34822 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34823 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34824 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34825 address.
34826
34827 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34828 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34829
34830 @kindex maint print type
34831 @cindex type chain of a data type
34832 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34833 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34834 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34835 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34836 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34837 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34838
34839 @kindex maint selftest
34840 @cindex self tests
34841 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
34842 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
34843
34844 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34845 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34846 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34847 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34848 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34849 information.
34850
34851 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34852 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34853 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34854 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34855 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34856 always see the disassembly form.
34857
34858 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34859
34860 @smallexample
34861 (gdb) info addr argc
34862 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34863 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34864 @end smallexample
34865
34866 For more information on these expressions, see
34867 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34868
34869 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34870 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34871 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34872 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34873 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34874
34875 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34876 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34877 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34878 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34879 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34880 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34881 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34882 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34883 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34884
34885 @kindex maint set profile
34886 @kindex maint show profile
34887 @cindex profiling GDB
34888 @item maint set profile
34889 @itemx maint show profile
34890 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34891
34892 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34893 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34894 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34895 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34896 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34897 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34898 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34899
34900 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34901 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34902
34903 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34904 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34905 @cindex hardware debug registers
34906 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34907 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34908 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34909 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34910 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34911 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34912 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34913
34914 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34915 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34916 @item maint set show-all-tib
34917 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34918 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34919 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34920 command.
34921
34922 @kindex maint set target-async
34923 @kindex maint show target-async
34924 @item maint set target-async
34925 @itemx maint show target-async
34926 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34927 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34928 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34929 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34930
34931 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34932 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34933 @item maint set target-non-stop
34934 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34935
34936 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34937 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34938 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34939 if supported by the target.
34940
34941 @table @code
34942 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34943 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34944 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34945
34946 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34947 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34948 does not indicate support.
34949
34950 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34951 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34952 target supports it.
34953 @end table
34954
34955 @kindex maint set per-command
34956 @kindex maint show per-command
34957 @item maint set per-command
34958 @itemx maint show per-command
34959 @cindex resources used by commands
34960
34961 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34962 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34963
34964 @table @code
34965 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34966 @itemx maint show per-command space
34967 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34968 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34969 took, following the command's own output.
34970 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34971 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34972
34973 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34974 @itemx maint show per-command time
34975 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34976 for each command.
34977 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34978 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34979 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34980 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34981 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34982 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34983 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34984 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34985 spent by the program been debugged.
34986 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34987 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34988
34989 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34990 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34991 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34992 for each command.
34993 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34994
34995 @enumerate a
34996 @item
34997 number of symbol tables
34998 @item
34999 number of primary symbol tables
35000 @item
35001 number of blocks in the blockvector
35002 @end enumerate
35003 @end table
35004
35005 @kindex maint space
35006 @cindex memory used by commands
35007 @item maint space @var{value}
35008 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35009 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35010
35011 @kindex maint time
35012 @cindex time of command execution
35013 @item maint time @var{value}
35014 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35015 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35016
35017 @kindex maint translate-address
35018 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35019 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35020 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35021 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35022 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35023 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35024 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35025
35026 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35027 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35028 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35029
35030 @end table
35031
35032 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35033 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35034
35035 @table @code
35036 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35037 @kindex set watchdog
35038 @cindex watchdog timer
35039 @cindex timeout for commands
35040 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35041 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35042 reports and error and the command is aborted.
35043
35044 @item show watchdog
35045 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35046 @end table
35047
35048 @node Remote Protocol
35049 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35050
35051 @menu
35052 * Overview::
35053 * Packets::
35054 * Stop Reply Packets::
35055 * General Query Packets::
35056 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35057 * Tracepoint Packets::
35058 * Host I/O Packets::
35059 * Interrupts::
35060 * Notification Packets::
35061 * Remote Non-Stop::
35062 * Packet Acknowledgment::
35063 * Examples::
35064 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35065 * Library List Format::
35066 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35067 * Memory Map Format::
35068 * Thread List Format::
35069 * Traceframe Info Format::
35070 * Branch Trace Format::
35071 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35072 @end menu
35073
35074 @node Overview
35075 @section Overview
35076
35077 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35078 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35079 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35080 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35081
35082 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35083 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35084
35085 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35086 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35087 @cindex remote serial protocol
35088 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35089 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35090 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35091 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35092 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35093
35094 @smallexample
35095 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35096 @end smallexample
35097 @noindent
35098
35099 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35100 @noindent
35101 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35102 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35103 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35104
35105 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35106 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35107
35108 @smallexample
35109 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35110 @end smallexample
35111
35112 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35113 @noindent
35114 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35115 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35116 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35117
35118 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35119 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35120 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35121 retransmission):
35122
35123 @smallexample
35124 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35125 <- @code{+}
35126 @end smallexample
35127 @noindent
35128
35129 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35130 once a connection is established.
35131 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35132
35133 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35134 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35135 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35136 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35137 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35138 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35139 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35140
35141 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35142 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35143 exceptions).
35144
35145 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35146 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35147 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35148 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35149
35150 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35151 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35152 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35153
35154 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35155 @anchor{Binary Data}
35156 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35157 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35158 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35159 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35160 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35161 binary data.
35162
35163 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35164 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35165 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35166 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35167 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35168 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35169 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35170 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35171 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35172 (described next).
35173
35174 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35175 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35176 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35177 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35178 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35179 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35180 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35181 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35182 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35183 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35184 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35185 3}} more times.
35186
35187 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35188 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35189 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35190 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35191 @samp{0*"00}.
35192
35193 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35194 error number. That number is not well defined.
35195
35196 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35197 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35198 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35199 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35200 on that response.
35201
35202 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35203 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35204 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35205 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35206 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35207 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35208
35209 @node Packets
35210 @section Packets
35211
35212 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35213 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35214 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35215 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35216
35217 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35218 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35219 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35220 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35221 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35222 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35223 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35224 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35225 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35226 @var{baz}.
35227
35228 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35229 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35230 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35231 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35232 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35233 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35234 pick any thread.
35235
35236 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35237 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35238 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35239 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35240 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35241 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35242 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35243 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35244 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35245 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35246 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35247 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35248 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35249
35250 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35251 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35252 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35253 more information.
35254
35255 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35256 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35257
35258 Here are the packet descriptions.
35259
35260 @table @samp
35261
35262 @item !
35263 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35264 @anchor{extended mode}
35265 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35266 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35267 debugged.
35268
35269 Reply:
35270 @table @samp
35271 @item OK
35272 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35273 @end table
35274
35275 @item ?
35276 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35277 @anchor{? packet}
35278 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35279 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35280 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35281
35282 Reply:
35283 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35284
35285 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35286 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35287 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35288 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35289 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35290
35291 Reply:
35292 @table @samp
35293 @item OK
35294 The arguments were set.
35295 @item E @var{NN}
35296 An error occurred.
35297 @end table
35298
35299 @item b @var{baud}
35300 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35301 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35302 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35303
35304 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35305 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35306 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35307
35308 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35309 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35310 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35311 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35312 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35313
35314 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35315 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35316 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35317 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35318
35319 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35320 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35321
35322 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35323 @anchor{bc}
35324 @item bc
35325 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35326 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35327
35328 Reply:
35329 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35330
35331 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35332 @anchor{bs}
35333 @item bs
35334 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35335 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35336
35337 Reply:
35338 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35339
35340 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35341 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35342 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35343 is omitted, resume at current address.
35344
35345 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35346 packet}.
35347
35348 Reply:
35349 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35350
35351 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35352 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35353 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35354 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35355
35356 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35357 packet}.
35358
35359 Reply:
35360 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35361
35362 @item d
35363 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35364 Toggle debug flag.
35365
35366 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35367 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35368
35369 @item D
35370 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35371 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35372 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35373 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35374 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35375
35376 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35377 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35378 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35379 big-endian hex string.
35380
35381 Reply:
35382 @table @samp
35383 @item OK
35384 for success
35385 @item E @var{NN}
35386 for an error
35387 @end table
35388
35389 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35390 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35391 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35392 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35393 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35394
35395 @item g
35396 @anchor{read registers packet}
35397 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35398 Read general registers.
35399
35400 Reply:
35401 @table @samp
35402 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35403 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35404 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35405 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35406 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35407 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35408
35409 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35410 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35411 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35412 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35413 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35414 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35415 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35416 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35417
35418 @smallexample
35419 -> @code{g}
35420 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35421 @end smallexample
35422
35423 @item E @var{NN}
35424 for an error.
35425 @end table
35426
35427 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35428 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35429 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35430 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35431
35432 Reply:
35433 @table @samp
35434 @item OK
35435 for success
35436 @item E @var{NN}
35437 for an error
35438 @end table
35439
35440 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35441 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35442 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35443 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35444 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35445 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35446 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35447 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35448 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35449
35450 Reply:
35451 @table @samp
35452 @item OK
35453 for success
35454 @item E @var{NN}
35455 for an error
35456 @end table
35457
35458 @c FIXME: JTC:
35459 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35460 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35461 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35462 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35463 @c described. For example:
35464 @c
35465 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35466 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35467 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35468 @c
35469 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35470 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35471 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35472
35473 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35474 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35475 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35476 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35477 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35478 step starting at that address.
35479
35480 @item I
35481 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35482 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35483 step packet}.
35484
35485 @item k
35486 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35487 Kill request.
35488
35489 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35490
35491 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35492 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35493
35494 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35495
35496 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35497 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35498 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35499
35500 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35501 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35502 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35503
35504 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35505 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35506 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35507 (@pxref{? packet}).
35508
35509 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35510 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35511 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35512 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35513 any particular boundary.
35514
35515 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35516 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35517 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35518 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35519 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35520 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35521 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35522 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35523
35524 Reply:
35525 @table @samp
35526 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35527 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35528 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35529 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35530 @item E @var{NN}
35531 @var{NN} is errno
35532 @end table
35533
35534 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35535 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35536 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35537 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35538 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35539
35540 Reply:
35541 @table @samp
35542 @item OK
35543 for success
35544 @item E @var{NN}
35545 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35546 written).
35547 @end table
35548
35549 @item p @var{n}
35550 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35551 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35552 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35553 register value is encoded.
35554
35555 Reply:
35556 @table @samp
35557 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35558 the register's value
35559 @item E @var{NN}
35560 for an error
35561 @item @w{}
35562 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35563 @end table
35564
35565 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35566 @anchor{write register packet}
35567 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35568 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35569 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35570 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35571
35572 Reply:
35573 @table @samp
35574 @item OK
35575 for success
35576 @item E @var{NN}
35577 for an error
35578 @end table
35579
35580 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35581 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35582 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35583 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35584 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35585 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35586
35587 @item r
35588 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35589 Reset the entire system.
35590
35591 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35592
35593 @item R @var{XX}
35594 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35595 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35596 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35597
35598 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35599
35600 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35601 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35602 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35603 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35604
35605 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35606 packet}.
35607
35608 Reply:
35609 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35610
35611 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35612 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35613 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35614 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35615 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35616
35617 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35618 packet}.
35619
35620 Reply:
35621 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35622
35623 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35624 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35625 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35626 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35627 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35628
35629 @item T @var{thread-id}
35630 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35631 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35632
35633 Reply:
35634 @table @samp
35635 @item OK
35636 thread is still alive
35637 @item E @var{NN}
35638 thread is dead
35639 @end table
35640
35641 @item v
35642 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35643 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35644
35645 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35646 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35647 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35648 The process ID is a
35649 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35650 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35651 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35652
35653 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35654 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35655 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35656 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35657 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35658 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35659 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35660 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35661
35662 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35663
35664 Reply:
35665 @table @samp
35666 @item E @var{nn}
35667 for an error
35668 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35669 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35670 @item OK
35671 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35672 @end table
35673
35674 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35675 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35676 @anchor{vCont packet}
35677 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35678
35679 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
35680 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
35681 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
35682 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
35683 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
35684 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
35685 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
35686 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
35687 error.
35688
35689 Currently supported actions are:
35690
35691 @table @samp
35692 @item c
35693 Continue.
35694 @item C @var{sig}
35695 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35696 @item s
35697 Step.
35698 @item S @var{sig}
35699 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35700 @item t
35701 Stop.
35702 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35703 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35704 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35705 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35706 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35707 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35708
35709 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35710 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35711 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35712 jumps to @var{start}).
35713
35714 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35715 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35716 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35717
35718 @end table
35719
35720 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35721 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35722 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35723
35724 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35725 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35726 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35727 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35728 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35729 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35730 as an implementation detail.
35731
35732 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
35733 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
35734 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
35735 stopped.
35736
35737 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
35738 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
35739 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
35740
35741 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35742 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
35743
35744 Reply:
35745 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35746
35747 @item vCont?
35748 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35749 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35750
35751 Reply:
35752 @table @samp
35753 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35754 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35755 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35756 @item @w{}
35757 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35758 @end table
35759
35760 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35761 @item vCtrlC
35762 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35763 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35764 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35765 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35766 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35767 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35768 variant.
35769
35770 Reply:
35771 @table @samp
35772 @item E @var{nn}
35773 for an error
35774 @item OK
35775 for success
35776 @end table
35777
35778 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35779 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35780 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35781 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35782
35783 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35784 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35785 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35786 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35787 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35788 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35789 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35790 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35791 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35792 packet is received.
35793
35794 Reply:
35795 @table @samp
35796 @item OK
35797 for success
35798 @item E @var{NN}
35799 for an error
35800 @end table
35801
35802 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35803 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35804 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35805 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35806 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35807 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35808 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35809 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35810 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35811 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35812 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35813 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35814
35815
35816 Reply:
35817 @table @samp
35818 @item OK
35819 for success
35820 @item E.memtype
35821 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35822 @item E @var{NN}
35823 for an error
35824 @end table
35825
35826 @item vFlashDone
35827 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35828 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35829 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35830 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35831 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35832 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35833 request is completed.
35834
35835 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35836 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35837 @anchor{vKill packet}
35838 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35839 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35840 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35841 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35842
35843 Reply:
35844 @table @samp
35845 @item E @var{nn}
35846 for an error
35847 @item OK
35848 for success
35849 @end table
35850
35851 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35852 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35853 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35854 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35855 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35856 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35857 state.
35858
35859 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35860
35861 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35862
35863 Reply:
35864 @table @samp
35865 @item E @var{nn}
35866 for an error
35867 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35868 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35869 @end table
35870
35871 @item vStopped
35872 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35873 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35874
35875 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35876 @anchor{X packet}
35877 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35878 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35879 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35880 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35881 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35882
35883 Reply:
35884 @table @samp
35885 @item OK
35886 for success
35887 @item E @var{NN}
35888 for an error
35889 @end table
35890
35891 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35892 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35893 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35894 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35895 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35896 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35897 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35898
35899 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35900 separately.
35901
35902 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35903 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35904 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35905 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35906 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35907 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35908
35909 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35910 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35911 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35912 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35913 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
35914 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35915
35916 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35917 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35918 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
35919 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
35920 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35921 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
35922 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
35923 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
35924 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
35925 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
35926 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
35927 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
35928 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35929
35930 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35931 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35932
35933 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35934 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35935
35936 @table @samp
35937
35938 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35939 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35940 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35941
35942 @end table
35943
35944 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35945 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35946 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35947 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35948 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35949 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35950 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35951
35952 @table @samp
35953
35954 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35955 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35956 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35957
35958 @end table
35959
35960 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35961 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35962 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35963 target, is not defined.}
35964
35965 Reply:
35966 @table @samp
35967 @item OK
35968 success
35969 @item @w{}
35970 not supported
35971 @item E @var{NN}
35972 for an error
35973 @end table
35974
35975 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35976 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35977 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35978 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35979 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35980 address @var{addr}.
35981
35982 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35983 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
35984 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
35985 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35986
35987 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35988 movement.}
35989
35990 Reply:
35991 @table @samp
35992 @item OK
35993 success
35994 @item @w{}
35995 not supported
35996 @item E @var{NN}
35997 for an error
35998 @end table
35999
36000 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36001 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36002 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
36003 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36004 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36005 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36006
36007 Reply:
36008 @table @samp
36009 @item OK
36010 success
36011 @item @w{}
36012 not supported
36013 @item E @var{NN}
36014 for an error
36015 @end table
36016
36017 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36018 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36019 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
36020 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36021 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36022 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36023
36024 Reply:
36025 @table @samp
36026 @item OK
36027 success
36028 @item @w{}
36029 not supported
36030 @item E @var{NN}
36031 for an error
36032 @end table
36033
36034 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36035 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36036 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
36037 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36038 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36039 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36040
36041 Reply:
36042 @table @samp
36043 @item OK
36044 success
36045 @item @w{}
36046 not supported
36047 @item E @var{NN}
36048 for an error
36049 @end table
36050
36051 @end table
36052
36053 @node Stop Reply Packets
36054 @section Stop Reply Packets
36055 @cindex stop reply packets
36056
36057 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36058 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36059 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36060 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36061 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36062 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36063 @value{GDBN} source code.
36064
36065 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36066 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36067 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36068
36069 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36070 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36071 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36072 components.
36073
36074 @table @samp
36075
36076 @item S @var{AA}
36077 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36078 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36079 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36080
36081 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36082 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36083 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36084 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36085 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36086 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36087 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36088 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36089
36090 @itemize @bullet
36091 @item
36092 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36093 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36094 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36095 two-digit hex number.
36096
36097 @item
36098 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36099 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36100
36101 @item
36102 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36103 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36104
36105 @item
36106 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36107 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36108 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36109 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36110
36111 @item
36112 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36113 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36114 future.
36115 @end itemize
36116
36117 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36118
36119 @table @samp
36120 @item watch
36121 @itemx rwatch
36122 @itemx awatch
36123 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36124 hex.
36125
36126 @item syscall_entry
36127 @itemx syscall_return
36128 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36129 syscall number, in hex.
36130
36131 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36132 @item library
36133 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36134 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36135 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36136
36137 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36138 @item replaylog
36139 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36140 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36141 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36142 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36143 for more information.
36144
36145 @item swbreak
36146 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36147 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36148 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36149 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36150 part must be left empty.
36151
36152 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36153 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36154 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36155 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36156 address.
36157
36158 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36159 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36160 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36161 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36162 indicating support.
36163
36164 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36165
36166 @item hwbreak
36167 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36168 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36169
36170 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36171 apply.
36172
36173 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36174 @item fork
36175 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36176 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36177 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36178 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36179 fork events.
36180
36181 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36182 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36183 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36184 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36185 indicating support.
36186
36187 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36188 @item vfork
36189 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36190 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36191 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36192 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36193 vfork events.
36194
36195 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36196 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36197 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36198 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36199 indicating support.
36200
36201 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36202 @item vforkdone
36203 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36204 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36205 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36206 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36207 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36208
36209 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36210 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36211 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36212 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36213 indicating support.
36214
36215 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36216 @item exec
36217 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36218 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36219 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36220
36221 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36222 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36223 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36224 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36225 indicating support.
36226
36227 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36228 @anchor{thread create event}
36229 @item create
36230 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36231 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36232 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36233 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36234 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36235 @var{r} part is ignored.
36236
36237 @end table
36238
36239 @item W @var{AA}
36240 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36241 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36242 applicable to certain targets.
36243
36244 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36245 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36246 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36247 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36248 hex strings.
36249
36250 @item X @var{AA}
36251 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36252 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36253
36254 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36255 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36256 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36257 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36258 hex strings.
36259
36260 @anchor{thread exit event}
36261 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36262 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36263
36264 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36265 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36266 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36267 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36268
36269 @item N
36270 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36271 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36272 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36273 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36274 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36275 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36276 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36277 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36278 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36279 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36280 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36281 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36282 support.
36283
36284 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36285 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36286 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36287 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36288 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36289
36290 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36291 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36292 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36293 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36294 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36295 system calls.
36296
36297 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36298 this very system call.
36299
36300 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36301 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36302 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36303 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36304 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36305 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36306
36307 @end table
36308
36309 @node General Query Packets
36310 @section General Query Packets
36311 @cindex remote query requests
36312
36313 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36314 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36315 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36316 sending information to and from the stub.
36317
36318 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36319 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36320 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36321 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36322 conventions:
36323
36324 @itemize @bullet
36325 @item
36326 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36327 @item
36328 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36329 letter.
36330 @item
36331 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36332 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36333 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36334 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36335 @end itemize
36336
36337 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36338 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36339 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36340 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36341 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36342 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36343 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36344 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36345 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36346 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36347 packet.}.
36348
36349 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36350 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36351 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36352 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36353 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36354
36355 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36356
36357 @table @samp
36358
36359 @item QAgent:1
36360 @itemx QAgent:0
36361 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36362 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36363
36364 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36365 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36366 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36367 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36368 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36369 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36370 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36371 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36372 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36373 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36374 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36375
36376 @item qC
36377 @cindex current thread, remote request
36378 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36379 Return the current thread ID.
36380
36381 Reply:
36382 @table @samp
36383 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36384 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36385 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36386 @item @r{(anything else)}
36387 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36388 @end table
36389
36390 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36391 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36392 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36393 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36394 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36395 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36396 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36397 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36398
36399 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36400 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36401 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36402 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36403 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36404 detect trailing zeros.
36405
36406 Reply:
36407 @table @samp
36408 @item E @var{NN}
36409 An error (such as memory fault)
36410 @item C @var{crc32}
36411 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36412 @end table
36413
36414 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36415 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36416 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36417 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36418 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36419 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36420 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36421 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36422 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36423 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36424 randomization.
36425
36426 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36427
36428 Reply:
36429 @table @samp
36430 @item OK
36431 The request succeeded.
36432
36433 @item E @var{nn}
36434 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36435
36436 @item @w{}
36437 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36438 by the stub.
36439 @end table
36440
36441 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36442 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36443 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36444 address space randomization.
36445
36446 @item qfThreadInfo
36447 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36448 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36449 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36450 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36451 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36452 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36453 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36454 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36455 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36456 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36457
36458 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36459
36460 Reply:
36461 @table @samp
36462 @item m @var{thread-id}
36463 A single thread ID
36464 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36465 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36466 @item l
36467 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36468 @end table
36469
36470 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36471 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36472 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36473 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36474 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36475 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36476 fields.
36477
36478 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36479 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36480 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36481 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36482 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36483
36484 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36485 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36486 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36487 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36488 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36489
36490 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36491 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36492
36493 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36494 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36495 information associated with the variable.)
36496
36497 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36498 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36499 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36500 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36501 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36502 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36503
36504 Reply:
36505 @table @samp
36506 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36507 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36508 local storage requested.
36509
36510 @item E @var{nn}
36511 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36512
36513 @item @w{}
36514 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36515 @end table
36516
36517 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36518 @cindex get thread information block address
36519 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36520 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36521
36522 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36523
36524 Reply:
36525 @table @samp
36526 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36527 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36528 thread information block.
36529
36530 @item E @var{nn}
36531 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36532 address could not be retrieved.
36533
36534 @item @w{}
36535 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36536 @end table
36537
36538 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36539 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36540 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36541 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36542 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36543 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36544 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36545
36546 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36547
36548 Reply:
36549 @table @samp
36550 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36551 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36552 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36553 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36554 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36555 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36556 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36557 @end table
36558
36559 @item qOffsets
36560 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36561 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36562 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36563 image.
36564
36565 Reply:
36566 @table @samp
36567 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36568 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36569 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36570 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36571 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36572 segments by the supplied offsets.
36573
36574 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36575 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36576 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36577
36578 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36579 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36580 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36581 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36582 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36583 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36584 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36585 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36586 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36587 @end table
36588
36589 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36590 @cindex thread information, remote request
36591 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36592 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36593 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36594 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36595
36596 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36597 (see below).
36598
36599 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36600
36601 @item QNonStop:1
36602 @itemx QNonStop:0
36603 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36604 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36605 @anchor{QNonStop}
36606 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36607 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36608
36609 Reply:
36610 @table @samp
36611 @item OK
36612 The request succeeded.
36613
36614 @item E @var{nn}
36615 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36616
36617 @item @w{}
36618 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36619 the stub.
36620 @end table
36621
36622 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36623 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36624 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36625 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36626
36627 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36628 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36629 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36630 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36631 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36632 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36633 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36634
36635 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36636 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36637 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36638
36639 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36640 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36641 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36642 report the requested syscalls.
36643
36644 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36645 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36646
36647 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36648 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36649 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36650 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36651
36652 Reply:
36653 @table @samp
36654 @item OK
36655 The request succeeded.
36656
36657 @item E @var{nn}
36658 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36659
36660 @item @w{}
36661 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36662 the stub.
36663 @end table
36664
36665 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36666 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36667 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36668 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36669
36670 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36671 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36672 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36673 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36674 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36675 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36676 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36677 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36678 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36679 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36680 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36681 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36682 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36683
36684 Reply:
36685 @table @samp
36686 @item OK
36687 The request succeeded.
36688
36689 @item E @var{nn}
36690 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36691
36692 @item @w{}
36693 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36694 the stub.
36695 @end table
36696
36697 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36698 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36699 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36700 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36701
36702 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36703 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36704 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36705 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36706 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36707 Others should be silently discarded.
36708
36709 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36710 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36711 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36712 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36713 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36714 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36715 signals.
36716
36717 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36718 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36719
36720 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36721 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36722 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36723 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36724 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36725
36726 Reply:
36727 @table @samp
36728 @item OK
36729 The request succeeded.
36730
36731 @item E @var{nn}
36732 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36733
36734 @item @w{}
36735 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36736 by the stub.
36737 @end table
36738
36739 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36740 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36741 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36742 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36743
36744 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36745 @item QThreadEvents:1
36746 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36747 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36748 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36749
36750 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36751 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36752 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36753 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36754 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36755 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36756 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36757 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36758 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36759 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36760
36761 Reply:
36762 @table @samp
36763 @item OK
36764 The request succeeded.
36765
36766 @item E @var{nn}
36767 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36768
36769 @item @w{}
36770 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36771 the stub.
36772 @end table
36773
36774 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36775 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36776
36777 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36778 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36779 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36780 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36781 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36782 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36783 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36784 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36785 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36786
36787 Reply:
36788 @table @samp
36789 @item OK
36790 A command response with no output.
36791 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36792 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36793 @item E @var{NN}
36794 Indicate a badly formed request.
36795 @item @w{}
36796 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36797 @end table
36798
36799 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36800 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36801 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36802 packets.)
36803
36804 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36805 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36806 @ifnotinfo
36807 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36808 @end ifnotinfo
36809 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36810 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36811 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36812 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36813 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36814
36815 Reply:
36816 @table @samp
36817 @item 0
36818 The pattern was not found.
36819 @item 1,address
36820 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36821 @item E @var{NN}
36822 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36823 @item @w{}
36824 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36825 @end table
36826
36827 @item QStartNoAckMode
36828 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36829 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36830 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36831 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36832
36833 Reply:
36834 @table @samp
36835 @item OK
36836 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36837 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36838 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36839 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36840 @item @w{}
36841 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36842 @end table
36843
36844 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36845 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36846 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36847 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36848 @anchor{qSupported}
36849 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36850 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36851 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36852 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36853 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36854 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36855 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36856 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36857 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36858 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36859 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36860 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36861 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36862 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36863
36864 Reply:
36865 @table @samp
36866 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36867 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36868 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36869 possible forms).
36870 @item @w{}
36871 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36872 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36873 @end table
36874
36875 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36876 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36877 are:
36878
36879 @table @samp
36880 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36881 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36882 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36883 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36884 @item @var{name}+
36885 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36886 need an associated value.
36887 @item @var{name}-
36888 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36889 @item @var{name}?
36890 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36891 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36892 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36893 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36894 @end table
36895
36896 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36897 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36898 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36899 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36900 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36901
36902 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36903 are defined:
36904
36905 @table @samp
36906 @item multiprocess
36907 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36908 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36909 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36910 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36911 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36912
36913 @item xmlRegisters
36914 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36915 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36916 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36917 description.
36918
36919 @item qRelocInsn
36920 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36921 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36922 instruction reply packet}).
36923
36924 @item swbreak
36925 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36926 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36927
36928 @item hwbreak
36929 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36930 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36931
36932 @item fork-events
36933 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36934 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36935 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36936 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36937
36938 @item vfork-events
36939 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36940 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36941 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36942 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36943
36944 @item exec-events
36945 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36946 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36947 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36948 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36949
36950 @item vContSupported
36951 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36952 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36953 @end table
36954
36955 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36956 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36957 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36958 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36959 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36960 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36961 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36962 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36963 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36964 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36965 all the features it supports.
36966
36967 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36968 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36969
36970 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36971 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36972 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36973 form response.
36974
36975 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36976 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36977 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36978 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36979
36980 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36981 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36982 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36983 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36984 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36985
36986 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36987
36988 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36989 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36990 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36991 @item Feature Name
36992 @tab Value Required
36993 @tab Default
36994 @tab Probe Allowed
36995
36996 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36997 @tab Yes
36998 @tab @samp{-}
36999 @tab No
37000
37001 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
37002 @tab No
37003 @tab @samp{-}
37004 @tab Yes
37005
37006 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37007 @tab No
37008 @tab @samp{-}
37009 @tab Yes
37010
37011 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37012 @tab No
37013 @tab @samp{-}
37014 @tab Yes
37015
37016 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
37017 @tab No
37018 @tab @samp{-}
37019 @tab Yes
37020
37021 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
37022 @tab No
37023 @tab @samp{-}
37024 @tab Yes
37025
37026 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37027 @tab No
37028 @tab @samp{-}
37029 @tab Yes
37030
37031 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
37032 @tab No
37033 @tab @samp{-}
37034 @tab Yes
37035
37036 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
37037 @tab No
37038 @tab @samp{-}
37039 @tab No
37040
37041 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37042 @tab No
37043 @tab @samp{-}
37044 @tab Yes
37045
37046 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
37047 @tab No
37048 @tab @samp{-}
37049 @tab Yes
37050
37051 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
37052 @tab No
37053 @tab @samp{-}
37054 @tab Yes
37055
37056 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
37057 @tab No
37058 @tab @samp{-}
37059 @tab Yes
37060
37061 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
37062 @tab No
37063 @tab @samp{-}
37064 @tab Yes
37065
37066 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
37067 @tab No
37068 @tab @samp{-}
37069 @tab Yes
37070
37071 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
37072 @tab No
37073 @tab @samp{-}
37074 @tab Yes
37075
37076 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37077 @tab No
37078 @tab @samp{-}
37079 @tab Yes
37080
37081 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37082 @tab No
37083 @tab @samp{-}
37084 @tab Yes
37085
37086 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37087 @tab No
37088 @tab @samp{-}
37089 @tab Yes
37090
37091 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37092 @tab Yes
37093 @tab @samp{-}
37094 @tab Yes
37095
37096 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37097 @tab Yes
37098 @tab @samp{-}
37099 @tab Yes
37100
37101 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37102 @tab Yes
37103 @tab @samp{-}
37104 @tab Yes
37105
37106 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
37107 @tab Yes
37108 @tab @samp{-}
37109 @tab Yes
37110
37111 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
37112 @tab Yes
37113 @tab @samp{-}
37114 @tab Yes
37115
37116 @item @samp{QNonStop}
37117 @tab No
37118 @tab @samp{-}
37119 @tab Yes
37120
37121 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37122 @tab No
37123 @tab @samp{-}
37124 @tab Yes
37125
37126 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
37127 @tab No
37128 @tab @samp{-}
37129 @tab Yes
37130
37131 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37132 @tab No
37133 @tab @samp{-}
37134 @tab Yes
37135
37136 @item @samp{multiprocess}
37137 @tab No
37138 @tab @samp{-}
37139 @tab No
37140
37141 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37142 @tab No
37143 @tab @samp{-}
37144 @tab No
37145
37146 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37147 @tab No
37148 @tab @samp{-}
37149 @tab No
37150
37151 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37152 @tab No
37153 @tab @samp{-}
37154 @tab No
37155
37156 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
37157 @tab No
37158 @tab @samp{-}
37159 @tab No
37160
37161 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
37162 @tab No
37163 @tab @samp{-}
37164 @tab No
37165
37166 @item @samp{QAgent}
37167 @tab No
37168 @tab @samp{-}
37169 @tab No
37170
37171 @item @samp{QAllow}
37172 @tab No
37173 @tab @samp{-}
37174 @tab No
37175
37176 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37177 @tab No
37178 @tab @samp{-}
37179 @tab No
37180
37181 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37182 @tab No
37183 @tab @samp{-}
37184 @tab No
37185
37186 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37187 @tab No
37188 @tab @samp{-}
37189 @tab No
37190
37191 @item @samp{tracenz}
37192 @tab No
37193 @tab @samp{-}
37194 @tab No
37195
37196 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37197 @tab No
37198 @tab @samp{-}
37199 @tab No
37200
37201 @item @samp{swbreak}
37202 @tab No
37203 @tab @samp{-}
37204 @tab No
37205
37206 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37207 @tab No
37208 @tab @samp{-}
37209 @tab No
37210
37211 @item @samp{fork-events}
37212 @tab No
37213 @tab @samp{-}
37214 @tab No
37215
37216 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37217 @tab No
37218 @tab @samp{-}
37219 @tab No
37220
37221 @item @samp{exec-events}
37222 @tab No
37223 @tab @samp{-}
37224 @tab No
37225
37226 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37227 @tab No
37228 @tab @samp{-}
37229 @tab No
37230
37231 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37232 @tab No
37233 @tab @samp{-}
37234 @tab No
37235
37236 @end multitable
37237
37238 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37239
37240 @table @samp
37241 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37242 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37243 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37244 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37245 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37246 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37247 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37248 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37249 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37250 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37251
37252 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37253 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37254 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37255
37256 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37257 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37258 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37259
37260 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37261 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37262 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37263
37264 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37265 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37266 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37267
37268 @item qXfer:features:read
37269 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37270 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37271
37272 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37273 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37274 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37275
37276 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37277 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37278 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37279
37280 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37281 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37282 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37283 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37284
37285 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37286 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37287 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37288
37289 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37290 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37291 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37292
37293 @item qXfer:spu:read
37294 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37295 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37296
37297 @item qXfer:spu:write
37298 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37299 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37300
37301 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37302 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37303 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37304
37305 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37306 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37307 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37308
37309 @item qXfer:threads:read
37310 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37311 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37312
37313 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37314 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37315 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37316
37317 @item qXfer:uib:read
37318 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37319 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37320
37321 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37322 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37323 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37324
37325 @item QNonStop
37326 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37327 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37328
37329 @item QCatchSyscalls
37330 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37331 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37332
37333 @item QPassSignals
37334 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37335 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37336
37337 @item QStartNoAckMode
37338 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37339 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37340
37341 @item multiprocess
37342 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37343 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37344 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37345 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37346 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37347 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37348 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37349 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37350 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37351 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37352 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37353
37354 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37355 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37356 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37357
37358 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37359 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37360 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37361 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37362
37363 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37364 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37365 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37366
37367 @item ReverseContinue
37368 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37369 (@pxref{bc}).
37370
37371 @item ReverseStep
37372 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37373 (@pxref{bs}).
37374
37375 @item TracepointSource
37376 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37377 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37378
37379 @item QAgent
37380 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37381
37382 @item QAllow
37383 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37384
37385 @item QDisableRandomization
37386 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37387
37388 @item StaticTracepoint
37389 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37390 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37391
37392 @item InstallInTrace
37393 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37394 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37395
37396 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37397 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37398 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37399 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37400
37401 @item QTBuffer:size
37402 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37403 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37404
37405 @item tracenz
37406 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37407 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37408 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37409
37410 @item BreakpointCommands
37411 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37412 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37413 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37414
37415 @item Qbtrace:off
37416 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37417
37418 @item Qbtrace:bts
37419 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37420
37421 @item Qbtrace:pt
37422 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37423
37424 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37425 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37426
37427 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37428 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37429
37430 @item swbreak
37431 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37432 breakpoints.
37433
37434 @item hwbreak
37435 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37436 breakpoints.
37437
37438 @item fork-events
37439 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37440
37441 @item vfork-events
37442 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37443 and vforkdone events.
37444
37445 @item exec-events
37446 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37447
37448 @item vContSupported
37449 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37450 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37451
37452 @item QThreadEvents
37453 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37454
37455 @item no-resumed
37456 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37457
37458 @end table
37459
37460 @item qSymbol::
37461 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37462 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37463 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37464 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37465
37466 Reply:
37467 @table @samp
37468 @item OK
37469 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37470 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37471 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37472 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37473 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37474 below.
37475 @end table
37476
37477 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37478 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37479
37480 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37481 target has previously requested.
37482
37483 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37484 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37485 will be empty.
37486
37487 Reply:
37488 @table @samp
37489 @item OK
37490 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37491 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37492 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37493 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37494 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37495 @end table
37496
37497 @item qTBuffer
37498 @itemx QTBuffer
37499 @itemx QTDisconnected
37500 @itemx QTDP
37501 @itemx QTDPsrc
37502 @itemx QTDV
37503 @itemx qTfP
37504 @itemx qTfV
37505 @itemx QTFrame
37506 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37507
37508 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37509
37510 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37511 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37512 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37513 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37514 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37515 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37516 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37517 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37518 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37519 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37520 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37521
37522 Reply:
37523 @table @samp
37524 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37525 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37526 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37527 the thread's attributes.
37528 @end table
37529
37530 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37531 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37532 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37533 packets.)
37534
37535 @item QTNotes
37536 @itemx qTP
37537 @itemx QTSave
37538 @itemx qTsP
37539 @itemx qTsV
37540 @itemx QTStart
37541 @itemx QTStop
37542 @itemx QTEnable
37543 @itemx QTDisable
37544 @itemx QTinit
37545 @itemx QTro
37546 @itemx qTStatus
37547 @itemx qTV
37548 @itemx qTfSTM
37549 @itemx qTsSTM
37550 @itemx qTSTMat
37551 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37552
37553 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37554 @cindex read special object, remote request
37555 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37556 @anchor{qXfer read}
37557 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37558 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37559 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37560 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37561 additional details about what data to access.
37562
37563 Reply:
37564 @table @samp
37565 @item m @var{data}
37566 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37567 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37568 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37569 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37570 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37571 request.
37572
37573 @item l @var{data}
37574 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37575 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37576 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37577
37578 @item l
37579 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37580 There is no more data to be read.
37581
37582 @item E00
37583 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37584
37585 @item E @var{nn}
37586 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37587 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37588
37589 @item @w{}
37590 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37591 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37592 @end table
37593
37594 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37595 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37596 formats, listed above.
37597
37598 @table @samp
37599 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37600 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37601 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37602 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37603
37604 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37605 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37606
37607 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37608 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37609
37610 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37611 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37612 packet may have one of the following values:
37613
37614 @table @code
37615 @item all
37616 Returns all available branch trace.
37617
37618 @item new
37619 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37620 the last read request.
37621
37622 @item delta
37623 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37624 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37625 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37626 used to stitch traces together.
37627
37628 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37629 @end table
37630
37631 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37632 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37633
37634 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37635 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37636
37637 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37638 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37639
37640 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37641 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37642
37643 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37644 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37645 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37646 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37647 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37648 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37649 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37650
37651 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37652 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37653
37654 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37655 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37656 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37657 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37658 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37659
37660 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37661 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37662
37663 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37664 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37665 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37666 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37667 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37668
37669 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37670 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37671 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37672
37673 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37674 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37675
37676 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37677 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37678 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37679 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37680 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37681 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37682 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37683 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37684
37685 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37686 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37687
37688 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37689 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37690
37691 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37692 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37693 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37694 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37695
37696 @table @code
37697 @item start=@var{address}
37698 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37699 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37700 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37701 chosen as the starting point.
37702
37703 @item prev=@var{address}
37704 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37705 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37706 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37707 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37708 exists prior to the starting point.
37709
37710 @end table
37711
37712 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37713 ignored.
37714
37715 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37716 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37717 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37718 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37719 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37720
37721 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37722 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37723
37724 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37725 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37726
37727 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37728 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37729 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37730 Action Lists}.
37731
37732 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37733 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37734 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37735
37736 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37737 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37738 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37739 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37740 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37741
37742 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37743 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37744 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37745
37746 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37747 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37748 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37749 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37750 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37751 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37752 in that context to be accessed.
37753
37754 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37755 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37756 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37757
37758 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37759 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37760 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37761 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37762 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37763
37764 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37765 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37766
37767 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37768 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37769
37770 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37771 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37772 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37773
37774 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37775 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37776
37777 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37778 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37779
37780 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37781 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37782
37783 This packet is not probed by default.
37784
37785 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37786 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37787 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37788 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37789 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37790
37791 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37792 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37793
37794 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37795 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37796 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37797 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37798
37799 @end table
37800
37801 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37802 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37803 @anchor{qXfer write}
37804 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37805 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37806 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37807 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37808 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37809 to access.
37810
37811 Reply:
37812 @table @samp
37813 @item @var{nn}
37814 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37815 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37816
37817 @item E00
37818 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37819
37820 @item E @var{nn}
37821 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37822 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37823
37824 @item @w{}
37825 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37826 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37827 @end table
37828
37829 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37830 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37831 formats, listed above.
37832
37833 @table @samp
37834 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37835 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37836 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37837 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37838 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37839
37840 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37841 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37842 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37843
37844 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37845 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37846 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37847 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37848 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37849 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37850 in that context to be accessed.
37851
37852 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37853 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37854 @end table
37855
37856 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37857 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37858 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37859 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37860 must respond with an empty packet.
37861
37862 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37863 @cindex query attached, remote request
37864 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37865 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37866 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37867 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37868 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37869 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37870 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37871
37872 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37873 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37874 the @code{quit} command.
37875
37876 Reply:
37877 @table @samp
37878 @item 1
37879 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37880 @item 0
37881 The remote server created a new process.
37882 @item E @var{NN}
37883 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37884 @end table
37885
37886 @item Qbtrace:bts
37887 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37888
37889 Reply:
37890 @table @samp
37891 @item OK
37892 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37893 @item E.errtext
37894 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37895 @end table
37896
37897 @item Qbtrace:pt
37898 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37899
37900 Reply:
37901 @table @samp
37902 @item OK
37903 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37904 @item E.errtext
37905 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37906 @end table
37907
37908 @item Qbtrace:off
37909 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37910
37911 Reply:
37912 @table @samp
37913 @item OK
37914 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37915 @item E.errtext
37916 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37917 @end table
37918
37919 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37920 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37921 btrace recording method in bts format.
37922
37923 Reply:
37924 @table @samp
37925 @item OK
37926 The ring buffer size has been set.
37927 @item E.errtext
37928 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37929 @end table
37930
37931 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37932 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37933 btrace recording method in pt format.
37934
37935 Reply:
37936 @table @samp
37937 @item OK
37938 The ring buffer size has been set.
37939 @item E.errtext
37940 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37941 @end table
37942
37943 @end table
37944
37945 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37946 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37947
37948 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37949 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37950 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37951
37952 @menu
37953 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37954 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37955 @end menu
37956
37957 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37958 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37959
37960 @menu
37961 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37962 @end menu
37963
37964 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37965 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37966 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37967
37968 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37969
37970 @table @r
37971
37972 @item 2
37973 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37974
37975 @item 3
37976 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37977
37978 @item 4
37979 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37980
37981 @end table
37982
37983 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37984 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37985
37986 @menu
37987 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37988 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37989 @end menu
37990
37991 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37992 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37993 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37994
37995 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37996 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37997 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37998 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37999 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
38000 most-significant -- least-significant.
38001
38002 @table @r
38003
38004 @item MIPS32
38005 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
38006 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
38007 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
38008
38009 @item MIPS64
38010 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
38011 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
38012 as @code{MIPS32}.
38013
38014 @end table
38015
38016 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
38017 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
38018 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
38019
38020 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38021
38022 @table @r
38023
38024 @item 2
38025 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
38026
38027 @item 3
38028 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38029
38030 @item 4
38031 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
38032
38033 @item 5
38034 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38035
38036 @end table
38037
38038 @node Tracepoint Packets
38039 @section Tracepoint Packets
38040 @cindex tracepoint packets
38041 @cindex packets, tracepoint
38042
38043 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
38044 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
38045
38046 @table @samp
38047
38048 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
38049 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
38050 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
38051 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
38052 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
38053 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
38054 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
38055 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
38056 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
38057 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
38058 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
38059 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
38060 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
38061 actions.
38062
38063 Replies:
38064 @table @samp
38065 @item OK
38066 The packet was understood and carried out.
38067 @item qRelocInsn
38068 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38069 @item @w{}
38070 The packet was not recognized.
38071 @end table
38072
38073 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38074 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
38075 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38076 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
38077 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
38078 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38079 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38080
38081 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38082 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
38083 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38084 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38085 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
38086 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38087 tracepoint actions.
38088
38089 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38090 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
38091 following forms:
38092
38093 @table @samp
38094
38095 @item R @var{mask}
38096 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38097 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38098 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
38099 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38100 not fit in a 32-bit word.
38101
38102 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38103 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38104 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
38105 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
38106 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
38107 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
38108 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
38109
38110 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38111 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
38112 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
38113 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
38114 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
38115 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
38116 packet).
38117
38118 @end table
38119
38120 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38121 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38122 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
38123 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38124 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38125 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
38126 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38127 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38128
38129 Replies:
38130 @table @samp
38131 @item OK
38132 The packet was understood and carried out.
38133 @item qRelocInsn
38134 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38135 @item @w{}
38136 The packet was not recognized.
38137 @end table
38138
38139 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38140 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38141 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38142 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38143 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
38144 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38145 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38146 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38147
38148 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38149 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38150 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38151 fit in a single packet.
38152 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38153 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
38154
38155 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38156 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38157 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38158 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38159
38160 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38161 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38162 query packets.
38163
38164 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38165 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38166 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38167 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38168 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38169 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38170 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38171 be found.
38172
38173 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38174 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38175 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38176 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38177 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38178 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38179 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38180 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38181 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38182 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38183 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38184 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38185 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38186 variable.
38187
38188 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
38189 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38190 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38191 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38192 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38193
38194 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38195 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38196 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38197 one of the following forms:
38198
38199 @table @samp
38200 @item F @var{f}
38201 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38202 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38203 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38204
38205 @item T @var{t}
38206 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38207 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38208
38209 @end table
38210
38211 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38212 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38213 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38214 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38215
38216 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38217 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38218 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38219 is a hexadecimal number.
38220
38221 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38222 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38223 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38224 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38225 numbers.
38226
38227 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38228 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38229 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38230
38231 @item qTMinFTPILen
38232 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38233 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38234 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38235 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38236 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38237 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38238 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38239 arrange for that.
38240
38241 Replies:
38242
38243 @table @samp
38244 @item 0
38245 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38246 @item @var{length}
38247 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38248 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38249 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38250 regardless of size.
38251 @item E
38252 An error has occurred.
38253 @item @w{}
38254 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38255 @end table
38256
38257 @item QTStart
38258 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38259 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38260 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38261 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38262 instruction reply packet}).
38263
38264 @item QTStop
38265 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38266 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38267
38268 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38269 @anchor{QTEnable}
38270 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38271 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38272 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38273 of data from it will resume.
38274
38275 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38276 @anchor{QTDisable}
38277 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38278 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38279 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38280 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38281
38282 @item QTinit
38283 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38284 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38285
38286 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38287 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38288 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38289 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38290 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38291
38292 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38293 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38294 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38295 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38296
38297 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38298 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38299 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38300 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38301 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38302 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38303
38304 @item qTStatus
38305 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38306 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38307
38308 The reply has the form:
38309
38310 @table @samp
38311
38312 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38313 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38314 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38315 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38316
38317 @end table
38318
38319 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38320 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38321
38322 @table @samp
38323
38324 @item tnotrun:0
38325 No trace has been run yet.
38326
38327 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38328 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38329 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38330 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38331 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38332
38333 @item tfull:0
38334 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38335
38336 @item tdisconnected:0
38337 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38338
38339 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38340 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38341
38342 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38343 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38344 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38345 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38346 is hex encoded.
38347
38348 @item tunknown:0
38349 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38350
38351 @end table
38352
38353 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38354 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38355 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38356 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38357 trace.
38358
38359 @table @samp
38360
38361 @item tframes:@var{n}
38362 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38363
38364 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38365 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38366 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38367
38368 @item tsize:@var{n}
38369 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38370
38371 @item tfree:@var{n}
38372 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38373
38374 @item circular:@var{n}
38375 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38376 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38377 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38378 and may fill up.
38379
38380 @item disconn:@var{n}
38381 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38382 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38383 that the trace run will stop.
38384
38385 @end table
38386
38387 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38388 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38389 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38390 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38391 address @var{addr}.
38392
38393 Replies:
38394 @table @samp
38395 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38396 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38397 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38398 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38399 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38400
38401 @end table
38402
38403 @item qTV:@var{var}
38404 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38405 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38406 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38407
38408 Replies:
38409 @table @samp
38410 @item V@var{value}
38411 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38412 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38413 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38414 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38415 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38416 program is running.
38417
38418 @item U
38419 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38420 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38421 was not collected.
38422 @end table
38423
38424 @item qTfP
38425 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38426 @itemx qTsP
38427 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38428 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38429 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38430 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38431 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38432 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38433
38434 @item qTfV
38435 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38436 @itemx qTsV
38437 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38438 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38439 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38440 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38441 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38442 trace state variables.
38443
38444 @item qTfSTM
38445 @itemx qTsSTM
38446 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38447 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38448 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38449 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38450 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38451 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38452 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38453 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38454
38455 Reply:
38456 @table @samp
38457 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38458 A single marker
38459 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38460 a comma-separated list of markers
38461 @item l
38462 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38463 @item E @var{nn}
38464 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38465 @item @w{}
38466 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38467 stub.
38468 @end table
38469
38470 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38471 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38472
38473 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38474 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38475 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38476 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38477 @dfn{last}).
38478
38479 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38480 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38481 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38482 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38483 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38484 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38485 tracepoint markers.
38486
38487 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38488 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38489 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38490 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38491 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38492 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38493
38494 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38495 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38496 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38497 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38498 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38499 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38500 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38501 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38502 available.
38503
38504 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38505 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38506 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38507
38508 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38509 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38510 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38511 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38512 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38513 use whatever size it prefers.
38514
38515 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38516 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38517 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38518 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38519 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38520
38521 @end table
38522
38523 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38524 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38525 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38526 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38527 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38528 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38529 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38530 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38531 it had executed in the original location.
38532
38533 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38534 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38535 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38536 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38537 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38538 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38539 format of the request is:
38540
38541 @table @samp
38542 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38543
38544 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38545 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38546 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38547 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38548 memory starting at @var{to}.
38549 @end table
38550
38551 Replies:
38552 @table @samp
38553 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38554 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38555 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38556 @item E @var{NN}
38557 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38558 relocating the instruction.
38559 @end table
38560
38561 @node Host I/O Packets
38562 @section Host I/O Packets
38563 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38564 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38565
38566 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38567 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38568 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38569 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38570 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38571 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38572 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38573 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38574 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38575 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38576
38577 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38578 its arguments. They have this format:
38579
38580 @table @samp
38581
38582 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38583 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38584 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38585 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38586 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38587 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38588 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38589 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38590 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38591
38592 @end table
38593
38594 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38595
38596 @table @samp
38597
38598 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38599 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38600 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38601 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38602 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38603 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38604 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38605 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38606 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38607 @var{attachment}.
38608
38609 @item @w{}
38610 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38611
38612 @end table
38613
38614 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38615
38616 @table @samp
38617 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38618 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38619 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38620 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38621 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38622 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38623 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38624
38625 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38626 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38627 -1 if an error occurs.
38628
38629 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38630 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38631 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38632 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38633 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38634 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38635 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38636 @var{count} was zero.
38637
38638 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38639 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38640 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38641 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38642 some characters were escaped.
38643
38644 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38645 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38646 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38647 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38648 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38649 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38650 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38651 error occurred.
38652
38653 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38654 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38655 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38656 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38657 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38658 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38659
38660 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38661 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38662 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38663
38664 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38665 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38666 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38667
38668 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38669 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38670 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38671 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38672 some characters were escaped.
38673
38674 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38675 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38676 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38677 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38678 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38679 inferior(s).
38680
38681 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38682 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38683 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38684 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38685 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38686 operation.
38687
38688 @end table
38689
38690 @node Interrupts
38691 @section Interrupts
38692 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38693 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38694
38695 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38696 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38697 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38698 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38699
38700 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38701 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38702 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38703 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38704 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38705
38706 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38707 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38708 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38709 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38710 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38711 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38712 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38713 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38714
38715 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38716 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38717 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38718
38719 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38720 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38721 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38722 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38723 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38724 @code{0x03}.
38725
38726 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38727 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38728 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38729 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38730 currently-executing threads and processes.
38731 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38732 running program, it should send one of the stop
38733 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38734 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38735 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38736 Interrupts received while the
38737 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38738 it is resumed next time.
38739
38740 @node Notification Packets
38741 @section Notification Packets
38742 @cindex notification packets
38743 @cindex packets, notification
38744
38745 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38746 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38747 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38748 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38749 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38750 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38751 is not a problem.
38752
38753 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38754 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38755 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38756 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38757 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38758 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38759 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38760
38761 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38762 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38763
38764 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38765 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38766 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38767 not they understand it.
38768
38769 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38770 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38771 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38772 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38773 recipients.
38774
38775 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38776 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38777 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38778 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38779 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38780
38781 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38782 @table @samp
38783 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38784 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38785 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38786 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38787 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38788 @item @var{ack}
38789 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38790 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38791 @end table
38792
38793 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38794 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38795
38796 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38797 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38798 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38799 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38800 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38801 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38802 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38803 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38804 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38805 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38806
38807 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38808 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38809 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38810 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38811 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38812 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38813
38814 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38815 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38816 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38817 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38818 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38819
38820 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38821 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38822 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38823 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38824 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38825 normally.
38826
38827 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38828 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38829 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38830 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38831 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38832 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38833 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38834 the process shall be repeated.
38835
38836 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38837 following example:
38838 @smallexample
38839 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38840 @code{...}
38841 -> @code{vStopped}
38842 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38843 -> @code{vStopped}
38844 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38845 -> @code{vStopped}
38846 <- @code{OK}
38847 @end smallexample
38848
38849 The following notifications are defined:
38850 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38851
38852 @item Notification
38853 @tab Ack
38854 @tab Event
38855 @tab Description
38856
38857 @item Stop
38858 @tab vStopped
38859 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38860 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38861 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38862 @value{GDBN}.
38863 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38864
38865 @end multitable
38866
38867 @node Remote Non-Stop
38868 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38869
38870 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38871 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38872 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38873 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38874
38875 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38876 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38877 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38878 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38879 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38880 probe the target state after a mode change.
38881
38882 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38883 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38884 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38885 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38886 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38887 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38888 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38889 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38890 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38891 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38892 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38893
38894 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38895 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38896 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38897 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38898 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38899 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38900 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38901 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38902 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38903 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38904 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38905 @samp{OK}.
38906
38907 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38908 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38909 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38910 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38911 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38912 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38913 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38914 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38915 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38916 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38917 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38918 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38919 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38920
38921 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38922 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38923
38924 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38925 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38926 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38927 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38928 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38929 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38930 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38931
38932 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38933 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38934 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38935 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38936 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38937
38938 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38939 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38940 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38941 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38942
38943 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38944 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38945 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38946 @pxref{qSupported}.
38947 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38948 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38949 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38950 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38951 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38952 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38953 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38954
38955 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38956 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38957 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38958 connection.
38959 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38960 new connection is established,
38961 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38962 for the current connection, once disabled.
38963
38964 @node Examples
38965 @section Examples
38966
38967 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38968 does not get any direct output:
38969
38970 @smallexample
38971 -> @code{R00}
38972 <- @code{+}
38973 @emph{target restarts}
38974 -> @code{?}
38975 <- @code{+}
38976 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38977 -> @code{+}
38978 @end smallexample
38979
38980 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38981
38982 @smallexample
38983 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38984 <- @code{+}
38985 -> @code{s}
38986 <- @code{+}
38987 @emph{time passes}
38988 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38989 -> @code{+}
38990 -> @code{g}
38991 <- @code{+}
38992 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38993 -> @code{+}
38994 @end smallexample
38995
38996 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38997 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38998 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38999
39000 @menu
39001 * File-I/O Overview::
39002 * Protocol Basics::
39003 * The F Request Packet::
39004 * The F Reply Packet::
39005 * The Ctrl-C Message::
39006 * Console I/O::
39007 * List of Supported Calls::
39008 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
39009 * Constants::
39010 * File-I/O Examples::
39011 @end menu
39012
39013 @node File-I/O Overview
39014 @subsection File-I/O Overview
39015 @cindex file-i/o overview
39016
39017 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
39018 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
39019 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
39020 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
39021 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
39022 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
39023
39024 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
39025 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
39026 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
39027 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
39028 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
39029
39030 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
39031 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39032 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
39033 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
39034 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
39035 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
39036 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
39037
39038 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
39039 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
39040 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
39041 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
39042 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
39043
39044 @smallexample
39045 (@value{GDBP}) continue
39046 <- target requests 'system call X'
39047 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
39048 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
39049 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
39050 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
39051 @end smallexample
39052
39053 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
39054 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
39055 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
39056 system are not supported by this protocol.
39057
39058 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
39059
39060 @node Protocol Basics
39061 @subsection Protocol Basics
39062 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
39063
39064 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
39065 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
39066 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
39067 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
39068 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
39069 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
39070 to call the appropriate host system call:
39071
39072 @itemize @bullet
39073 @item
39074 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39075
39076 @item
39077 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
39078 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
39079 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
39080 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39081
39082 @end itemize
39083
39084 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39085
39086 @itemize @bullet
39087 @item
39088 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39089 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39090 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
39091 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39092 packet.
39093
39094 @item
39095 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39096 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39097
39098 @item
39099 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39100
39101 @item
39102 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39103
39104 @item
39105 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
39106 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
39107 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
39108 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
39109 packet.
39110
39111 @end itemize
39112
39113 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
39114 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
39115
39116 @itemize @bullet
39117 @item
39118 Return value.
39119
39120 @item
39121 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39122
39123 @item
39124 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39125
39126 @end itemize
39127
39128 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39129 the latest continue or step action.
39130
39131 @node The F Request Packet
39132 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39133 @cindex file-i/o request packet
39134 @cindex @code{F} request packet
39135
39136 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39137
39138 @table @samp
39139 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39140
39141 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39142 This is just the name of the function.
39143
39144 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39145 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39146 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39147 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39148 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39149 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39150 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39151
39152 @end table
39153
39154
39155
39156 @node The F Reply Packet
39157 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39158 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
39159 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
39160
39161 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39162
39163 @table @samp
39164
39165 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39166
39167 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39168
39169 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39170 representation.
39171 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39172
39173 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39174 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39175 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39176
39177 @smallexample
39178 F0,0,C
39179 @end smallexample
39180
39181 @noindent
39182 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39183
39184 @smallexample
39185 F-1,4,C
39186 @end smallexample
39187
39188 @noindent
39189 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39190
39191 @end table
39192
39193
39194 @node The Ctrl-C Message
39195 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39196 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39197
39198 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39199 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39200 the target should behave as if it had
39201 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39202 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39203 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39204 packet.
39205
39206 It's important for the target to know in which
39207 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39208
39209 @itemize @bullet
39210 @item
39211 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39212
39213 @item
39214 The system call on the host has been finished.
39215
39216 @end itemize
39217
39218 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39219 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39220 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39221 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39222 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39223 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39224
39225 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39226 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39227 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39228 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39229 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39230 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39231 or the full action has been completed.
39232
39233 @node Console I/O
39234 @subsection Console I/O
39235 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39236
39237 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39238 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39239 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39240 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39241 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39242 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39243 conditions is met:
39244
39245 @itemize @bullet
39246 @item
39247 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39248 @code{read}
39249 system call is treated as finished.
39250
39251 @item
39252 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39253 newline.
39254
39255 @item
39256 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39257 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39258
39259 @end itemize
39260
39261 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39262 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39263 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39264 is stopped at the user's request.
39265
39266
39267 @node List of Supported Calls
39268 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39269 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39270
39271 @menu
39272 * open::
39273 * close::
39274 * read::
39275 * write::
39276 * lseek::
39277 * rename::
39278 * unlink::
39279 * stat/fstat::
39280 * gettimeofday::
39281 * isatty::
39282 * system::
39283 @end menu
39284
39285 @node open
39286 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39287 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39288
39289 @table @asis
39290 @item Synopsis:
39291 @smallexample
39292 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39293 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39294 @end smallexample
39295
39296 @item Request:
39297 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39298
39299 @noindent
39300 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39301
39302 @table @code
39303 @item O_CREAT
39304 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39305 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39306 are concerned.
39307
39308 @item O_EXCL
39309 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39310 an error and open() fails.
39311
39312 @item O_TRUNC
39313 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39314 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39315 truncated to zero length.
39316
39317 @item O_APPEND
39318 The file is opened in append mode.
39319
39320 @item O_RDONLY
39321 The file is opened for reading only.
39322
39323 @item O_WRONLY
39324 The file is opened for writing only.
39325
39326 @item O_RDWR
39327 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39328 @end table
39329
39330 @noindent
39331 Other bits are silently ignored.
39332
39333
39334 @noindent
39335 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39336
39337 @table @code
39338 @item S_IRUSR
39339 User has read permission.
39340
39341 @item S_IWUSR
39342 User has write permission.
39343
39344 @item S_IRGRP
39345 Group has read permission.
39346
39347 @item S_IWGRP
39348 Group has write permission.
39349
39350 @item S_IROTH
39351 Others have read permission.
39352
39353 @item S_IWOTH
39354 Others have write permission.
39355 @end table
39356
39357 @noindent
39358 Other bits are silently ignored.
39359
39360
39361 @item Return value:
39362 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39363 occurred.
39364
39365 @item Errors:
39366
39367 @table @code
39368 @item EEXIST
39369 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39370
39371 @item EISDIR
39372 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39373
39374 @item EACCES
39375 The requested access is not allowed.
39376
39377 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39378 @var{pathname} was too long.
39379
39380 @item ENOENT
39381 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39382
39383 @item ENODEV
39384 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39385
39386 @item EROFS
39387 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39388 write access was requested.
39389
39390 @item EFAULT
39391 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39392
39393 @item ENOSPC
39394 No space on device to create the file.
39395
39396 @item EMFILE
39397 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39398
39399 @item ENFILE
39400 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39401 has been reached.
39402
39403 @item EINTR
39404 The call was interrupted by the user.
39405 @end table
39406
39407 @end table
39408
39409 @node close
39410 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39411 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39412
39413 @table @asis
39414 @item Synopsis:
39415 @smallexample
39416 int close(int fd);
39417 @end smallexample
39418
39419 @item Request:
39420 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39421
39422 @item Return value:
39423 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39424
39425 @item Errors:
39426
39427 @table @code
39428 @item EBADF
39429 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39430
39431 @item EINTR
39432 The call was interrupted by the user.
39433 @end table
39434
39435 @end table
39436
39437 @node read
39438 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39439 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39440
39441 @table @asis
39442 @item Synopsis:
39443 @smallexample
39444 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39445 @end smallexample
39446
39447 @item Request:
39448 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39449
39450 @item Return value:
39451 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39452 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39453 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39454
39455 @item Errors:
39456
39457 @table @code
39458 @item EBADF
39459 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39460 reading.
39461
39462 @item EFAULT
39463 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39464
39465 @item EINTR
39466 The call was interrupted by the user.
39467 @end table
39468
39469 @end table
39470
39471 @node write
39472 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39473 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39474
39475 @table @asis
39476 @item Synopsis:
39477 @smallexample
39478 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39479 @end smallexample
39480
39481 @item Request:
39482 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39483
39484 @item Return value:
39485 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39486 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39487 is returned.
39488
39489 @item Errors:
39490
39491 @table @code
39492 @item EBADF
39493 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39494 writing.
39495
39496 @item EFAULT
39497 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39498
39499 @item EFBIG
39500 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39501 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39502
39503 @item ENOSPC
39504 No space on device to write the data.
39505
39506 @item EINTR
39507 The call was interrupted by the user.
39508 @end table
39509
39510 @end table
39511
39512 @node lseek
39513 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39514 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39515
39516 @table @asis
39517 @item Synopsis:
39518 @smallexample
39519 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39520 @end smallexample
39521
39522 @item Request:
39523 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39524
39525 @var{flag} is one of:
39526
39527 @table @code
39528 @item SEEK_SET
39529 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39530
39531 @item SEEK_CUR
39532 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39533 bytes.
39534
39535 @item SEEK_END
39536 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39537 bytes.
39538 @end table
39539
39540 @item Return value:
39541 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39542 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39543 value of -1 is returned.
39544
39545 @item Errors:
39546
39547 @table @code
39548 @item EBADF
39549 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39550
39551 @item ESPIPE
39552 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39553
39554 @item EINVAL
39555 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39556
39557 @item EINTR
39558 The call was interrupted by the user.
39559 @end table
39560
39561 @end table
39562
39563 @node rename
39564 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39565 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39566
39567 @table @asis
39568 @item Synopsis:
39569 @smallexample
39570 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39571 @end smallexample
39572
39573 @item Request:
39574 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39575
39576 @item Return value:
39577 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39578
39579 @item Errors:
39580
39581 @table @code
39582 @item EISDIR
39583 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39584 directory.
39585
39586 @item EEXIST
39587 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39588
39589 @item EBUSY
39590 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39591 process.
39592
39593 @item EINVAL
39594 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39595 of itself.
39596
39597 @item ENOTDIR
39598 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39599 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39600 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39601
39602 @item EFAULT
39603 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39604
39605 @item EACCES
39606 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39607
39608 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39609
39610 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39611
39612 @item ENOENT
39613 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39614
39615 @item EROFS
39616 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39617
39618 @item ENOSPC
39619 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39620 directory entry.
39621
39622 @item EINTR
39623 The call was interrupted by the user.
39624 @end table
39625
39626 @end table
39627
39628 @node unlink
39629 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39630 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39631
39632 @table @asis
39633 @item Synopsis:
39634 @smallexample
39635 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39636 @end smallexample
39637
39638 @item Request:
39639 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39640
39641 @item Return value:
39642 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39643
39644 @item Errors:
39645
39646 @table @code
39647 @item EACCES
39648 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39649
39650 @item EPERM
39651 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39652
39653 @item EBUSY
39654 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39655 being used by another process.
39656
39657 @item EFAULT
39658 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39659
39660 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39661 @var{pathname} was too long.
39662
39663 @item ENOENT
39664 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39665
39666 @item ENOTDIR
39667 A component of the path is not a directory.
39668
39669 @item EROFS
39670 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39671
39672 @item EINTR
39673 The call was interrupted by the user.
39674 @end table
39675
39676 @end table
39677
39678 @node stat/fstat
39679 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39680 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39681 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39682
39683 @table @asis
39684 @item Synopsis:
39685 @smallexample
39686 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39687 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39688 @end smallexample
39689
39690 @item Request:
39691 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39692 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39693
39694 @item Return value:
39695 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39696
39697 @item Errors:
39698
39699 @table @code
39700 @item EBADF
39701 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39702
39703 @item ENOENT
39704 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39705 path is an empty string.
39706
39707 @item ENOTDIR
39708 A component of the path is not a directory.
39709
39710 @item EFAULT
39711 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39712
39713 @item EACCES
39714 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39715
39716 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39717 @var{pathname} was too long.
39718
39719 @item EINTR
39720 The call was interrupted by the user.
39721 @end table
39722
39723 @end table
39724
39725 @node gettimeofday
39726 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39727 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39728
39729 @table @asis
39730 @item Synopsis:
39731 @smallexample
39732 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39733 @end smallexample
39734
39735 @item Request:
39736 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39737
39738 @item Return value:
39739 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39740
39741 @item Errors:
39742
39743 @table @code
39744 @item EINVAL
39745 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39746
39747 @item EFAULT
39748 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39749 @end table
39750
39751 @end table
39752
39753 @node isatty
39754 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39755 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39756
39757 @table @asis
39758 @item Synopsis:
39759 @smallexample
39760 int isatty(int fd);
39761 @end smallexample
39762
39763 @item Request:
39764 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39765
39766 @item Return value:
39767 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39768
39769 @item Errors:
39770
39771 @table @code
39772 @item EINTR
39773 The call was interrupted by the user.
39774 @end table
39775
39776 @end table
39777
39778 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39779 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39780 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39781 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39782 needed.
39783
39784
39785 @node system
39786 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39787 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39788
39789 @table @asis
39790 @item Synopsis:
39791 @smallexample
39792 int system(const char *command);
39793 @end smallexample
39794
39795 @item Request:
39796 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39797
39798 @item Return value:
39799 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39800 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39801 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39802 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39803 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39804 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39805 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39806
39807 @item Errors:
39808
39809 @table @code
39810 @item EINTR
39811 The call was interrupted by the user.
39812 @end table
39813
39814 @end table
39815
39816 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39817 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39818 the host is simplified before it's returned
39819 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39820 is discarded, and the return value consists
39821 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39822
39823 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39824 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39825 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39826
39827 @table @code
39828 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39829 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39830 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39831 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39832
39833 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39834 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39835 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39836 protocol.
39837 @end table
39838
39839 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39840 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39841 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39842
39843 @menu
39844 * Integral Datatypes::
39845 * Pointer Values::
39846 * Memory Transfer::
39847 * struct stat::
39848 * struct timeval::
39849 @end menu
39850
39851 @node Integral Datatypes
39852 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39853 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39854
39855 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39856 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39857 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39858
39859 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39860 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39861
39862 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39863
39864 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39865 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39866
39867 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39868
39869 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39870 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39871 byte order.
39872
39873 @node Pointer Values
39874 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39875 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39876
39877 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39878 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39879 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39880 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39881
39882 @smallexample
39883 @code{1aaf/12}
39884 @end smallexample
39885
39886 @noindent
39887 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39888 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39889 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39890 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39891
39892 @smallexample
39893 @code{123456/d}
39894 @end smallexample
39895
39896 @node Memory Transfer
39897 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39898 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39899
39900 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39901 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39902 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39903 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39904 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39905 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39906 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39907
39908
39909 @node struct stat
39910 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39911 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39912
39913 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39914 is defined as follows:
39915
39916 @smallexample
39917 struct stat @{
39918 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39919 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39920 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39921 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39922 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39923 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39924 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39925 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39926 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39927 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39928 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39929 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39930 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39931 @};
39932 @end smallexample
39933
39934 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39935 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39936 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39937
39938 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39939 range of values.
39940
39941 @table @code
39942
39943 @item st_dev
39944 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39945
39946 @item st_ino
39947 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39948
39949 @item st_mode
39950 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39951 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39952
39953 @item st_uid
39954 @itemx st_gid
39955 @itemx st_rdev
39956 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39957
39958 @item st_atime
39959 @itemx st_mtime
39960 @itemx st_ctime
39961 These values have a host and file system dependent
39962 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39963 support exact timing values.
39964 @end table
39965
39966 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39967 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39968 continuing.
39969
39970 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39971 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39972 get truncated on the target.
39973
39974 @node struct timeval
39975 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39976 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39977
39978 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39979 is defined as follows:
39980
39981 @smallexample
39982 struct timeval @{
39983 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39984 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39985 @};
39986 @end smallexample
39987
39988 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39989 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39990 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39991
39992 @node Constants
39993 @subsection Constants
39994 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39995
39996 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39997 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39998 values before and after the call as needed.
39999
40000 @menu
40001 * Open Flags::
40002 * mode_t Values::
40003 * Errno Values::
40004 * Lseek Flags::
40005 * Limits::
40006 @end menu
40007
40008 @node Open Flags
40009 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
40010 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
40011
40012 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
40013
40014 @smallexample
40015 O_RDONLY 0x0
40016 O_WRONLY 0x1
40017 O_RDWR 0x2
40018 O_APPEND 0x8
40019 O_CREAT 0x200
40020 O_TRUNC 0x400
40021 O_EXCL 0x800
40022 @end smallexample
40023
40024 @node mode_t Values
40025 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
40026 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
40027
40028 All values are given in octal representation.
40029
40030 @smallexample
40031 S_IFREG 0100000
40032 S_IFDIR 040000
40033 S_IRUSR 0400
40034 S_IWUSR 0200
40035 S_IXUSR 0100
40036 S_IRGRP 040
40037 S_IWGRP 020
40038 S_IXGRP 010
40039 S_IROTH 04
40040 S_IWOTH 02
40041 S_IXOTH 01
40042 @end smallexample
40043
40044 @node Errno Values
40045 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
40046 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
40047
40048 All values are given in decimal representation.
40049
40050 @smallexample
40051 EPERM 1
40052 ENOENT 2
40053 EINTR 4
40054 EBADF 9
40055 EACCES 13
40056 EFAULT 14
40057 EBUSY 16
40058 EEXIST 17
40059 ENODEV 19
40060 ENOTDIR 20
40061 EISDIR 21
40062 EINVAL 22
40063 ENFILE 23
40064 EMFILE 24
40065 EFBIG 27
40066 ENOSPC 28
40067 ESPIPE 29
40068 EROFS 30
40069 ENAMETOOLONG 91
40070 EUNKNOWN 9999
40071 @end smallexample
40072
40073 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40074 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40075
40076 @node Lseek Flags
40077 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40078 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40079
40080 @smallexample
40081 SEEK_SET 0
40082 SEEK_CUR 1
40083 SEEK_END 2
40084 @end smallexample
40085
40086 @node Limits
40087 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40088 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40089
40090 All values are given in decimal representation.
40091
40092 @smallexample
40093 INT_MIN -2147483648
40094 INT_MAX 2147483647
40095 UINT_MAX 4294967295
40096 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
40097 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
40098 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
40099 @end smallexample
40100
40101 @node File-I/O Examples
40102 @subsection File-I/O Examples
40103 @cindex file-i/o examples
40104
40105 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40106 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
40107
40108 @smallexample
40109 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
40110 @emph{request memory read from target}
40111 -> @code{m1234,6}
40112 <- XXXXXX
40113 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
40114 -> @code{F6}
40115 @end smallexample
40116
40117 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40118 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40119
40120 @smallexample
40121 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40122 @emph{request memory write to target}
40123 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40124 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40125 -> @code{F6}
40126 @end smallexample
40127
40128 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40129 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40130
40131 @smallexample
40132 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40133 -> @code{F-1,9}
40134 @end smallexample
40135
40136 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40137 host is called:
40138
40139 @smallexample
40140 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40141 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
40142 <- @code{T02}
40143 @end smallexample
40144
40145 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40146 host is called:
40147
40148 @smallexample
40149 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40150 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40151 <- @code{T02}
40152 @end smallexample
40153
40154 @node Library List Format
40155 @section Library List Format
40156 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40157
40158 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40159 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40160 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40161 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40162 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40163 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40164 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40165 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40166 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40167 are loaded.
40168
40169 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40170 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40171 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40172 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40173
40174 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40175 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40176 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40177 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40178 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40179 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40180
40181 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40182 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40183
40184 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40185 offset, looks like this:
40186
40187 @smallexample
40188 <library-list>
40189 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40190 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40191 </library>
40192 </library-list>
40193 @end smallexample
40194
40195 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40196 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40197
40198 @smallexample
40199 <library-list>
40200 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40201 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40202 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40203 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40204 </library>
40205 </library-list>
40206 @end smallexample
40207
40208 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40209
40210 @smallexample
40211 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40212 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40213 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40214 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40215 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40216 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40217 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40218 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40219 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40220 @end smallexample
40221
40222 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40223 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40224 section for each library.
40225
40226 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40227 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40228 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40229
40230 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40231 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40232 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40233 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40234
40235 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40236 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40237 target, the following parameters are reported:
40238
40239 @itemize @minus
40240 @item
40241 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40242 @code{struct link_map}.
40243 @item
40244 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40245 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40246 @item
40247 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40248 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40249 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40250 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40251 @item
40252 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40253 @end itemize
40254
40255 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40256 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40257 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40258
40259 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40260 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40261
40262 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40263 looks like this:
40264
40265 @smallexample
40266 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40267 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40268 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40269 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40270 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40271 </library-list-svr>
40272 @end smallexample
40273
40274 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40275
40276 @smallexample
40277 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40278 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40279 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40280 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40281 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40282 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40283 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40284 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40285 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40286 @end smallexample
40287
40288 @node Memory Map Format
40289 @section Memory Map Format
40290 @cindex memory map format
40291
40292 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40293 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40294 memory map.
40295
40296 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40297 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40298 lists memory regions.
40299
40300 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40301 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40302
40303 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40304
40305 @smallexample
40306 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40307 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40308 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40309 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40310 <memory-map>
40311 region...
40312 </memory-map>
40313 @end smallexample
40314
40315 Each region can be either:
40316
40317 @itemize
40318
40319 @item
40320 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40321 bytes from there:
40322
40323 @smallexample
40324 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40325 @end smallexample
40326
40327
40328 @item
40329 A region of read-only memory:
40330
40331 @smallexample
40332 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40333 @end smallexample
40334
40335
40336 @item
40337 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40338 bytes in length:
40339
40340 @smallexample
40341 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40342 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40343 </memory>
40344 @end smallexample
40345
40346 @end itemize
40347
40348 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40349 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40350 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40351
40352 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40353
40354 @smallexample
40355 <!-- ................................................... -->
40356 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40357 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40358 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40359 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40360 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40361 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40362 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40363 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40364 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40365 and its type, or device. -->
40366 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40367 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40368 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40369 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40370 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40371 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40372 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40373 @end smallexample
40374
40375 @node Thread List Format
40376 @section Thread List Format
40377 @cindex thread list format
40378
40379 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40380 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40381 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40382 the following structure:
40383
40384 @smallexample
40385 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40386 <threads>
40387 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40388 ... description ...
40389 </thread>
40390 </threads>
40391 @end smallexample
40392
40393 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40394 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40395 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40396 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40397 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40398 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40399 auxiliary information.
40400
40401 @node Traceframe Info Format
40402 @section Traceframe Info Format
40403 @cindex traceframe info format
40404
40405 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40406 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40407 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40408 collected in a traceframe.
40409
40410 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40411 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40412
40413 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40414 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40415
40416 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40417
40418 @smallexample
40419 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40420 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40421 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40422 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40423 <traceframe-info>
40424 block...
40425 </traceframe-info>
40426 @end smallexample
40427
40428 Each traceframe block can be either:
40429
40430 @itemize
40431
40432 @item
40433 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40434 @var{length} bytes from there:
40435
40436 @smallexample
40437 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40438 @end smallexample
40439
40440 @item
40441 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40442 collected:
40443
40444 @smallexample
40445 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40446 @end smallexample
40447
40448 @end itemize
40449
40450 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40451
40452 @smallexample
40453 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40454 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40455
40456 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40457 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40458 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40459 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40460 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40461 @end smallexample
40462
40463 @node Branch Trace Format
40464 @section Branch Trace Format
40465 @cindex branch trace format
40466
40467 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40468 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40469 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40470 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40471
40472 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40473 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40474
40475 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40476 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40477
40478 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40479
40480 @smallexample
40481 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40482 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40483 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40484 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40485 <btrace>
40486 block...
40487 </btrace>
40488 @end smallexample
40489
40490 @itemize
40491
40492 @item
40493 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40494 and ending at @var{end}:
40495
40496 @smallexample
40497 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40498 @end smallexample
40499
40500 @end itemize
40501
40502 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40503
40504 @smallexample
40505 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40506 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40507
40508 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40509 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40510 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40511
40512 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40513
40514 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40515
40516 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40517 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40518 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40519 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40520 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40521
40522 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40523 @end smallexample
40524
40525 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40526 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40527 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40528
40529 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40530 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40531 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40532
40533 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40534 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40535
40536 @table @code
40537 @item bts
40538 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40539 @table @code
40540 @item size
40541 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40542 @end table
40543 @item pt
40544 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40545 PT}) format.
40546 @table @code
40547 @item size
40548 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40549 @end table
40550 @end table
40551
40552 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40553 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40554
40555 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40556
40557 @smallexample
40558 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40559 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40560
40561 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40562 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40563
40564 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40565 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40566 @end smallexample
40567
40568 @include agentexpr.texi
40569
40570 @node Target Descriptions
40571 @appendix Target Descriptions
40572 @cindex target descriptions
40573
40574 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40575 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40576 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40577 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40578 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40579 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40580 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40581
40582 @itemize @bullet
40583 @item
40584 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40585 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40586 @item
40587 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40588 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40589 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40590 @item
40591 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40592 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40593 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40594 @end itemize
40595
40596 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40597 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40598 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40599 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40600 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40601
40602 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40603 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40604
40605 @menu
40606 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40607 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40608 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40609 descriptions.
40610 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
40611 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40612 @end menu
40613
40614 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40615 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40616
40617 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40618 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40619 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40620 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40621 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40622 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40623 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40624 Format}.
40625
40626 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40627 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40628 specify a file are:
40629
40630 @table @code
40631 @cindex set tdesc filename
40632 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40633 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40634
40635 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40636 @item unset tdesc filename
40637 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40638 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40639
40640 @cindex show tdesc filename
40641 @item show tdesc filename
40642 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40643 @end table
40644
40645
40646 @node Target Description Format
40647 @section Target Description Format
40648 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40649
40650 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40651 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40652 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40653 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40654 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40655 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40656 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40657
40658 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40659 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40660 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40661 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40662 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40663
40664 Here is a simple target description:
40665
40666 @smallexample
40667 <target version="1.0">
40668 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40669 </target>
40670 @end smallexample
40671
40672 @noindent
40673 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40674 the x86-64 architecture.
40675
40676 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40677 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40678 are explained further below.
40679
40680 @smallexample
40681 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40682 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40683 <target version="1.0">
40684 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40685 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40686 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40687 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40688 </target>
40689 @end smallexample
40690
40691 @noindent
40692 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40693 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40694 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40695 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40696 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40697 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40698 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40699 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40700 the version mismatch.
40701
40702 @subsection Inclusion
40703 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40704 @cindex XInclude
40705 @ifnotinfo
40706 @cindex <xi:include>
40707 @end ifnotinfo
40708
40709 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40710 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40711 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40712 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40713 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40714
40715 @smallexample
40716 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40717 @end smallexample
40718
40719 @noindent
40720 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40721 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40722 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40723 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40724 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40725 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40726 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40727 original description.
40728
40729 @subsection Architecture
40730 @cindex <architecture>
40731
40732 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40733
40734 @smallexample
40735 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40736 @end smallexample
40737
40738 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40739 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40740
40741 @subsection OS ABI
40742 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40743
40744 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40745 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40746
40747 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40748
40749 @smallexample
40750 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40751 @end smallexample
40752
40753 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40754 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40755
40756 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40757 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40758
40759 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40760 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40761
40762 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40763
40764 @smallexample
40765 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40766 @end smallexample
40767
40768 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40769 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40770
40771 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40772 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40773 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40774 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40775 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40776 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40777 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40778
40779 @smallexample
40780 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40781 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40782 @end smallexample
40783
40784 @subsection Features
40785 @cindex <feature>
40786
40787 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40788 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40789 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40790 has this form:
40791
40792 @smallexample
40793 <feature name="@var{name}">
40794 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40795 @var{reg}@dots{}
40796 </feature>
40797 @end smallexample
40798
40799 @noindent
40800 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40801 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40802 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40803 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40804
40805 @subsection Types
40806
40807 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40808 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40809 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40810 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40811 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
40812 and enum types.
40813
40814 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40815 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40816 Types must be defined before they are used.
40817
40818 @cindex <vector>
40819 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40820 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40821 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40822 @var{count}:
40823
40824 @smallexample
40825 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40826 @end smallexample
40827
40828 @cindex <union>
40829 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40830 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40831 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40832 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40833
40834 @smallexample
40835 <union id="@var{id}">
40836 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40837 @dots{}
40838 </union>
40839 @end smallexample
40840
40841 @cindex <struct>
40842 @cindex <flags>
40843 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40844 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
40845 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
40846 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
40847 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
40848 specified.
40849
40850 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
40851
40852 @smallexample
40853 <struct id="@var{id}">
40854 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40855 @dots{}
40856 </struct>
40857 @end smallexample
40858
40859 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
40860 No implicit padding is added.
40861
40862 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
40863
40864 @smallexample
40865 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40866 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40867 @dots{}
40868 </struct>
40869 @end smallexample
40870
40871 @smallexample
40872 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40873 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40874 @dots{}
40875 </flags>
40876 @end smallexample
40877
40878 The @var{name} value is required.
40879 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
40880 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
40881 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
40882
40883 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
40884 is optional.
40885 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
40886 and zero represents the least significant bit.
40887
40888 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
40889 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
40890
40891 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
40892
40893 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
40894 defining them with @samp{struct}:
40895
40896 @itemize @bullet
40897 @item
40898 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
40899 @item
40900 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
40901 @end itemize
40902
40903 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
40904 defining them with @samp{flags}:
40905
40906 @itemize @bullet
40907 @item
40908 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
40909
40910 @smallexample
40911 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
40912 $1 = 42
40913 @end smallexample
40914
40915 @end itemize
40916
40917 @subsection Registers
40918 @cindex <reg>
40919
40920 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40921
40922 @smallexample
40923 <reg name="@var{name}"
40924 bitsize="@var{size}"
40925 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40926 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40927 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40928 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40929 @end smallexample
40930
40931 @noindent
40932 The components are as follows:
40933
40934 @table @var
40935
40936 @item name
40937 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40938
40939 @item bitsize
40940 The register's size, in bits.
40941
40942 @item regnum
40943 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40944 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40945 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40946 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40947 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40948 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40949 in order of increasing register number.
40950
40951 @item save-restore
40952 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40953 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40954 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40955 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40956 ABI.
40957
40958 @item type
40959 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40960 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40961 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40962 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40963 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40964 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40965
40966 @item group
40967 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40968 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40969 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40970 in @code{info registers}.
40971
40972 @end table
40973
40974 @node Predefined Target Types
40975 @section Predefined Target Types
40976 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40977
40978 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40979 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40980 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40981 types. The currently supported types are:
40982
40983 @table @code
40984
40985 @item bool
40986 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
40987
40988 @item int8
40989 @itemx int16
40990 @itemx int32
40991 @itemx int64
40992 @itemx int128
40993 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40994
40995 @item uint8
40996 @itemx uint16
40997 @itemx uint32
40998 @itemx uint64
40999 @itemx uint128
41000 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41001
41002 @item code_ptr
41003 @itemx data_ptr
41004 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
41005 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
41006 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
41007 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
41008 may be marked as data pointers.
41009
41010 @item ieee_single
41011 Single precision IEEE floating point.
41012
41013 @item ieee_double
41014 Double precision IEEE floating point.
41015
41016 @item arm_fpa_ext
41017 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
41018
41019 @item i387_ext
41020 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
41021
41022 @item i386_eflags
41023 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
41024
41025 @item i386_mxcsr
41026 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
41027
41028 @end table
41029
41030 @node Enum Target Types
41031 @section Enum Target Types
41032 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
41033
41034 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
41035 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
41036
41037 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
41038
41039 @smallexample
41040 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41041 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
41042 @dots{}
41043 </enum>
41044 @end smallexample
41045
41046 Enums must be defined before they are used.
41047
41048 @smallexample
41049 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
41050 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
41051 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
41052 </enum>
41053 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
41054 <field name="X" start="0"/>
41055 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
41056 </flags>
41057 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
41058 @end smallexample
41059
41060 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
41061 would be printed as:
41062
41063 @smallexample
41064 (gdb) info register flags
41065 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
41066 @end smallexample
41067
41068 @node Standard Target Features
41069 @section Standard Target Features
41070 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
41071
41072 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41073 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
41074 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41075 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
41076 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41077 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41078 can recognize them.
41079
41080 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41081 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
41082 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41083 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41084 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41085 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
41086 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41087 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41088
41089 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41090 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41091 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41092
41093 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41094 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41095 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41096 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41097
41098 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41099 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41100 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
41101
41102 @menu
41103 * AArch64 Features::
41104 * ARC Features::
41105 * ARM Features::
41106 * i386 Features::
41107 * MicroBlaze Features::
41108 * MIPS Features::
41109 * M68K Features::
41110 * NDS32 Features::
41111 * Nios II Features::
41112 * PowerPC Features::
41113 * S/390 and System z Features::
41114 * Sparc Features::
41115 * TIC6x Features::
41116 @end menu
41117
41118
41119 @node AArch64 Features
41120 @subsection AArch64 Features
41121 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41122
41123 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41124 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41125 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41126
41127 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41128 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41129 and @samp{fpcr}.
41130
41131 @node ARC Features
41132 @subsection ARC Features
41133 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41134
41135 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41136 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
41137 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
41138 that one of the core registers features is present.
41139 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41140
41141 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41142 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41143 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41144 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41145 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41146 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41147 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41148
41149 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41150 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41151 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41152 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41153 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41154 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41155
41156 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41157 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41158 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41159 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41160 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41161 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41162 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41163 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41164 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41165 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41166
41167 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41168 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41169
41170 @node ARM Features
41171 @subsection ARM Features
41172 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41173
41174 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41175 ARM targets.
41176 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41177 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41178
41179 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41180 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41181 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41182 and @samp{xpsr}.
41183
41184 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41185 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41186
41187 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41188 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41189 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41190 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41191
41192 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41193 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41194 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41195 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41196 halves of the double-precision registers.
41197
41198 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41199 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41200 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41201 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41202 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41203 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41204
41205 @node i386 Features
41206 @subsection i386 Features
41207 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41208
41209 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41210 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41211
41212 @itemize @minus
41213 @item
41214 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41215 @item
41216 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41217 @item
41218 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41219 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41220 @item
41221 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41222 @item
41223 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41224 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41225 @end itemize
41226
41227 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41228
41229 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41230 describe registers:
41231
41232 @itemize @minus
41233 @item
41234 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41235 @item
41236 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41237 @item
41238 @samp{mxcsr}
41239 @end itemize
41240
41241 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41242 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41243 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41244
41245 @itemize @minus
41246 @item
41247 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41248 @item
41249 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41250 @end itemize
41251
41252 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41253 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41254
41255 @itemize @minus
41256 @item
41257 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41258 @item
41259 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41260 @end itemize
41261
41262 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41263 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41264
41265 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
41266 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
41267
41268 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41269 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41270 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41271
41272 @itemize @minus
41273 @item
41274 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41275 @end itemize
41276
41277 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41278
41279 @itemize @minus
41280 @item
41281 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41282 @end itemize
41283
41284 It should
41285 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41286
41287 @itemize @minus
41288 @item
41289 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41290 @item
41291 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41292 @end itemize
41293
41294 It should
41295 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41296
41297 @itemize @minus
41298 @item
41299 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41300 @end itemize
41301
41302 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
41303 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
41304 valid for i386 and amd64.
41305
41306 @node MicroBlaze Features
41307 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41308 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41309
41310 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41311 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41312 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41313 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41314 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41315
41316 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41317 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41318
41319 @node MIPS Features
41320 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41321 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41322
41323 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41324 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41325 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41326 on the target.
41327
41328 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41329 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41330 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41331
41332 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41333 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41334 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41335 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41336
41337 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41338 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41339 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41340 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41341
41342 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41343 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41344 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41345
41346 @node M68K Features
41347 @subsection M68K Features
41348 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41349
41350 @table @code
41351 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41352 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41353 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41354 One of those features must be always present.
41355 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41356 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41357 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41358 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41359
41360 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41361 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41362 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41363 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41364 @end table
41365
41366 @node NDS32 Features
41367 @subsection NDS32 Features
41368 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41369
41370 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41371 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41372 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41373 and @samp{pc}.
41374
41375 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41376 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41377 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41378 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41379
41380 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41381 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41382 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41383 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41384 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41385 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41386 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41387
41388 @node Nios II Features
41389 @subsection Nios II Features
41390 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41391
41392 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41393 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41394 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41395 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41396 @samp{mpuacc}).
41397
41398 @node PowerPC Features
41399 @subsection PowerPC Features
41400 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41401
41402 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41403 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41404 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41405 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41406
41407 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41408 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41409
41410 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41411 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41412 and @samp{vrsave}.
41413
41414 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41415 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41416 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41417 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41418 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41419 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41420
41421 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41422 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41423 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41424 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41425 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41426 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41427 user.
41428
41429 @node S/390 and System z Features
41430 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41431 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41432 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41433
41434 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41435 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41436 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41437 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41438 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41439 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41440 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41441 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41442 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41443
41444 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41445 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41446 @samp{fpc}.
41447
41448 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41449 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41450
41451 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41452 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41453 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41454 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41455 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41456 32-bit wide.
41457
41458 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41459 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41460 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41461
41462 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41463 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41464 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41465 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41466 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41467 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41468 @samp{v31}.
41469
41470 @node Sparc Features
41471 @subsection Sparc Features
41472 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
41473 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
41474 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41475 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41476
41477 @itemize @minus
41478 @item
41479 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
41480 @item
41481 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
41482 @item
41483 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
41484 @item
41485 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
41486 @end itemize
41487
41488 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41489
41490 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41491 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41492
41493 @itemize @minus
41494 @item
41495 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
41496 @item
41497 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
41498 @end itemize
41499
41500 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41501 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41502
41503 @itemize @minus
41504 @item
41505 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
41506 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
41507 @item
41508 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
41509 for sparc64
41510 @end itemize
41511
41512 @node TIC6x Features
41513 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41514 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41515 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41516 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41517 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41518 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41519
41520 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41521 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41522 through @samp{B31}.
41523
41524 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41525 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41526
41527 @node Operating System Information
41528 @appendix Operating System Information
41529 @cindex operating system information
41530
41531 @menu
41532 * Process list::
41533 @end menu
41534
41535 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41536 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41537 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41538 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41539 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41540 on a different aspect of target.
41541
41542 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41543 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41544 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41545 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41546
41547 @node Process list
41548 @appendixsection Process list
41549 @cindex operating system information, process list
41550
41551 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41552 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41553 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41554 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41555
41556 An example document is:
41557
41558 @smallexample
41559 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41560 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41561 <osdata type="processes">
41562 <item>
41563 <column name="pid">1</column>
41564 <column name="user">root</column>
41565 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41566 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41567 </item>
41568 </osdata>
41569 @end smallexample
41570
41571 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41572 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41573 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41574 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41575 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41576 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41577 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41578
41579 @node Trace File Format
41580 @appendix Trace File Format
41581 @cindex trace file format
41582
41583 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41584 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41585
41586 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41587 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41588 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41589 in the future.
41590
41591 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41592 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41593 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41594 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41595 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41596 of this section.
41597
41598 @table @code
41599 @item R @var{size}
41600 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41601 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41602 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41603 a single trace file.
41604
41605 @item status @var{status}
41606 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41607 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41608 file.
41609
41610 @item tp @var{payload}
41611 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41612 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
41613 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41614 reply packets.
41615
41616 @item tsv @var{payload}
41617 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41618 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
41619 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41620 reply packets.
41621
41622 @item tdesc @var{payload}
41623 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
41624 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41625 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41626 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41627 file. Includes are not allowed.
41628
41629 @end table
41630
41631 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41632 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41633 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
41634 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41635 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41636 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41637 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41638 endianness.
41639
41640 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41641
41642 @table @code
41643 @item R @var{bytes}
41644 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41645 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
41646 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41647
41648 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41649 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41650 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41651 @var{length} bytes.
41652
41653 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
41654 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
41655 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41656
41657 @end table
41658
41659 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41660 of blocks.
41661
41662 @node Index Section Format
41663 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41664 @cindex .gdb_index section format
41665 @cindex index section format
41666
41667 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41668 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
41669 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41670 description.
41671
41672 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41673 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
41674 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41675 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41676 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
41677 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41678
41679 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41680
41681 @enumerate
41682 @item
41683 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41684 unless otherwise noted:
41685
41686 @enumerate
41687 @item
41688 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41689 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41690 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41691 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41692 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41693 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41694 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41695
41696 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41697 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41698 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41699 currently not flagged as deprecated.
41700
41701 @item
41702 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41703
41704 @item
41705 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
41706 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41707 to the next offset.
41708
41709 @item
41710 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41711
41712 @item
41713 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41714
41715 @item
41716 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41717 @end enumerate
41718
41719 @item
41720 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41721 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
41722 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
41723 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
41724 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
41725 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
41726 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41727 CU indices.
41728
41729 @item
41730 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41731 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41732 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41733 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41734
41735 @item
41736 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41737 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41738
41739 @enumerate
41740 @item
41741 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41742
41743 @item
41744 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41745 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41746
41747 @item
41748 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41749 @end enumerate
41750
41751 @item
41752 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41753 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41754
41755 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41756 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41757 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41758 constant pool.
41759
41760 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41761 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41762 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41763
41764 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41765 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41766 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41767 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41768 index version:
41769
41770 @table @asis
41771 @item Version 4
41772 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41773
41774 @item Versions 5 to 7
41775 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41776 @end table
41777
41778 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41779
41780 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41781 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41782 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41783 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41784 collision.
41785
41786 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41787 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41788 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41789 the code.
41790
41791 @item
41792 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41793 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41794 strings.
41795
41796 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41797 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41798 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41799 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41800 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41801 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41802
41803 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41804 @end enumerate
41805
41806 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41807 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41808 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41809
41810 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41811 (bit 0 = LSB):
41812
41813 @table @asis
41814
41815 @item Bits 0-23
41816 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41817 @item Bits 24-27
41818 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41819 @item Bits 28-30
41820 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41821
41822 @table @asis
41823 @item 0
41824 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41825 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41826 with previous versions of the index.
41827 @item 1
41828 The symbol is a type.
41829 @item 2
41830 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41831 @item 3
41832 The symbol is a function.
41833 @item 4
41834 Any other kind of symbol.
41835 @item 5,6,7
41836 These values are reserved.
41837 @end table
41838
41839 @item Bit 31
41840 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41841
41842 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41843 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41844 @value{GDBN} sources.
41845
41846 @end table
41847
41848 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41849 global/static attributes in the index.
41850
41851 @smallexample
41852 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41853 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41854 switch (die->tag)
41855 @{
41856 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41857 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41858 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41859 kind = TYPE;
41860 is_static = 1;
41861 break;
41862 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41863 kind = VARIABLE;
41864 is_static = language != CPLUS;
41865 break;
41866 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41867 kind = FUNCTION;
41868 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41869 break;
41870 case DW_TAG_constant:
41871 kind = VARIABLE;
41872 is_static = ! is_external;
41873 break;
41874 case DW_TAG_variable:
41875 kind = VARIABLE;
41876 is_static = ! is_external;
41877 break;
41878 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41879 kind = TYPE;
41880 is_static = 0;
41881 break;
41882 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41883 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41884 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41885 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41886 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41887 kind = TYPE;
41888 is_static = language != CPLUS;
41889 break;
41890 default:
41891 assert (0);
41892 @}
41893 @end smallexample
41894
41895 @node Man Pages
41896 @appendix Manual pages
41897 @cindex Man pages
41898
41899 @menu
41900 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41901 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41902 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41903 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41904 @end menu
41905
41906 @node gdb man
41907 @heading gdb man
41908
41909 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41910
41911 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41912 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41913 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41914 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41915 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41916 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41917 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41918 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41919 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41920 @c man end
41921
41922 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41923 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41924 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41925 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41926
41927 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41928 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41929
41930 @itemize @bullet
41931 @item
41932 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41933
41934 @item
41935 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41936
41937 @item
41938 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41939
41940 @item
41941 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41942 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41943 @end itemize
41944
41945 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41946 Modula-2.
41947
41948 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41949 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41950 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41951 by using the command @code{help}.
41952
41953 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41954 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41955 executable program as the argument:
41956
41957 @smallexample
41958 gdb program
41959 @end smallexample
41960
41961 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41962
41963 @smallexample
41964 gdb program core
41965 @end smallexample
41966
41967 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41968 to debug a running process:
41969
41970 @smallexample
41971 gdb program 1234
41972 gdb -p 1234
41973 @end smallexample
41974
41975 @noindent
41976 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41977 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41978 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41979
41980 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41981
41982 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41983 @table @env
41984 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41985 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41986
41987 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41988 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41989
41990 @item bt
41991 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41992
41993 @item print @var{expr}
41994 Display the value of an expression.
41995
41996 @item c
41997 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41998
41999 @item next
42000 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42001 function calls in the line.
42002
42003 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42004 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42005
42006 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42007 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42008
42009 @item step
42010 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42011 function calls in the line.
42012
42013 @item help [@var{name}]
42014 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42015 about using @value{GDBN}.
42016
42017 @item quit
42018 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42019 @end table
42020
42021 @ifset man
42022 For full details on @value{GDBN},
42023 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42024 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
42025 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42026 @end ifset
42027 @c man end
42028
42029 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42030 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42031 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42032 encountered with no
42033 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42034 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42035 Many options have
42036 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
42037 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42038 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
42039 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42040 more usual convention.)
42041
42042 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42043 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42044 option is used.
42045
42046 @table @env
42047 @item -help
42048 @itemx -h
42049 List all options, with brief explanations.
42050
42051 @item -symbols=@var{file}
42052 @itemx -s @var{file}
42053 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42054
42055 @item -write
42056 Enable writing into executable and core files.
42057
42058 @item -exec=@var{file}
42059 @itemx -e @var{file}
42060 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42061 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42062 dump.
42063
42064 @item -se=@var{file}
42065 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42066 file.
42067
42068 @item -core=@var{file}
42069 @itemx -c @var{file}
42070 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42071
42072 @item -command=@var{file}
42073 @itemx -x @var{file}
42074 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42075
42076 @item -ex @var{command}
42077 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42078
42079 @item -directory=@var{directory}
42080 @itemx -d @var{directory}
42081 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42082
42083 @item -nh
42084 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
42085
42086 @item -nx
42087 @itemx -n
42088 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
42089
42090 @item -quiet
42091 @itemx -q
42092 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
42093 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
42094
42095 @item -batch
42096 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
42097 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
42098 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
42099 commands in the command files.
42100
42101 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
42102 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
42103 more useful, the message
42104
42105 @smallexample
42106 Program exited normally.
42107 @end smallexample
42108
42109 @noindent
42110 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
42111 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
42112
42113 @item -cd=@var{directory}
42114 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
42115 instead of the current directory.
42116
42117 @item -fullname
42118 @itemx -f
42119 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
42120 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
42121 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
42122 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
42123 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
42124 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
42125 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
42126 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
42127
42128 @item -b @var{bps}
42129 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
42130 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
42131
42132 @item -tty=@var{device}
42133 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
42134 @end table
42135 @c man end
42136
42137 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
42138 @ifset man
42139 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42140 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42141 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42142
42143 @smallexample
42144 info gdb
42145 @end smallexample
42146
42147 @noindent
42148 should give you access to the complete manual.
42149
42150 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42151 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42152 @end ifset
42153 @c man end
42154
42155 @node gdbserver man
42156 @heading gdbserver man
42157
42158 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
42159 @format
42160 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
42161 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42162
42163 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42164
42165 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42166 @c man end
42167 @end format
42168
42169 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42170 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42171 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42172
42173 @ifclear man
42174 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42175 @end ifclear
42176 @ifset man
42177 Usage (server (target) side):
42178 @end ifset
42179
42180 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42181 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42182 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
42183 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42184
42185 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42186 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42187 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
42188
42189 @smallexample
42190 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42191 @end smallexample
42192
42193 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42194
42195 @smallexample
42196 @ifset man
42197 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42198 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42199 @end ifset
42200 @ifclear man
42201 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42202 @end ifclear
42203 @end smallexample
42204
42205 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42206 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42207 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42208
42209 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42210
42211 @smallexample
42212 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42213 @end smallexample
42214
42215 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42216 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42217 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
42218 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42219 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42220 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42221 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42222 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42223 print an error message and exit.
42224
42225 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42226 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42227
42228 @smallexample
42229 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42230 @end smallexample
42231
42232 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42233 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42234
42235 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42236 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42237 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42238 the program you want to debug.
42239
42240 @smallexample
42241 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42242 @end smallexample
42243
42244 @ifclear man
42245 @subheading Usage (host side)
42246 @end ifclear
42247 @ifset man
42248 Usage (host side):
42249 @end ifset
42250
42251 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42252 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42253 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42254 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42255 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42256 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42257 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42258 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42259 descriptor. For example:
42260
42261 @smallexample
42262 @ifset man
42263 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42264 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42265 @end ifset
42266 @ifclear man
42267 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42268 @end ifclear
42269 @end smallexample
42270
42271 @noindent
42272 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42273
42274 @smallexample
42275 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42276 @end smallexample
42277
42278 @noindent
42279 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42280 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42281 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42282 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42283 `Connection refused'.
42284
42285 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42286 described in
42287 @ifset man
42288 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42289 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42290 @end ifset
42291 @ifclear man
42292 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42293 @end ifclear
42294 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42295
42296 @smallexample
42297 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42298 @end smallexample
42299
42300 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42301 case.
42302 @c man end
42303
42304 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42305 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42306
42307 @itemize @bullet
42308
42309 @item
42310 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42311
42312 @smallexample
42313 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42314 @end smallexample
42315
42316 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42317 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42318 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42319 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42320 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42321 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42322 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42323
42324 @item
42325 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42326 program:
42327
42328 @smallexample
42329 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42330 @end smallexample
42331
42332 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42333 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42334 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42335 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42336
42337 @item
42338 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42339
42340 @smallexample
42341 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42342 @end smallexample
42343
42344 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42345 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42346 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42347 debug several processes in the same session.
42348 @end itemize
42349
42350 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42351
42352 @table @env
42353
42354 @item --help
42355 List all options, with brief explanations.
42356
42357 @item --version
42358 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42359
42360 @item --attach
42361 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42362
42363 @smallexample
42364 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42365 @end smallexample
42366
42367 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42368 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42369
42370 @item --multi
42371 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42372 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42373 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42374 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42375
42376 @smallexample
42377 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42378 @end smallexample
42379
42380 @item --debug
42381 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42382 process.
42383 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42384 the developers.
42385
42386 @item --remote-debug
42387 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42388 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42389 the developers.
42390
42391 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42392 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42393 of debugging output.
42394 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42395
42396 @item --wrapper
42397 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42398 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42399 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42400 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42401
42402 @item --once
42403 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42404 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42405 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42406 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42407
42408 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42409
42410 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42411 @c QDisableRandomization.
42412
42413 @end table
42414 @c man end
42415
42416 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42417 @ifset man
42418 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42419 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42420 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42421
42422 @smallexample
42423 info gdb
42424 @end smallexample
42425
42426 should give you access to the complete manual.
42427
42428 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42429 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42430 @end ifset
42431 @c man end
42432
42433 @node gcore man
42434 @heading gcore
42435
42436 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42437
42438 @format
42439 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42440 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42441 @c man end
42442 @end format
42443
42444 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42445 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42446 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42447 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42448 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42449 running without any change.
42450 @c man end
42451
42452 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42453 @table @env
42454 @item -o @var{filename}
42455 The optional argument
42456 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42457 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42458 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42459 @end table
42460 @c man end
42461
42462 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42463 @ifset man
42464 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42465 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42466 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42467
42468 @smallexample
42469 info gdb
42470 @end smallexample
42471
42472 @noindent
42473 should give you access to the complete manual.
42474
42475 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42476 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42477 @end ifset
42478 @c man end
42479
42480 @node gdbinit man
42481 @heading gdbinit
42482
42483 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42484
42485 @format
42486 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42487 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42488 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42489 @end ifset
42490
42491 ~/.gdbinit
42492
42493 ./.gdbinit
42494 @c man end
42495 @end format
42496
42497 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42498 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42499 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42500 described in
42501 @ifset man
42502 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42503 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42504 @end ifset
42505 @ifclear man
42506 @ref{Sequences}.
42507 @end ifclear
42508
42509 Please read more in
42510 @ifset man
42511 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42512 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42513 @end ifset
42514 @ifclear man
42515 @ref{Startup}.
42516 @end ifclear
42517
42518 @table @env
42519 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42520 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42521 @end ifset
42522 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42523 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42524 @end ifclear
42525 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42526 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42527 See more in
42528 @ifset man
42529 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42530 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42531 @end ifset
42532 @ifclear man
42533 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42534 @end ifclear
42535
42536 @item ~/.gdbinit
42537 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42538 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42539
42540 @item ./.gdbinit
42541 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42542 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42543 See more in
42544 @ifset man
42545 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42546 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42547 @end ifset
42548 @ifclear man
42549 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42550 @end ifclear
42551 @end table
42552 @c man end
42553
42554 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42555 @ifset man
42556 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42557
42558 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42559 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42560 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42561
42562 @smallexample
42563 info gdb
42564 @end smallexample
42565
42566 should give you access to the complete manual.
42567
42568 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42569 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42570 @end ifset
42571 @c man end
42572
42573 @include gpl.texi
42574
42575 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42576 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42577 @include fdl.texi
42578
42579 @node Concept Index
42580 @unnumbered Concept Index
42581
42582 @printindex cp
42583
42584 @node Command and Variable Index
42585 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42586
42587 @printindex fn
42588
42589 @tex
42590 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42591 % meantime:
42592 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42593 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42594 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42595 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42596 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42597 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42598 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42599 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42600 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42601 \page\colophon
42602 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42603 @end tex
42604
42605 @bye
This page took 1.475517 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.